S 1250AJP JLG Service English
S 1250AJP JLG Service English
Model
          1250AJP
PN - 3121171
AS/NZS
                                                                                                                    INTRODUCTION
A       GENERAL                                                        C       MAINTENANCE
    This section contains the general safety precautions which
    must be observed during maintenance of the aerial platform.
    It is of utmost importance that maintenance personnel pay          FAILURE TO COMPLY WITH SAFETY PRECAUTIONS LISTED IN THIS SECTION
    strict attention to these warnings and precautions to avoid        COULD RESULT IN MACHINE DAMAGE, PERSONNEL INJURY OR DEATH AND IS A
    possible injury to themselves or others, or damage to the          SAFETY VIOLATION.
    equipment. A maintenance program must be followed to
    ensure that the machine is safe to operate.
                                                                           • ENSURE REPLACEMENT PARTS OR COMPONENTS ARE
                                                                             IDENTICAL OR EQUIVALENT TO ORIGINAL PARTS OR
                                                                             COMPONENTS.
MODIFICATION OR ALTERATION OF AN AERIAL WORK PLATFORM SHALL BE
MADE ONLY WITH WRITTEN PERMISSION FROM THE MANUFACTURER.                   • NO SMOKING IS MANDATORY. NEVER REFUEL DURING ELEC-
                                                                             TRICAL STORMS. ENSURE THAT FUEL CAP IS CLOSED AND
    The specific precautions to be observed during maintenance               SECURE AT ALL OTHER TIMES.
    are inserted at the appropriate point in the manual. These pre-
    cautions are, for the most part, those that apply when servic-         • REMOVE ALL RINGS, WATCHES AND JEWELRY WHEN PER-
    ing hydraulic and larger machine component parts.                        FORMING ANY MAINTENANCE.
    Your safety, and that of others, is the first consideration when       • DO NOT WEAR LONG HAIR UNRESTRAINED, OR LOOSE-FIT-
    engaging in the maintenance of equipment. Always be con-                 TING CLOTHING AND NECKTIES WHICH ARE APT TO BECOME
    scious of weight. Never attempt to move heavy parts without              CAUGHT ON OR ENTANGLED IN EQUIPMENT.
    the aid of a mechanical device. Do not allow heavy objects to
    rest in an unstable position. When raising a portion of the            • OBSERVE AND OBEY ALL WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS ON
    equipment, ensure that adequate support is provided.                     MACHINE AND IN SERVICE MANUAL.
3121171                                                                                                                             A-1
   INTRODUCTION
REVISON LOG
  A-2                                          3121171
                                                                                                                                                                                       TABLE OF CONTENTS
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                         i
TABLE OF CONTENTS
ii                                                                                                                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                                                                                                                 TABLE OF CONTENTS
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                    iii
TABLE OF CONTENTS
iv                                                                                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                                                                                                                 TABLE OF CONTENTS
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                    v
TABLE OF CONTENTS
vi                                                                                                                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                                                                                                                TABLE OF CONTENTS
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                   vii
TABLE OF CONTENTS
viii                                                                                                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                                                                                                                      LIST OF FIGURES
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                            ix
LIST OF FIGURES
x                                                                                                                                                                                                   3121171
                                                                                                                                                                                        LIST OF FIGURES
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                               xi
 LIST OF FIGURES
xii                                                                                                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                                                                                                                         LIST OF FIGURES
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                xiii
LIST OF FIGURES
xiv                                                                                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                                                                                                                            LIST OF TABLES
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                 xv
LIST OF TABLES
xvi                                                                                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                                                                      SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
                                                              SECTION 1. SPECIFICATIONS
1.1       OPERATING SPECIFICATIONS & PERFORMANCE                                   1.3       CHASSIS SPECIFICATIONS
          DATA                                                                                        Table 1-3. Chassis Specifications
  Table 1-1. Operating Specifications & Performance Data                           Maximum Travel Grade With boom in stowed position                         45%
                                                                                   (Gradeability)
Maximum Work Load (Capacity)
 Unrestricted                                                  500 lb (230 kg)     Maximum Travel Grade With boom in stowed position                            5°
 Restricted                                                   1000 lb (450 kg)     (Side Slope)
Max.Vertical Platform Height (Unrestricted)                     125 ft (38.1 m)    Turning Radius (Axles Retracted)
                                                                                    Outside                                                      22 ft-6 in (6.8 m)
Max.Vertical Platform Height (Restricted)                       125 ft (38.1 m)
                                                                                    Inside                                                       14 ft-5 in (4.4 m)
Max.Horizontal Platform Reach (Unrestricted)                 63 ft-2 in (19.3 m)
                                                                                   Turning Radius (Axles Extended)
Max.Horizontal Platform Reach (Restricted)                   53 ft-2 in (16.2 m)    Inside                                                             8 ft (2.4 m)
Up and Over Height                                           60 ft-7 in (18.5 m)    Outside                                                      19 ft-4 in (5.9 m)
Main Boom Range (At Maximum Up & Over)                             +75° / -55°     Max Tire Load                                              23700 lb (10750 kg)
Main Boom Range (At Maximum Left & Right)                          +70° / -55°     Max Ground Bearing Pressure                               100 psi (7.03 kg/cm2)
Maximum Boom Swing                                            360° Continuous      Maximum Drive Speed
JibPLUS                                                                             Stowed                                                     3.25 mph (5.2 kph)
  Length                                                          8 ft (2.44 m)     Elevated                                                   0.75 mph (1.2 kph)
  Horizontal Motion                                 125° working, 210° stowed      Gross Machine Weight
  Vertical Motion                                             130° (+75/-55)         Platform Empty                                          44,000 lb (19,958 kg)
Max. Hydraulic System Pressure                               4600 psi (317 Bar)      Platform Empty w/ Skypower                              44,215 lb (20,056 kg)
Maximum Wind Speed                                          28 mph (12.5 m/s)
Maximum Manual Force                                                     400 N     1.4       TIRES
Electrical System Voltage                                              12 Volts
                                                                                                        Table 1-4. Tire Specifications
Max Tire Load                                             23,700 lb (10750 kg)
Maximum Platform Rotation                                                 ±90°       Size                                                          445/50D710
                                                                                     Load Range                                                                J
1.2       CAPACITIES                                                                 Ply Rating                                                               18
                                                                                     Foam Fill                              Polyurethane HD (55 Durometer) Foam
                            Table 1-2. Capacities                                    Diameter                                                46.45 in (117.9 cm)
  Hydraulic Tank                                           53.3 gal (201.7 L)        Width                                                       18 in (45.7 cm)
  Fuel Tank                                                    31 gal (117 L)        Rim Size                                                             15x28
  Hydraulic System                                         65.4 gal (247.5 L)        Tire & Wheel Weight                                         867 lb (393 kg)
  Drive Hub                                                                          Max Tire Load                                          23,700 lb (10750 kg)
   Bonfiglioli                                         0.53 qt (0.5 L) ± 10%         Size                                                            445/65-24
   Reggiana Riduttori                                  1.59 qt (1.5 L) ± 10%
                                                                                     Type                                                                  Solid
                                                                                     Diameter                                                 45.3 in (115.1 cm)
                                                                                     Width                                                     17.3 in (43.9 cm)
                                                                                     Rim Size                                                         12.00-24
                                                                                     Tire & Wheel Weight                                       960 lb (435.4 kg)
                                                                                     Max Tire Load                                          23,700 lb (10750 kg)
3121171                                                                                                                                                        1-1
 SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
Stowed Length (Transport Mode) 37 ft-7 in (11.46 m) Stroke 4.4 in (112 mm)
Stowed Length (Working Mode) 47 ft-6 in (14.48 m) Total Displacement 190 cu. in (3108 cm³)
1-2                                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                                                                  SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
3121171                                                                                                                                                                 1-3
 SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
1-4                                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                                 SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
3121171                                                                                                                     1-5
 SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
                           4                                                   4
                                          12
                                    19         13,15        10
                                                                 6                        21
                                                                       7
17,22
                                                                 2,3
                                      8        9
                                                        5   1
                               4                                                   4
                                                                                                  MAE37800
Figure 1-1. Lubrication & Operator Maintenance Diagram - Deutz 2011/CAT Engines
                                                   
                                                          
                                         
                                                                                         
                                                                           
                     
                                                                 	
                                              
                                                           
Figure 1-2. Lubrication & Operator Maintenance Diagram - Deutz 2.9 Engine
1-6                                                                                               3121171
                                                                                                                 SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
   KEY                                   SPECIFICATIONS
   MPG      Multipurpose Grease having a minimum dripping point of 350° F (177° C).
            Excellent water resistance and adhesive qualities, and being of extreme
            pressure type.
            (Timken OK 40 pounds minimum.)
   EPGL     Extreme Pressure Gear Lube (oil) meeting API service classification GL-5
            or MIL-Spec MIL-L-2105
    HO      Hydraulic Oil. API service classification GL-3, e.g. Mobilfluid 424.
    EO      Engine (crankcase). Gas (5W30)- API SN, -Arctic ACEA AI/BI, A5/B5 - API
            SM, SL, SJ, EC, CF, CD - ILSAC GF-4. Diesel (15W40, 5W30 Arctic) - API CJ-4.
                                                                                              Lube Point(s) - Fill Plug
                                                                                              Capacity - 79 oz (2.3 L)
                                                                                              Lube - GL-5
LUBRICATION INTERVALS ARE BASED ON MACHINE OPERATION UNDER NOR-                               Interval - Check level every 150 hours/Change every
MAL CONDITIONS. FOR MACHINES USED IN MULTI-SHIFT OPERATIONS AND/                                 1200 hours of operation. Fill to cover ring gear.
OR EXPOSED TO HOSTILE ENVIRONMENTS OR CONDITIONS, LUBRICATION
                                                                                           3. Swing Brake
FREQUENCIES MUST BE INCREASED ACCORDINGLY.
3121171                                                                                                                                              1-7
 SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
NOTE: After S/N 0300134389 machines may be built with either               C: Wheel Drive Hub - Reggiana Riduttori (S/N 134389 to
      Bonfiglioli or Reggiana Riduttori wheel drive hubs.                      Present)
1-8                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                                        SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
3121171                                                                                                        1-9
 SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
1-10                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
9. Suction Strainers (In Tank) 11. Oil Change w/Filter - Deutz TCD2.9 L4
3121171                                                                                                                 1-11
 SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
13. Fuel Filter - Deutz D2011 15. Fuel Strainer - Deutz 2011
1-12                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
17. Fuel Filter/Water Separator - CAT 19. Air Filter - Deutz 2011/CAT
DEUTZ D2011
CAT
3121171                                                                                                                1-13
 SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
1-14                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
          Torq ue
          Torq ue
              To rqu e
             Torq ue
          To rqu e
                     Torq ue
3121171                                                                                                        1-15
 SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
                      To rqu e
                   Torqu e
                             Torq ue
                      Tor que
                   Torq ue
1-16                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                                  SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
                 Torq ue
          Tor que
                     Torqu e
                        Cl amp L oa d
                 Torq ue
          To rqu e
                        To rque
3121171                                                                                                                 1-17
 SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
                                     To rq ue
                          To rqu e
                                      To rq ue
                          Torq u e
                                     To rqu e
                                                 To rqu e
1-18                                                                                            3121171
                                                                        SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
                     To rq ue
          To rqu e
                     To rqu e
             Tor qu e
                     To rqu e
                     Torq ue
3121171                                                                                       1-19
 SECTION 1 - SPECIFICATIONS
NOTES:
1-20                          3121171
                                                                                                          SECTION 2 - GENERAL
                                                         SECTION 2. GENERAL
2.1    MACHINE PREPARATION, INSPECTION, AND                            Reference the JLG Pre-Delivery and Frequent Inspection Form
                                                                       and the Inspection and Preventative Maintenance Schedule
       MAINTENANCE                                                     for items requiring inspection during the performance of
                                                                       these inspections. Reference the appropriate areas of this
General                                                                manual for servicing and maintenance procedures.
 This section provides the necessary information needed by            Annual Machine Inspection
 those personnel that are responsible to place the machine in
 operation readiness and maintain its safe operating condition.        The Annual Machine Inspection must be performed by a Fac-
 For maximum service life and safe operation, ensure that all          tory-Certified Service Technician on an annual basis, no later
 the necessary inspections and maintenance have been com-              than thirteen (13) months from the date of the prior Annual
 pleted before placing the machine into service. With proper           Machine Inspection. JLG Industries, Inc. recognizes a Factory-
 care, maintenance, and inspections performed per JLG's rec-           Trained Service Technician as a person who has successfully
 ommendations, and with any and all discrepancies corrected,           completed the JLG Service Training School for the subject JLG
 this product will be fit for continued use.                           product model. Reference the machine Service and Mainte-
                                                                       nance Manual and appropriate JLG inspection form for perfor-
                                                                       mance of this inspection.
Preparation, Inspection, and Maintenance
                                                                       Reference the JLG Annual Machine Inspection Form and the
 It is important to establish and conform to a comprehensive           Inspection and Preventative Maintenance Schedule for items
 inspection and preventive maintenance program. The follow-            requiring inspection during the performance of this inspec-
 ing table outlines the periodic machine inspections and main-         tion. Reference the appropriate areas of this manual for servic-
 tenance recommended by JLG Industries, Inc. Consult your              ing and maintenance procedures.
 national, regional, or local regulations for further requirements
 for aerial work platforms. The frequency of inspections and           For the purpose of receiving safety-related bulletins, it is
 maintenance must be increased as environment, severity and            important that JLG Industries, Inc. has updated ownership
 frequency of usage requires.                                          information for each machine. When performing each Annual
                                                                       Machine Inspection, notify JLG Industries, Inc. of the current
Pre-Start Inspection                                                   machine ownership.
3121171                                                                                                                           2-1
 SECTION 2 - GENERAL
                                                                                          Primary                   Service
             Type                                Frequency                                                                                         Reference
                                                                                       Responsibility             Qualification
      Pre-Start Inspection                 Prior to use each day; or                   User or Operator          User or Operator          Operation and Safety Manual
                                          At each Operator change.
  Pre-Delivery Inspection                Prior to each sale, lease, or               Owner, Dealer, or User   Qualified JLG Mechanic     Service and Maintenance Manual
                                               rental delivery.                                                                         and applicable JLG inspection form.
      Frequent Inspection     In service for 3 months or 150 hours, whichever        Owner, Dealer, or User   Qualified JLG Mechanic     Service and Maintenance Manual
                                                  comes first; or                                                                       and applicable JLG inspection form.
                             Out of service for a period of more than 3 months; or
                                                purchased used.
 Annual Machine Inspection   Annually, no later than 13 months from the date of      Owner, Dealer, or User   Factory-Trained Service    Service and Maintenance Manual
                                            the prior inspection.                                                   Technician          and applicable JLG inspection form.
                                                                                                                 (Recommended)
          Preventive         At intervals as specified in the Service and Mainte-    Owner, Dealer, or User   Qualified JLG Mechanic     Service and Maintenance Manual
         Maintenance                            nance Manual.
2.2        SERVICE AND GUIDELINES                                                               3. Clean and inspect all parts during servicing or mainte-
                                                                                                   nance, and ensure all passages and openings are unob-
                                                                                                   structed. Cover all parts to keep them clean. Be sure all
General                                                                                            parts are clean before they are installed. New parts
                                                                                                   should remain in their containers until needed.
 The following information is provided to assist you in the use
 and application of servicing and maintenance procedures                                  Components Removal and Installation
 contained in this book.
                                                                                                1. Use adjustable lifting devices, whenever possible, if
                                                                                                   mechanical assistance is required. All slings (chains,
Safety and Workmanship                                                                             cables, etc.) should be parallel to each other and as near
                                                                                                   perpendicular as possible to top of part being lifted.
 Your safety, and that of others, is the first consideration when
 working on or around equipment. Always be conscious of                                         2. If a component must be removed on an angle, keep in
                                                                                                   mind the capacity of an eyebolt or similar bracket less-
 weight. Never attempt to move heavy parts without the aid of
                                                                                                   ens, as the angle between the supporting structure and
 a mechanical device. Do not allow heavy objects to rest in an
                                                                                                   the component becomes less than 90 degrees.
 unstable position. Always provide adequate support when lift-
 ing a portion of the equipment.                                                                3. If a part resists removal, check if all nuts, bolts, cables,
                                                                                                   brackets, wiring, etc., have been removed and that no
                                                                                                   adjacent parts are interfering.
Cleanliness
      1. The most important single item in preserving the long
         service life of a machine is to keep dirt and foreign mate-
         rials out of vital components. Precautions have been
         taken to safeguard against this. Shields, covers, seals,
         and filters are provided to keep air, fuel, and oil supplies
         clean; however, these items must be maintained on a
         scheduled basis to function properly.
2-2                                                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                                           SECTION 2 - GENERAL
Gaskets
 Check holes in gaskets align with openings in the mating
 parts. If it becomes necessary to hand-fabricate a gasket, use
 gasket material or stock of equivalent material and thickness.
 Be sure to cut holes in the right location, as blank gaskets can
 cause serious system damage.
3121171                                                                                                                            2-3
 SECTION 2 - GENERAL
Lubrication and Servicing                                                    3. The only exception to the above is to drain and fill the
                                                                                system with Mobil DTE 13 oil or its equivalent. This will
  Components and assemblies requiring lubrication and servic-                   allow start up at temperatures down to -20 degrees F (-
  ing are shown in the Lubrication Chart in Section 1.                          29 degrees C). However, use of this oil will give poor per-
                                                                                formance at temperatures above 120 degrees F (49
                                                                                degrees C). Systems using DTE 13 oil should not be oper-
2.3       LUBRICATION AND INFORMATION                                           ated at temperatures above 200 degrees F (94 degrees
                                                                                C) under any condition.
Hydraulic System
                                                                         Changing Hydraulic Oil
      1. The primary enemy of a hydraulic system is contamina-
         tion. Contaminants enter the system by various means,
                                                                             1. Filter elements must be changed after the first 50 hours
         e.g., using inadequate hydraulic oil, allowing moisture,
                                                                                of operation and every 300 hours (unless specified oth-
         grease, filings, sealing components, sand, etc., to enter
                                                                                erwise) thereafter. If it is necessary to change the oil, use
         when performing maintenance, or by permitting the
                                                                                only those oils meeting or exceeding the specifications
         pump to cavitate due to insufficient system warm-up or
                                                                                appearing in this manual. If unable to obtain the same
         leaks in the pump supply (suction) lines.
                                                                                type of oil supplied with the machine, consult local sup-
                                                                                plier for assistance in selecting the proper equivalent.
      2. Design and manufacturing tolerances of component
                                                                                Avoid mixing petroleum and synthetic base oils.
         working parts are very close, therefore, even the small-
         est amount of dirt or foreign matter entering a system
                                                                             2. Use every precaution to keep the hydraulic oil clean. If
         can cause wear or damage to the components and
                                                                                the oil must be poured from the original container into
         cause faulty operation. Every precaution must be taken
                                                                                another, be sure to clean all possible contaminants from
         to keep hydraulic oil clean, including reserve oil in stor-
                                                                                the service container. Always clean the mesh element of
         age. Hydraulic system filters should be checked,
                                                                                the filter and replace the cartridge any time the system
         cleaned, and/or replaced as necessary, at intervals speci-
                                                                                oil is changed.
         fied in the Lubrication Chart in Section 1. Always exam-
         ine filters for evidence of metal particles.                        3. While the unit is shut down, a good preventive mainte-
                                                                                nance measure is to make a thorough inspection of all
      3. Cloudy oils indicate a high moisture content which per-
                                                                                hydraulic components, lines, fittings, etc., as well as a
         mits organic growth, resulting in oxidation or corrosion.
                                                                                functional check of each system, before placing the
         If this condition occurs, the system must be drained,
                                                                                machine back in service.
         flushed, and refilled with clean oil.
2-4                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                                            SECTION 2 - GENERAL
  Maximum acceptable cylinder drift is to be measured using            In an area free of obstructions, cylinder must have load
  the following methods.                                               applied and appropriately positioned to detect drift.
3121171                                                                                                                                2-5
 SECTION 2 - GENERAL
2.5       PINS AND COMPOSITE BEARING REPAIR                            2.6     WELDING ON JLG EQUIPMENT
          GUIDELINES                                                   NOTE: This instruction applies to repairs, or modifications to the
 Filament wound bearings.                                                    machine and to welding performed from the machine on
                                                                             an external structure, or component,
      1. Pinned joints should be disassembled and inspected if
         the following occurs:
                                                                       Do the Following When Welding on JLG Equipment
          a. Excessive sloppiness in joints.
                                                                          • Disconnect the battery.
          b. Noise originating from the joint during operation.
                                                                          • Disconnect the moment pin connection (where fitted)
      2. Filament wound bearings should be replaced if any of
         the following is observed:                                       • Ground only to structure being welded.
          a. Frayed or separated fibers on the liner surface.          Do NOT Do the Following When Welding on JLG
          b. Cracked or damaged liner backing.                         Equipment
          c. Bearings that have moved or spun in their housing.
                                                                          • Ground on frame and weld on any other area than the
          d. Debris embedded in liner surface.                              chassis.
      3. Pins should be replaced if any of the following is               • Ground on turntable and weld on any other area than the
         observed (pin should be properly cleaned prior to                  turntable.
         inspection):
                                                                          • Ground on the platform/support and weld on any other
          a. Detectable wear in the bearing area.                           area than the platform/support.
          b. Flaking, peeling, scoring, or scratches on the pin sur-      • Ground on a specific boom section and weld on any other
             face.                                                          area than that specific boom section.
          c. Rusting of the pin in the bearing area.
                                                                          • Allow pins, wear pads, wire ropes, bearings, gearing, seals,
      4. Re-assembly of pinned joints using filament wound                  valves, electrical wiring, or hoses to be between the
         bearings.                                                          grounding position and the welded area.
          a. Housing should be blown out to remove all dirt and
             debris. bearings and bearing housings must be free
             of all contamination.                                     FAILURE TO COMPLY WITH THE ABOVE REQUIREMENTS MAY RESULT IN COM-
          b. Bearing / pins should be cleaned with a solvent to        PONENT DAMAGE (I.E. ELECTRONIC MODULES, SWING BEARING, COLLECTOR
             remove all grease and oil. filament wound bearing         RING, BOOM WIRE ROPES ETC.)
             are a dry joint and should not be lubricated unless
             otherwise instructed (i.e. sheave pins).
          c. Pins should be inspected to ensure it is free of burrs,
             nicks, and scratches which would damage the bear-
             ing during installation and operation.
2-6                                                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                                                    SECTION 2 - GENERAL
INTERVAL
3121171                                                                                                                             2-7
 SECTION 2 - GENERAL
INTERVAL
2-8                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                                                                   SECTION 2 - GENERAL
INTERVAL
          Performance Codes:
          1 - Check for proper and secure installation
          2 - Visual inspection for damage, cracks, distortion or excessive wear
          3 - Check for proper adjustment
          4 - Check for cracked or broken welds
          5 - Operates Properly
          6 - Returns to neutral or “off” position when released
          7 - Clean and free of debris
          8 - Interlocks function properly
          9 - Check for signs of leakage
          10 - Decals installed and legible
          11 - Check for proper fluid level
          12 - Check for chafing and proper routing
          13 - Check for proper tolerances
          14 - Properly lubricated
          15 - Torqued to proper specification
          16 - No gouges, excessive wear, or cords showing
          17 - Properly inflated and seated around rim
          18 - Proper and authorized components
          19 - Fully charged
          20 - No loose connections, corrosion, or abrasions
          21 - Verify
          22 - Perform
          23 - Sealed Properly
          24 - Drain, Clean, Refill
3121171                                                                                                                                            2-9
 SECTION 2 - GENERAL
1001159163-B
2-10                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       SECTION 2 - GENERAL
                                                                                                                                                                                        Readily Biodegradable*
                                                                                                                                                              Synthetic Polyol Esters
Virtually Non-toxic**
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Fire Resistant***
                                                                                               Viscosity Index
                                                                                                                                Vegetable Oils
                                                                                                                 Mineral Oils
                      Description
Synthetic
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               2-11
 SECTION 2 - GENERAL
                                                                                                                                                                                        AMBIENT AIR
                                                                                                                                                                                       TEMPERATURE
                                                                                                                                                                     120 F(49 C)
                                      NO OPERATION ABOVE THIS
                                      AMBIENT TEMPERATURE                                                                                                            110 F(43 C)
                                                                                                                                                                     100 F(38 C)
                                                                                                                                                                      90 F(32 C)
                                                                                                                                                                      80 F(27 C)
                                                                                                                                                                      70 F(21 C)
                                   ENGINE                                                                                                                             60 F(16 C)
                                   SPECIFICATIONS
                                                                                                                                                                      50 F(10 C)
                                                                                                                                                                        40 F(4 C)
                                                                                                                                                                       30 F(-1 C)
                                                                                                                                                                       20 F(-7 C)
          ENGINE WILL START AND OPERATE UNAIDED AT THIS
          TEMPERATURE WITH THE RECOMMENDED FLUIDS AND A                                                                                                               10 F(-12 C)
          FULLY CHARGED BATTERY.
                                                                                                                                                                       0 F(-18 C)
           ENGINE WILL START AND OPERATE AT THIS TEMPERATURE                                                                                                         -10 F(-23 C)
           WITH THE RECOMMENDED FLUIDS, A FULLY CHARGED BATTERY
           AND THE AID OF A COMPLETE JLG SPECIFIED COLD WEATHER                                                                                                      -20 F(-29 C)
           PACKAGE (IE. ENGINE BLOCK HEATER, BATTERY WARMER AND
           HYDRAULIC OIL TANK HEATER)                                                                                                                                -30 F(-34 C)
                                                                                                                                                                     -40 F(-40 C)
                                        NO OPERATION BELOW THIS
                                        AMBIENT TEMPERATURE
                    90° F (32° C)
                    80° F (27° C)
                                                                           EXXON UNIVIS HVI 26
                    70° F (21° C)
                    60° F (16° C)
                    50° F (10° C)                                                                                     HYDRAULIC
                                                            MOBIL DTE 13
                    40° F (4° C)
                                                                                                                      SPECIFICATIONS
                    30° F (-1° C)
                    20° F (-7° C)
                    10° F (-12° C)
                    0° F (-18° C)                                                                       DO NOT START UP HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
                                                                                                        WITHOUT HEATING AIDS WITH MOBILE 424
                   -10° F (-23° C)                                                                      HYDRAULIC OIL BELOW THIS TEMPERATURE
                   -20° F (-29° C)                                                                                                                           NOTE:
                                                                                                  DO NOT START UP HYDRAULIC SYSTEM WITHOUT HEATING AIDS
                   -30° F (-34° C)                                                                AND COLD WEATHERHYDRAULIC OIL BELOW THIS TEMPERATURE       1) RECOMMENDATIONS ARE FOR AMBIENT TEMPERATURES
                   -40° F (-40° C)                                                                                                                              CONSISTENTLY WITHIN SHOWN LIMITS
                                                                           NO OPERATION BELOW THIS
                                                                           AMBIENT TEMPERATURE                                                               2) ALL VALUES ARE ASSUMED TO BE AT SEA LEVEL.
4150548-E
2-12                                                                                                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  • any tears or rips (ragged edges) in cord plies which exceeds      Wheel and Tire Replacement
    1 in (2.5 cm) in any direction
                                                                       Rims installed on each product model have been designed for
  • any punctures which exceed 1 in (2.5 cm) in diameter
                                                                       stability requirements which consist of track width, tire pres-
  • any damage to bead area cords of the tire                          sure, and load capacity. Size changes such as rim width, center
                                                                       piece location, larger or smaller diameter, etc., without written
 If a tire is damaged but is within the above noted criteria, the
                                                                       factory recommendations, may result in an unsafe condition
 tire must be inspected on a daily basis to ensure damage has
                                                                       regarding stability.
 not exceeded allowable criteria.
3121171                                                                                                                             3-1
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                                       TORQUE SEQUENCE
                                                                           1st Stage      2nd Stage      3rd Stage
                                                                           45 ft-lb        100 ft-lb     180 ft-lb
                                                                           (60 Nm)         (140 Nm)      (252 Nm)
                                                                   4. Torque wheel nuts before first road use and after each
                                                                      wheel removal. Check and torque every 3 months or 150
                                                                      hours of operation.
3-2                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.2    AXLE EXTENSION SYSTEM                                           automatically reduce the wheel angle to 25 degrees during
                                                                       axle retraction.
 The Axle Extension System allows each of the four axles to be
 extended and retracted together while maintaining full steer-       NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-
 ing control as the machine is driven. The system allows the               ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-
 axles to extend or retract only while the boom is in the trans-           tem.
 port position (see Section 4.2, Transport Position Sensing Sys-
 tem) and in order to minimize wheel scrubbing during axle           3.3       AXLE LIMIT SWITCH ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE
 movement, a minimum drive speed must be attained before                   1. Fully extend axles.
 axle extension/retraction will be permitted.
 To extend/retract the axles, the user engages the axle extend/            2. Initially position the limit switch arm straight.
 retract switch on the platform console and the drive control at           3. Select the mounting plate bolt pattern to position the
 the same time. The axle set indicator will be off when the axles             switch roller within 0.125 inches (mm) from the edge of
 are not fully extended and the axle extend/retract switch is                 the axle cutout. It may be necessary to reposition the
 not engaged. It will flash while the axles are extending or                  switch arm ±10° to accomplish this.
 retracting and will be on constantly when the axles are fully
 extended.                                                                 4. Ensure the arm will clear the axle (without bottoming
                                                                              out to 70° stroke of the switch) in the retracted position.
 The system uses four limit switches (one at each axle) to sense
 when the axles are fully extended. If any of the switches are             5. Check for proper operation. Axle set light is to deacti-
 not made, the control system considers the axles retracted.                  vate when the axle is retracted 0.625 inches (16 mm)
 With the axles not fully extended, the boom is restricted to                 maximum from fully extended.
 operation within the transport position (see Section 4.2, Trans-
 port Position Sensing System). If a signal from any axle extend
 sensing switch is lost when the boom is beyond the transport
 position, the axle set indicator will flash and drive/steer func-
 tions will be disabled until the boom is brought back into the
 transport position. The steering angle will be automatically
 limited to ± 25 degrees anytime the axles are not fully
 extended. If the wheel angle is more than ± 25 degrees when
 the axle retract command is engaged, the control system will
3121171                                                                                                                              3-3
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-4                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171                                                                                                                            3-5
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
0274670 D
3-6                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
          1.   Axle Limit Switch (Right Front)         9.    Axle Limit Switch (Left Rear)
          2.   Steer Angle Sensor (Right Front)        10.   Steer Angle Sensor (Left Rear)
          3.   Steer Valve (Front)                     11.   Chassis Module
          4.   Axle Lockout Valve                      12.   Swivel/Collector Ring
          5.   Traction Valve                          13.   Axle Lockout Pressure Switch
          6.   Steer Valve (Rear)                      14.   Steer Angle Sensor (Left Front)
          7.   Steer Angle Sensor (Right Rear)         15.   Axle Limit Switch (Left Front)
          8.   Axle Limit Switch (Right Rear)
3121171                                                                                                           3-7
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
0274670 D
3-8                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
          1.    Headlight                       13.   Glow Plug Relay                    24.   Tower Lift Enable Valve
          2.    2500W Generator                 14.   Drive Pump                         25.   Tower Tele Enable Valve
          3.    2500W Generator Control Box     15.   Swivel                             26.   Main Control Valve
          4.    Alternator                      16.   7500W Generator Control Box        27.   Main Lift Enable Valve
          5.    Throttle Actuator               17.   Taillight                          28.   Alarm
          6.    Oil Temperature Switch          18.   Taillight                          29.   Horn
          7.    Oil Pressure Switch             19.   Tower Lift Cylinder Load Pin       30.   Fuel Level Sensor
          8.    Glow Plugs                      20.   Tower Lift Cylinder Angle Sensor   31.   Ground Control Box
          9.    Engine Speed Sensor             21.   Auxiliary Power Unit               32.   BLAM Module
          10.   Starter                         22.   Headlight/Taillight Relay          33.   Headlight
          11.   Drive Pump                      23.   Auxiliary Power Relay              34.   Strobe Light
          12.   Starter Relay
3121171                                                                                                                  3-9
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                            3
                             1                                            DETAIL A
DETAIL B
3-10                                                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                                                              SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                                                                              9
                                                                                                                                                      3
                                      11,12,B,G
                                                                                      6
         11,12,A,G
                                                                                                                    8
       10
11,12,C,G DETAIL A
11,12,E,G
                                                                   11,12,F,G
                                                       2
                                                                                                                    4
   A - Assemble to Axle Box Mid Plate; Typical 8 Places.
   B- Assemble to Top Plate of Axle Boxes; Typical 4 Places; Torque; Select appropriate bolt to ensure 0.5 ±0.062                      DETAIL B
      inches (12.7 ± 1.587 mm) thread engagement.
   C - Assemble to Side Plates of Axle Weldments; Typical 16 Places.
   D - Assemble to Front and Rear Plates of Axle Boxes; Typical 8 Places.
   E - Assemble to Top Plate of Axle Weldment; Typical 4 Places; Torque; Select appropriate bolt to ensure 0.5
       ±0.062 inches (12.7 ± 1.587 mm) thread engagement.
   F - Assemble to Bottom Plate of Axle Box Weldment; Typical 8 Places.
   G - See Axle Stop Shimming Procedure on Sheet 1
3121171                                                                                                                                                   3-11
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                            *   *
                                                                  **
                                                                       **
                                                                                             *
                                                ***                                              *
                                        *
                                                                                                         ***
                                *
               *
         *                                                                               *   *
                                         *
                                         *                                                           *
                   *        *
                                                                                             *
                                                                                         *
* MAE38440
3-12                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                       SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171                                                                                             3-13
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.10 OSCILLATING AXLE SYSTEM                                          3.11 OSCILLATING AXLE BLEEDING PROCEDURE AND
  The oscillating front axle is attached to the frame by a pivot           LOCKOUT TEST
  pin, which allows all four wheels to remain on the ground
  when traveling on rough terrain. The oscillating axle also          Lockout Cylinder Bleeding
  incorporates two lockout cylinders connected between the
  frame and the axle. The lockout cylinders permit axle oscilla-        To start the test, the axle must be fully oscillated in one direc-
  tion when the boom is in the transport position (see Section          tion. Start with oscillating the axle so that the left lock-out cyl.
  4.2, Transport Position Sensing System) and drive is com-             is fully retracted (left front tire up), and the right lock-out cyl. Is
  manded.                                                               fully extended (right front tire down).
  Lockout cylinders lock and hold the axle when drive is not
  commanded or when the boom is outside the transport posi-
  tion. Cylinders unlock when pilot pressure is applied to the        ENSURE PLATFORM IS FULLY LOWERED AND BOOM IS CENTERED OVER REAR
  holding valves mounted on the cylinders and lock when pilot         AXLE PRIOR TO BEGINNING BLEEDING PROCEDURE. MAKING SURE MACHINE
  pressure is removed. Pilot pressure is available from brake         IS ON A LEVEL SURFACE AND REAR WHEELS ARE BLOCKED, BRAKE WIRE IS
  pressure and is controlled by a solenoid operated lockout           DISCONNECTED.
  valve mounted in the frame. To ensure the lockout valve is
  functioning correctly, a NO pressure switch is mounted
  between the lockout valve and the holding valves. The system            1. Making sure machine is on a level surface and rear
  is “healthy” when pressure trips the pressure switch when the              wheels are blocked, machine is in transport mode.
  lockout valve is energized and conversely is healthy when the           2. Disengage drive hubs.
  lack of pressure resets the pressure switch when the lockout
  valve is de-energized.                                                  3. Use suitable container to catch any residual hydraulic
  Failures in the oscillating axle system will cause the control             fluid, place container under the lockout cylinder.
  system to disallow main boom lift up and telescope out, and             4. With left lockout cylinder retracted, open bleeder on top
  tower boom lift up when both booms are within the transport                of the cylinder, then have an operator from the platform
  position and will disallow drive/steer, lift up and telescope out          (on high engine) feather drive. Activate drive fully.
  when either boom is beyond the transport position.
                                                                          5. Close bleeder when there is a steady stream of oil and
NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-                not air.
      ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-
      tem.                                                                6. With axle in the same position, go to right lockout cylin-
                                                                             der and open bleeder at the rod end. Activate drive in
                                                                             the same manner and close when all air has been
                                                                             purged.
                                                                          7. Close bleeder when there is a steady stream of oil and
                                                                             not air.
                                                                          8. Oscillate axle the other direction, left lock-out cyl.
                                                                             extended (tire down), right lock-out cyl. retracted (tire
                                                                             up). Use the same procedure for the bleeder in the rod
                                                                             end of the left lock-out cyl., Then the piston end of the
                                                                             right lock-out cyl. then close.
                                                                          9. Repeat process one more time to ensure all air has been
                                                                             purged from the system.
                                                                        10.   Perform oscillating axle lockout test.
                                                                        11.   If necessary, repeat steps 1 thru 9.
3-14                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                        SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Oscillating Axle Lockout Test                                          6. Drive machine off of block and ramp back on level sur-
                                                                          face.
  The front axles will oscillate when the boom is in the transport
  position.                                                            7. Have an assistant check left front wheel remains locked
                                                                          in position off ground.
NOTE:     The machine is in transport mode until one of the follow-    8. Retract boom back in to transport position. Activate
          ing three factors are exceeded:                                 drive and the lockout cylinders should release.
            Main boom extended more than 4 ft. (1.2 m)
                           OR                                          9. Place the 6 inch (15.2 cm) high block with ascension
            Main boom 6° above horizontal (w/tower stowed                 ramp in front of right front wheel.
                          OR                                          10.   Place DRIVE control lever to FORWARD and carefully
            Tower above horizontal.                                         drive machine up ascension ramp until right front wheel
                                                                            is on top of block.
                                                                      11.   Telescope the boom out of the transport position.
LOCKOUT SYSTEM TEST MUST BE PERFORMED QUARTERLY, ANY TIME A SYS-
                                                                      12.   Drive machine off of block and ramp back onto the level
TEM COMPONENT IS REPLACED, OR WHEN IMPROPER SYSTEM OPERATION IS
                                                                            surface.
SUSPECTED.
                                                                      13.   Have an assistant check to see that right front wheel
NOTE: Ensure booms are fully retracted, lowered, and centered               remains locked in position off of ground.
      between drive wheels prior to beginning lockout cylinder
                                                                      14.   Retract the boom back in to the transport position. Acti-
      test. The axles must also be fully extended.
                                                                            vate drive and the lockout cylinders should release.
                                                                      15.   If lockout cylinders do not function properly, have quali-
    1. Place a 6 inch (15.2 cm) high block with ascension ramp
                                                                            fied personnel correct the malfunction prior to any fur-
       in front of left front wheel.
                                                                            ther operation.
    2. From platform control station, activate machine hydrau-
       lic system.
    3. Place FUNCTION SPEED CONTROL and DRIVE SPEED/
       TORQUE SELECT control switches to their respective
       LOW positions.
    4. Place DRIVE control lever to FORWARD position and
       carefully drive machine up ascension ramp until left
       front wheel is on top of block.
    5. Telescope boom out of transport position.
3121171                                                                                                                         3-15
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.12 WHEEL DRIVE ASSEMBLY                                               NOTE: The drive hub and drive motor assembly weighs approxi-
                                                                              mately 267 lbs. (121 kg).
Removal                                                                     4. Use a supporting device capable of handling the weight
NOTE: The drive motors can be removed through the axle flange                  of the drive hub and drive motor, and unbolt the drive
      as part of the wheel drive assembly or they can be removed               hub from the frame. Remove the entire assembly from
      separately through the bottom of the frame while leaving                 the machine.
      the drive hub bolted to the axle.                                     5. Remove the capscrews and washers that secure the
                                                                               drive motor to the drive hub and remove the drive
    1. Use a jack to lift the frame enough so the tire and wheel               motor. Remove and discard the brake gasket between
       assembly is off the ground. Place blocking strong                       the drive motor and drive hub.
       enough to support the weight of the machine under the
       frame and remove the jack.                                       Installation
NOTE: The foam-filled tire & wheel assembly weighs approxi-                 1. Install a new brake gasket between the drive motor and
      mately 867 lbs. (393 kg). The solid tire & wheel assembly                drive hub. Apply a coat of JLG Threadlocker PN 0100011
      weighs approximately 960 lbs. (435 kg).                                  on capscrews. Install the washers and capscrews to
                                                                               secure the drive hub and drive motor, and torque to
    2. Remove hardware securing wheel and remove tire and                      178 ft. lbs. (241 Nm).
       wheel assembly. Using suitable lifting device lift the tire
       and wheel assembly and place in a suitable area.                     2. Place the drive hub flange against the mounting flange
                                                                               on the axle and fasten it in place with the bolts and
    3. Tag and disconnect the hydraulic lines running to the                   washers. Torque the bolts to 180 ft. lbs. (244 Nm).
       drive motor. Cap or plug all openings to ensure no dirt
       enters the hydraulic system.                                         3. Using adequate support, install wheel into wheel
                                                                               assembly and secure with bolts and washers.
DRIVE MOTOR
                                                                         BRAKE GASKET
                                                                                        DRIVE HUB
NUT
                                                       WASHER
                                                             CAPSCREW
WHEEL
3-16                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.13 DRIVE HUB - IF EQUIPPED WITH REXROTH                                15.   Inspect planetary stage assemblies as complete units.
                                                                               Thoroughly clean and check gearing and the bearings
  The final drive consists of two planetary stages with an inte-               for damage and apply new oil. If gears or bearings need
  grated disconnect mechanism. Each stage incorporates a set                   replacing, they must be replaced as complete sets.
  of matched planetary gears, which provide an equal load dis-
  tribution. All torque transmitting components are made of              16.   First stage planetary gears (2) must be changed in sets of
  forged quenched and tempered high-alloy steels. External                     three pieces.
  gears are carburized. Precision roller bearings support the            17.   The first stage planetary gears (2) must be changed as a
  sprocket or wheel loads. A shaft seal protects the unit against              complete set of three and JLG recommends changing
  contamination.                                                               the sun gear shaft (43) along with this set of planets.
                                                                         18.   The second stage planetary bearings (11) must be
Disassembly                                                                    replaced in sets of four pieces.
    1. Position drive so that one of the fill holes is at bottom of      19.   The second stage planetary gears (1) must be changed
       end cover and drain oil.                                                as a complete set of four. JLG recommends changing the
    2. Remove all bolts holding the motor. Remove motor from                   sun gear (3) along with this set of planets.
       drive.
                                                                       Cover Disassembly
    3. Compress spring (55) using a simple fixture or other suit-
       able device.                                                     Loosen and remove hex head bolts (53) to remove cover (51).
    4. Remove snap ring (66) and release pressure on spring            First Stage Planetary (7) Disassembly
       (55) until loose.
    5. Remove spring (55).                                                1. Push sun gear shaft (43) out of first stage.
6. Turn unit so that cover (8) is in the up position. 2. Remove snap rings (14).
7. Remove screw plugs (21) and seal rings (22). 3. Press planet pins (5) out of planet gears (2).
8. Remove O-ring (33). 4. Pull cylindrical roller bearing (10) out of planet gears (2).
    9. Remove first stage planetary assembly (7).                         5. Remove snap ring (16) from sun gear (3). Remove planet
                                                                             carrier (7) from sun gear (3).
  10.   Remove hex bolts (23).
  12.   Remove ring gear (30) and O-ring (19).                         Second Stage Planet Gears (1) Disassembly
  13.   Remove snap rings (15).                                         Press cylindrical roller bearings out of planet gears (1).
  14.   Pull off planet gears (1) together with cylindrical roller
        bearings (11) from spindle (60).
3121171                                                                                                                              3-17
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
First Stage Planetary (7) Assembly                                        6. Before installation of motor, CHECK THERE IS 1-2 mm OF
                                                                             CLEARANCE BETWEEN THE MOTOR SPLINE SHAFT
                                                                             SHOULDER AND THE COUPLER (62).
   1. Pre-freeze planet pins (5) and install into planet carrier
      (7).                                                                7. Install motor and reconnect hydraulic lines.
   2. Install planet carrier (7) together with planet pins (5) on         8. Roll motor so one fill plug is at 12 o’clock position, and
      sun gear (3), and install snap ring (16).                              the other is at 3 o’clock. Fill to bottom of 3 o’ clock plug
                                                                             with gear oil. reinstall plugs.
   3. Put sun gear shaft (43) into sun gear (3).
   4. Pre-heat stay rings (17) and install onto planet pins (5).      Initial Start-up And After Repairs
   5. Pre-heat cylindrical roller bearings (10) and install onto        Before operating machine, make sure drive is filled with clean
      planet pins (5) and fix bearings with snap rings (14).            oil, approximately 0.2 US gal (0.8 L). An accurate oil level is
                                                                        determined by the oil level plug, which should be removed
End Cover Unit (8) Assembly                                             before oil fill.
   1. Install O-ring (54) into groove of cover (8).                     With gear case filled to their proper levels, start machine and
                                                                        allow sufficient time for run-in at moderate pressure and
   2. Install the cover (51) into cover (8) and fix cover (51) with     speed before running at full speed. After 4 hours of operation,
      hex bolts (53). Tighten bolts with torque wrench to 6.3           recheck oil level.Maintenance
      ft-lb (8.5 Nm).
                                                                        Daily: - Check for oil leakage
Final Assembly                                                          Weekly: - Check oil level
   1. Install planet gears (1) onto planet pins which are part of       Monthly: - Check mounting bolt torque
      spindle (60).
                                                                      Oil Change Interval-Gear Drive
   2. Install snap rings (15) on planet pins of spindle (60) to
      retain planet gears (1).                                            1. Perform first oil change after approximately 150 hours.
   3. Insert first stage planetary assembly (7) into drive.               2. Subsequent changes, every 1500 hours or annually,
                                                                             whichever occurs first.
   4. Install O-ring (33) in groove of ring gear (30).
                                                                      NOTE: Flush drive before filling with new oil.
   5. Install seal rings (22) and screw plugs (21).
3-18                                                                                                                           3121171
          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171                              3-19
3-20
                                                                                                                           SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
          1.    Planet Gear      14.   Snap Ring      28.   Washer           52.   Thrust Washer    67.   Retaining Ring
          2.    Planet Gear      15.   Snap Ring      30.   Ring Gear        53.   Bolt             68.   Retaining Ring
          3.    Sun Gear         16.   Snap Ring      33.   O-ring           54.   O-ring           69.   Bolt
          4.    Shaft Nut        17.   Stay Rings     41.   Planet Carrier   55.   Spring           72.   Brake Disc
          5.    Planet Pin       19.   O-ring         42.   Sun Gear         60.   Spindle          73.   Brake Disc
          7.    Planet Carrier   20.   Shaft Seal     43.   Sun Gear         61.   Piston           74.   Spring
          8.    Cover            21.   Plug           45.   Planet Pin       62.   Coupler          75.   Backup Ring
          9.    Thrust Button    22.   Seal Ring      46.   Roller Bearing   63.   Ring Locator     76.   Seal
          10.   Roller Bearing   23.   Bolt           47.   Retaining Ring   64.   Backup Plate     77.   Backup Ring
          11.   Roller Bearing   24.   Detent Ball    48.   Retaining Ring   65.   Backup Plate     78.   Seal
          12.   Ball Bearing     27.   Bolt           51.   Cover            66.   Retaining Ring   81.   O-ring
          13.   Hex Bolt
3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.14 DRIVE HUB - IF EQUIPPED WITH BONFIGLIOLI                            1. Clean the mating surfaces from oils or paint and fit the
                                                                            wheel drive on the machine frame.
NOTE: After SN 0300134389 machines may be built with either
                                                                         2. Attach the gearbox to the machine frame with the
      Bonfiglioli or Reggiana Riduttori wheel drive hubs. See Sec-
                                                                            mounting bolts and torque to 178 ft.lbs. (241 Nm).
      tion 3.15, Drive Hub - If Equipped With Reggiana Riduttori.
      Do not use different hubs on the same machine.
                                                                     Start Up and Running In
Product Identification                                               If new hubs are being installed, it is advised to follow the
                                                                     measures given below:
  The identification data of the hub is shown on a name plates on
  the hub. Figure 3-16., Drive Hub Identification Plate shows            1. Bleed air from every part of the hydraulic and add oil in
  how the information is displayed.                                         the tank if necessary.
3121171                                                                                                                            3-21
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
After running-in the gearbox, follow steps below.                 CONNECTING THE BRAKE
   6. Check there are no oil leaks. If leaks are present, fix       The gearbox is fitted with a negative multi disk safety brake
      them before proceeding.                                       with hydraulic control release (parking brake). For information
                                                                    regarding the characteristics of the brake refer to the installa-
   7. Check gearmotor oil level.                                    tion drawing.
   8. It possible the presence of air in the system during
                                                                                       Table 3-2. Brake Technical Data
      the first start up could cause application of the brake
      to be slowed down. It is advised to repeat the                  Brake Release Pressure                       (16 bar)
      application and release functions of the brake to
                                                                      Maximum Operating Pressure Brake             (50 bar)
      purge air from the brake.
                                                                      Braking Torque                            (265 ± 10% Nm)
   9. Check there are no other problems in general.
3-22                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171                                                                                                          3-23
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Table 3-3. Suggested Lubricants According SAE 80W/90 and SAE 85W/140 API GL5 Grade
NOTE: Do not mix together oils of different brands or characteris-       4. Tighten fill and level oil plug (B) and let gearbox run.
      tics.                                                                 After a few minutes, stop and check the oil level.
NOTE: The gearbox is supplied without oil; before putting the            5. If necessary, refill with lubricant oil. Approximate oil
      gearbox into operation, it is necessary to fill it with oil.          capacity = 2 L ±10%
3-24                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                 4. Turn cap nut (5) upside down. Pin (3) will be pushed
                                                                    inside to permit disengagement of the gearbox.
   1. Remove two socket head screws M8x16 (4) from the end
      cover (7) with a male hex head wrench.
3121171                                                                                                            3-25
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
    6. Tighten two socket head screws M8x16 (4) with a male        Maintenance Information
       hex head torque wrench to 18.4 ft-lb (25 Nm) torque.
                                                                   PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
                                                                     The gearbox only requires the scheduled maintenance proce-
                                                                     dures set out by the manufacturer (see Table 3-4).
                                                                     Good maintenance will ensure an ongoing functioning in time
                                                                     as well as maximum reliability.
                                                                     Should irregularities in function arise, it will be necessary to
                                                                     consult the troubleshooting checklist to find the most ade-
                                                                     quate solution.
                                                                     If unsuccessful, it may be necessary to partially or completely
                                                                     disassemble the gearbox.
                                                                                Table 3-4. Drive Hub Maintenance Schedule
        Operation:
        a. Engaged gearbox
NOTE: Never mix mineral oils with synthetic oils and vice versa.
3-26                                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                                                              SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
TROUBLESHOOTING
 The following table is provided to help locate problems in the
 gearbox.
Disassembly Information                                                                                     4. Provide a work area that meets Work and Health Safety
                                                                                                               in the Workplace guidelines.
 It is also important this procedure is performed in a workshop
 equipped with the proper tools. As well as normal workshop                                             Disassembly
 tools, it is necessary to use special tools that can be made (see
 special tools attachment) or may be requested from the manu-                                           NOTE: Below are all the steps to follow during Disassembly and
 facturer.                                                                                                    Assembly. Numbers in brackets in the text correspond to
 Special Tools:                                                                                               the references in the exploded view.
 Puller...............................................Code/: 6689960240                                   Initial inspection can be made without disassembling the hub
 Tool for lifetime seal assembly........Code/: 6689960300                                                 from the machine. Before wheel drive disassembling, make
                                                                                                          sure that the oil is drained from the hub.
 Puller for brake disassembly..........Code/: 6689960310
                                                                                                          Unscrew and remove the nos. 2 screws M12, grade 8,8, and
 Torque multiplier............................Code/: ATZ.09.016.0
                                                                                                          remove the hydraulic motor and its O-ring seal (48).
 To be able to produce these special tools refer to Figure 3-21.
 thru Figure 3-24.
 It is important to strictly adhere to all procedures for disassem-
 bling and reassembling the gearbox. Proceed with these
 instructions using all necessary safety measures, for example:
   1. Plug all gearbox hydraulic ports to prevent contaminat-
      ing the circuit and gearbox.
   2. Do not damage coupling surfaces.
   3. Handle with care to ensure personnel safety and guar-
      antee reliability of the gearbox.
3121171                                                                                                                                                               3-27
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
   1. Install special tool (6689960310) on the flanged hub   4. Mark position of springs (45) for reassembly.
      (31). Turn screw until it compresses springs (45).
                                                             6. Using pliers, remove circlip (36) from its seat in the brake
   3. Remove spring retainer disc (46).                         shaft (35).
3-28                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                              SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
      1.    Screw                11.   Elastic Ring             21.   Spacer            31.   Flanged Hub             41.   O-ring
      2.    O-ring               12.   Washers                  22.   Ring Nut          32.   Disc (Internal Teeth    42.   O-ring
      3.    Pin                  13.   Spring                   23.   Gearbox Housing   33.   Disc (External Teeth)   43.   Backup Ring
      4.    Screw                14.   Splined Shaft            24.   Bearing           34.   Spacer                  44.   Brake Piston
      5.    Cap Nut              15.   Disengagement Shaft      25.   Spacer            35.   Brake Shaft             45.   Springs
      6.    Oil Plug             16.   1st Reduction Assembly   26.   Spacer            36.   Circlip                 46.   Retainer Disc
      7.    End Cover            17.   2nd Stage Sun Gear       27.   O-ring            37.   Backup Ring             47.   Circlip
      8.    Pad                  18.   2nd Reduction Assembly   28.   Spacer            38.   O-ring
      9.    O-ring               19.   Circlip                  29.   Half Seal         39.   Spacer
      10.   1st Stage Sun Gear   20.   3rd Reduction Assembly   30.   Seal Ring         40.   Backup Ring
3121171                                                                                                                                     3-29
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
   7. Using a puller, remove at the same time, the brake pis-   10.   Remove external O-Ring seal (38) and backup ring (37)
      ton (44), spacer (39) and brake shaft (35).                     from their seat in the spacer (39).
                                                                11.   Remove O-ring seal (42) and backup ring (43) from their
                                                                      seats in the flanged hub (31).
   8. Remove spacer (39) from brake piston (44).
3-30                                                                                                               3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
13. Remove disengagement shaft kit (15). 16. Use pliers to remove elastic ring (11) from splined shaft (14).
  14.   Place the disengagement shaft kit (15) inside the special   17.   Remove special tool, spring (13), and washers (12).
        tool (6689960240).
3121171                                                                                                                             3-31
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  19.   Remove cap nut (5).                                          22.   Remove draining-filling-level oil plugs (6) using a male
                                                                           hex head wrench.
  21.   Remove O-ring seal (2) from its seat in the end cover (7).
                                                                     24.   Remove end cover (7).
3-32                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
25. Remove O-ring seal (9) from its seat in the end cover (7). 28. Remove 2nd stage sun gear (17).
26. Remove 1st stage sun gear (10). 29. Remove 2nd reduction assembly (18).
  27.   Remove 1st reduction assembly (16).                          30.   Using pliers, remove circlips (19) from their seats in the
                                                                           flanged hub's pins (31).
3121171                                                                                                                        3-33
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  31.   Using a puller, remove planet assemblies of the 3rd      34.   Using a tackle, place torque multiplier (ATZ.09.016.0) on
        reduction (20).                                                ring nut (22).
  32.   Remove spacer (21) from their seats in the pins of the   35.   Using the torque multiplier (ATZ.09.016.0), loosen ring
        flanged hub (31).                                              nut (22).
NOTE: To proceed with gearbox disassembly, remove it from        36.   Remove ring nut (22).
      machine and bring it to a properly equipped workshop.
3-34                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                    SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  37.   Using a puller and a metal stopper, remove the flanged     40.   Using a screwdriver, remove 1st half-seal (29) from the
        hub (31) from the gearbox housing (23).                          flanged hub (31).
  38.   Using a tackle, remove gearbox housing (23) from           41.   Using a screwdriver, remove 2nd half-seal (29) from
        flanged hub (31).                                                gearbox housing (23).
  39.   Remove seal ring (30) from flanged hub (31).             NOTE: Gearbox disassembly ends with the above operation. All
                                                                       items are now available for inspection.
3121171                                                                                                                   3-35
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Assembly
 Apply grease TECNOLUBE SEAL GS730 on gearbox housing
                                                                  b. Make sure sealing surfaces (D) of metal rings (E) are
 (23).
                                                                     free from scratches, dings, or foreign substances;
                                                                     metallic ring surfaces must be perfectly clean and
                                                                     dry. We suggest to dip the metallic rings in volatile
                                                                     solvent or industrial degreasing alcohol.
                                                                  c. Carefully clean lapped surface (D) of metal rings (E)
                                                                     and remove dust or fingerprints. Lubricate them
                                                                     with a thin oil film. Do not oil other components.
                                                              2. Assemble half seal (29) on tool (6689960300).
3-36                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3. Assemble 1st half seal (29) on gearbox housing (23). 6. Insert seal ring (30) in its seat in the flanged hub (31).
   4. Using the same tool (6689960300), assemble 2nd half                7. Apply grease TECNOLUBE SEAL GS730 on seal ring (30).
      seal (29) on the flanged hub (31).
3121171                                                                                                                            3-37
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
    9. Using a press and a metallic stopper, push gearbox             11.   Using multiplier (ATZ.09.016.0), tighten ring nut (22),
       housing (23) against shoulder on flanged hub (31) until              using a torque wrench with an input multiplier torque of
       assembling of unit is complete.                                      71 ± 3 ft-lb (96,5 ± 4, 5 Nm) corresponding to an output
                                                                            multiplier torque of 3688 ± 184 ft-lb (5000 ± 250 Nm).
                                                                      12.   Stake ring nut (22) near two seats at 180° of flanged hub
SCREW NUT (22) PARTIALLY IN TO PREVENT FLANGED HUB (31) FROM COM-           (31) on the right side.
ING OUT OF GEARBOX HOUSING (23) DURING THE FOLLOWING STEPS.
3-38                                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  13.   Install spacers (21) on flanged hub (31)pins.               16.   Using pliers, assemble circlips (19) in flanged hub pin
                                                                          seats (31).
  15.   Using a rubber hammer and a metal stopper, push             18.   Install 2nd stage sun gear (17).
        planet assemblies of the 3rd reduction (20) against the
        shoulder until assembly is complete.
3121171                                                                                                                    3-39
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
19. Assemble 1st reduction assembly (16). 22. Place end cover (7) on gearbox housing (23).
  20.   Install 1st stage sun gear (10).                              23.   Tighten 10 socket head screws M10x25 (1),grade 12,9,
                                                                            by a torque wrench to 62.7 ft-lb torque (85 Nm).
  21.   Install O-ring seal (9) into its seat in the end cover (7).
                                                                      24.   Install plugs (6) in oil drain-fill holes of the end cover (7).
                                                                            Torque plugs to 52 ± 7 ft-lb (70±10 Nm).
3-40                                                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                    SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
25. Install O-ring (2) into its seat in the end cover (7). 28. Torque two screws M8x16 (4) to 18.4 ft-lb (25 Nm).
  26.   Protect seat and pin (3) with grease type MOLYKOTE        29.   Install 1st washer (12) on splined shaft (14).
        G6000. Wait 15 minutes for it to completely dry. Insert
        pin (3) in its seat in the end cover (7).
3121171                                                                                                                      3-41
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  31.   Insert splined shaft (14) in special tool (6689960240).       34.   Using pliers, assemble elastic ring (11) into its seat in the
                                                                            splined shaft (14).
32. Insert 2nd washer (12) correctly in the splined shaft (14).
3-42                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  36.   Using pliers, install circlip (36) into its seat in the brake   39.   Insert an internally toothed steel disc (32). Repeat opera-
        shaft (35).                                                           tion until all five sintered bronze discs and four steel
                                                                              discs are installed.
  37.   Turn gearbox upside down. Install brake shaft (35) inside
        flanged hub (31).                                               40.   Fit internal O-ring seal (41) and backup ring (40) into
                                                                              their seats in the spacer (39).
3121171                                                                                                                            3-43
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  42.   Insert spacer (39) inside flanged hub (31). Do not dam-     44.   Lube seal seats into flanged hub (31) and assemble the
        age seals already installed.                                      O-ring seal (42) and the backup ring (43).
  43.   Using a rubber hammer and a metal stopper, push           NOTE: O-ring seals (A) and backup rings (B) must be fitted in seats
        spacer (39) against flanged hub (31). Do not damage             according mutual position shown below.
        seals already installed.
3-44                                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  45.   Insert brake piston (44) inside flanged hub (31). Do not   47.   Insert springs (45) in previously marked brake piston
        damage seals already fitted.                                     (44) holes.
  46.   Using a rubber hammer and a metal stopper, push brake      48.   Install spring retainer disc (46).
        piston (44) against flanged hub (31). Do not damage
        seals already installed.
3121171                                                                                                                 3-45
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  49.   Install special tool (6689960310) on flanged hub (31).      Final Test and Reinstallation
        Turn screw until it compresses springs (45).
                                                                      Check product by remounting it to the machine.
                                                                      Check function of drive hub following all checks shown in
                                                                      Startup and Running In.
                                                                      If work on the brake was performed, check for oil leaks. Follow
                                                                      procedure below:
                                                                        1. Connect pressure pilot line with manometer (with a
                                                                           base scale of 100 bars) to the brake release port.
50. Install circlip (47) in its seat and remove special tool.
NOTE: Before assembling hydraulic motor, verify by a depth slide        2. Open flow valve and release brake with pilot pressure of
      gauge the correct assembly of the unit checking the axial            50 bar.
      distance as shown below.
                                                                        3. Close flow valve and keep brake released 3 minutes or
                                                                           longer.
                                                                        4. Using a manometer, check pressure remains constant.
                                                                    NOTE: If pressure drops, it may mean brake seals are not tight and
                                                                          must be replaced, or reassembling was not completed
                                                                          properly.
3-46                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171                                                                              3-47
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-48                                                                             3121171
                                                          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171                                                                              3-49
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-50                                                                             3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.15 DRIVE HUB - IF EQUIPPED WITH REGGIANA                            8. Wrench for M6, M8, M10 socket head screws and 1/4”G
                                                                         plug.
      RIDUTTORI
                                                                      9. Socket wrench for M6 hexagonal screw.
NOTE: After SN 0300134389 machines may be built with either
      Bonfiglioli or Reggiana Riduttori wheel drive hubs. See Sec-
      tion 3.14, Drive Hub - If Equipped With Bonfiglioli. Do not
      use different hubs on the same machine.                                              M- 1326
Symbol Nomenclature                                                                                  Ø240
                                                                                                     Ø130
Ø30 5x45°
                                                                                                                             35
                                                                                                                       °
           = ADHESIVE                                                                                                15
                                                                                                             R5
                                                                                                     Ø224
10
                                                                                                                      5
                                                                                                      Ø233
                                                                                                     Ø240
                                                                                               60°
                 = LUBRICANT
                                                                                                             60
                                                                                 60
                                                                                                                °
                                                                          A                                           A
= GREASE
                                                                               M- 1537
                 = DISPOSAL                                                                     Ø249
                                                                                                Ø130
Tools                                                                                            Ø30
                                                                                                             N° 4 Hole to 90° Ø30
  Tools required for assembling and disassembling the wheel
  gear RRTD1701TB
                                                                                                                     29.5
    1. Hammer;
    2. Clamps for inner retention rings;                                                        Ø210
                                                                                                              14.5
                                                                                                               10
    6. Torque wrench;
    7. Hydraulic press;
3121171                                                                                                                           3-51
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Ø210
                                                  5x45°
                                    Ø130
                                                           25
                                      Ø30
        M- 1321
                                   LOCTITE 2701
  N° 4 Hole to 90° Ø40
                                                          110
       M- 1320
                                    Ø197.5
                                    Ø210
3-52                                                                           3121171
                                                                                                                  SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
M- 1316 M- 1020
                                                              30
                                            Ø34                                                                                   35        35
                                                                                                                                                           10
                                                                                                                 10                                   10
  M- 1317
                                                                             45°
                                           45°
             8           M- 1317
       N° 4 R
                                                                                                                                                                35
                                                      45°
                                                                    45°
                                                                                                             70
                                                                                                                      A                                              A
                                                                                                                                                                35
 50
                                            M- 1317
                                                                                                                                       70
                                                                                                               50
                                                             216.5
                                                                                                              Ø
      12
                                                                                                                                                           10
                                                                                                                                        Ø11
                                                                    Ø230
                                                                                             20
                                    M- 1316                            10x45°
                                                                                                            60
                                            Ø16                                                   90
                                                                                             70
                                                                                                                                            Ø17
                         55
38
                                                                                                                 11
                                            M- 1317
                                                                                             M- 1317
                          M- 1317                                                                           Figure 3-31. Anti-rotation Block
                                                                       16 n° 8 Routing to 45°
                                                                    Ø205
          0
                                                                                                  20
30° 30°
                                                0
                                              °
                                                                                    30
                                            3
                                                                                       °
                                      30°
30°
A A
3121171                                                                                                                                                                  3-53
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
M- 1126 M- 1126
                          M- 1020
                                                                VTCEI M10X60 n°4
3-54                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                        SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                                              5
                                                 5
                                                               9
                                                                                                   80
                                                                                              70
                                                                        50
                          8.5
                                                                   20
                                         Ø8.5
                                         Ø13.5                                        Ø40.5
                                                                                              5
                                                                                      Ø46
M- 1547
                                                     2.5x15°
                                                                        Ø39.5
t.u. 12
                                                                               88.5
                                                               0
                                                                         3.5
                                                                          M8
                                                Ø20 -0.1
Figure 3-34. Tools For Assembling Bearing 3rd Stage Planetary Gear Assembly Diagram
3121171                                                                                                            3-55
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Disassembly                                                    3. Release the screws from the release cover and pull the
                                                                  pin out.
   1. Remove plugs and pour lubricant in a container.
                                                               4. Remove the BR250 ring and pull cover out. Do not dam-
                                                                  age O-Ring.
3-56                                                                                                           3121171
3121171
          Figure 3-35. Reggiana Riduttori Hub - Sheet 1 of 2
3-57
                                                               SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-58
                                                                                                                                   SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
          1.    Screw                  13.   Iron Brake Disc           25.   Tapered Roller Bearing   37.   O-ring
          2.    Motor Support          14.   Plastic Plug              26.   Bearing Support          38.   Crown Gear
          3.    O-ring                 15.   Spindle                   27.   Ring Nut                 39.   Crown Gear Screw
          4.    Inner Retention Ring   16.   Planet Wheel              28.   Sphere                   40.   O-ring
          5.    Brake Spring Spacer    17.   Bearing                   29.   Screw                    41.   Support Tablet
          6.    Brake Spring           18.   Outer Retention Ring      30.   Pinion                   42.   O-ring
          7.    Brake Piston           19.   Input Shaft               31.   Reduction Gears          43.   Cover
          8.    Parbak                 20.   Input Shaft Bearing       32.   Outer Retention Ring     44.   Steel Plug
          9.    O-ring                 21.   Ring                      33.   Pinion                   45.   Cover Retaining Ring
          10.   O-ring                 22.   Disengagement Spring      34.   Reduction Gears          46.   Disengagement Stud
          11.   Parbak                 23.   Disengagement Shaft       35.   Outer Retention Ring     47.   Disengagement Cap
          12.   Sintered Brake Disc    24.   Spindle Oil Seal          36.   Pinion                   48.   Disengagement Screw
3121171
                                                                                SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
   6. Loosen the M10x25 flathead socket screws. Remove          9. Loosen the M6x6 socket headless screws and remove
      planetary ring. Do not damage O-Ring.                        the 3/16” balls.
7. Remove release joint together with the spring. 10. Loosen the ring nut using the special wrench.
   8. Disassemble the Ø40 outer snap rings. Using an extrac-   11.   Remove hub support with roller bearing inner track.
      tor, remove planetary gears from spindle pins.
3121171                                                                                                               3-59
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  12.   Disassemble the Ø160 inner snap ring and pull the            Assembly
        spring holder spacer out. Remove springs. Using a com-
        pressed air jet in the brake control hole, pull piston out     1. Make sure all wheel gear components are devoid of
        of the spindle.                                                   burrs, machining residues, and are correctly washed.
                                                                       2. Fit ball bearing in input shaft. Lock with a Ø40 outer
                                                                          snap ring.
  14.   Fit ball bearing into input shaft and lock it with a Ø40
        outer snap ring. Install motor shaft in spindle and lock
        with a BR68 ring. Lubricate bearing.
3-60                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                  SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
   4. Fit brake sealing rings O-Ring and PARBAK (lubricated       6. Prepare hub support, mounting on it the two roller bear-
      with grease) in the respective spindle seats. Place the        ing outer tracks. Place first roller bearing inner track.
      brake discs making sure to center them on the spindle
      and on the input shaft.
3121171                                                                                                                    3-61
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
    9. Check unit roll torque and proceed in the following           11.   Using special tool and hammer, make four dents on the
       order:                                                              spindle thread by the M6 holes of the ring nut.
  10.   Keeping spindle locked, apply a setting preload by tight-
        ening ring nut at 40daNm, turn completely the hub sup-
        port twice using the special wrench to recover any
        bearing cage misalignments. Release and tighten the
        ring nut at the final torque of 30daNm (alternate tight-
        ening and some setting turns). Check roll torque with
        seal which must be within 1÷1,5 daNm.
                                                                     12.   Fit the 4 3/16” balls and tighten with LOCTITE 243 the 4
                                                                           M6x6 socket headless screws at the torque of 1daNm.
NOTE: Place ring nut with convex part facing the roller bearing as
      shown below.
3-62                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                     SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  13.   Fit bearings on 3rd stage planetary gears and using a      15.   Place hub on support making the two holes coincide for
        spacer mounting mount everything on the spindle pins.            tightening the M10x25 flathead socket screws at the
        Lock with an outer snap ring. Lubricate bearings.                torque of 5daNm.
16. Fit the reduction gears and the pinion in the unit.
3121171                                                                                                                        3-63
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  17.   Prepare the closing cover fitting the O-ring 5-582 suit-   19.   Fit O-Ring 2-163 suitably greased, on motor coupling
        ably greased and lock it with the shimming ring. Lubri-          flange S-D LC/KC. Mount flange on spindle with 6 M8x25
        cate the bearings.                                               socket capscrews at the torque of 2.4daNm with LOC-
                                                                         TITE 243 Insert pin and perform rotation test according
                                                                         to PGQ-22 standard.
  18.   Fit O-Ring 2-177 suitably greased, mount the cover lock-
        ing it with the BR250 ring.
                                                                   20.   Mount release cover fastening it with 2 M6x20 hexago-
                                                                         nal screws at the torque of 1daNm. Mount the 1/4”GAS
                                                                         plugs on the cover at the torque of 1daNm.
3-64                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                    SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171                                                                                                        3-65
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                                                 6
                                                    4
MAE37970
3-66                                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                                    SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.16 SWING DRIVE HUB                                                            5. Place swing drive hub in the clean area.
                                                                                6. Refer to Figure 3-39., Swing Drive Installation, for swing
Removal                                                                            drive maintenance.
   1. Gently loosen the setscrew (1). Do not remove.                     Assembly/Disassembly
   2. Remove the bolt (2).
                                                                            For detail assembly/disassembly instructions, refer Swing
   3. Remove the mounting bolts (8) securing swing drive                    Drive Hub Manual or contact JLG service for more details.
      hub to the turntable.
                                                                         Installation
   4. Using the suitable lifting device, remove the swing drive
      hub from mounting plate without damaging the swing                    Ensure mounting plate and mounting location of the base
      gear.                                                                 plate are clean and painted with a uniform coating of mini-
                                                                            mum thickness (no runs, drips, etc.).
                                                                                                8
                                                  4
                                                                                               5
                                                                                                               1001228617-D
                                                                                                                 MAE38510D
3121171                                                                                                                                3-67
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
NOTE: Brake must be released before performing the roll test. This
      can be accomplished by pressure testing using the Brake
      Leak Test procedure below or tightening the 12 bolts into
      the piston through the end plate (See Brake Disassembly
      Procedure)
  Roll Test
  The purpose of the roll test is to determine if the unit's gears
  are rotating freely and properly. You should be able to rotate
  the gears in your unit by applying constant force to the roll
  checker. If you feel more drag in the gears only at certain
  points, then the gears are not rolling freely and should be
  examined for improper installation or defects. Some gear
  packages roll with more difficulty than others. Do not be con-
  cerned if the gears in your unit seem to roll hard as long as
  they roll with consistency.
  LEAK TEST (MAIN UNIT)
  The purpose of a leak test is to make sure the unit is air tight.      1. Tighten (but do not torque) bolt “A" until snug.
  You can tell if your unit has a leak if the pressure gauge read-       2. Go to opposite side of bolt circle and tighten bolt “B”
  ing on your air checker starts to fall after unit has been pres-          until equally snug.
  surized and allowed to equalize. Leaks will most likely occur at
  pipe plugs, main seal, or wherever O-rings or gaskets are              3. Crisscross around the bolt circle and tighten remaining
  located. The exact location of a leak can usually be detected by          bolts.
  brushing a soap and water solution around the main seal and            4. Use a torque wrench, apply specified torque to bolt “A”.
  where the O-rings or gaskets meet on the exterior of the unit,
  then checking for air bubbles. If a leak is detected in a seal, O-     5. Using the same sequence, crisscross around the bolt cir-
  ring or gasket, the part must be replaced, and the unit                   cle and apply equal torque to remaining bolts.
  rechecked. Leak test at 10 psi (0.7 bar) for 20 minutes.
3-68                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                  SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Motor Control Valve Disassembly                                    4. Using a wrench, loosen jam nuts on Elbow Fittings (36).
                                                                      Remove fittings from Brake (26) and Motor Control Valve
   1. Place unit on bench with motor end up.                          (32).
   2. Remove O-ring Plug (1J). Drain oil from gearbox.             5. Remove O-ring Plugs (21) from Motor Control Valve (32).
   3. Remove Hydraulic Tubing Assembly (35) by loosening           6. Remove Motor Control Valve (32) from Motor (10) by
      fittings on both ends of tube with a wrench.                    removing four Bolts (34) and washers (33).
Figure 3-40. Swing Drive - Motor Control Valve Disassembly (SN 0300201017 through 0300254456)
3121171                                                                                                                3-69
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Motor and Brake Disassembly                                      3. Remove Gasket (31) between Brake (26) and Motor (10).
                                                                 4. Remove Brake (26) from Main Torque-Hub Assembly
   1. With unit resting on bench with Motor (10) end up,
                                                                    and dump oil out of Brake (26).
      loosen Hex Bolts (29) and remove Lift Lugs (28) from
      Motor (10).                                                5. Remove O-ring (27) between Motor (10) and Brake (26).
   2. Pull Motor (10) straight up and remove from Brake (26).
Figure 3-41. Swing Drive - Motor and Brake Disassembly (SN 0300201017 through 0300254456)
3-70                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                            SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Main Disassembly                                                    6. Remove Thrust Washers (16) and Thrust Bearing (15)
                                                                       between Input Cover (6) and Carrier (3A) Subassembly.
   1. With unit resting on Output Shaft (Pinion) (1A), remove
                                                                    7. Remove Ring Gear (4) from Housing (1G).
      eight Bolts (17), four Shoulder Bolts (18), and four Lock
      Washers (19) from Input Cover (6).                            8. Remove O-ring (5) between Ring Gear (4) and Housing
                                                                       (1G).
   2. Thread either 1/2-13 UNC eye bolts or motor mounting
      Bolts (29) into threaded holes in Input Cover (6) and pull    9. Remove Carrier (3A) Subassembly.
      Input Cover (6) off on the main assembly.
                                                                   10.     Remove Thrust Washers (16) and Thrust Bearing (15)
   3. Remove O-ring (5) between Input Cover (6) and Ring                   between Carrier (3A) Subassembly and Internal Gear (2).
      Gear (4).
                                                                   11.     Remove Internal Gear (2).
   4. Remove Thrust Washer (8) from end of Sun Gear (13).
   5. Remove Sun Gear (13).
Figure 3-42. Swing Drive - Main Disassembly (SN 0300201017 through 0300254456)
3121171                                                                                                                     3-71
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
   2. Remove Thrust Washer (1H).                                NOTE: If bearing replacement is necessary, Bearing Cups (1C & 1E)
                                                                      can be removed with a slide hammer puller or driven out
   3. While supporting Housing (1G) on Output Shaft (1A)              with a punch.
      end, press Output Shaft (1A) out of Housing (1G).
NOTE: Lip Seal (1B) may or may not be pressed out of Housing
      (1G) by Bearing Cone (1D) during this step.
Figure 3-43. Swing Drive - Hub Shaft Disassembly (SN 0300201017 through 0300254456)
3-72                                                                                                                   3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Carrier Disassembly                                               3. Slide Planet Gear (3F), two Ball-Indented Thrust Washers
                                                                     (3H), and two Thrust Washers (3B) out of Carrier (3A).
   1. Using a 3/16” (5 mm) punch drive Roll Pin (3G) which
                                                                  4. Remove both rows of Needle Bearings (3C) and Spacer
      holds Planet Shaft (3E) in Carrier (3A) down into the
                                                                     (3D) from bore of Planet Gear (3F).
      Planet Shaft (3E) until it bottoms.
                                                                  5. Repeat Steps 1 thru 4 for the remaining two Cluster
NOTE: Make sure Roll Pin has bottomed. Otherwise, damage to
                                                                     Gears (3F).
      carrier could occur when Planet Shaft is removed.
Figure 3-44. Swing Drive - Carrier Disassembly (SN 0300201017 through 0300254456)
3121171                                                                                                                3-73
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Hub-Shaft Sub-Assembly                                                9. Install Bearing Spacer (1H) on Output Shaft (1A) and
                                                                         against Bearing Cone (1F).
   1. Press Bearing Cone (1D) onto Shaft (1A).
                                                                     10.   Install Retaining Ring (1I) in groove of Output Shaft (1A).
   2. Press Bearing Cup (1C) into Housing (1G). Ensure cup                 This Retaining Ring (1I) should never be reused in a
      starts square with bore of Hub (1G).                                 repair or rebuild.
   3. Place Bearing Cone (1D) in Bearing Cup (1C) in Housing
      1G).
                                                                        EYE PROTECTION SHOULD BE WORN DURING THIS PROCEDURE.
   4. Press or tap Seal (1B) into counterbore of Housing (1G)
      to the point where it becomes flush with the Housing
                                                                     11.   Tap Retaining Ring (1I) with a soft metal punch to ensure
      (1G) face. Ensure Seal (1B) is correctly installed (smooth
                                                                           Retaining Ring (1I) is completely seated in groove of
      face up).
                                                                           Output Shaft (1A).
   5. Invert Hub (1G) and press Bearing Cup (1E) into counter-
      bore of Housing (1G).
   6. Carefully lower Housing (1G) onto Output Shaft (1A).              EYE PROTECTION SHOULD BE WORN DURING THIS PROCEDURE.
   7. Start Bearing Cone (1F) onto Output Shaft (1A).                12.   Install O-ring Plug (1J). Torque to 23 to 24 ft-lb (32 - 33.5
   8. Press or tap Bearing Cone (1F) onto Output Shaft (1A)                Nm).
      until it is seated in Bearing Cup (1E).
           1A. Output Shaft               1D. Tapered Bearing Cone   1G. Housing                 1I. Retaining Ring
           1B. Lip Seal                   1E. Tapered Bearing Cup    1H. Thrust Washer           1J. O-Ring Plug
           1C. Tapered Bearing Cup        1F. Tapered Bearing Cone
Figure 3-45. Swing Drive - Hub Shaft Sub-Assembly (SN 0300201017 through 0300254456)
3-74                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Carrier Sub-Assembly                                                 8. Slide second Thrust Washer (3E) between Cluster Gear
                                                                        (3F) and Carrier (3A) with tang of washer located in the
   1. Apply a liberal coat of grease to the bore of Cluster Gear        cast slot of Carrier (3A). Slide ball-indented Thrust
      (3F). This will enable Needle Rollers (3C) to be held in          Washer (3H) onto end of the Planet Shaft with indents
      place during assembly.                                            against second thrust Washer. Finish sliding the Planet
                                                                        Shaft (3E) through Thrust Washers (3H) & (3B) and into
   2. Install first row of 14 Needle Rollers (3C) into bore of
                                                                        the Carrier (3A).
      Cluster Gear (3F).
                                                                     9. Position the non-chamfered side on the Planet Shaft (3E)
   3. Insert Spacer (3D) into bore of Cluster Gear (3F) on top of
                                                                        roll pin hole so that it is in line with the hole in the Car-
      Needle Rollers (3C).
                                                                        rier (3A) using a 1/8” (3 mm) diameter punch.
   4. Place second row of Needle Rollers (3C) into bore of
                                                                    10.   Use a 3/16” (5 mm) punch to align the two roll pin holes.
      Cluster Gear (3F) against Spacer (3D). Remove Planet
                                                                          Drive Roll Pin (3G) through Carrier (3A) and into the
      Shaft (3E).
                                                                          Planet Shaft (3E) until Roll Pin (3G) is flush with bottom
   5. Place Carrier (3A) into tool fixture so one of the roll pin         of cast tang slot in the Carrier (3A). Use a 1/4” (6 mm) pin
      holes is straight up.                                               punch to make sure Roll Pin (3G) is flush in the slot.
   6. Start Planet Shaft (3E) through hole in Carrier (3A). Using   11.   Repeat Steps 1 - 10 for remaining two Cluster Gears (3F).
      ample grease to hold it in position, slide one Thrust
      Washer (3B) over Planet Shaft (3E) with tang resting in
      cast slot of the Carrier (3A). Place Ball-Indented Thrust
      Washer (3H) on Planet Shaft (3E) with indents against
      first washer.
   7. With large end of Cluster Gear (3F) facing roll pin hole in
      the carrier, place cluster gear into position in Carrier
      (3A). Push Planet Shaft (3E) through Cluster Gear (3F)
      without going all the way through.
3121171                                                                                                                         3-75
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Figure 3-46. Swing Drive - Carrier Sub-Assembly (SN 0300201017 through 0300254456)
3-76                                                                                               3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Main Assembly                                                            9. While holding Ring Gear (4) and Cluster Gears (3F) in
                                                                            mesh, place small end of Cluster Gears (3F) into mesh
    1. With Hub Shaft Sub-Assembly resting on Shaft (1A)                    with the Internal Gear (2) and Input Gear (13). On the
       install Internal Gear (2). Spline of Internal Gear (2) bore          Ring Gear (4) locate hole marked “X”, or punch marked,
       will mesh with spline of the Output Shaft (1A).                      over one of the marked counter-bored holes (Step 5) in
                                                                            Hub (1G). Check timing through slots in the carrier.
    2. Inspect location of Internal Gear (2) on Output Shaft
                                                                            Rotate carrier in assembly to check freedom of rotation.
       (1A). The portion of the Output Shaft (1A), which does
       not have full spline, should protrude through the Inter-      NOTE: NOTE: If gears do not mesh easily or Carrier Assembly does
       nal Gear (2) bore.                                                  not rotate freely, remove Carrier and Ring Gear and check
                                                                           Cluster Gear timing
    3. Install two Thrust Washers (15) and one Thrust Bearing
       (16) on portion of Output Shaft (1A) which protrudes            10.   Install Thrust Washer (15)/Thrust Bearing (16) set into
       through Internal Gear (2).                                            the counter-bore in the face of the carrier. Use grease to
    4. Center Input Gear (13) on end of the Output Shaft (1A)                hold in place.
       opposite gear with large diameter down.                         11.   Place O-ring (5) into Cover (6) counter-bore. Use grease
    5. Place O-ring (5) into Hub counter-bore. Use grease to                 to hold O-Ring in place.
       hold O-ring in place.
3121171                                                                                                                           3-77
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Figure 3-47. Swing Drive - Main Assembly (SN 0300201017 through 0300254456)
3-78                                                                                          3121171
                                                                                    SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Motor and Brake Assembly                                          4. Assemble Lift Lugs (28) onto Hex Bolts (29). Assemble
                                                                     Hex Bolts (29) with Lift Lugs through the Motor (10) and
   1. Place O-ring (27) onto end of Brake (26) and locate brake      Brake (26) against the motor flange. Torque to 35 ft-lb.
      into pilot of cover.
                                                                  5. Fill Brake (26) with 2.7 oz (80cc) of BRAKOILVG32
   2. Place Gasket (31) on brake face and line up holes.             (DTE24).
   3. Place Motor (10) into Brake pilot against Gasket (31).
Figure 3-48. Swing Drive - Motor and Brake Assembly (SN 0300201017 through 0300254456)
3121171                                                                                                                3-79
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Motor Control Valve Assembly                                                       4. Assemble Tube (35) into Elbow Fittings (36) and torque
                                                                                      13 to 15 ft-lb (18 to 21 Nm).
    1. Lay assembly down with motor ports facing up. Remove
                                                                                   5. Install O-ring Plugs (21) into Motor Control Valve (32)
       two plastic plugs in motor ports, being careful not to
                                                                                      and torque 30 to 31 ft-lb (42 to 43 Nm).
       loose O-ring in each port. Assemble Motor control Valve
       (32) to Motor (10) with Bolt (34) and Lock Washers (33).                    6. Pressure test brake, tube and control valve connections
       Torque Bolts (33) 23 to 27 ft-lb (32 to 38 Nm).                                by applying 3000 psi (207 bar) pressure to brake bleed
                                                                                      port and holding for 1 minute. Check for leaks at control-
NOTE: Align holes in control valve with motor ports.
                                                                                      valve-motor interface and the tube connections.
    2. Install Elbow Fittings (36) into Brake (26) and torque 13                      Release pressure.
       to 15 ft-lb (18 to 21 Nm).                                                  7. Install I.D. Plate (24) on Housing (1G) with two Drive
    3. Install Elbow Fittings (36) into Motor Control Valve (32)                      Screws (25). Plate must be inline with O-ring Plug (1J).
       and torque to 13 to 15 ft-lb (18 to 21 Nm).
Figure 3-49. Swing Drive - Motor Control Valve Assembly (SN 0300201017 through 0300254456)
3-80                                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                                  SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
15
                                                                                                                    11
                                                                                                      9        10
                                                                                       12
                                                                             13
                                                                                                                                                   17
                                                                      12
                                                                                                                                         14
                                                                                                                                  16
                                                             8
                               5          6
                                                   4
                         4
                    3
               2                                             7                                                               40
                                                                                                          30
                                                                                                                6    27
    1
                                                                                                 26
                                                                                           25
                                                                                  20
                                                                            18                                                  28
                                                                       19
                                                                                                                                29
                                                                 18
                                                   24                                                                    7
                                                                                                               27
                                              23
                                         22
                                    21                                                                               49
                         20                                                                               48
                    18
               19
          18                                                                                43                                                 47
                                                                                                                                        46
                                                                                                                          45
44
                                                                                                 42
                                                                                      41
                                                                                 31
                                                                            32
                                                                    39
                                                                  38
                                                             37
                                                        36
                                                   35
                                              32
                                         31
                                   34
                         33                                                                                                         1001228488-B
                                                                                                                                      MAE37600B
3121171                                                                                                                                                 3-81
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-82                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                                   SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171                                                                                                                                 3-83
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
    4. Remove friction plates (3 & 6) and pressure plate (4).         1. Lightly lubricate rotary shaft seal (12) and assemble to
                                                                         housing (2) taking care not to damage seal lip.
    5. Remove 2-off dowel pins (19).
3-84                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
   2. Apply ring of Loctite 641 or equivalent adhesive to full        4. Lubricate O-ring seals (15 & 17) with Molykote 55M (or
      circumference of housing (2) bearing recess adjacent to            equivalent) silicone grease and assemble together with
      shoulder. Apply complete coverage of Loctite 641 to                backing rings (16 & 18) to piston (9). To ensure correct
      outside diameter of bearing (10) and assemble fully in             brake operation, it is important that the backing rings
      housing (2), retaining with internal retaining ring (11).          are assembled opposite to the pressurized side of piston
      Remove excess adhesive with clean cloth. Press shaft (1)           (9).
      through bearing (10), ensuring bearing inner ring is ade-
                                                                      5. Correctly orientate piston (9) aligning spaces with the
      quately supported.
                                                                         two dowel pin holes and, assemble into cylinder hous-
   3. Assemble correct quantity of springs (8) as shown. Refer           ing (2) taking care not to damage seals and carefully lay
      to (See Figure 3-53.)and (See Figure 3-54.).                       aside.
                                                                      6. Loctite two-off pins (19) in housing (2) followed by pres-
                                                                         sure plate (4) and friction plates i.e. an inner (3) followed
                                                                         by an outer (6) in correct sequence.
                                                                      7. Position gasket (7) in correct orientation.
                                                                      8. Align two holes in cylinder with dowel pins (19) and
                                                                         assemble piston & cylinder sub-assembly to remainder
                                                                         of brake securing with 6-off socket head capscrews and
                                                                         washers (13 & 14). Torque to 55ft-lb (75 Nm).
3121171                                                                                                                         3-85
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-86                                                                                                 3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                          3. Remove the five, six, or seven special ring head bolts (1)
                                                                             using an appropriate 1/2 or 9/16 inch size socket.
                                                                             Inspect bolts for damaged threads, or sealing rings,
                                                                             under the bolt head. Replace damaged bolts.
3121171                                                                                                                             3-87
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                           NOTE: The insert and if included the orifice plug in the end cover
                                                                                 (2) must not be removed as they are serviced as an integral
                                                                                 part of the end cover.
3-88                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
   6. Thoroughly wash end cover (2) in proper solvent and             8. Remove commutator (5) and seal ring (3) Remove seal
      blow dry. Be sure the end cover valve apertures, includ-           ring from commutator, using an air hose to blow air into
      ing the internal orifice plug, are free of contamination.          ring groove until seal ring is lifted out and discard seal
      Inspect end cover for cracks and the bolt head recesses            ring. Inspect commutator for cracks or burrs, wear, scor-
      for good bolt head sealing surfaces. Replace end cover             ing, spalling or brinelling. If any of these conditions exist,
      as necessary.                                                      replace commutator and commutator ring as a matched
                                                                         set.
3121171                                                                                                                          3-89
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  10.   Remove rotor set (8) and warplane (9), together to retain
        the rotor set in its assembled form, maintaining the
        same rotor vane (8C) to stator (8B) contact surfaces. The
        drive link (10) may come away from the coupling shaft
        (12) with the rotor set, and wearplate.You may have to
        shift the rotor set on the warplane to work the drive link
        out of the rotor (8A) and warplane. Inspect the rotor set
        in its assembled form for nicks, scoring, or spalling on
        any surface and for broken or worn splines. If the rotor
        set component requires replacement, the complete              NOTE: Series TG Torqlinks™ may have a rotor set with two stator
        rotor set must be replaced as it is a matched set. Inspect          halves (8B) with a seal ring (4) between them and two sets
        the warplane for cracks, brinelling, or scoring. Discard            of seven vanes (8C). Discard seal ring only if stator halves
        seal ring (4) that is between the rotor set and wearplate.          become disassembled during the service procedures.
                                                                        11.   Place rotor set (8) and wear plate (9) on a flat surface
                                                                              and center rotor (8A) in stator (8B) such that two
                                                                              rotor lobes (180 degrees apart) and a roller vane
                                                                              (8C) centerline are on the same stator centerline.
                                                                              Check the rotor lobe to roller vane clearance with a
                                                                              feeler gage at this common centerline. If there is
                                                                              more than 0.005 inches (0.13 mm) of clearance,
                                                                              replace rotor set.
                                                                      NOTE:    If rotor set (8) has two stator halves (8B & 8D) and two sets
                                                                              of seven vanes (8C & 8E) as shown in the alternate con-
                                                                              struction TG rotor set assembly view, check the rotor lobe
                                                                              to roller vane clearance at both ends of rotor.
3-90                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                        SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  12.   Remove drive link (10) from coupling shaft (12) if it was     15.   Remove coupling shaft (12), by pushing on the output
        not removed with rotor set and wear plate. Inspect drive            end of shaft. Inspect coupling shaft bearing and seal sur-
        link for cracks and worn or damaged splines. No percep-             faces for spalling, nicks, grooves, severe wear or corro-
        tible lash (play) should be noted between mating spline             sion and discoloration. Inspect for damaged or worn
        parts. Remove and discard seal ring (4) from housing                internal and external splines or keyway. Replace cou-
        (18).                                                               pling shaft if any of these conditions exist.
3121171                                                                                                                           3-91
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  17.   Remove thrust bearing (15) and thrust washer (14)            19.   Remove housing (18) from vise, invert it and remove and
        Inspect for wear, brinelling, corrosion and a full comple-         discard seal (20). A blind hole bearing or seal puller is
        ment of retained rollers.                                          required.
  18.    Remove seal (16) and backup washer (17) from Small          20.   Inspect housing (18) assembly for cracks, the machined
        Frame, housing (18). Discard both.                                 surfaces for nicks, burrs, brinelling or corrosion. Remove
                                                                           burrs that can be removed without changing dimen-
                                                                           sional characteristics. Inspect tapped holes for thread
                                                                           damage. If the housing is defective in these areas, dis-
                                                                           card the housing assembly.
3-92                                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  21.   If housing (18) assembly has passed inspection to this       NOTE: The depth or location of bearing/bushing (13) in relation to
        point, inspect housing bearings/bushings (19) and (13)             the housing wear plate surface and the depth or location
        and if they are captured in the housing cavity, the two            of bearing/bushing (19) in relation to the beginning of
        thrust washers (14) and thrust bearing (15). Bearing roll-         bearing/bushing counter bore should be measured and
        ers must be firmly retained in bearing cages, but must             noted before removing the bearings/ bushings. This will
        rotate and orbit freely. All rollers and thrust washers            facilitate the correct reassembly of new bearings/bushings.
        must be free of brinelling and corrosion. The bushing
        (19) or (13) to coupling shaft diameter clearance must
        not exceed 0.010 inch (0.025 mm). A bearing, bushing,
        or thrust washer that does not pass inspection must be
        replaced. If the housing has passed this inspection the
        disassembly of the Torqlink™ is completed.
3121171                                                                                                                          3-93
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Assembly
  Replace all seals and seal rings with new ones each time you
  reassemble the Torqlink™ unit. Lubricate all seals and seal rings
  with SAE 10W40 oil or clean grease before assembly.
SINCE THEY ARE FLAMMABLE, BE EXTREMELY CAREFUL WHEN USING ANY         IF BEARING MANDREL SPECIFIED IN “TOOLS AND MATERIALS REQUIRED FOR
SOLVENT. EVEN A SMALL EXPLOSION OR FIRE COULD CAUSE INJURY OR         SERVICING” SECTION IS NOT AVAILABLE AND ALTERNATE METHODS ARE USED
DEATH.                                                                TO PRESS IN BEARING/BUSHING (13) AND (19) THE BEARING/BUSHING
                                                                      DEPTHS SPECIFIED MUST BE ACHIEVED TO INSURE ADEQUATE BEARING SUP-
                                                                      PORT AND CORRECT RELATIONSHIP TO ADJACENT COMPONENTS WHEN
                                                                      ASSEMBLED.
WEAR EYE PROTECTION AND BE SURE TO COMPLY WITH OSHA OR OTHER MAX-
IMUM AIR PRESSURE REQUIREMENTS.
    1. If housing (18) bearing components were removed for            BECAUSE BEARING/BUSHINGS (13) AND (19) HAVE A PRESS FIT INTO THE
       replacement, thoroughly coat and pack a new outer              HOUSING THEY MUST BE DISCARDED WHEN REMOVED. THEY MUST NOT BE
       bearing/bushing (19) with clean corrosion resistant            REUSED.
       grease recommended in the material section. Press the
       new bearing/bushing into the counterbore at the
       mounting flange end of the housing, using the appro-
       priate sized bearing mandrel, which will control the
       bearing/ bushing depth.
3-94                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                                 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                3. Press a new dirt and water seal (20) into the housing (18)
                                                                   outer bearing counterbore.
                                                               The Torqlink™ dirt and water seal (20) must be pressed in until
                                                               its’ flange is flush against the housing.
3121171                                                                                                                 3-95
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
    4. Place housing (18) assembly into a soft jawed vise with           6. Assemble thrust washer (14) then thrust bearing (15)
       the coupling shaft bore down, clamping against the                   removed from the Torqlink™.
       mounting flange.
                                                                     NOTE: Torqlinks™ require one thrust washer (14) with thrust bear-
    5. On the Torqlinks™ assemble a new backup washer (17)                 ing (15). Coupling shaft will be seated directly against the
       and new seal (16) with the seal lip facing toward the               thrust bearing.
       inside of Torqlink™, into their respective counterbores in
       housing (18) if they were not assembled in procedure 2.           7. Apply masking tape around splines or keyway on shaft
                                                                            (12) to prevent damage to seal.
3-96                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                      NOTE: One or two alignment studs screwed finger tight into hous-
                                                                            ing (18) bolt holes, approximately 180 degrees apart, will
OUTER BEARING (19) IS NOT LUBRICATED BY THE SYSTEM’S HYDRAULIC              facilitate the assembly and alignment of components as
FLUID. BE SURE IT IS THOROUGHLY PACKED WITH RECOMMENDED GREASE,             required in the following procedures.The studs can be
PARKER GEAR GREASE SPECIFICATION #045236, E/M LUBRICANT #K-70M.             made by cutting off the heads of either 3/8-24 UNF 2A or 5/
                                                                            16-24 UNF 2A bolts as required that are over 0.5 inch (12.7
NOTE: Mobil Mobilith SHC ® 460                                              mm) longer than the bolts (1) used in the Torqlink™.
NOTE: A 102Tube (PN 406010) is included in each seal kit.               10.   Install drive link (10) the long splined end down into the
                                                                              coupling shaft (12) and engage the drive link splines
NOTE: The coupling shaft (12) will be flush or just below the hous-           into mesh with the coupling shaft splines.
      ing wear plate surface on Torqlinks™ when properly seated.
      The coupling shaft must rotate smoothly on the thrust
      bearing package.
                                                                      NOTE: Use any alignment marks put on the coupling shaft and
                                                                            drive link before disassembly to assemble the drive link
                                                                            splines in their original position in the mating coupling
                                                                            shaft splines.
                                                                        11.   Assemble wear plate (9) over drive link (10) and align-
                                                                              ment studs onto the housing (18).
3121171                                                                                                                           3-97
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  12.   Apply a small amount of clean grease to a new seal ring         14.   Apply clean grease to a new seal ring (4) and assemble it
        (4) and assemble it into the seal ring groove on the wear             in the seal ring groove in the rotor set contact side of
        plate side of the rotor set stator (8B).                              manifold (7).
  13.   Install the assembled rotor set (8) onto wear plate (9)       NOTE: The manifold (7) is made up of several plates bonded
        with rotor (8A) counterbore and seal ring side down and             together permanently to form an integral component.The
        the splines into mesh with the drive link splines.                  manifold surface that must contact the rotor set has it’s
                                                                            series of irregular shaped cavities on the largest circumfer-
                                                                            ence or circle around the inside diameter.The polished
                                                                            impression left on the manifold by the rotor set is another
                                                                            indication of which surface must contact the rotor set.
NOTE: The rotor set rotor counterbore side must be down against         16.   Apply grease to a new seal ring (4) and insert it in the
      wear plate for drive link clearance and to maintain original            seal ring groove exposed on the manifold.
      rotor-drive link spline contact. A rotor set without a coun-
      terbore that was not etched before disassembly can be
      reinstalled using the drive link spline pattern on the rotor
      splines if apparent, to determine which side was down.The
      rotor set seal ring groove faces toward the wear plate (9).
3-98                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                        SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  17.   Assemble commutator ring (6) over alignment studs             20.   Assemble a new seal ring (4) into end cover (2) and
        onto the manifold.                                                  assemble end cover over the alignment studs and onto
                                                                            the commutator set. If end cover has only 5 bolt holes
                                                                            make sure cover holes are aligned with the 5 threaded
                                                                            holes in housing (18). The correct 5 bolt end cover bolt
                                                                            hole relationship to housing port bosses.
  18.   Assemble a new seal ring (3) flat side up, into commuta-
        tor (5) and assemble commutator over the end of drive
        link (10) onto manifold (7) with seal ring side up.
                                                                    NOTE:    If end cover has a valve (24) or has five bolt holes, use the
                                                                            line you previously scribed on the cover to radially align the
                                                                            end cover into its original position.
3121171                                                                                                                             3-99
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  21.    Assemble the five or seven special bolts (1) and screw in        22.   Torque two shuttle valve plug assemblies (21) in end
         finger tight. Remove and replace the two alignment                     cover assembly to 9-12 ft-lb (12-16 N m) if cover is so
         studs with bolts after the other bolts are in place. Alter-            equipped.
         nately and progressively tighten bolts to pull end cover
                                                                          23.   Torque the two relief valve plug assemblies (21) in end
         and other components into place with a final torque of
                                                                                cover assembly to 45-55 ft-lb (61-75 N m) if cover is so
         22-26 ft- lb for five bolts or 45-55 ft-lb (61-75 Nm) for the
                                                                                equipped.
         seven 3/8-24 threaded bolts.
3-100                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
   3. Assemble rotor (8A), counterbore down if applicable,            5. Grasp output end of coupling shaft (12) with locking pli-
      into stator (8B), and onto wear plate (9) with rotor               ers or other appropriate turning device and rotate cou-
      splines into mesh with drive link (10) splines.                    pling shaft, drive link and rotor to seat the rotor and
                                                                         assembled vanes (8C) into stator (8B), creating the nec-
                                                                         essary clearance to assemble the seventh or full comple-
                                                                         ment of seven vanes. Assemble the seven vanes using
                                                                         minimum force.
EXCESSIVE FORCE USED TO PUSH THE ROTOR VANES INTO PLACE COULD
SHEAR OFF THE COATING APPLIED TO THE STATOR VANE POCKETS.
3121171                                                                                                                    3-101
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.20 PROCEDURE FOR SETTING GEAR BACKLASH                         5. Pre-torque capscrews (shown below) to 90 ft-lb (122
                                                                    Nm) with JLG Threadlocker PN 0100019.
   1. Set backlash to 0.010 to 0.015" using the following pro-
      cedure.
   2. Place shim (JLG PN 4071041) between pinion and bear-
      ing on bearing high spot. The bearing high spot should
      be stamped with an “X” on the surface below the teeth
      and marked with yellow paint in the tooth space.
   3. Torque shoulder screw (shown below) to 660 ft-lb (896      6. Tighten setscrew (shown below) until pinion is com-
      Nm) with JLG Threadlocker PN 0100019.                         pletely snug against shim and bearing, then back off the
                                                                    setscrew.
3-102                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                  SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
   8. Tighten jam nut (shown below) with JLG Threadlocker       The Swing Gearbox is to be filled with 79 ounces (2.3 L) of API
      PN 0100019.                                               Service Classification GL-5 Extreme Pressure Gear Lube. Fill to
                                                                cover the ring gear..
                                                                Swing Brake is to be filled half full, 2.7 ounces (80 ml), with
                                                                DTE24 oil.
3121171                                                                                                                 3-103
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
MAE37630
3-104                                                                 3121171
                                                                                               SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.22 TURNTABLE BEARING                                                             d. Check a sample of bolts in this 90° quadrant (45° left
                                                                                      and right of indicated position) of the bolt circle.
Turntable Bearing Mounting Bolts Condition Check                                   e. Swing turntable 90 degrees and check selected
                                                                                      bolts at the new position.
                                                                                   f. Continue rotating turntable at 90 degree intervals
                                                                                      until a sampling of bolts have been checked in all
THE TURNTABLE BEARING IS ONE OF THE MOST CRITICAL POINTS ON AN AER-
                                                                                      quadrants.
IAL LIFT. IT IS HERE STRESSES OF LIFTING ARE CONCENTRATED AT THE CENTER
OF ROTATION. BECAUSE OF THIS, PROPER MAINTENANCE OF THE SWING                2. Check turntable side bearing bolts as follows:
BEARING BOLTS IS A MUST FOR SAFE OPERATION.
                                                                                   a. Raise main boom to be fully elevated and retracted.
                                                                                      Raise Tower boom 10° or enough to gain access to
NOTE: This check must be performed after first 50 hours of
                                                                                      bearing bolts. Raise jib to be fully elevated and cen-
      machine operation and every 600 hours of machine opera-
                                                                                      tered. Center platform and keep it unloaded. (See
      tion thereafter. If any bolts are missing or loose, replace
                                                                                      Figure 3-69.)
      with new bolts. Apply JLG Threadlocker PN 0100019 to the
      bolt threads and torque to 190 ft-lb (260 Nm). Check all
      bolts for looseness after replacing or re-torquing any bolt.
                                                                          NEVER WORK BENEATH BOOM WITHOUT FIRST ENGAGING BOOM SAFETY
    1. Check frame side bearing bolts as follows:                         PROP OR PROVIDING ADEQUATE OVERHEAD SLING SUPPORT OR BLOCKING.
          a. Raise main boom to be fully elevated and retracted.
             Stow tower boom. Raise jib to be fully elevated and                   b. At position indicated on Figure 3-69., try to insert a
             centered. Center platform and keep it unloaded.                          0.0015 in (0.038 mm) feeler gauge between turnta-
             (See Figure 3-68.)                                                       ble side bearing bolt and hardened washer.
          b. At position indicated on Figure 3-68., try to insert a
             0.0015 in (0.038 mm) feeler gauge between frame                 
             side bearing bolt and hardened washer.
                                                                                                                      	
                                                                                
                                  
                                               	
                        
                                    
                                                                                
                                  
       
                                     
                                                      
                           
       
       
                                     
                
                                                                               Figure 3-62. Turntable Side Bearing Bolt Location
                                          
                                                                                   c. Ensure 0.0015 in (0.038 mm) feeler gauge will not fit
        Figure 3-60. Frame Side Bearing Bolt Location                                 under bolt head to bolt shank as shown in Figure 3-63.
         	
         
                                                                                                             	
                                                                                                             
3121171                                                                                                                              3-105
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
        e. Fully raise the tower boom. Lower main boom to be              c. Position indicator point to measure turntable base
           horizontal and fully extended. Position jib and plat-             plate (on doubling plate) 3.5 in (88.9 mm) from gear
           form to be horizontal and centered. (See Figure 3-70.)            tooth root as shown in Figure 3-65. and Figure 3-66.
        f. At position indicated in Figure 3-70., try and insert a
           0.0015 in (0.038 mm) feeler gauge between bolt
           head and hardened washer.
        g. Ensure 0.0015 in (0.038 mm) feeler gauge will not fit                                       
           under bolt head to bolt shank as shown in Figure 3-63.
        h. Check a sample of bolts in this 90° quadrant of the
           bolt circle (45° left and right of indicated position).   
                                                                     
Turntable Bearing Wear Measurement
   1. Position machine as follows and as shown in Figure 3-68.
        a. Rotate turntable 90° so counterweight is over right                                            
           side of frame.                                                                               		
        b. Stow tower boom.
        c. Raise main boom to be fully elevated and retracted         Figure 3-65. Turntable Bearing Measurement Point
        d. Raise jib to be fully elevated and centered
        e. Center platform and keep it unloaded
                                                                                   3.5 in (88.9 mm)
   2. Set up dial indicator as follows:
        a. Locate dial indicator at rear center of machine, next
           to bearing, and opposite counterweight.
        b. Position magnetic base of the indicator on vertical
           member of frame as shown in Figure 3-64.
3-106                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
    6. Position machine back to the first position as outlined in      Determine turntable bearing wear measurement allowance by
       Step 1 and shown in Figure 3-68. The dial indicator             bearing model as shown in Figure 3-7.
       should return to zero. If dial indicator does not return to
       zero, determine corrective action and repeat test.                Table 3-7. Turntable Bearing Wear by Bearing Model
    7. Determine which model turntable bearing is installed                      Bearing Model         Wear Measurement
       by checking location shown in Figure 3-67. and compar-
                                                                                      1                 0.179 in (4.54 mm)
       ing with markings in Table 3-6.
                                                                                      2                0.205 in (5.214 mm)
NOTE: JLG Boom Lifts may utilize multiple model bearings.                             3                 0.255 in (6.47 mm)
                                                                                      4                  0.197 in (5 mm)
Model Marking
     2                       JLG 1234567 A
                             XX 0001 11 04
4 D123456
3121171                                                                                                                         3-107
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                            	
	
                                                
	
                                                
	
                                
	
                                
		
                                   	
	
                       
                                            	
                    
	                                            
	
3-108                                                                                            3121171
                                                               SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                      
                                         	
                                         
                             
                             	
                             	
             	
          
	
3121171                                                                                  3-109
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                      	
                                                                                    
                                                                                    	
                                                                                    
                    
                    
                              
3-110                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
    2. Attach an adequate support sling to the boom. Remove          JLG INDUSTRIES RECOMMENDS DISCARDING ALL REMOVED BEARING BOLTS
       all slack from sling. Prop or block boom if possible.         AND REPLACING WITH NEW BOLTS. SINCE THE TURNTABLE BEARING IS THE
                                                                     ONLY STRUCTURAL LINK BETWEEN FRAME AND TURNTABLE, IT IS IMPERA-
    3. From inside turntable, remove mounting hardware
                                                                     TIVE THAT SUCH REPLACEMENT HARDWARE MEETS JLG SPECIFICATIONS. USE
       attaching rotary coupling retaining yoke brackets to
                                                                     OF GENUINE JLG HARDWARE IS HIGHLY RECOMMENDED.
       turntable.
                                                                         2. Spray a light coat of Safety Solvent 13 on new bearing
                                                                            bolts.
HYDRAULIC LINES AND PORTS SHOULD BE CAPPED IMMEDIATELY AFTER DIS-
                                                                         3. Apply a light coating of JLG Threadlocker PN 0100019 to
CONNECTING LINES TO AVOID ENTRY OF CONTAMINANTS INTO THE SYSTEM.
                                                                            new bearing bolts. Loosely install bolts and washers to
                                                                            frame and bearing outer race.
    4. Tag and disconnect hydraulic lines from fittings on top
       of rotary coupling. Use a suitable container to retain any
       residual hydraulic fluid. Immediately cap lines and ports.
                                                                     IF COMPRESSED AIR OR ELECTRICALLY OPERATED IMPACT WRENCH IS USED
    5. Attach suitable overhead lifting equipment to base of
                                                                     FOR TIGHTENING BEARING ATTACHMENT BOLTS, CHECK TOOL TORQUE SET-
       turntable.
                                                                     TING ACCURACY BEFORE USE.
    6. Scribe a line on the turntable bearing inner race and
       underside of turntable. This will aid in aligning the bear-       4. Torque bolts to 190 ft-lb (260 Nm) in sequence shown in
       ing during re-installation. Remove bolts and washers                 Figure 3-72., Turntable Bearing Torque Sequence.
       attaching turntable to bearing inner race. Discard bolts.
                                                                         5. Remove lifting equipment from bearing.
    7. Carefully lift complete turntable assembly from bearing.
                                                                         6. Using suitable lifting equipment, carefully position turn-
       Ensure no damage occurs to turntable, bearing, or
                                                                            table assembly above machine frame.
       frame-mounted components. Refer to Figure 3-71.,
       Turntable Bearing Removal.                                        7. Carefully lower turntable onto turntable bearing, ensur-
                                                                            ing scribed line on bearing inner race aligns with scribed
    8. Carefully place turntable on a suitably supported trestle.
                                                                            line on turntable. If a new turntable bearing is used,
    9. Scribe a line on turntable bearing outer race and frame.             ensure filler plug fitting is at 90 degrees from fore and
       This helps align the bearing during re-installation.                 aft center line of turntable.
       Remove bolts and washers attaching bearing outer race
                                                                         8. Spray a light coat of Safety Solvent 13 on new bearing
       to the frame. Discard bolts.
                                                                            bolts.
  10.   Use suitable lifting equipment to remove bearing from
                                                                         9. Apply a light coating of JLG Threadlocker PN 0100019 to
        frame. Move bearing to a clean, suitably supported work
                                                                            new bearing bolts. Install bolts and washers to turntable
        area.
                                                                            and bearing inner race.
3121171                                                                                                                        3-111
3-112
          8)4903                              3)3
          /1/4///4                            0!2//4                                	
                                                        467
                                                                                                                           SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                              /)3
                                                                              //1/4,5
                 
                 !""
#$%&#'
                 (&#$)&
                  *+,,$#-+.                                                 //
                                                                                                        0
                                                                                                      12
3121171
                                                                                               SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
  10.    Torque bolts to 190 ft-lb (260 Nm) following sequence               14.   At ground control station, use boom lift control to lower
         shown in Figure 3-72., Turntable Bearing Torque                           boom to stowed position.
         Sequence.
                                                                             15.   Using all applicable safety precautions, activate hydrau-
  11.    Remove lifting equipment.                                                 lic system and check swing system for proper and safe
                                                                                   operation.
  12.    Install rotary coupling retaining yoke brackets. Apply a
         light coating of JLG Threadlocker PN 0100011 to the
         attaching bolts and secure yoke to turntable with
         mounting hardware.                                               CHECK FOR MISSING OR LOOSE INNER AND OUTER TURNTABLE BEARING
                                                                          BOLTS AFTER FIRST 50 HOURS OF OPERATION AND EVERY 600 HOURS THERE-
  13.    Connect hydraulic lines to rotary coupling as tagged
                                                                          AFTER.
         before removal.
NOTE: Turntable Bearing Torque Sequence is identical for both inner and outer races. Torque all bolts to 190 ft-lb (260 Nm).
3121171                                                                                                                                3-113
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-114                                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Use the following procedure to for installing the seal kit.             7. Heat cap seals in hydraulic oil for 5 minutes at 300° F
                                                                            (149° C).
   1. Remove snap ring from end.
                                                                         8. Assemble cap seals over O-rings
   2. Remove thrust ring from same end.
                                                                         9. Reinsert center body into housing (lube with hydraulic
   3. Remove center body from housing.                                      oil).
   4. Cut off old seals.                                                10.   Replace thrust ring and snap ring.
   5. Assemble lip seals in direction shown in Figure 3-73.,
      Rotary Coupling Seal Installation.
3121171                                                                                                                     3-115
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-116                                                                                                3121171
                                                       SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171                                                                          3-117
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
         1/2 in.
        (13 mm)
3-118                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                       INSPECTING BRUSHES
                                                                        Remove the end panel. Inspect the wires. Remove the brush
                                                                        holder assembly. Pull brushes from the holders.
3121171                                                                                                                          3-119
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                                                2
                                            3
                    Acceptable                                            Unacceptable
                                                Brushes must ride
                                                completely on slip
                                                rings
                                                          1/4 in (6 mm)
                                                        Or Less - Replace
                                                                      7/16 in - 1/2 in
                    2                                               (11 - 12 mm) New
Figure 3-76. Inspecting Generator Brushes, Replacing Brushes, and Cleaning Slip Rings
3-120                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.27 COLD WEATHER PACKAGE                                                 in the engine manufacturer’s operator’s manual. Refer to
                                                                          Figure 3-77., Deutz Engine Dipstick.
  As an option, a cold weather package is available to allow the
  machine to be operated in lower temperatures. The package
  consists of battery heaters, a hydraulic tank heater, Exxon Uni-
  vis hydraulic oil, and diesel fuel conditioner. See Figure 3-79.,                   MINIMUM OIL
                                                                                      LEVEL
  Cold Weather Package.
3.28 ENGINE
NOTE: Refer to the engine manufacturer’s manual for detailed
      operating and maintenance instructions.                                              MAXIMUM OIL
                                                                                           LEVEL
Glow Plugs
  If the glow plug option is enabled in the JLG Control System,
  the glow plug and indicator lamp will be energized when the
  Power/Emergency Stop switch is pulled on if the ambient air
  temperature is less than 50° F (10° C) and engine coolant tem-
  perature is less than 140° F (60° C). This determination occurs
  one second after the Power/Emergency Stop switch has been                              MINIMUM LEVEL,
                                                                                         OIL HOT
  pulled on. The lamp and glow plugs remain energized for the                                              MAXIMUM LEVEL,
  period of time specified by the setting in the JLG Control Sys-                                          OIL HOT
  tem. Engine start shall be disabled during this period. On
  Deutz engines, glow plugs will continue (post glow) after
  engine has started for three times the machine digit setting.           MINIMUM LEVEL,
                                                                          OIL COLD
                                                                                           MAXIMUM LEVEL,
Checking Oil Level                                                                         OIL COLD
                                                                         NOTE: Hot oil checks should not be made until the engine
   1. Switch engine off before checking oil level.                       has been shut down for a period of 5 minutes.
   2. Make sure machine and engine are level.
                                                                               Figure 3-77. Deutz Engine Dipstick
   3. Remove dipstick.
                                                                      7. Replace dipstick. Make sure it is fully seated in the dip-
   4. Wipe dipstick with non-fibrous, clean cloth.                       stick tube to seal off the crankcase.
   5. Insert dipstick to the stop and remove again.
3121171                                                                                                                             3-121
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Changing Engine Oil                                                  8. Pour in new engine oil. Refer to Section 1 for capacity
                                                                        and refer to Figure 3-78., Engine Oil Viscosity for the
    1. Allow engine to warm up. Engine oil should reach                 proper grade.
       approximately 176° F (80° C).
    2. Make sure machine and engine are level.
    3. Switch off engine.
    4. Place an oil tray under the engine.
    5. Open oil drain valve.
DO NOT LET USED OIL RUN INTO SOIL; COLLECT USED OIL IN A CONTAINER
SUITABLE FOR DISPOSAL OR RECYCLING. DISPOSE OF USED ENGINE OIL IN
ACCORDANCE WITH ENVIRONMENTAL REGULATIONS.
    6. Drain oil.
    7. Close oil drain valve.
3-122                                                                                                                 3121171
                                                                                                SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Changing Oil Filter 5. Lightly oil rubber gasket on new oil filter.
 Most engine oil filters are mounted vertically. Tier 4 engine oil filters
 are mounted horizontally. Removal and installation is identical.
3121171                                                                                                                                3-123
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Replacing Fuel Filter or Pre-Filter Cleaning Fuel Strainer (D2011 L03 Only)
WHEN WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM, MAKE SURE THERE ARE NO OPEN FLAMES       WHEN WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM, MAKE SURE THERE ARE NO OPEN FLAMES
OR SPARKS IN THE AREA. DO NOT SMOKE WHEN WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM.      OR SPARKS IN THE AREA. DO NOT SMOKE WHEN WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM.
1. Wipe area around filter to clean any dirt from area. 1. Unscrew hexagonal nut (1).
3-124                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                          
                                         
                                               
                                                    
                                                                     
          	
	
3121171                                                                                    3-125
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
   1. Disconnect battery.
   2. Use a tie strap as shown below to secure hood support
      while hood is being removed.
                                                                    6. When all bolts are removed, lift hood support away from
                                                                       machine.
3-126                                                                                                                 3121171
                                                 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
          1.   Hood           5.   Washer
          2.   Hood Support   6.   Clamp
          3.   Gas Spring     7.   Hinge
          4.   Bolt           8.   Engine Tray
3121171                                                                    3-127
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
8. Pull pump assembly away from engine. NOTE: Engine assembly weighs approximately 1275 lb (579 kg).
   9. Using a ratchet strap, support pump in a position that          13.   Carefully lift engine assembly away from machine.
      will keep pump from interfering with engine removal.
  10.   Disconnect all fuel lines from engine. Cap all open hoses
        to prevent fuel leakage.
  11.   Swing engine out to gain access to the back of the
        engine, and tag and disconnect all electrical wiring from
        relays, switches, etc. Carefully pull disconnected har-
        nesses and fuel lines away from engine.
3-128                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                             SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
    Installation
       1. Using an adequate lifting device, support weight of the
          engine assembly and position it in place on the
          machine. Install engine pivot pin.
3121171                                                                                                                            3-129
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
    5. Use a tie strap as shown below to secure the hood sup-            3.29 DEUTZ EMR 2 (SN 87575 TO PRESENT)
       port when the hood is being installed.
                                                                         NOTE: SN’s 85693 & 85910 also incorporated EMR2.
                                                                           The EMR2 consists of the sensors, the control unit and the
                                                                           actuator. Engine-side controls as well as the JLG Control Sys-
                                                                           tem are connected by means of separate cable harnesses to
                                                                           the EMR control unit.
                                                                           The sensors attached to the engine provide the electronics in
                                                                           the control unit with all the relevant physical parameters In
                                                                           accordance with the information of the current condition of
                                                                           the engine and the preconditions (throttle position etc.), the
                                                                           EMR2 controls an actuator that operates the control rod of the
                                                                           injection pump and thus doses the fuel quantity in accordance
                                                                           with the performance requirements.
    6. Carefully lift engine hood assembly onto hood support.              The exact position of the regulating rod is reported back and,
                                                                           if necessary, is corrected, by means of the control rod travel
NOTE: Engine hood assembly weighs approximately 84 lb (38 kg).
                                                                           sensor, situated together with the rotation magnets in a hous-
                                                                           ing of the actuator.
                                                                           The EMR2 is equipped with safety devices and measures in the
                                                                           hardware and software in order to ensure emergency running
                                                                           (Limp home) functions.
                                                                           In order to switch the engine off, the EMR2 is switched in a de-
                                                                           energized fashion over the ignition switch. A strong spring in
                                                                           the actuator presses the control rod in the de-energized con-
                                                                           dition into the zero position. As a redundancy measure, an
                                                                           additional solenoid serves for switching off and this, indepen-
                                                                           dently of the actuator, also moves the control rod in the de-
                                                                           energized condition into the zero position.
                                                                           After programming, carried out over the ISO9141 interface,
    7. Install bolts and clamps that secure engine hood assem-
                                                                           the EMR2 is possesses a motor-specific data set and this is then
       bly to hood support.
                                                                           fixedly assigned to the engine. Included in this are the various
    8. Start engine and check for proper operation and any                 application cases as well as the customer’s wishes regarding a
       leakage. If engine does not start immediately, fuel lines           particular scope of function.
       may need primed.
                                                                           Each EMR2 module is matched by serial number to the engine.
NOTE: The delay in starting the engine can be reduced by remov-            Modules cannot be swapped between engines.
      ing the fuel filter, pre-filling the filter with fuel, and rein-
      stalling the filter before attempting to start engine.
3-130                                                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171                                                                                                                                        3-131
3-132
                                                                SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171
3121171
          Figure 3-83. Deutz EMR 2 Vehicle Side Connection Diagram
3-133
                                                                     SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-134
                                                                                   SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171
3121171
          Figure 3-85. Deutz EMR 2 Engine Side Connection Diagram - Sheet 2 of 2
3-135
                                                                                   SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-136                                                                            3121171
                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171                                                                            3-137
3-138
                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171
3121171
          Figure 3-89. EMR2 Fault Codes - Sheet 2 of 5
3-139
                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-140
                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171
3121171
          Figure 3-91. EMR2 Fault Codes - Sheet 4 of 5
3-141
                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-142
                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171
                                                                                             SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.30 BIO FUEL IN DEUTZ ENGINES                                             The use of US bio-diesel based on soy oil methylester is only
                                                                           permissible in mixtures with diesel fuel with a bio-diesel part of
                                                                           a max. 20 weight-%. The US bio-diesel used for the mixture must
General
                                                                           comply with the ASTM D6751-07a (B100) standard.
  Use of bio fuels is permitted for the compact engines made by
                                                                          APPROVED ENGINES
  DEUTZ.
                                                                           The 912, 913, 914, 1011, 2011, 1012, 2012, 1013, 2013, 413 and
  Distillate fuels with residue oil percentages or mixed fuels may         513 series are approved for bio-diesel from year of manufac-
  not be used in DEUTZ compact engines.                                    ture 1993 under compliance with the basic conditions speci-
  The DEUTZ vehicle engines are designed for diesel fuels in               fied below.
  accordance with EN 590 with a cetane number of at least 51.             BASIC CONDITIONS TO BE OBSERVED
  DEUTZ engines for mobile machinery are designed for a cetane
  number of at least 45. When using fuels of a low cetane num-              • A power loss of 5-9% in relation to diesel fuel in accordance
  ber, disturbing white smoke and ignition misfires are to be                 with EN 590 is possible due to the lower heating value.
  expected under some circumstances.                                          Blocking of the fuel injector is not allowed.
                                                                            • The lubricating oil quality must correspond to TR 0199-
  A cetane number of at least 40 is permissible for the US market,
                                                                              99-3002. The lubricating oil change interval must be
  therefore special engine models have been developed to
                                                                              halved in relation to operation with diesel fuel in accor-
  avoid starting difficulties, extreme white smoke or increased
                                                                              dance with EN 590.
  hydrocarbon emissions (EPA specification - US EPA REGULA-
  TIONS FOR LARGE NONROAD COMPRESSION-IGNITION                              • Standstills of longer than 4 to 6 weeks must be avoided
  ENGINES).                                                                   with bio-diesel. Otherwise the engine must be started and
                                                                              stopped with diesel fuel.
  If the white smoke behavior is unacceptable when using a very
  low cetane number, the use of ignition improvers is to be rec-            • Bio-diesels can be mixed with normal diesel fuel but the
  ommended as a later remedial measure.                                       basic conditions described in this subsection apply for mix-
                                                                              tures. Mixtures with up to 5% (m/m) bio-diesel (B5) which
  The certification measurements for compliance with the legal                have recently been on sale at European fuel stations are
  emission limits are carried out with the test fuels prescribed by           excepted. These fuels must be treated like normal diesel
  law. These correspond to the diesel fuels in accordance with                fuels because EN 590 expressly permits adding up to 5%
  EN 590 and ASTM D 975. No emission values are guaranteed                    (m/m) bio-diesel in accordance with EN 14214.
  with the other fuels described. It is the obligation of the owner
  to check the permission for use of the fuels in accordance with           • Approx. 30-50 hours after changing over from diesel fuel to
  regional regulations.                                                       bio-diesel, the fuel filter should be changed as a preventive
                                                                              measure to avoid a drop in performance due to clogged fuel
Bio Fuel                                                                      filters. Deposited fuel ageing products are dissolved by bio-
                                                                              diesel and transported into the fuel filter. They should not
PERMITTED BIO-DIESEL FUELS                                                    be changed immediately but after approx. 30 to 50 hours
  Originally only rape seed oil methylester (RME) was sold as a               because the dissolving of dirt takes a certain amount of
  bio-diesel fuel in Europe but fatty acid methylester (FAME)                 time.
  based on other oils have come onto the market increasingly in
  recent years. However, with the latter there is a risk that the limit
  values of EN 14214 are not kept in the field. Anyone who uses
  bio-diesel fuel in DEUTZ engines must therefore choose his
  supplier very carefully and have him guarantee compliance
  with the EN 14214 limit values. Since experience has shown
  that rape seed oil methylester (RME) exceeds the limit values
  less often that other esters, it is expressly recommended to use
  only rape seed oil methyester. DEUTZ customers in Germany
  can additionally ensure the quality by buying bio-diesel fuel
  with an AGQM certificate (Arbeitsgemeinschaft Qualitäts-Man-
  agement Biodiesel e.V.).
3121171                                                                                                                              3-143
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-144                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                        SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.31 DEUTZ TURBOCHARGER OPERATION                                    LOW AIR TEMPERATURES & INACTIVE OPERATION
                                                                     If the engine has been inactive for some time or the air tem-
 Good engine operating procedures are essential to prolong           perature is very low, crank the engine first and then run at idle.
 turbocharger life.                                                  This allows the oil to circulate throughout the full system
 Particular attention to oil system and air system will eliminate    before high loads and speeds are applied to engine and turbo-
 the two main causes of turbocharger failure. To prevent this        charger.
 Operators/Owners must ensure that :-
                                                                     SHUT DOWN
   1. Air and oil filters are checked regularly to the manufac-      Before shutting the engine down, let the turbocharger cool
      turer's specifications.                                        down. When an engine runs at maximum power/high torque,
                                                                     the turbocharger is operating at very high temperatures and
   2. Engine maintenance intervals are adhered to.
                                                                     speeds. Hot shut down can cause reduced service life which is
   3. Engine and equipment are operated in such a way that           avoidable by a minute or two of idling. Most mobile equip-
      is not harmful to the life of the turbocharger.                ment applications include an adequate cooling period during
                                                                     parking or mooring procedures.
Operating Practices                                                  Allow the engine to idle for 1-5 minutes to allow the high tem-
 Operators and owners can get maximum service life from their        peratures and speed to reduce and thus prolong the life of the
 turbochargers if a few good practices are followed:                 turbocharger.
3121171                                                                                                                          3-145
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN   FMI                  Description                                    Possible Cause                                         Action
 Code    Code
  978    1-2-6   29     2    Diagnostic fault check of synchronism of       Plausibility error between sensor and idle        Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             hand throttle and Low idle switch(LIS).        switch                                            threshold.
                                                                                                                              The accelerator pedal must have detected full
                                                                                                                              load and idle plausibility at least once.
  932    1-2-6   29     3    Diagnostic fault check of short circuit to sup- The signal exceeds the applicatable threshold;   If the signal is below the applicatable threshold
                             ply voltage                                     signal range violation                           APP_uRawSRCHiHTLIS_C, the signal
                             (signal range check high) of acceleration                                                        range violation is reset
                             pedal signal.                                                                                    after the healing debouncing.
                                                                                                                              In case when the CCP is active (CCP_stActive =
                                                                                                                              1)and the reading from the EEPROM
                                                                                                                              memory is successful, the
                                                                                                                              signal is below the threshold
                                                                                                                              APP_uHTLISCCPHi[1], a signal range violation
                                                                                                                              is reset
                                                                                                                              after debouncing.
  937    1-2-6   29     4    Diagnostic fault check of short circuit to   The signal is below the applicatable threshold;     If the signal exceeds the applicatable threshold
                             ground (signal range check low) of accelera- signal range violation                              APP_uRawSRCLoHTLIS_C, the signal
                             tion pedal signal                                                                                range violation is reset
                                                                                                                              after the healing debouncing.
                                                                                                                              In case when the CCP is active (CCP_stActive =
                                                                                                                              1)and the reading from the EEPROM
                                                                                                                              memory is successful, the
                                                                                                                              signal exceeds the threshold
                                                                                                                              APP_uHTLISCCPLo[1], a signal range violation
                                                                                                                              is reset
                                                                                                                              after debouncing.
  935    2-2-6   91     3    Analog accelerator pedal sensor 1 or double Sensor defect.                                       Check cabling, check accelerator pedal sensor
                             accelerator pedal sensor: the voltage mea- Short cut to battery or open loop.                    and if necessary replace it, check
                             sured by ECU is out of the target range or the                                                   connection cable and if necessary repair or
                             calculated pedal position is implausible                                                         replace it.
                             compared with the position of the second                                                         If the signal is below the applicatable threshold
                             pedal                                                                                            APP_uRaw1SRCHigh_C, the signal
                                                                                                                              range violation is reset after
                                                                                                                              the healing debouncing.
  940    2-2-6   91     4    Analog accelerator pedal sensor 1 or double Short circuit to ground.                             Check cabling, check accelerator pedal sensor
                             accelerator pedal sensor: the voltage mea-                                                       and if necessary replace it, check
                             sured by ECU is out of the target range or the                                                   connection cable and if necessary repair or
                             calculated pedal position is implausible                                                         replace it
                             compared with the position of the second                                                         If the signal exceeds the applicatable threshold
                             pedal                                                                                            APP_uRaw1SRCLow_C, the signal
                                                                                                                              range violation is reset after the
                                                                                                                              healing
  976    2-2-6   91    11    Diagnostic fault check of synchronism of sin- Measured voltage of accelerator pedal 1 is out of Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             gle potentiometer and Low idle switch(LIS). plausible range.                                    threshold.
                                                                                                                             Check cabling, check accelerator pedal and
                                                                                                                             pedal sensor and if necessary replace it,
                                                                                                                             check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                             or replace it.
                                                                                                                             When the PWM period APP_tiPWMPer is in
                                                                                                                             between APP_tiSRCLoPWMPer_C and
                                                                                                                             APP_tiSRCHiPWMPer_C .
3-146                                                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                                                        SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN   FMI                   Description                                      Possible Cause                                        Action
 Code    Code
  474     216    94     1    Low fuel pressure: the low fuel pressure cal- Fuel pressure below warning threshold                Check low fuel pressure system (fuel feed
                             culated by ECU is underneath the target                                                            pump, relay , fuse, wiring, sensor) and if
                             range; the ECU activates a system reaction                                                         necessary repair or replace it.
  472     216    94     3    Low fuel pressure sensor: the voltage of sen- cable break or short circuit, sensor defective,      Check cabling, if sensor not working, check sen-
                             sor measured by ECU is out of the target      connection cable damaged                             sor and if necessary replace it, check
                             range                                         Short cut to battery or open loop                    connection cable and if necessary repair or
                                                                                                                                replace it
  473     216    94     4    Low fuel pressure sensor: the voltage of sen- cable break or short circuit, sensor defective,      Check cabling, if sensor not working, check sen-
                             sor measured by ECU is out of the target      connection cable damaged                             sor and if necessary replace it, check
                             range                                         short cut to ground                                  connection cable and if necessary repair or
                                                                                                                                replace it
  464     228    97     3    Fuel filter water level sensor: the voltage of   Sensor not connected or sensor defect.            Check of wiring and water in fuel sensor.
                             sensor measured by ECU is out of the target                                                        Check cabling, if charge Water in Fuel sensor is
                             range                                                                                              not working, check sensor and if
                                                                                                                                necessary replace it,
                                                                                                                                check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                                or replace it.
  465     228    97     4    Fuel filter water level sensor: the voltage of   cable break or short circuit, sensor defective,   Check sensor and if necessary replace it, check
                             sensor measured by ECU is out of the target      connection cable damaged.                         connection cable
                             range.                                           Short cut to ground.                              and if necessary repair or replace it.
 1157     228    97    12    Fuel filter water level sensor: the maximum      Water level in fuel pre-filter reservoir over limit Measure Voltage at Water in Fuel Sensor and
                             level is exceeded                                (bad fuel quality)                                  renew harness if needed.
  736     231    100    1    Oil pressure is below the target range (warn- Oilpressure too low (pressure below warning          Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             ing threshold)                                threshold)                                           threshold.
                                                                                                                                Check oil level, check engine for oil leckage,
                                                                                                                                measure oil pressure external to evaluate
                                                                                                                                sensor value
  737     231    100    1    Oil pressure is below the target range (shut     Oilpressure too low (pressure below shut off      Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             off threshold)                                   threshold).                                       threshold.
                                                                                                                                Check oil level, check engine for oil leckage,
                                                                                                                                measure oil pressure external to evaluate
                                                                                                                                sensor value.
  732     224    100    3    Oil pressure sensor: the voltage of sensor       short circuit to battery or cable break           check battery and wiring
                             measured by ECU is out of the target range                                                         Check cabling. If sensor not working, check sen-
                                                                                                                                sor and if necessary replace it,
                                                                                                                                check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                                or replace it.
  733     224    100    4    Oil pressure sensor: the voltage of sensor       Short circuit to ground                           The sensed raw voltage value Oil_uRawPSwmp
                             measured by ECU is out of the target range                                                         is above Oil_SRCPSwmp.uMin_C
                                                                                                                                Check cabling, if sensor not working, check sen-
                                                                                                                                sor and if necessary replace it, check
                                                                                                                                connection cable and if necessary repair or
                                                                                                                                replace it
                                                                                                                                No detail informationen!
  774     223    102    1    charge air pressure below lower limit            measured charge air pressure below the thresh- Check complete air system of engine for mas-
                                                                              old.                                           sive leakage, especially from compressor
                                                                                                                             to intake air manifold.
                                                                                                                             Check air filter.
                                                                                                                             Exchange charge air presure sensor.
3121171                                                                                                                                                                  3-147
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN   FMI                   Description                                       Possible Cause                                      Action
 Code    Code
  88     223     102    2    Charge air pressure messured by sensor is         Charged air cooler pressure below threshold.   Check waste gate system if necessary replace
                             above the shut off threshold.                                                                    TC,
                                                                                                                              check CAC if all channels are clean,check charge
                                                                                                                              air piping if nececery.
  89     223     102    2    Charge air pressure messured by sensor is         Charge air pressure above shut off threshold   Check waste gate system if necessary replace
                             above the warning threshold                                                                      TC, check CAC if all channels are clean,
                                                                                                                              check charge air piping if necessery.
  772    223     102    2    Deviation between sensed intake manifold          deviation between ambient pressure sensor      1) Exchange boost pressure sensor
                             pressure is not plausible compared to envi-       and charge air pressure sensor at not          2) Exchange ECU
                             ronment pressure. Which sensor is not okay        running engine to high
                             can not be said.
  776    223     102    3    Charge air pressure sensor: the measured          The Sensor Voltage is above the Threshold.     Check cabling, if charge air pressure/tempera-
                             voltage of sensor by ECU is out of the target                                                    ture sensor is not working, check sensor
                             range                                                                                            and if necessary replace it, check connection
                                                                                                                              cable and if necessary repair or replace it.
  777    223     102    4    Charge air pressure sensor: the measured          The Sensor Voltage is below the Threshold.     Check cabling, if charge air pressure/tempera-
                             voltage of sensor by ECU is out of the target                                                    ture sensor is not working, check sensor
                             range                                                                                            and
                                                                                                                              if necessary replace it, check connection cable
                                                                                                                              and if necessary repair or replace it
  996    233     105    0    Charge air temperature downstream calcu-          Charge air temperature (downstream) over       Check CAC system and clean it. Check fan func-
                             lated by ECU is above the target range.           warning threshold.                             tionality.
                             The ECU activates a system reaction.                                                             Check cooling perfomance with temperature
                                                                                                                              measurement.
  997    233     105    0    Charge air temperature downstream calcu-          Charge air temperature (downstream) over the Check CAC system and clean it. Check fan func-
                             lated by ECU is under the shut down thresh-       low threshold.                               tionality. Check cooling perfomance
                             old.                                                                                           with temperature measurement.
                             The ECU activates a system reaction.
  992    128     105    1    Charged Air cooler down stream tempera-           Sensed temperature within intake air manifold actual temperature below -40°C?
                             ture.                                             < threshold.                                  exchange sensor
                             Temperature below lower physical thresh-
                             old.
  994    128     105    3    Charge air temperature sensor: the voltage        Short circuit to battery.                      The sensor raw signal Air_uRawTCACDs (volt-
                             of sensor measured by ECU is out of the tar-      sensor voltage > limit                         age) > Air_SRCTCACDs.uMin_C.
                             get range.                                                                                       Check CAC-sensor and if necessary replace it,
                                                                                                                              check connection cable and if
                                                                                                                              necessary repair or replace it.
  995    128     105    4    Charge air temperature sensor: the voltage        Short circuit to ground or open load.          The sensor raw signal Air_uRawTCACDs (volt-
                             of sensor measured by ECU is out of the tar-      sensor voltage < limit.                        age) is below Air_SRCTCACDs.uMin_C.
                             get range.                                                                                       Check CAC-sensor and if necessary replace it,
                                                                                                                              check connection cable and if
                                                                                                                              necessary repair or replace it
  752    136     107    0    Air filter differential pressure: the pressure    Pressure loss above target range with system   Check airfilter and if necessary clean or renew it,
                             difference of the intake air between the filter   reaction, air filter clogged or defective,     check cabling, check sensor and if
                             inlet and outlet calculated by ECU is above       sensor not working, connection cable damaged   necessary replace it, check connection cable
                             the target range and the ECU activates a          Pressure value above warning threshold         and if necessary repair or replace it
                             system reaction
  98     232     110    0    Coolant temperature: the coolant tempera- Cooling temperature too high. Coolant temper- Clean radiator, check fan drive, check coolant
                             ture calculated by ECU is above the target ature above warning threshold                level, check cooling system in general,
                             range; the ECU activates a system reaction                                              check thermostat function, check water pump
3-148                                                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                                                     SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN   FMI                   Description                                    Possible Cause                                          Action
 Code    Code
  99      232    110    0    Coolant temperature: the coolant tempera- Coolant temperature above shut off threshold.           Clean radiator, check fan drive, check coolant
                             ture calculated by ECU is above the target                                                        level, check cooling system in general,
                             range.                                                                                            check thermostat function, check water pump
                             The ECU activates a system reaction
  93      225    110    1    Coolant temperature sensor: the voltage of Suspected components:wiring harness, cool-             Check wiring harness and connected Coolant
                             the sensor measured by ECU is out of the tar- ant temperature sensor.                             Temp Sens.
                             get range.
  96      225    110    3    Coolant temperature sensor: the voltage of Short cut to battery or open load.                     Check sensor and if necessary replace it, check
                             the sensor measured by ECU is out of the tar-                                                     connection cable and if necessary
                             get range                                                                                         repair or replace it.
  97      225    110    4    Coolant temperature sensor: the voltage of Voltage Surveillance has found shortcut to             Check sensor and if necessary replace it, check
                             the sensor measured by ECU is out of the tar- Ground at Coolant Temperatur Sensor.                connection cable and if necessary
                             get range                                                                                         repair or replace it
                                                                                                                               Measure Voltage at Coolant Temperature Sen-
                                                                                                                               sor and renew harness if needed.
  101     235    111    1    Coolant level: the coolant level calculated by Coolant level too low, leakage in cooling sys-     Check coolant level, inspect cooling system for
                             ECU is underneath the allowed minimum. tem, sensor defective, wiring damaged.                     leakage and if necessary repair it,
                                                                                                                               check sensor and wiring
  877     147    157    3    Rail pressure sensor: the voltage of sensor    Short cut to battery.                              Check cabling, check rail pressure sensor and if
                             measured by ECU is out of the target range.    Damaged rail pressure sensor.                      necessary replace it,
                                                                                                                               check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                               or replace it.
  878     147    157    4    Rail pressure sensor: the voltage of sensor    Check cabling, check rail pressure sensor and if   Check cabling, check rail pressure sensor and if
                             measured by ECU is out of the target range.    necessary replace it,                              necessary replace it,
                                                                            check connection cable and if necessary repair     check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                            or replace it.                                     or replace it.
 1381     839    164    2    Rail pressure safety function is not executed Rail pressure is still above threshold.             Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             correctly                                                                                         threshold.
                                                                                                                               Reset the fault and at reappearance check ECU
                                                                                                                               and injection system
 1180     318    168    0    Battery voltage: the voltage measured by       Battery voltage over limit                         Check alternator, regulator of alternator and if
                             ECU is out of the target range                                                                    necessary replace it, check wiring and
                                                                                                                               voltage of alternator
 1181     318    168    1    Battery voltage: the voltage measured by       Battery voltage below limit                        Check alternator, cabling, contact resistance,
                             ECU is out of the target range                                                                    safety fuses, too high load in energy
                                                                                                                               system, check battery and if necessary replace it
  47      318    168    2    Battery voltage: the voltage measured by       If Batteryvoltage (Ubatt_U) > 17V or 31V for       Check wiring harness and connected alternator.
                             ECU is out of the target range, system reac-   mor than =0.5sec a warning is generated
                             tion is initiated                              Battery voltage above warning threshold
  45      318    168    3    Battery voltage: the voltage measured by       Battery voltage above warning threshold            Check wiring harness and connected alternator.
                             ECU is out of the target range, system reac-   (~38,9Volt), Short cut to battery possible.
                             tion is initiated
  46      318    168    4    Battery voltage: the voltage measured by       Battery voltage below warning threshold,           Check wiring harness and connected alternator.
                             ECU is out of the target range, system reac-   Short cut to ground
                             tion is initiated
  417     312    171    3    Sensor error SCR-System environment tem- open loop to sensor                                      Check cabling, if environment temperature sen-
                             perature; DPF-System air inlet temperature;                                                       sor is not working, check sensor
                             signal range check high                                                                           and if necessary replace it, check connection
                                                                                                                               cable and if necessary repair or replace it.
3121171                                                                                                                                                                 3-149
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN   FMI                   Description                                     Possible Cause                                      Action
 Code    Code
  418    312     171    4    Sensor error SCR-System environment tem- short circuit to Ground                                Check cabling, if environment temperature sen-
                             perature; DPF-System air inlet temperature;                                                     sor is not working, check sensor
                             signal range check low                                                                          and if necessary replace it, check connection
                                                                                                                             cable and if necessary repair or replace it
 1425    226     172    0    sensed intake air temperature at air filter >   sensed intake air temperature at air filter >   Check outside conditions:
                             physical high limit                             physical high limit                             Temperature > Threshold within the intake air
                                                                                                                             system of the engine?
                                                                                                                             E.G: engine sucks in air from hot asphalt out of
                                                                                                                             paver bucket
                                                                                                                             Sensor positioned within black air filter housing
                                                                                                                             above engine lid at hot environmental
                                                                                                                             conditions and idling or similar?
                                                                                                                             => if yes check with application team to adapt
                                                                                                                             limits
                                                                                                                             if not check sensor and wiring harness
                                                                                                                             exchange sensor
 1183    226     172    1    sensed air temperature within air intake        sensed air temperature within air intake path of Cold start and ambient temperature < thresh-
                             path of engine below physical low limit         engine below physical low limit                  old
                                                                                                                              Check wiring harness to AFST-sensor
                                                                                                                              Exchange AFST-sensor
  389    214     190    0    Engine speed: the engine speed calculated       Overspeed monitoring during 1 level of FOC      check powertrain settings regarding overspeed
                             by ECU is above the target range; the ECU       (Failure overrun condition) if engine speed
                             activates a system reaction                     was over Limit.
  421    213     190    2    ECU measures a deviation between cam-           Offset error between crankshaft and camshaft. Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             shaft and crankshaft angle to target.                                                         threshold, occurs by offset between
                                                                                                                           crankshaft and camshaft.
                                                                                                                           Check increment wheel position, clean and
                                                                                                                           adjust if necessary, check sensor postition.
                                                                                                                           Check Camshaft and Crankshaft senor or wiring.
  419    212     190    8    Camshaft speed sensor: the ECU receives no      When disturbed camshaft signal detected.        Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             signal and uses the signal from crankshaft      Error in sensor or wiring.                      threshold, occurs by disturbed
                             speed sensor as alternative to calculate the                                                    camshaft signal.
                             engine speed                                                                                    Check increment wheel position, clean and
                                                                                                                             adjust if necessary, check sensor postition.
                                                                                                                             Check Camshaft Sensor or wiring.
  422    212     190    8    Sensor crankshaft speed; disturbed signal       Error in sensor or wiring.                      Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                             Crankshaft sensor defect.                       threshold, occurs by disturbed
                                                                                                                             crankshaft signal.
                                                                                                                             Check increment wheel position, clean and
                                                                                                                             adjust if necessary, check sensor postition.
                                                                                                                             Check Crankshaft Sensor or wiring.
  390    214     190   11    Engine speed: the engine speed calculated       Overspeed monitoring during 2 level of FOC      check powertrain0 settings regarding over-
                             by ECU is above the target range; the ECU       (Failure overrun condition) if engine speed     speed
                             activates a system reaction                     was over limit.
  420    212     190   12    Camshaft speed sensor: the ECU receives no      Error in sensor or wiring.                      Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             signal and uses the signal from camshaft                                                        threshold, occurs by disturbed or no
                             speed sensor as alternative to calculate the                                                    camshaft signal.
                             engine speed                                                                                    Check increment wheel position, clean and
                             Threshold:                                                                                      adjust if necessary, check sensor postition.
                                                                                                                             Check Camshaft Sensor or wiring.
3-150                                                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                                                SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN   FMI                   Description                                   Possible Cause                                      Action
 Code    Code
  423     212    190   12    Crankshaft speed sensor: the ECU receives no Error in sensor or wiring.                       Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             signal and uses the signal from camshaft                                                      threshold, occurs by disturbed or no
                             speed sensor as alternative to calculate the                                                  Crankshaft signal.
                             engine speed.                                                                                 Check increment wheel position, clean and
                                                                                                                           adjust if necessary, check Crankshaft
                                                                                                                           sensor postition or wiring.
  391     214    190   14    Engine speed: the engine speed calculated     Overspeed monitoring during ORC (Override       check powertrain settings regarding overspeed
                             by ECU is above the target range; the ECU     conditions) if engine speed was over
                             activates a system reaction                   2900rpm
 1222    2-1-2   190   14    Camshaft- and Crankshaft speed sensor sig- Sensors for engine speed are defect.               Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             nal not available on CAN or defect.                                                           threshold.
                                                                                                                           Check wiring, check cabels and repair or replace
                                                                                                                           if necessary.
  791     693    411    0    delta pressure across venturi in EGR line     sensed value of venturi difference pressure >   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             above physical high limit                     high limit                                      threshold.
                                                                                                                           EGR-Valve blocked open
                                                                                                                           EGR-Valve actuator defect
                                                                                                                           EGR-cooler defect (check for coolant water)
                                                                                                                           Reed Valve defect
                                                                                                                           Intake throttle blocked in closed position =>
                                                                                                                           Check intake throttle
                                                                                                                           Exhaust pressure too high => Check Exhaust
                                                                                                                           pressure
                                                                                                                           Check Nox-sensor upstream SCR catalyst
                                                                                                                           dp venturi sensor defect
  792     693    411    1    delta pressure across venturi in EGR line     sensed value of venturi difference pressure <   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             below physical low limit                      low limit                                       threshold.
                                                                                                                           Check correct mounting of difference pressure
                                                                                                                           sensor at venturi tube
                                                                                                                           Exchange difference pressure sensor broken
  795     693    411    3    The sensed raw voltage                        EGR Delta pressure Sensor defect                Check cabling, if charge EGR Delta pressure sen-
                             Air_uRawPEGRDeltaP is above the maxi-                                                         sor is not working, check sensor and
                             mum threshold.                                                                                if necessary replace it, check connection cable
                                                                                                                           and if necessary repair or replace it.
  381     693    411    4    Range check cannot be done or interrupted. EGR or wiring defect                               Check wiring harness and connected EGR.
  796     693    411    4    The sensed raw voltage value                  EGR Delta pressure Sensor defect                Check cabling. If charge EGR Delta pressure sen-
                             Air_uRawPEGRDeltaP is above the mini-                                                         sor is not working, check sensor and
                             mum threshold.                                                                                if necessary replace it, check connection cable
                                                                                                                           and if necessary repair or replace it.
3121171                                                                                                                                                             3-151
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN   FMI                  Description                                      Possible Cause                                          Action
 Code    Code
  793    693     411   11    DFC is stored in EEPROM and status kept until   deviation between desired O2 concentration in      Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             check is allowed                                intake air manifold                                threshold.
                             to be carried out again                         and the real O2-concentration within intake air    EGR-Valve mechanically blocked open or closed
                             DFC can be reset by service routine 216         manifold > limit                                   EGR-pipe blocked with metall plate instead
                                                                                                                                sealing downstream EGR-Valve
                                                                                                                                EGR-Valve actuator defect
                                                                                                                                EGR-cooler defect (check for coolant water)
                                                                                                                                Reed Valve defect
                                                                                                                                Intake throttle blocked in closed position =>
                                                                                                                                Check intake throttle
                                                                                                                                Exhaust pressure too high => Check Exhaust
                                                                                                                                pressure
                                                                                                                                Check Nox-sensor upstream SCR catalyst
                                                                                                                                dp venturi sensor defect
 1007    682     412    3    EGR downstream temperature sensor: the          Short circuit to battery.                          Check wiring harness to TEGR-sensor.
                             voltage of sensor measured by ECU is out of     sensor voltage > limit                             Exchange TEGR-sensor.
                             the target range.
 1008    682     412    4    EGR downstream temperature sensor: the          Short circuit to ground or open load.              Check wiring harness to TEGR-sensor.
                             voltage of sensor measured by ECU is out of     sensor voltage < limit                             Exchange TEGR-sensor.
                             the target range.
  376    281     630   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the ECU finds Section could not be erased                            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             an error during the access to its EEPROM                                                           threshold.
                             memory or works with an alternative value                                                          There is no healing possible for the error. In the
                                                                                                                                every new initialization phase, the
                                                                                                                                debounce level is set to zero.
                                                                                                                                If not programmed, EEPROM is defect --> ECU is
                                                                                                                                defect, reprogramm ECU and if
                                                                                                                                necessary replace it.
  377    281     630   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the ECU finds Minimum 3 blocks could not be readed,                  There is no healing possible for the error. In the
                             an error during the access to its EEPROM    EEPROM has Checksum Error                              every new initialization phase, the
                             memory or works with an alternative value                                                          debounce level is set to zero.
                                                                                                                                If not programmed, EEPROM is defect -->ECU is
                                                                                                                                defect, reprogramm ECU and if
                                                                                                                                necessary replace it
  378    281     630   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the ECU finds Block could not be written for minimum 3 times Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             an error during the access to it's EEPROM                                                  threshold.
                             memory or works with an alternative value                                                  If not programmed, EEPROM is defect --> ECU is
                                                                                                                        defect, reprogramm ECU and if
                                                                                                                        necessary replace it.
  84     271     639   14    CAN bus 0: the ECU is not allowed to send       CAN BusOff error; CAN 0 (Customer CAN)             Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             messages, because the status "BusOff" is                                                           threshold.
                             detected.                                                                                          BusOff bit for CAN A node is set.
                                                                                                                                Check wiring of CAN bus and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                                it, check connection cable and if
                                                                                                                                necessary repair or replace it, check resistance in
                                                                                                                                CAN lines (120 Ohm)
  580    154     651    3    Injector cyl. 1: the current drop measured by Suspected Components:                                Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             ECU is above the target range                 injector cylinder 1                                  threshold.
                                                                           wiring harness, cable break or short circuit, sen-   Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                           sor defective, connection cable                      repair/replace it. Use SerDia Injector
                                                                           damaged                                              test for diagnosis.
3-152                                                                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                                                   SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN   FMI                   Description                                     Possible Cause                                         Action
 Code    Code
  568     154    651    5    Injector cyl. 1: interruption of electrical con- Interruption of electronic connection Injector    Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             nection                                          cyl. 1                                            threshold.
                                                                                                                                Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                                                                                repair/replace it.
  581     155    652    3    Injector cyl. 2: the current drop measured by Suspected Components:                                Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             ECU is above the target range                 injector cylinder 2                                  threshold.
                                                                           wiring harness, cable break or short circuit, sen-   Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                           sor defective, connection cable                      repair/replace it. Use SerDia Injector
                                                                           damaged                                              test for diagnosis.
  569     155    652    5    Injector cyl. 2: interruption of electrical con- Interruption of electronic connection Injector    Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             nection                                          cyl. 2                                            threshold.
                                                                                                                                Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                                                                                repair/replace it.
  582     156    653    3    Injector cyl. 3: the current drop measured by Suspected Components:                                Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             ECU is above the target range                 injector cylinder 3                                  threshold.
                                                                           wiring harness, cable break or short circuit, sen-   Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                           sor defective, connection cable                      repair/replace it. Use SerDia Injector
                                                                           damaged                                              test for diagnosis.
  570     156    653    5    Injector cyl. 3: interruption of electrical con- Interruption of electronic connection Injector    Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             nection                                          cyl. 3                                            threshold.
                                                                                                                                Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                                                                                repair/replace it.
  583     161    654    3    Injector cyl. 4: the current drop measured by Suspected Components:                                Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             ECU is above the target range                 injector cylinder 4                                  threshold.
                                                                           wiring harness, cable break or short circuit, sen-   Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                           sor defective, connection cable                      repair/replace it. Use SerDia Injector
                                                                                                                                test for diagnosis.
  571     161    654    5    Injector cyl. 4: interruption of electrical con- Interruption of electronic connection Injector    Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             nection                                          cyl. 4                                            threshold.
                                                                                                                                Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                                                                                repair/replace it.
  584     162    655    3    Injector cyl. 5: the current drop measured by Suspected Components:                                Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             ECU is above the target range                 injector cylinder 5                                  threshold.
                                                                           wiring harness, cable break or short circuit, sen-   Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                           sor defective, connection cable                      repair/replace it. Use SerDia Injector
                                                                                                                                test for diagnosis.
  572     162    655    5    Injector cyl. 5: interruption of electrical con- Interruption of electronic connection Injector    Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             nection                                          cyl. 5                                            threshold.
                                                                                                                                Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                                                                                repair/replace it.
  585     163    656    3    Injector cyl. 6: the current drop measured by Suspected Components:                                Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             ECU is above the target range                 injector cylinder 6                                  threshold.
                                                                           wiring harness, cable break or short circuit, sen-   Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                           sor defective, connection cable                      repair/replace it. Use SerDia Injector
                                                                                                                                test for diagnosis.
  573     163    656    5    Injector cyl. 6: interruption of electrical con- Interruption of electronic connection Injector    Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             nection                                          cyl. 6                                            threshold.
                                                                                                                                Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                                                                                repair/replace it.
3121171                                                                                                                                                                 3-153
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN   FMI                    Description                                   Possible Cause                                          Action
 Code    Code
  543    263     676   11    Cold start aid relay error.                     Relay defect or wire harness problem              Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                                                                               threshold.
                                                                                                                               check wire harness, replace relay
  544    263     676   11    Cold start aid relay open load                  Relay or wire harness                             Threshold for error detection is an internal
                                                                                                                               threshold.
                                                                                                                               check wire harness, replace relay
  956    512     677    3    Start relay (high side power stage): the cur-   Short cut HighSide-output to battery.             Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             rent drop measured by ECU is above the tar-                                                       threshold.
                             get range.                                                                                        Check cabling and start relay and if necessary
                                                                                                                               replace it,
                                                                                                                               check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                               or replace it.
  960    512     677    3    Start relay (low side power stage): the cur- Shortcut LowSide-Output to battery.                  Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             rent drain measured by ECU is above the tar-                                                      threshold.
                             get range.                                                                                        Check cabling and start relay and if necessary
                                                                                                                               replace it,
                                                                                                                               check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                               or replace it.
  957    512     677    4    Start relay (high side power stage):            Shortcut HighSide-output to ground.               Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             the current drain measured by ECU is above                                                        threshold.
                             the target range.                                                                                 Check cabling and start relay and if necessary
                                                                                                                               replace it,
                                                                                                                               check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                               or replace it.
  961    512     677    4    Start relay (low side power stage): the cur-    Shortcut LowSide-Output to ground.                Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             rent drop measured by ECU is above the tar-                                                       threshold.
                             get range.                                                                                        Check cabling and start relay and if necessary
                                                                                                                               replace it,
                                                                                                                               check connection cable of terminal 50 and if
                                                                                                                               necessary repair or replace it.
  958    512     677    5    Start relay (low side power stage): the cur-    Open circuit/disconnection LowSide-Output.        Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             rent drop measured by ECU is above the tar-                                                       threshold.
                             get range                                                                                         Check cabling and start relay and if necessary
                                                                                                                               replace it,
                                                                                                                               check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                               or replace it.
  959    512     677   12    Start relay (low side power stage): the cur-    Temperature over limit.                           Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             rent drop measured by ECU is above the tar-                                                       threshold.
                             get range.                                                                                        Check cabling and start relay and if necessary
                                                                                                                               replace it,
                                                                                                                               check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                               or replace it.
  928    928     691    8    Supply module heater: PWM time periode          PWM signal for temperature readout from sup-      The Time period of the received PWM signal
                             out of valid range.                             ply module to the control unit is out of          SCR_tiSMPerPwm is within the specified
                                                                             range.                                            range of150ms to 250ms
                                                                             Supply modul defect, fault in the wiring.         Supply module check and replace if necessary.
                                                                                                                               Check the wiring.
  549    263     729    3    wiring to the intake air heater device is       Intake Air Heater Device: overload, short-circuit Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                             faulty.                                                                                           threshold.
                                                                                                                               Electrical error, Check wiring to the intake air
                                                                                                                               heater device.
3-154                                                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                                                      SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                   Description                                     Possible Cause                                            Action
 Code    Code
  551     263    729     4    wiring to the air intake heater is faulty       Relay (for cold start aid) cable break or short to   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                              ground:                                              threshold.
                                                                                                                                   Electrical error, check wiring to the air intake
                                                                                                                                   heater.
  545     263    729     5    The cold start aid relay is according to wiring Relay defect or wire harness problem                 Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              faulty.                                                                                              threshold.
                                                                                                                                   Electrical error, check wires
  547     263    729    12    The cold start aid relay is overheated, which   High temperature around the cold start relay.        Check the functionality of relay and replace it if
                              causes this error                                                                                    needed.
                                                                                                                                   Check the temperature around the cold start
                                                                                                                                   relay during worst case operation.
  305     118    898     9    Timeout Error of CAN-Receive-Frame TSC1TE Timeout Error (Missing CAN Bus message)                    Check CAN Bus cabling (Bus sheduling, polarity,
                              - active                                                                                             short circuit, power interrupt), test
                                                                                                                                   protocol of receiver, check CAN functional
                                                                                                                                   range.
  946     282    1079   13    Internal hardware monitoring: the ECU          Suspected components EDC17cv52                        Check cabling of external components, check
                              detects a deviation of the target range of the Pin A19: DEF press / Exh.PressBeforeTurb (P3) /       working voltage and if necessary correct
                              power supply voltage of sensor output 1.       Air Pump Press                                        it,
                                                                             /BrnFuelPressAfterDV2 Pin K19: Fan Speed Sen-         check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                             sor                                                   or replace it,
                                                                             Pin A21: LDF6T / OilPress / LowFuelPress Pin          if error is not removable, change ECU.
                                                                             A17: Rail Pressure Sensor
                                                                             Suspected components EDC17cv54
                                                                             Pin A21: CAM speed Pin K44: Delta Press Venturi
                                                                             / Poti EGR or Inlet Throttle
                                                                             Pin A24: LDF6T / OilPress / LowFuelPressPin
                                                                             K43: Reserve 5V Sensor Supply
                                                                             Pin A09: second footpedal
                                                                             Suspected components EDC17cv56
                                                                             Pin A21: Cam speed Pin K44: DEF press / Air Fil-
                                                                             terDiffPress
                                                                             Pin A24: LDF6T / OilPress / LowFuelPress Pin
                                                                             K43: second footpedal
                                                                             Pin A09: Delta Press Venturi
  947     282    1080   13    Internal hardware monitoring: the ECU          Suspected components EDC17cv52                        Check cabling of external components, check
                              detects a deviation of the target range of the Pin K16: second footpedal                             working voltage and if necessary correct
                              power supply voltage of sensor output 2.       Pin A20: Exh.PressAfterTurb/DPFDiffPress/             it, check connection cable and if necessary
                                                                             BrnDV1Press/HCIPressDV1DV2                            repair or replace it, if error is not removable,
                                                                             Suspected components EDC17cv54                        change ECU.
                                                                             Pin K45: DPF Diff Press / Exh. Press After Turb /
                                                                             Fan Speed Sensor
                                                                             Pin A46: first footpedal
                                                                             Suspected components EDC17cv56
                                                                             Pin A22: Fan Speed Sensor
                                                                             Pin K45: Position EGR or Intake throttle flap
                                                                             Pin K46: First footpedal
  121     341    1109    2    Request of engine shut off: the operator      Engine Shut Off demand has been ignored by             Depending on error requested a shut off.
                              ignores the engine shut off request within an the user
                              allowed period.
 1398     681    1136    0    ECU internal temperature; temperature           Short-Circuit in ECU, ECU heated by hot air          Close warm air circuits, replace ECU
                              measured by ECU is out of the target range
3121171                                                                                                                                                                      3-155
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                  Description                                  Possible Cause                                         Action
 Code    Code
  85     271     1231   14    CAN bus 1: the ECU is not allowed to send    CAN BusOff error; CAN 1 (Diagnostic CAN)         Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              messages, because the status "BusOff" is                                                      threshold.
                              detected                                                                                      BusOff bit for CAN B node is set.
                              Warning, no diagnostic with SERDIA2010                                                        Check wiring of CAN bus and if necessary repair
                              possible                                                                                      it, check connection cable and if
                                                                                                                            necessary repair or replace it, check resistance in
                                                                                                                            CAN lines (120 Ohm)
  86     271     1235   14    CAN bus 2: the ECU is not allowed to send    CAN BusOff error; CAN 2 (Engine CAN)             Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              messages, because the status "BusOff" is                                                      threshold.
                              detected.                                                                                     BusOff bit for CAN C node is set.
                              Warning, depends on engine, EAT.                                                              Check wiring of CAN bus and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                            it, check connection cable and if
                                                                                                                            necessary repair or replace it, check resistance in
                                                                                                                            CAN lines (120 Ohm)
  747    145     1237    2    Override switch switch: the ECU receives a   Switch is blocked, taster locked, connection     If the Block Button is pressed shorter than the
                              permanent signal.                            cable damaged                                    Maximum Plausible pressing Time.
                                                                           plausbility error "override switch > 250ms       Check cabling, if sensor is not working, check
                                                                           pressed".                                        switch and if necessary replace it, check
                                                                                                                            connection cable and if necessary repair or
                                                                                                                            replace it.
 1593    129     1761    0    The urea tank level sensor detects a value   Suspected components:                            Check level sensor and float gauge
                              higher than the maximum allowed thresh-      Urea Quality Sensor defect
                              old                                          mechanical defect at the float gauge
 1594    129     1761    1    The DEF tank level sensor detects a value Suspected components:                               Check level sensor and float gauge
                              lower than the minimum allowed threshold Urea Quality Sensor defect
                                                                        mechanical defect at the float gauge
 1655    138     1761   14    The urea tank volume ratio is below the      actual urea tank level SCRUTnk_rVol_mp [%] is Check urea level => if empty, then fill in urea
                              threshold of <5%                             below applicable threshold 5%                 Check DEF level sensor.
                                                                                                                         If there is urea in the tank, then move the floater
                                                                                                                         of the level sensor. The floater must
                                                                                                                         be free. If you lift the sensor body, then
                                                                                                                         SCRUTnk_rVol_mp must change.
                                                                                                                         Exchange DEF level sensor, if no change of value
                                                                                                                         or it's implausible.
 1656    138     1761   14    The urea tank volume ratio is below the      actual urea tank level SCRUTnk_rVol_mp [%] is Check urea level => if empty, then fill in urea
                              threshold of <2.5%                           below 2.5%                                    Check DEF level sensor.
                                                                                                                         If there is urea in the tank, then move the floater
                                                                                                                         of the level sensor. The floater must
                                                                                                                         be free. If you lift the sensor body, then
                                                                                                                         SCRUTnk_rVol_mp must change.
                                                                                                                         Exchange DEF level sensor, if no change of value
                                                                                                                         or it's implausible.
3-156                                                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                                                    SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                   Description                                  Possible Cause                                        Action
 Code    Code
 1880     138    1761   14    The DEF tank level is below the threshold.    actual DEF tank level SCRUTnk_rVol_mp [%] is Check DEF level => if empty, refill
                                                                            below the threshold                          Check DEF level sensor.
                                                                                                                         If there is urea in the tank loose the sensor and
                                                                                                                         move it. The floater must be free and
                                                                                                                         move if you lift the sensor body.
                                                                                                                         SCRUTnk_rVol_mp must change.
                                                                                                                         Compare SCRUTnk_rVol_mp to:
                                                                                                                         1 = SCR_rawUTnkLvl
                                                                                                                         2 = SCR_rAdapUtnkLvl
                                                                                                                         3 = SCRUTnk_rActTnkVol
                                                                                                                         *SCRUTnk_facVolPer_mp
                                                                                                                         In case of malfunction, exchange DEF level sen-
                                                                                                                         sor.
 1763     415    2791    0    Internal actuator temperature is above        Overheating of EGR actuator during operation.    Let EGR actuator cool down and check heat
                              threshold.                                                                                     accumulation during worst case operation.
 1753     415    2791    2    corrupted CAN communication with actua-       CAN bus error or faulty EGR actuator.            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              tor.                                                                                           threshold.
                                                                                                                             Check other CAN bus components. If no mes-
                                                                                                                             sage is sent, fix the wiring.
                                                                                                                             If o.k. exchange EGR actuaror.
 1758     415    2791    3    Overvoltage at EGR actuator.                  High voltage from the battery                    Check battery voltage.
 1759     415    2791    4    Undervoltage at EGR actuator.                 Low voltage from the battery.                    Check battery voltage.
 1757     415    2791    6    Overcurrent to EGR actuator.                  High voltage from battery.                       Check battery voltage. Check if EGR is blocked or
                                                                            EGR actuator is blocked or moving very hard.     not running smoothly.
                                                                                                                             If everything is o.k. change EGR actuator.
 1752     415    2791    7    EGR actuator is mechanically blocked.         EGR actuator faulty or blocked.                  Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                                                                             threshold.
                                                                                                                             Check the EGR actuator and EGR valve to
                                                                                                                             mechanical blockage / clean.
                                                                                                                             Check for free movement of the valve. If it'S
                                                                                                                             blocked, then exchange the EGR valve.
 1761     415    2791    7    EGR actuator spring broken.                   mechanical damage of spring due to overstress. Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                                                                           threshold.
                                                                                                                           Exchange EGR actuator.
 1755     415    2791   12    Internal electrical fault of EGR actuator.    Internal damage of EGR actuator due to high      Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                            temperature or electrical wiring issue.          threshold.
                                                                                                                             Exchange EGR actuator.
 1754     415    2791   13    EGR actuator can not learn stop positions.    Error detection during the learning process.     Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              Possibly only second failure if other EGRTV                                                    threshold.
                              failures occure.                                                                               Start Serdia Usecase to reset EGR actuator.
                                                                                                                             Check EGR valve and mounting situation. If o.k.
                                                                                                                             change EGR actuator.
 1756     415    2791   13    EGR actuator can not learn stop positions     Interruption of learning process due to mechan- Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              because procedure was interrupted.            ical damage.                                    threshold.
                                                                                                                            Start Serdia Usecase to reset EGR actuator.
 1760     415    2791   13    Stop positions of EGR valve not o.k.          Mechanical damage of EGR actuator.               Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                            EGR valve is blocked or moving very hard.        threshold.
                                                                                                                             Start Serdia Usecase to reset EGR actuator.
 1762     415    2791   16    Internal actuator temperature above thresh- overheating of EGR actuator                        Let EGR actuator cool down, check heat accu-
                              old.                                                                                           mulation during worst case operation.
3121171                                                                                                                                                               3-157
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                  Description                                  Possible Cause                                       Action
 Code    Code
 1337    565     2797    4    Injector diagnosis: Timeout of Injetor detec- Short-Circuit to ground on component wiring    Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              tion cylinder bank 0                                                                         threshold.
                                                                                                                           Check wiring, component, ECU
                                                                                                                           Note: affected injector has to be evaluated
                                                                                                                           according to firing order
 1339    565     2797    4    Injector test: Short cut to ground on cylinder Short-Circuit to ground on component wiring   Check wiring, component, ECU
                              bank 0                                                                                       Note: affected injector has to be evaluated
                                                                                                                           according to firing order
 1338    566     2798    4    Injector diagnosis: Timeout of Injetor detec- Short-Circuit to ground on component wiring    Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              tion cylinder bank 1                                                                         threshold.
                                                                                                                           Check wiring, component, ECU
                                                                                                                           Note: affected injector has to be evaluated
                                                                                                                           according to firing order
 1340    566     2798    4    Injector test: Short cut to ground on cylinder Short-Circuit to ground on component wiring   Check wiring, component, ECU
                              bank 1                                                                                       Note: affected injector has to be evaluated
                                                                                                                           according to firing order
 1135    669     3031    0    The urea tank temperature sensor detects a   Sensed urea tank temperature > physical range Case "CANBUS sensor":
                              value above the maximum allowed thresh-      high limit                                    Check urea tank temperature: really hot?
                              old                                                                                        Check CANBus-message of DEF sensor urea tank
                                                                                                                         temperature Com_dRxSCR2Byt2
                                                                                                                         Compare it to Com_dRxSCR1Byt1 (urea tem-
                                                                                                                         perature at quality sensor) identical?
                                                                                                                         Tank heater permantly on?
                                                                                                                         Check wiring of DEF-quality sensor
                                                                                                                         Case "analog DEF T & Level sensor":
                                                                                                                         Check urea tank temperature: really hot?
                                                                                                                         Check urea tank temperature SCR_tSensUTnkT
                                                                                                                         Compare urea tank temperature to EnvT_t or to
                                                                                                                         SCR_tSMT (the urea temperature
                                                                                                                         inside the supply module) identical?
                                                                                                                         Tank heater permantly on?
                                                                                                                         Check wiring of analog DEF T & Level sensor
 1136    669     3031    1    The urea tank temperature sensor detects a   sensed urea tank temperature < physical range Case "CANBUS sensor":
                              value lower than the minimum allowed         low limit                                     Check ambient temperature EnvT_t => About
                              threshold.                                                                                 -40 °C? If yes Error could be plausible
                                                                                                                         Check CANBus-message of DEF sensor urea tank
                                                                                                                         temperature Com_dRxSCR2Byt2
                                                                                                                         Compare it to Com_dRxSCR1Byt1 (urea tem-
                                                                                                                         perature at quality sensor) identical?
                                                                                                                         Check wiring of DEF-quality sensor
                                                                                                                         Check quality sensor
                                                                                                                         Case "analog DEF T & Level sensor":
                                                                                                                         Check urea tank temperature: really that cold?
                                                                                                                         Check ambient temperature EnvT_t =>
                                                                                                                         About -40 °C? If yes Error could be plausible
                                                                                                                         Check urea tank temperature SCR_tSensUTnkT
                                                                                                                         Check wiring of analog DEF T & Level sensor
                                                                                                                         Check analog DEF T & Level sensor
  129    596     3224    2    DLC Error of CAN-Receive-Frame AT1IG1Vol Not Used                                            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              NOX Sensor (SCR-system upstream cat; DPF-                                                    threshold.
                              system downstream cat); length of frame                                                      Check Nox-Sensor and the wiring from CAN-
                              incorrect                                                                                    BUS.
3-158                                                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                                                   SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                  Description                                     Possible Cause                                     Action
 Code    Code
  130     597    3224    9    Timeout Error of CAN-Receive-Frame       Failure of the CAN Bus message                       NOX sensor and sensor connection check
                              AT1IG1Vol; NOX sensor (SCR-system
                              upstream cat; DPF-system downstream cat)
  138     114    3234    2    DLC Error of CAN-Receive-Frame AT1O1Vol        Failure of the CAN Bus message                 NOX downstream sensor and sensor connection
                              NOX Sensor (SCR-system downstream cat;                                                        check
                              DPF-system downstream cat); length of
                              frame incorrect
  139     117    3234    9    Timeout Error of CAN-Receive-Frame      Failure of the CAN Bus message                        NOX downstream sensor and sensor connection
                              AT1OG1Vol; NOX sensor (SCR-system down-                                                       check
                              stream cat; DPF-system downstream cat)
 1077     677    3361    3    Urea dosing valve (low side power stage):      Fault in the wiring                            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              the current drain measured by ECU is above                                                    threshold
                              the target range                                                                              See substitute function
                                                                                                                            Check the wiring
 1078     677    3361    3    Urea dosing valve (high side power stage):     Fault in the wiring                            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              the current drain measured by ECU is above                                                    threshold
                              the target range                                                                              Check the wiring
 1079     677    3361    4    Urea dosing valve (low side power stage):      Fault in the wiring                            Check the wiring
                              the current drain measured by ECU is above
                              the target range
 1080     677    3361    4    Urea dosing valve (high side power stage):     Fault in the wiring                            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              the current drain measured by ECU is above                                                    threshold
                              the target range                                                                              Check the wiring
 1075     677    3361    6    Urea dosing valve: the current measured         Fault in the wiriing                          Check wiring
                              value by ECU at the end of the injection is too Defect urea dosing injection valve            Check the urea dosing injection valve
                              high
 1898     277    3519    3    The integrated diagnostic of the tempera- Wrong diagnostic of the short circuits logic        Check the wiring to the suction unit in the DEF
                              ture sensor of the Urea Quality Sensor recog- inside the temperature sensor of the UQS        tank.
                              nized a short circuit to battery.             CAN Communication corrupted                     Check the CAN bus communication of the suc-
                              The UQS Sensor is an combined sensor of                                                       tion unit. In case the communication is
                              tank temperature, filling grade and DEF                                                       corrupt, exchange the suction unit.
                              quality and it is also an CAN sensor --> no
                              PIN
 1899     277    3519    4    The integrated diagnostic of the tempera- DEF quality sensor in the suction unit of the DEF Check the wiring to the suction unit of the DEF
                              ture sensor of the Urea Quality Sensor recog- tank is defect                                tank.
                              nized a short circuit to ground               CAN Communication corrupted                   Check the CAN bus communication from the
                                                                                                                          suction unit. In case the signal is corrupt,
                                                                                                                          exchange the suction unit in the DEF tank.
3121171                                                                                                                                                              3-159
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                   Description                                    Possible Cause                                           Action
 Code    Code
 1895    277     3519   12    The integrated temperature sensor of the        Temperature sensor inside the UQS defect.          Check the temperature sensor signal for plausi-
                              Urea Quality Sensor measures higher tem-        CAN Communication corrupted.                       bility. In case of improper signal,
                              perature than threshold                         Overheating of the DEF tank due to malfunction     exchange the suction unit in the tank.
                                                                              of the heating valve.                              Check CAN bus communication for proper sig-
                                                                              Flow direction is of coolant is wrong due to       nal. In case of improper signal, exchange
                                                                              mixed up the hoses routed to the heating           the suction unit in the tank.
                                                                              valve.                                             Check the function of heating valve and routing
                                                                              Overheating of the DEF tank due to heat transfer   of the hoses. The coolant flow through
                                                                              from neighbor parts.                               the heating valve must be observed according
                                                                                                                                 to the shown arrow.
                                                                                                                                 In case all actions above are OK, check the real
                                                                                                                                 temperature in the DEF tank during
                                                                                                                                 worst case condition and improve the installa-
                                                                                                                                 tion of the DEF tank.
 1908    277     3519   13    Temperature at UQS out of range the speci-      Suspected Components                               Check temperature system and/or DEF quality
                              fied thresholds; invalid quality of the tem-    Tank heater                                        sensor
                              perature                                        DEF sensor
 1904    2-7-8   3520    2    Measured DEF Quality from UQS is too low.       Suspected components:                              Check that there is liquid urea of known quality
                              Quality value received from UQS is < 22 % for   Urea quality sensor defect                         in the tank first
                              a certain time and a certain number or for      Wrong installation (measuring air)                 Check urea tank level. Add urea until level is at
                              measuring conditions not observed for a cer-    Urea level sensor defect                           least 10 cm above sensor.
                              tain time.                                      Non urea filled in tank                            Ensure that urea is not frozen / sufficient urea is
                                                                              CANBUS problems                                    liquid
                                                                              Evaluation conditions for new quality check not    Check Sensor: Are urea tank temperature and
                                                                              fulfilled after one previous mal detection         level displayed? Changes the level if you
                                                                                                                                 refill urea?
                                                                                                                                 Check electrical connection
                                                                                                                                 Check CANBus
                                                                                                                                 New quality detection is carried out if urea re-
                                                                                                                                 fill is detected or if an quality evaluation
                                                                                                                                 was triggered and was not finished success-
                                                                                                                                 fully: To provoke a quality measurement: refill
                                                                                                                                 urea, at least 10 % of tank volume
                                                                                                                                 Wait until quality evaluation was carried out,
                                                                                                                                 can take up to 30 minutes => check value.
                                                                                                                                 It should be about 33 %
                                                                                                                                 Exchange quality sensor
 1896    278     3520    3    The integrated diagnostic of the Urea Quality wiring harness of UQS corrupted                      Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              Sensor recognized a short circuit to battery CAN Communication corrupted                           threshold.
                                                                                                                                 Check the wiring harness from the ECU to the
                                                                                                                                 suction unit of the DEF tank
                                                                                                                                 Check the CAN bus communication. If the signal
                                                                                                                                 is corrupt, then exchange the suction
                                                                                                                                 unit.
 1897    278     3520    4    The integrated diagnostic of the Urea Quality wiring harness to the suction unit in the DEF        Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              Sensor recognized a short circuit to ground. tank is corrupted                                     threshold.
                                                                            CAN Communication corrupted                          Check the wiring to the suction unit in the DEF
                                                                                                                                 tank.
                                                                                                                                 Check the CAN bus communication. In case the
                                                                                                                                 communication is corrupt, exchange
                                                                                                                                 the suction unit in the DEF tank.
3-160                                                                                                                                                                   3121171
                                                                                                                   SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                   Description                                    Possible Cause                                       Action
 Code    Code
 1907     278    3520   13    Urea quality at UQS out of range the speci-    Suspected components                            Check DEF quality and/or DEF quality sensor
                              fied thresholds; invalid quality of the urea   DEF quality sensor
                              qualiy                                         DEF
 1911     127    3532    3    The urea quality value from the sensor is Suspected Components:                                Check DEF quality and/or sensor.
                              greater than the maximum physical range UQS defect
                              threshold
                              Comment: tank temperature is measured by
                              the UQS sensor
 1912     127    3532    4    The urea quality value from the sensor is      Suspected Components:                           Check DEF quality and/or Sensor.
                              lower than the minimum physical range          UQS defect
                              threshold.
 1455     711    3711   12    Temperature Phy_tPfWgh, the weighted           temperature Phy_tPfWgh, the weighted DPF        Check temperature upstream DOC
                              DPF temperature < Threshold 1                  temperature, is below or above                  Exh_tSensOxiCatUs within Stand-still: > 450
                              Temperature Phy_tPfWgh, the weighted           the target temperature towards the end of the   °C? If
                              DPF temperature > Threshold 2                  stand-still main phase.                         not:
                              towards the end of the stand-still main                                                        => Check air path of engine: EGR-Valve,
                              phase.                                                                                         Intake-Throttle, Turbocharger and Piping
                                                                                                                             each for leakage and correct function
                                                                                                                             Check temperature difference across DOC by
                                                                                                                             Exh_tSensOxiCatDs -
                                                                                                                             Exh_tSensOxiCatUs within Stand-still: <
                                                                                                                             100°C? If not:
                                                                                                                             Check exhaust pipe downstream turbo charger
                                                                                                                             for oil?
                                                                                                                             check injectors: is an injector got stuck?
                                                                                                                             Too many hydrocarbons in exhaust? White
                                                                                                                             smoke (at hot EAT system, not at cold
                                                                                                                             start)?
                                                                                                                             Check air path of engine: EGR-Valve, Intake-
                                                                                                                             Throttle, Turbocharger and Piping each
                                                                                                                             for leakage and correct function
                                                                                                                             Check exhaust gas temperature sensors within
                                                                                                                             EAT-system: T upstream DOCC, T
                                                                                                                             downstream DOC & T upstream SCR catalyst
                                                                                                                             all three of them can influence Phy_tPfWgh
 1917    2-8-6   3936   14    Standstill escalation by time. In case the      Stand-still request ignored by the operator.   Perform Stand-still. If soot load level of DPF has
                              standstill request will not be released within Display / stand-still request lamp broken.      increased too high already call service
                              50 h by the driver this fault code will be set.                                                to perform stand-still.
                                                                                                                             In case the DPF soot load level remove DPF =>
                                                                                                                             Exchange DPF.
 1122     665    4334    0    The absolute pressure value of the urea    Suspected Components:                               Check the urea pump
                              pump is greater than an applicable maximal Urea pump defect                                    Check the supply module pressur sensor
                              filtered pressure threshold                Supply module pressure sensor defect                Clean the urea pump (filter)
                                                                         Pump contains dirty parts
 1123     665    4334    1    Urea supply module pressure sensor: The        Check the urea pump                             Check the urea pump
                              absolute pressure value of the urea pump is    Check the supply module pressur sensor          Check the supply module pressur sensor
                              less than an applicable minimal filtered       Clean the urea pump (filter)                    Clean the urea pump (filter)
                              pressure threshold
3121171                                                                                                                                                                3-161
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                   Description                                       Possible Cause                                        Action
 Code    Code
 1866    665     4334    2    absolute difference of sensed urea pump        absolute difference of sensed urea pump pres-        Check environment pressure sensor (EnvP_p)
                              pressure (SCR_pAbsSensUPmpP) and ambi-         sure (SCR_pAbsSensUPmpP) and                         => plausible value?
                              ent pressure (EnvP_p) > limit                  ambient pressure (EnvP_p) > limit                    Engine shut-off and immediately re-started?
                              abs(UPmpP_pDiffPmpEnv_mp) >                    abs(UPmpP_pDiffPmpEnv_mp) >                          => Shut-off again. Wait until afterun of
                              UPmpP_pDiffPmpEnv_C (250 hPa)                  UPmpP_pDiffPmpEnv_C                                  ECU has finished, re-Start engine
                                                                                                                                  Back-flow line free? Does the urea pump pres-
                                                                                                                                  sure show values < 1000 hPa in SCR
                                                                                                                                  state emptying (64)?
                                                                                                                                  Check revision valve => Does the urea pump
                                                                                                                                  pressure show values < 1000 hPa in SCR
                                                                                                                                  state emptying (64)? => exchange supply
                                                                                                                                  module
                                                                                                                                  Supply module pressure sensor defect =>
                                                                                                                                  exchange supply module
 1104    675     4341    3    Urea heater supply line: the current drain     electrical error                                     Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range                                                           threshold
                                                                                                                                  Check wire harness
                                                                                                                                  Check supply line
 1105    675     4341    4    Urea heater supply line: the current drain     electrical error                                     Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range                                                           threshold
                                                                                                                                  Check wire harness
                                                                                                                                  Check supply line
 1102    675     4341    5    Urea heater supply line: the current drain     electrical error                                     Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range                                                           threshold
                                                                                                                                  Check wire harness
                                                                                                                                  Check supply line
 1096    673     4343    3    Urea pressure line heater: the current drain   shortcut to battery                                  Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range      If this error detected during the heating phase is   threshold
                                                                             a result error: KWP 1089                             Check wiring
                                                                             broken heating element in pressure line              Check heating element
 1097    673     4343    4    Urea pressure line heater: the current drain   Shortcut to ground                                   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range      If this error detected during the heating phase is   threshold
                                                                             a result error: KWP 1089                             Check wiring
                                                                             Short cut to ground or broken wiring, broken         Check heating element
                                                                             heating element in pressure line
 1094    673     4343    5    Urea pressure line heater: the current drain   Open load                                            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range      If this error detected during the heating phase is   threshold
                                                                             a result error: KWP 1089                             Check wiring
                                                                             Broken wiring, broken heating element in pres-       Check heating element
                                                                             sure line
 1092    674     4345    3    Urea backflow line heater: the current drain Shortcut to battery                                    Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range If this error detected during the heating phase is        threshold
                                                                           a result error: KWP 1089                               Check wiring
                                                                           Short cut to battery or broken wiring, broken          Check heating element
                                                                           heating element in backflow line
 1093    674     4345    4    Urea backflow line heater: the current drain Shortcut to ground                                     Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range If this error detected during the heating phase is        threshold
                                                                           a result error: KWP 1089                               Check wiring
                                                                           Short cut to ground or broken wiring, broken           Check heating element
                                                                           heating element in backflow line
3-162                                                                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                                                        SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                   Description                                       Possible Cause                                            Action
 Code    Code
 1090     674    4345    5    Urea backflow line heater: the current drain Open load                                                  Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range If this error detected during the heating phase is            threshold
                                                                           a result error: KWP 1089                                   Check wiring
                                                                           Broken wiring, broken heating element in back-             Check heating element
                                                                           flow line
 1069     668    4360    0    The filtered urea cat upstream temperature Sensed temperature upstream SCR > physical                   Check temperature difference across DOC
                              is greater than an applicable maximum tem- high limit                                                   (Exh_tOxiCatDs-Exh_TOxiCatUs) at higher
                              perature threshold                                                                                      engine load => high difference > 100 K?
                                                                                                                                      If yes, the engine emitts too many Hydrocar-
                                                                                                                                      bons => check injectors: is an injector got
                                                                                                                                      stuck?
                                                                                                                                      => Check EGR Valve
                                                                                                                                      If difference normal the exhaust out of the engie
                                                                                                                                      itself is too hot:
                                                                                                                                      => Check air path of engine: EGR-Valve,
                                                                                                                                      Intake-Throttle, Turbocharger and Piping
                                                                                                                                      each for leakage and correct function
                                                                                                                                      If that error was set while stand-still operation
                                                                                                                                      the error source could be exothermal
                                                                                                                                      soot burn off in DPF (which should not happen)
                                                                                                                                      => Dismount DPF and check it visually
                                                                                                                                      exchange temperature sensor upstream SCR
 1070     668    4360    1    The filtered temperature before urea cat is       Sensed temperature upstream SCR catalyst <            Cold start and ambient temperature < Thresh-
                              less than an applicable minimum tempera-          than physical low limit                               old? Missdetection?
                              ture threshold                                                                                          Check wiring harness to UCatUsT-sensor
                                                                                                                                      Exchange UCatUsT-sensor
 1865     668    4360    2    Error at static plausibility check:               Error at static plausibility check:                   Check whether temperature sensor upstream of
                              absolut temperature difference of sensed          absolut temperature difference of sensed tem-         SCR catalyst is physically mounted
                              temperature upstream SCR catalyst and             perature upstream SCR catalyst and                    within exhaust pipe
                              ambient temperature > as static plausibility      ambient temperature > as static plausibility          If cold start condition can be made sure (engine
                              limit                                             limit                                                 was off for at least 8 h) compare
                              at engine cold start (engine was off for at       at engine cold start (engine was off for at least 8   values of EnvT_t, EngDa_tEng, Exh_TOxiCatUs,
                              least 8 h), temperature upstream of SCR cat-      h), temperature upstream of SCR                       Exh_tOxiCatDs and
                              alyst is expected to be identical to ambient      catalyst is expected to be identical to ambient       SCR_tSensUCatUsT at ignition on, without
                              temperature => see enable conditions for          temperature => see enable conditions for              starting the engine. All identical?
                              details.                                          details.                                              Compare values of Exh_TOxiCatUs,
                              Error at dynamic plausibility check:              Error at dynamic plausibility check:                  Exh_tOxiCatDs and SCR_tSensUCatUsT after 15
                              temperature difference of sensed tempera-         temperature difference of sensed temperature          min in constant operation point: show all simi-
                              ture upstream SCR catalyst and ambient            upstream SCR catalyst and ambient                     lar values (30 K tolerance width). Are
                              temperature < as dynamic plausibility limit       temperature < as dynamic plausibility limit           ambient temperature and (EnvT_t), cooling
                              dynamic check is blocked if static plausibility   dynamic check is blocked if static plausibility       water temperature (EngDa_tEng) plausible?
                              check is already faulty                           check is already faulty                               Sensor coated with urea crystalls? Dismount
                              => Temperature upstream SCR catalyst              => Temperature upstream SCR catalyst must             urea injector and inspect temperature
                              must be by 40°C higher than ambient tem-          be by 40°C higher than ambient                        sensor upstream SCR catalyst visually
                              perature if engine runs and a certain delay       temperature if engine runs and a certain delay        Check wiring of sensor
                              time has expired.                                 time has expired.                                     Replace sensor
 1072     668    4361    3    Urea catalyst upstream temperature sensor: Voltage of temperature sensor upstream SCR                   Check sensor
                              the voltage of sensor measured by ECU is out catalyst > maximum limit                                   Check wiring
                              of the target range                          Short circuit to battery                                   Replace UCatUsT-sensor
 1073     668    4361    4    Urea catalyst upstream temperature sensor: Voltage of temperature sensor upstream SCR                   Check sensor
                              the voltage of sensor measured by ECU is out catalyst < minimum limit                                   Check wiring
                              of the target range                          Short circuit to ground                                    Replace UCatUsT-sensor
3121171                                                                                                                                                                        3-163
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                   Description                                  Possible Cause                                           Action
 Code    Code
 1137    6-6-9   4365    2    Signal error in case of Urea tank temperature CAN message is not send properly.                   Check sensor connector
                              trnasmitted via CAN-signal Com_tUTnkT.                                                            Check CANbus
 1138    6-6-9   4365    3    Urea tank temperature sensor: he current     Shortcut or open load.                               Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              drain measured by ECU is above the target                                                         threshold.
                              range.                                                                                            The Sensed raw voltage value SCR_uRawUTnkT
                                                                                                                                is below SCR_SRCUTnkT.uMax_C.
                                                                                                                                Check wiring.
 1914    669     4365    3    Internal error of DEF qualitysensor.         Suspected componentes:                               Check wiring harness and DEF qualitysensor
                                                                           DEF qualitysensor
                                                                           Wiring harness
 1139    6-6-9   4365    4    Urea tank temperature sensor: he current     Shortcut or open load.                               Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              drain measured by ECU is above the target                                                         threshold.
                              range.                                                                                            The sensed raw voltage value SCR_uRawUTnkT
                                                                                                                                is above SCR_SRCUTnkT.uMin_C.
                                                                                                                                Check wiring.
 1915    6-6-9   4365    4    Internal error of DEF qualitysensor.         Suspected componentes:                               Check wiring harness and DEF qualitysensor
                                                                           DEF qualitysensor
                                                                           Wiring harness
 1112    671     4366    3    Urea tank heating valve: the current drain   Shortcut to battery                                  Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range    If this error detected during the heating phase is   threshold
                                                                           a result error: KWP 1089                             Check wiring
                                                                           Broken wiring                                        Check urea tank heating valve
                                                                           Urea tank heating valve defect
 1113    671     4366    4    Urea tank heating valve: the current drain   Shortcut to ground                                   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range    If this error detected during the heating phase is   threshold
                                                                           a result error: KWP 1089                             Check wiring
                                                                           Broken wiring                                        Check urea tank heating valve
                                                                           Urea tank heating valve defect
 1110    671     4366    5    Urea tank heating valve: the current drain   Open load                                            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range    If this error detected during the heating phase is   threshold
                                                                           a result error: KWP 1089                             Check wiring
                                                                           Broken wiring                                        Check urea tank heating valve
                                                                           Urea tank heating valve defect
 1120    666     4375    3    Urea supply module pump: the current drain Shortcut to battery                                    Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range If this error detected during the heating phase is      threshold
                                                                         a result error: KWP 1089                               The hardware detects absence of any short cir-
                                                                         Broken wiring                                          cuit to battery on the PWM output power
                                                                         Pump in urea supply module defect                      stage for the urea pump module actuator
                                                                                                                                Check wiring
                                                                                                                                Check pump in the urea supply module
 1121    666     4375    4    Urea supply module pump: the current drain Shortcut to ground                                     Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measured by ECU is above the target range If this error detected during the heating phase is      threshold
                                                                         a result error: KWP 1089                               The hardware detects a short circuit to ground
                                                                         Broken wiring                                          error on the PWM output power stage
                                                                         Pump in urea supply module defect                      for the UreaPump Module Motor Actuator. The
                                                                                                                                error is updated by setting bit 1 of
                                                                                                                                measuring point UPmp-
                                                                                                                                Mot_stPrevTstRslt_mp
                                                                                                                                Check wiring
                                                                                                                                Check pump in the urea supply module
3-164                                                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                                                SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                  Description                                   Possible Cause                                        Action
 Code    Code
 1118     666    4375    5    Urea supply module pump: the ECU can not      Open load                                        Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              measure any reaction during pump control      Broken wiring                                    threshold
                                                                            Pump in urea supply module defect                The hardware detects the presence of load on
                                                                                                                             the PWM output power stage for the
                                                                                                                             urea pump module actuator.
                                                                                                                             Check wiring
                                                                                                                             Check pump in the urea supply module
 1131     667    4376    3    Urea supply module reversal valve: the cur- Shortcut to battery                              Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              rent drain measured by ECU is above the tar- Fault in the wiring                             threshold
                              get range                                    Reversal valve in the urea supply module defect Check wiring
                                                                                                                           Check urea supply modul
 1132     667    4376    4    Urea supply module reversal valve: the cur- Shortcut to ground                               Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              rent drain measured by ECU is above the tar- Fault in the wiring                             threshold
                              get range                                    Reversal valve in the urea supply module defect Check wiring
                                                                                                                           Check urea supply modul
 1129     667    4376    5    Urea supply module reversal valve: the cur- Open load                                        Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              rent drain measured by ECU is above the tar- Fault in the wiring                             threshold
                              get range                                    Reversal valve in the urea supply module defect Check wiring
                                                                                                                           Check urea supply modul
 1039     683    4765    0    The exhaust temperature value from the       sensed temperature upstream DOC > shut-off        Check air path of engine: EGR-Valve, Intake-
                              sensor befor DOC                             limit                                             Throttle,
                              is above an applicable upper shutoff thresh-                                                   Check Turbocharger and Piping each for leakage
                              old                                                                                            and correct function
                              TOxiCatUs_tShOffThresHiAds_C = Thresh-                                                         Check injectors: is an injector got stuck?
                              old 1 in Normal and                                                                            Exchange temperature sensor upstream DOC
                              Heatmodes
                              (TOxiCatUs_tShOffThresHiRgn_C = Thresh-
                              old 2
                              in stand-still)
 1040     683    4765    0    The exhaust temperature value from the        Sensed temperature upstream DOC > warning Check air path of engine: EGR-Valve, Intake-
                              sensor befor DOC                              limit                                     Throttle, Turbocharger and Piping each
                              is above an applicable upper warning                                                    for leakage and correct function
                              threshold                                                                               Check injectors: is an injector got stuck?
                              TOxiCatUs_tWarnThresHi_C = Threshold                                                    Exchange temperature sensor upstream DOC
3121171                                                                                                                                                               3-165
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                    Description                                      Possible Cause                                         Action
 Code    Code
 1036    683     4768    2    Static plausibility check:                          Static plausibility check:                       Check ambient temperature => value plausi-
                              The exhaust temperature value from the              The exhaust temperature value from the sensor    ble?
                              sensor before DOC, the exhaust temperature          before DOC, the exhaust temperature              upstream DOC sensor mounted within exhaust
                              value from the sensor after DOC, the temper-        value from the sensor after DOC, the tempera-    line?
                              ature value from the sensor before                  ture value from the sensor before                T upstream DOC sensor physically mounted in
                              SCR-Cat, the environment temperature and            SCR-Cat, the environment temperature and the     correct position upstream DOC? (not
                              the coolant engine temperature their ratios         coolant engine temperature their ratios          upstream SCR or downstream DOC?)
                              to each other exceed their related thresh-          to each other exceed their related thresholds.   Check T upstream DOC sensor
                              olds.                                               (difference between temperature after DOC and    Check other T-sensors within EAT-system
                              Dynamic plausibility check with environ-            temperature before DOC > Threshold 1             (Exh_tOxiCatDs & UCatUsT_tFlt_mp show
                              ment temperature sensor value:                      difference between temperature befor DOC and     plausible values? No errors on them?
                              The exhaust temperature value from the              before SCR > Threshold 2
                              sensor before DOC is lower than an applica-         difference between temperature after DOC and
                              ble environment temperature threshold               before SCR < Threshold 3
                                                                                  difference between temperature after DOC and
                                                                                  ambinet temperature < Threshold 4
                                                                                  differnece between temperatur ambient tem-
                                                                                  perature and engine temperature <
                                                                                  Threshold 5)
                                                                                  Dynamic plausibility check with environment
                                                                                  temperature sensor value:
                                                                                  The exhaust temperature value from the sensor
                                                                                  before DOC is lower than an applicable
                                                                                  environment temperature threshold (< envi-
                                                                                  ronmental temperature + Threshold 6)
 1881    683     4768    2    At engine cold start conditions the sensed          Difference temperature of exhaust gas temper-    Check whether all exhaust gas temperature
                              exhaust gas temperature downstream DOC              ature downstream DOC and fixed                   sensors within the EAT system are
                              (Exh_tSensTOxiCatDs)                                ambient temperature at ignition on exceeds a     mounted properly: Within the exhaust line and
                              has exceeded the sum of ambient tempera-            certain limit earlier than the difference        at correct positions.
                              ture (EnvT_t) + offset (40°C) earlier than the      temperature of exhaust gas temperature           Check the position of the sensor upstream SCR
                              sensed exhaust gas                                  upstream DOC and fixed ambient temperature       which might be physically mounted in
                              temperature upstream of DOC                         at ignition on.                                  the wrong position.
                              (Exh_tSensTOxiCatUs).                                                                                If cold start condition can be made sure (engine
                              The check is only performed once each igni-                                                          was off for at least 8 h) compare
                              tion cycle and only if the start is judged a cold                                                    values of EnvT_t, EngDa_tEng, Exh_TOxiCatUs,
                              start.                                                                                               Exh_tOxiCatDs and
                              Error status is frozen for that ignition cycle.                                                      SCR_tSensUCatUsT at ignition on, without
                              No healing possible.                                                                                 starting the engine. All identical? Then the
                                                                                                                                   sensors itself are okay.
                                                                                                                                   Check exhaust piping for leakage.
                                                                                                                                   Check wiring of sensors
                                                                                                                                   Replace sensors
                                                                                                                                   Check DOC => physicallly intact?
 1044    683     4768    3    Oxidation catalyst upstream temperature             The sensed raw voltage value                     Check wiring harness to temperature sensor
                              sensor: the voltage of sensor measured by           Exh_uRawTOxiCatUs is above                       upstream DOC
                              ECU is out of the target range                      Exh_SRCTOxiCatUs.uMax_C                          Exchange temperature sensor upstream DOC
                                                                                  Shortcut to battery
 1045    683     4768    4    Oxidation catalyst upstream temperature             The sensed raw voltage value                     Check wiring harness to temperature sensor
                              sensor: the voltage of sensor measured by           Exh_uRawTOxiCatUs is                             upstream DOC
                              ECU is out of the target range                      below Exh_SRCTOxiCatUs.uMin_C                    Exchange temperature sensor upstream DOC
                                                                                  Shortcut to ground
3-166                                                                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                                                   SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                 SPN    FMI                   Description                                    Possible Cause                                     Action
 Code    Code
 1024     594    5763    3    Actuator of the external EGR valve: the ECU    Short cut to battery or open loop.             Check cabling, actuator defect, check actuator
                              detects a short circuit to battery or open                                                    and if necessary replace it, check
                              load.                                                                                         connection cable and if necessary repair or
                                                                                                                            replace it.
 1226     594    5763    3    Actuator EGR-valve: short cut to battery is    Short-Circuit to battery on component wiring   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              detected                                                                                      threshold.
                                                                                                                            Check wiring, component, ECU
                                                                                                                            Check repair with SerDia 2010 use case
 1227     594    5763    3    Actuator EGR-valve: short cut to battery on    Short-Circuit to battery on component wiring   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              ECU pin is detected                                                                           threshold.
                                                                                                                            Check wiring, component, ECU
                                                                                                                            Check repair with SerDia 2010 use case
 1025     594    5763    4    Actuator of the external EGR valve: the ECU    Short cut to ground                            Check cabling, actuator defect, check actuator
                              detects a short circuit to ground.                                                            and if necessary replace it, check
                                                                                                                            connection cable and if necessary repair or
                                                                                                                            replace it.
 1228     594    5763    4    Actuator EGR-valve: short cut to ground on     Short-Circuit to ground on component wiring    Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              ECU pin is detected                                                                           threshold.
                                                                                                                            Check wiring, component, ECU
                                                                                                                            Check repair with SerDia 2010 use case
 1229     594    5763    4    Actuator EGR-valve: short cut to battery on    Short-Circuit to ground on component           Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              ECU pin is detected                                                                           threshold.
                                                                                                                            Check wiring, component, ECU
                                                                                                                            Check repair with SerDia 2010 use case
 1232    5-9-4   5763    4    Actuator error EGR-Valve (2.9;3.6) or Throt-   Monitoring for CY146 Under Voltage.            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              tle-Valve (4.1;6.1;7.8); Voltage below                                                        threshold.
                              threshold                                                                                     Check wiring, component
                              3.6) Drosselklappe (4.1;6.1;7.8); Voltage
                              below threshold;
 1023    5-9-4   5763    5    Actuator error EGR-Valve; signal range check Short circuit to ground.                         Check wiring, check cabels and repair or replace
                              low, measured current is below target                                                         if necessary, check actuator with
                                                                                                                            SERDIA 2010 test for EGR and if necessary
                                                                                                                            replace it.
 1014     594    5763    6    Actuator error EGR-Valve.                      Short cut to batterie.                         Check wiring and repair or replace if necessary,
                              Signal range check high.                                                                      check actuator with SERDIA test for
                                                                                                                            EGR and if necessary replace it.
 1022    5-9-4   5763    6    Actuator error EGR-Valve; signal range check Short circuit to battery or open circuit.        Check cabling, actuator defect, check actuator
                              high, measured current by ECU is over target                                                  and if necessary replace it, check
                                                                                                                            connection cable and if necessary repair or
                                                                                                                            replace it.
 1223     594    5763    6    Actuator EGR-Valve: Open load on ECU out-      Open circuit on component wiring               Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              put is detected                                                                               threshold.
                                                                                                                            Check wiring, component, ECU
                                                                                                                            Check repair with SerDia 2010 use case
 1224     594    5763    6    Actuator EGR-valve: too high curent is going Overload on component wiring                     Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                              into the actuator. Output is switched off                                                     threshold.
                                                                                                                            Check wiring, component, ECU
                                                                                                                            Check repair with SerDia 2010 use case
3121171                                                                                                                                                              3-167
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                   Description                                     Possible Cause                                           Action
 Code    Code
 1230    5-9-4   5763      6    Actuator error EGR-valve; Overload by short- Short Circuit over Load                                Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                circuit                                                                                             threshold.
                                                                                                                                    Check wiring, component
 1016    594     5763      7    Actuator position for EGR valve is not plausi- Position error of throttle flap (deviation > 7%). Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                ble, internal error, angular misalignement of                                                    threshold.
                                the flap.                                                                                        Threshold for error detection, deviation from
                                                                                                                                 setpoint > 7%.
                                                                                                                                 Troubleshooting with SERDIA 2010 Use Case
                                                                                                                                 "EGR Diagnostic".
 1231    5-9-4   5763     11    Power stage overtemperature due to high         Temperature dependent Over Current                  Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                current.                                                                                            threshold.
                                                                                                                                    Check wiring, component
 1015    594     520521    5    Actuator error EGR-Valve.                       Short cut to ground.                                Check wiring and repair or replace if necessary,
                                Signal range check low.                                                                             check actuator with SERDIA test for
                                                                                                                                    EGR and if necessary replace it.
  825    253     523009    9    The pressure relief valve (PRV) has reached     Rail pressure has exceeded the trigger thresh-      Replace pressure relief valve (PRV) and reset
                                the number of allowed activations.              old of the pressure limiting valve.                 fault with Serdia.
  833    2-5-3   523009   10    The pressure relief valve (PRV) has reached     Rail pressure has exceeded the trigger thresh-      Replace pressure relief valve (PRV) and reset
                                the allowed opening time.                       old of the pressure limiting valve.                 fault with Serdia.
  171    3-3-3   523212    9    Timeout Error of CAN-Receive-Frame              Timeout Error (Missing CAN Bus message)             Check wiring harness and customer devices
                                ComEngPrt; Engine Protection
  179    527     523240    9    Timeout CAN-message FunModCtl; Func-            Timeout Error (Missing CAN Bus message)             Check CAN Bus cabling (Bus sheduling, polarity,
                                tion Mode Control                                                                                   short circuit, power interrupt), test
                                                                                                                                    protocol of receiver, check CAN functional
                                                                                                                                    range.
  565    151     523350    4    Injector cylinder bank 1: the current drop      Short circuit injection bank 1 (all injectors of this Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                measured by ECU is above the target range       bank can be affected)                                 threshold.
                                                                                                                                      Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                                                                                      repair/replace it.
  566    152     523352    4    Injector cylinder bank 2: the current drop      Short circuit injection bank 2 (all injectors of this Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                measured by ECU is above the target range       bank can be affected)                                 threshold.
                                                                                                                                      Check wiring harness, injectors and if necessary
                                                                                                                                      repair/replace it.
  567    153     523354   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the ECU           Defective powerstage in ECU                         Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                detects an error of its injector high current                                                       threshold.
                                output. Chip of CY33x defect power stage                                                            If error is not removable, change ECU.
                                components
  839    1-4-3   523450    4    Diagnostic fault check for min error of COM     The sensed raw value is less than the threshold. Check cabling, check sensor and if necessary
                                message.                                                                                         replace it,
                                                                                                                                 check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                                 or replace it.
  826    146     523470    2    The pressure relief valve (PRV) has been        Rail pressure has exceeded the trigger thresh-      Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                opened due to excessive pressure.               old of the pressure limiting valve.                 threshold.
                                                                                                                                    Reset the fault and at reappearance check injec-
                                                                                                                                    tion system.
  827    146     523470    2    The pressure relief valve (PRV) has been        Rail pressure has exceeded the trigger thresh-      Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                opened due to excessive pressure.               old of the pressure limiting valve.                 threshold.
                                                                                                                                    Reset the fault and at reappearance check injec-
                                                                                                                                    tion system.
3-168                                                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                                                        SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                    Description                                     Possible Cause                                          Action
 Code    Code
  876     146    523470    7    Rail pressure is out of the expected average      Rail pressure is out of the expected average      (A) Check railpressure relief valve and replace if
                                range.                                            range.                                            necessary.
                                                                                  PRV can not be opened.                            (B) Check high pressure pumps, pressure relief
                                                                                                                                    valve and metering unit.
                                                                                                                                    (C) Change components if necessary
  831     146    523470   11    Rail pressure relief valve can not be opened      Railpressure out of tolerance range (PRV can not Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                due to the railpressure.                          be opened by a pressure peak in this             threshold.
                                                                                  operating point)                                 Check railpressure, check rail pressure sensor for
                                                                                                                                   plausibility, check FCU.
  832     146    523470   11    Rail pressure is out of the expected average Averaged rail pressure is outside the expected         Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                range.                                       tolerance range.                                       threshold.
                                The PRV can not be opened at this operating                                                         Check PRV and replace if necessary.
                                point with a pressure shock.
  828     146    523470   12    Rail pressure relief valve: is open.              Shut Off after PRV Open                           Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                Shutoff conditions.                                                                                 threshold.
                                                                                                                                    Check PRV opening counter and if necessary
                                                                                                                                    replace PRV,
                                                                                                                                    check rail-pressure sensor for plausibility and if
                                                                                                                                    necessary replace it,
                                                                                                                                    check FCU and if necessary replace it.
  829     146    523470   12    Rail pressure relief valve is open.               Warning PRV open                                  Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                Warning conditions.                                                                                 threshold.
                                                                                                                                    Check PRV opening counter and if necessary
                                                                                                                                    replace PRV,
                                                                                                                                    check rail-pressure sensor for plausibility and if
                                                                                                                                    necessary replace it,
                                                                                                                                    check FCU and if necessary replace it.
  830     146    523470   14    Rail pressure relief valve is open. (PRV)         Open PRV                                          Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                                                                                    threshold.
                                                                                                                                    Only after ECU reset.
                                                                                                                                    Check PRV opening counter and if necessary
                                                                                                                                    replace it,
                                                                                                                                    check rail-pressure sensor for plausibility and if
                                                                                                                                    necessary replace it,
                                                                                                                                    check FCU and if necessary replace it.
  980     515    523550   12    Terminal 50 was operated for more than 2          Startinformation to Starter (T50-switch)          Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                minutes. This may happen due to short to          erratic/defect.                                   threshold.
                                battery or wrong usage of Terminal 50.                                                              Check cabling, if sensor not working, check start
                                Starter control is disabled until this error is                                                     switch and if necessary replace it,
                                healed.                                                                                             check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                                                                                    or replace it.
  948     282    523601   13    Internal hardware monitoring: the ECU          Suspected components EDC17cv52                       Check cabling of external components, check
                                detects a deviation of the target range of the Pin A18: DeltaPressVenturi / Position intake         working voltage and if necessary correct
                                power supply voltage of sensor output 3.       throttle flap                                        it,
                                                                               Pin K20: First footpedal                             check connection cable and if necessary repair
                                                                               Pin K21: Air FilterDiffPress                         or replace it,
                                                                               Suspected components EDC17cv54 and cv56              if error is not removable, change ECU.
                                                                               Pin A07: Rail pressure
  644     555    523612    3    supply voltage too high                           not used                                          Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                                                                                    threshold.
3121171                                                                                                                                                                       3-169
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                   Description                                      Possible Cause                                          Action
 Code    Code
  646    555     523612    4    supply voltage too low                            not used                                           Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                                                                                     threshold.
  387    555     523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Injector shut off demand for the ICO coordinator     Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter- System responses:                                    threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem- not                                                     Caution ! Sequence error, check error memory
                                ory                                                                                                  for other errors.
  612    555     523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Plausibility check failed (MoCADC_uNTP_mp is Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter- higher than MoCADC_uNTPMax_C).               threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem-                                                 If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                ory.
  613    555     523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Analysis of test voltage (Value is out of the tar-   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter- get -> ECU internal error)                           threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem-                                                         Check wiring, check connected sensors actua-
                                ory                                                                                                  tors.
                                                                                                                                     If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  614    555     523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Analysis of the ratiometric correction (Value is     Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter- out of the target -> ECU internal error)             threshold.
                                nally;                                                                                               Check wiring, check connected sensors actua-
                                no item will be created in error memory                                                              tors.
                                                                                                                                     If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  615    555     523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Error report due to an error in the plausbility of   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter- Function Coordination(FC) and                        threshold.
                                nally;                                          Monitoring Modul(MM)(ECU internal error)             If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                no item will be created in error memory
  616    555     523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Error report due to an interrupted SPI communi- Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter- cation (ECU internal error)                     threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem-                                                    If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                ory
  617    555     523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        multiple error in complete ROM-test during           Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter- postdrive detected (ECU internal error)              threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem-                                                         If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                ory
  618    555     523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of          Too less bytes received by monitoring memory Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter-   from CPU as response (ECU internal               threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem-      error). Loss of synchronization sending bytes to If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                ory                                               the monitoring memory from CPU
  619    555     523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of          Suspected components:                              Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter-   Injector                                           threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem-      ECU                                                If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                ory                                               wiring harness/connector
  620    555     523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Error trying to set MM Response time (ECU            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter- internal error)                                      threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem-                                                         If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                ory
  621    555     523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Error detected in the internal ECU communica-        Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter- tion, Too many SPI errors during                     threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem- MoCSOP execution                                        If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                ory
3-170                                                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                                                           SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                    Description                                       Possible Cause                                         Action
 Code    Code
  623     555    523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of          Error in the check of the shut-off path test of the Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter-   under voltage detection (ECU internal               threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem-      error). Diagnostic fault check to report the error If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                ory                                               in undervoltage monitoring
  624     555    523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Error in the check of the shut-off path of the        Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter- monitoring module (ECU internal error).               threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem-                                                          If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                ory
  625     555    523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Time out error trying to set or cancelling the        Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter- alarm task (ECU internal error). Failure              threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem- setting the alarm task period                            If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                ory
  627     555    523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of          Error in time monitoring of the shut-off path       Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter-   test (ECU internal error). Diagnostic fault         threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem-      check to report the timeout in the shut             If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                ory                                               off path test
  628     555    523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of          Error in the check of the shut-off path test of the Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter-   over voltage detection (ECU internal                threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem-      error). Diagnostic fault check to report the error If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                ory                                               in overvoltage monitoring
  629     555    523612   12    The two voltage values (ADC_VAL1,                 Defect pedal or wiring                              Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                ADC_VAL2), detected by                                                                                threshold.
                                the accelerator pedal, are not plausible to                                                           Check Pedal, repair or exchange the Pedal.
                                each other.                                                                                           Check wiring.
                                                                                                                                      If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  630     555    523612   12    Impermissible offset between the engine           Calculated engine speed in level 1/2 implausi-      Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                speed of level 2 and level 1                      ble (-> ECU internal error).                        threshold.
                                                                                                                                      If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  631     555    523612   12    Diagnostic fault check to report the plausi-      Implausible injection energizing time for either Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                bility error between level 1 energizing time      PiIx or MI1 or PoIx.                             threshold.
                                and level 2 information                                                                            If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  632     555    523612   12    Error in the plausibility of the start of ener-   Implausible start of energising of either PiIx or   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                gising angles                                     MI1 or PoIx.                                        threshold.
                                                                                                                                      If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  633     555    523612   12    Error in the plausibility of the energising       The energising times of the zero fuel quantity      Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                times of the zero fuel quantity calibration       calibration ZFC is out of the target. (->           threshold.
                                                                                  ECU internal error)                                 If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  634     555    523612   12    Error in the plausibility of PoI2 efficiency.     Error in the plausibility of PoI2 efficiency.       Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                                                                                      threshold.
                                                                                                                                      If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  635     555    523612   12    Error in the PoI2 shut-off.                       Error in the PoI2 shut-off.                         Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                                                                                      threshold.
                                                                                                                                      If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  636     555    523612   12    Error in the plausibility of PoI3 efficiency.     Error in the plausibility of PoI3 efficiency.       Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                                                                                      threshold.
                                                                                                                                      If error is still present, exchange ECU.
3121171                                                                                                                                                                        3-171
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                   Description                                      Possible Cause                                              Action
 Code    Code
  637    555     523612   12    Engine speed: the engine speed calculated        Error in the plausibility of current energising        Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                by ECU is above the target range; the ECU        time with maximum permitted energising                 threshold.
                                activates a system reaction                      time. Diagnostic fault check to report the error       If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                                                                 due to Over
                                                                                 Run
  638    555     523612   12    Error in the plausibility of the wave correc-    Error in the plausibility of the wave correction       Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                tion parts                                       parts                                                  threshold.
                                                                                                                                        If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  639    555     523612   12    Plausibility error of the Rail pressure sensor   In case the gradient of rail pressure is larger than   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                                 the max threshold or lesser than the                   threshold.
                                                                                 min threshold.                                         Check metering unit or cable.
                                                                                 Rail metering unit defect.                             Check Rail pressure. Check the Rail System of
                                                                                 Leakge in the Rail System.                             leakage.
  640    555     523612   12    Error in the torque comparison between per- Error in the torque comparison between the                  Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                missible engine torque and current actual permissible inner engine torque and the                       threshold.
                                torque                                      current plausible actual torque.                            If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  641    555     523612   12    Diagnosis of curr path limitation forced by      The torque comparison is not plausible with the Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                ECU monitoring level 2                           torque monitoring.                              threshold.
                                                                                                                                 If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  642    555     523612   12    Diagnosis of lead path limitation forced by      The setpoint path of the air system is limited by Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                ECU monitoring level 2                           the limitation torque of the functional           threshold.
                                                                                 control unit monitoring.                          If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  643    555     523612   12    Diagnosis of set path limitation forced by       If the quantity setpoint is exceeds the limit of       Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                ECU monitoring level 2.                          the torque function.                                   threshold.
                                                                                                                                        If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  714    555     523612   12    Error report "WDA wire is active" due to a       Error detection by monitoring module                   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                defect query/response communication                                                                     threshold.
                                                                                                                                        Software reset.
  715    555     523612   12    Error report "ABE wire is active" due to         The reason is that a slow dropping of the vehicle Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                undervoltage detection                           electrical system voltage (defective              threshold.
                                                                                 autobattery)                                      Software reset.
                                                                                 should not lead the ECU OCWDA's diagnose to
                                                                                 enter an error in the fault memory due
                                                                                 to an undervoltage
                                                                                 recognition.
  716    555     523612   12    Error report "ABE wire is active" due to over- If the ABE/WDA powerstage shut-off is active             Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                voltage detection                              due to an overvoltage detection.                         threshold.
                                                                                                                                        software reset.
  717    555     523612   12    Error report "ABE/WDA active" due to an          The reason is that a slow dropping of the vehicle Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                unknown reason                                   electrical system voltage (defective              threshold.
                                                                                 autobattery)                                      Software reset.
                                                                                 should not lead the ECU OCWDA's diagnose to
                                                                                 enter an error in the fault memory due
                                                                                 to an undervoltage
                                                                                 recognition.
 1170    555     523612   12    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Error during positive test (ECU internal error).        Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter- Diagnostic fault check to report that the               threshold.
                                nally; no item will be created in error mem- positive test failed                                       Reflash ECU. If error is still activ replace ECU.
                                ory
3-172                                                                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                                                        SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                    Description                                     Possible Cause                                      Action
 Code    Code
 1857     555    523612   12    Fault in the monitoring during the engine         wiring is not according DEUTZ requirements     Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                start. Start requested in level 1, but not        engine start conditions are not observed       threshold.
                                released in level 2 which leads to no fuel        low battery voltage during start               check other active errors and fix them.
                                injection.                                        malfunction of starter                         check all needed engine start conditions, e.g.
                                                                                                                                 neutral switch.
                                                                                                                                 check the engine speed during starting of the
                                                                                                                                 engine. If it's too low, then check the
                                                                                                                                 battery voltage and then check the starter for
                                                                                                                                 malfunction.
  973     555    523612   14    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Visibility of Softwareresets in DSM              Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter-                                                  threshold.
                                nally;
                                no item will be created in error memory.
  974     555    523612   14    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Visibility of Softwareresets in DSM              Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter-                                                  threshold.
                                nally;
                                no item will be created in error memory.
  975     555    523612   14    Internal hardware monitoring: the CPU of        Visibility of SoftwareResets in DSM              Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                the ECU is reset and the cause is logged inter-                                                  threshold.
                                nally;                                                                                           If possible the software update has to be done.
                                no item will be created in error memory                                                          Replace the ECU.
  856     134    523613    0    Rail pressure: the fuel pressure in rail calcu- Pressure governor deviation exceeds the limit-   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                lated by ECU is below the target range which ing value based on the engine speed.                threshold.
                                is dependant on the engine speed.                                                                (A) Check for leakage
                                                                                                                                 (B) Check fuel-primary pressure
                                                                                                                                 (C) Change components, check sensor and if
                                                                                                                                 necessary replace it, check fuel system
                                                                                                                                 and if necessary repair it
  857     134    523613    0    Rail pressure: the fuel pressure in rail calcu- maximum positive deviation of rail pressure      Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                lated by ECU is below the target range which exceeded concerning set flow of fuel.               threshold.
                                is dependant on the engine speed.                                                                (A) Check for leakage
                                                                                                                                 (B) Check fuel-primary pressure
                                                                                                                                 (C) Change components, check sensor and if
                                                                                                                                 necessary replace it, check fuel system
                                                                                                                                 and if necessary repair it
  858     134    523613    0    Rail pressure: the fuel pressure in rail calcu- leakage is detected based on fuel quantity bal- Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                lated by ECU is above the target range which ance.                                              threshold.
                                is dependant on the engine speed.                                                               (A) Check backflow pressure
                                                                                                                                (B) Check Injector function with SerDia
                                                                                                                                (C) Change components (metering unit, injec-
                                                                                                                                tor) if necessary
  859     134    523613    0    Rail pressure: the fuel pressure in rail calcu- Maximum negative rail pressure deviation with Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                lated by ECU is above the target range which metering unit on lower limit is exceeded.        threshold.
                                is dependant on the engine speed.                                                             (A) Check backflow pressure
                                                                                                                              (B) Check Injector function with SerDia
                                                                                                                              (C) Change components (metering unit, injec-
                                                                                                                              tor) if necessary
  862     134    523613    0    Rail pressure: the fuel pressure in rail calcu-   Rail pressure exceeds the limiting value.      (A) Check backflow pressure
                                lated by ECU is above the target range.                                                          (B) Check pressure relief valve and metering
                                                                                                                                 unit.
                                                                                                                                 (C) Change components if necessary
3121171                                                                                                                                                                   3-173
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                    Description                                      Possible Cause                                     Action
 Code    Code
  861    134     523613    1    Rail pressure: the fuel pressure in rail calcu-   Rail pressure falls below the limiting value   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                lated by ECU is below the target range            based on the engine speed.                     threshold.
                                which is dependant on the engine speed.                                                          (A) Check backflow pressure
                                                                                                                                 (B) Check Injector function with SerDia
                                                                                                                                 (C) Change components (metering unit, injec-
                                                                                                                                 tor) if necessary
  864    134     523613    2    Rail pressure metering unit, Setpoint of          Pressure pump delivery quantity in overrun     Threshold for detection is an internal ECU
                                metering unit in overrun mode not plausi-         exceeds the threshold based on the             threshold.
                                ble.                                              pressure.                                      (A) Check backflow pressure
                                                                                                                                 (B) Check pressure relief valve and metering
                                                                                                                                 unit.
                                                                                                                                 (C) Change components if necessary
  594    135     523615    3    Fuel metering unit: the current drain mea-        short circuit to battery high side             Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                sured by ECU is above the target range                                                           threshold.
                                                                                                                                 Check wiring harness and metering unit if nec-
                                                                                                                                 essary repair/replace it.
  596    135     523615    3    Fuel metering unit: the current drain mea-        short circuit to battery low side              Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                sured by ECU is above the target range                                                           threshold.
                                                                                                                                 Check wiring harness and metering unit if nec-
                                                                                                                                 essary repair/replace it.
  595    135     523615    4    Fuel metering unit: the current drain mea-        short circuit to ground high side              Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                sured by ECU is above the target range                                                           threshold.
                                                                                                                                 Check wiring harness and metering unit if nec-
                                                                                                                                 essary repair/replace it.
  597    135     523615    4    Fuel metering unit: the current drain mea-        short circuit to ground low side               Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                sured by ECU is above the target range                                                           threshold.
                                                                                                                                 Check wiring harness and metering unit if nec-
                                                                                                                                 essary repair/replace it.
  592    135     523615    5    Detecting an open load fault in the metering wiring harness defective, cable break               Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                unit                                                                                             threshold.
                                                                                                                                 Check wiring harness and metering unit if nec-
                                                                                                                                 essary repair/replace it.
  593    135     523615   12    powerstage of metering unit is overheated         over temperature                               Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                                                                                                                 threshold.
                                                                                                                                 Check functionality of metering unit and
                                                                                                                                 replace it if needed.
                                                                                                                                 Check temperature of metering unit and
                                                                                                                                 improve the installation in case of overheating.
 1127    665     523632    3    Urea supply module pressure sensor: the           Shortcut to battery                            Check wiring
                                current drain measured by ECU is above the        Broken wiring                                  Check pressure sensor in urea supply module
                                target range                                      Pressure sensor in urea supply module defect
 1128    665     523632    4    Urea supply module pressure sensor: the           Shortcut to ground                             Check wiring
                                current drain measured by ECU is above the        Broken wiring                                  Check pressure sensor in urea supply module
                                target range                                      Pressure sensor in urea supply module defect
                                The sensed raw voltage value
                                SCR_uRawUPmpP is above
                                SCR_SRCUPmpP.uMin_C
 1117    666     523632   11    Urea supply module pump: the current drain When the pump motor does not switch to pump Threshold for error is an internal ECU threshold
                                measured by ECU is above the target range actuation mode after temperature
                                                                           measurement has
                                                                           been carried out.
3-174                                                                                                                                                                 3121171
                                                                                                                     SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                  Description                                    Possible Cause                                           Action
 Code    Code
  122     591    523698   11    Shut off request from supervisory monitor-    Engine Shut Off due to supervisory function          Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                ing function                                                                                       threshold.
                                                                                                                                   Check error memory for additional errorcode to
                                                                                                                                   find root cause.
                                                                                                                                   Depending on additional error follow the docu-
                                                                                                                                   mented "Take action for repair".
 1100     676    523718    3    Urea heater relay: the current drain mea-     Shortcut to battery                                  Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                sured by ECU is above the target range        If this error detected during the heating phase it   threshold
                                                                              is a result error: KWP 1089                          Check wiring
                                                                              Broken wiring, broken relay                          Check SCR main relay
 1101     676    523718    4    Urea heater relay: the current drain mea-     Shortcut to ground                                   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                sured by ECU is above the target range        If this error detected during the heating phase it   threshold
                                                                              is a result error: KWP 1089                          Check wiring
                                                                              Broken wiring, broken relay                          Check SCR main relay
 1098     676    523718    5    Urea heater relay: the current drain mea-     Open load                                            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                sured by ECU is above the target range        If this error detected during the heating phase it   threshold
                                                                              is a result error: KWP 1089                          Test SCR main relay
                                                                              Broken wiring                                        Check cabling, if necessary replace relay.
                                                                              broken relay
 1109     672    523719    4    Urea supply module heater: the current        Shortcut to ground                                   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                drain measured by ECU is above the target     If this error detected during the heating phase it   threshold
                                range                                         is a result error: KWP 1089                          Check wiring
                                                                              Broken wiring                                        Check cabling, if necessary replace supply mod-
                                                                              Heating element in supply module defect              ule
 1106     672    523719    5    Urea supply module heater: the current        Open load                                            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                drain measured by ECU is above the target     If this error detected during the heating phase is   threshold
                                range                                         a result error: KWP 1089                             Check wiring
                                                                              Broken wiring                                        Check cabling, if necessary replace supply mod-
                                                                              Heating element in supply module defect              ule
  925     148    523720    8    Supply module heater: Duration of switch on uty cycle for temperature readout from supply          When the received supply module heater tem-
                                is too long.                                module heater to the control unit is out               perature duty cycle SCR_rSMT is out of
                                                                            of range; Supply modul defect, fault in the wir-       the failurerange (SCR_rSMFailMax_C <
                                                                            ing.                                                   SCR_rSMHtrT < SCR_rSMFailMin_C)
                                                                                                                                   Supply module check and replace if necessary.
                                                                                                                                   Check the wiring.
  926     148    523720    8    Supply module heater: Dutycycle timing        Duty cycle for temperature readout from supply       When the received supply module heater duty
                                over error threshold.                         module heater to the control unit is not             cycle SCR_rSMHtrT is in the valid range
                                                                              valid.                                               (SCR_r-
                                                                              Supply modul defect, fault in the wiring.            Supply module check and replace if necessary.
                                                                                                                                   Check the wiring.
  930     689    523721    8    Supply module heater: Dutycycle timing        Duty cycle for temperature readout from supply Supply module check and replace if necessary.
                                over error threshold.                         module to the control unit is out of           Check the wiring.
                                                                              range.
                                                                              Supply modul defect, fault in the wiring.
3121171                                                                                                                                                                     3-175
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                  Description                                 Possible Cause                                         Action
 Code    Code
  931    689     523721    8    Supply module heater: Dutycycle timing out Duty cycle for temperature readout from supply When the received supply module duty cycle
                                of valid range.                            module to the control unit is not valid.       SCR_rSMT is in the valid range
                                                                           Supply modul defect, fault in the wiring.      (SCR_rSMTVld-Min_C <= SCR_rSMT <=
                                                                                                                          SCR_rSMTVldMax_C), OR in the failure
                                                                                                                          range (SCR_rSMFailMin_C <=SCR_rSMT <=
                                                                                                                          SCR_rSMFailMax_C)
                                                                                                                          Supply module check and replace if necessary.
                                                                                                                          Check wiring.
  927    689     523721   11    Supply module heater: temperature mea-       Duty cycle for temperature readout from supply   Threshold for detection is an internal ECU
                                surement not available.                      module heater to the control unit is not         threshold.
                                                                             available.                                       No erasing in the current driving cycle.
                                                                             Supply modul defect, fault in the wiring.        Supply module check and replace if necessary.
                                                                                                                              Check the wiring.
  929    691     523722    8    Supply module heater: Faulty PWM signal      PWM Signal for temperature readout from sup- Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                from supply module.                          ply module to the control unit is not valid. threshold.
                                                                             Supply modul defect, fault in the wiring.    When valid Sync followed by temperature
                                                                                                                          information signal is received AND valid sync
                                                                                                                          and temperaturesignal for both information is
                                                                                                                          received one after the other.
                                                                                                                          Supply module check and replace if necessary.
                                                                                                                          Check the wiring.
  291    119     523776    9    Timeout Error of CAN-Receive-Frame TSC1TE Timeout Error (Missing CAN Bus message)             Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                - active                                                                                      threshold.
                                                                                                                              Check CAN Bus cabling (Bus sheduling, polarity,
                                                                                                                              short circuit, power interrupt), test
                                                                                                                              protocol of receiver, check CAN functional
                                                                                                                              range.
  292    119     523777    9    Message TSC1-TE has been missing (passive) Passive timeout Error (Missing CAN Bus mes-        Check CAN Bus cabling (Bus scheduling, polar-
                                                                           sage)                                              ity, short circuit, power interrupt), test
                                                                                                                              protocol of receiver, check CAN functional
                                                                                                                              range, check actuator
  559    1-5-8   523895   13    Missing or wrong injector adjustment value Missing or wrong injector adjustment value for Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                programming (IMA) injector 1 (in firing    cyl. 1.                                        threshold.
                                order).                                                                                   Check correct injector adjustment value (IMA).
                                                                                                                          Use SERDIA UseCase to check it.
  560    1-5-8   523896   13    Missing or wrong injector adjustment value Missing or wrong injector adjustment value for Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                programming (IMA) injector 2 (in firing    cyl. 2                                         threshold.
                                order).                                                                                   check dataset and flash correct injector adjuste-
                                                                                                                          ment value (IMA). Use SERDIA
                                                                                                                          UseCase to check it.
  561    1-5-8   523897   13    Missing or wrong injector adjustment value Missing or wrong parametrisation of injector       Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                programming (IMA) injector 3 (in firing    adjustment cyl. 3.                                 threshold.
                                order).                                                                                       Check correct injector adjustment value (IMA).
  562    1-5-8   523898   13    Missing or wrong injector adjustment value Missing or wrong injector adjustment value for Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                programming (IMA) injector 4 (in firing    cyl. 4.                                        threshold.
                                order).                                                                                   Check correct injector adjustment value (IMA).
  563    1-5-8   523899   13    Missing or wrong injector adjustment value Missing or wrong injector adjustment value for Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                programming (IMA) injector 5 (in firing    cyl. 5.                                        threshold.
                                order).                                                                                   Check correct injector adjustment value (IMA).
3-176                                                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                   Description                                       Possible Cause                                         Action
 Code    Code
  564    1-5-8   523900   13    Missing or wrong injector adjustment value Missing or wrong injector adjustment value for Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                programming (IMA) injector 6 (in firing    cyl. 6.                                        threshold.
                                order).                                                                                   Check correct injector adjustment value (IMA).
  73     7-2-2   523912    4    @ engines < 4l:                                    The sensed raw voltage value is below the mini- The sensed raw voltage value
                                Throttle valve error, Open Load or Short cut       mum threshold.                                  DPM_uRawBrnDVDsP is above the minimum
                                to Battery, blocked valve or wrong control                                                         threshold
                                signal for valve.                                                                                  DPM_SRCBrnDVDsP.uMin_C
                                @ engines with Burner T4i:                                                                         @ CRT < 4l: check throttle valve
                                Pressure Sensor error after valve (DV2),                                                           @ engines with Burner T4i: check back-pressure
                                lower limit reached                                                                                valve
  42      167    523924    4    Overload at Pins O_V_RH2x: A01, K74, K91.          Suspected components:                             Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                Components on A01, K74, K91 cannot be              1- Pin K91:                                       threshold.
                                activated.                                         Clutch switch, Brake switch, Engine brake         Check wiring harness and connected loads on
                                Internal ECU power stage switched off.             demand, Regeneration activation, Parking          pins A01, K74, K91 and/or reflash ECU.
                                                                                   brake, Gearbox N, Fan control 1                   If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                                                                   2- Pin K74:
                                                                                   Boost air cooler bypass or electrical fuel pump
                                                                                   relay, Fan control 2/fuel valve for flame
                                                                                   star
  38      731    523925    3    Short circuit to battery error of actuator relay   Suspected Components:                             Check wiring harness and connected loads on
                                2. Components on Pin A88, K57 cannot be            1- Lamps K57: Warn Ash Charge, Diagnostic,        pins A88, K57.
                                activated.                                         Warn Coolant Temp/Level, Warn Oil,
                                Internal ECU power stage switched off.             Warn Boost Air, Warn Air Filter, Warn Water in
                                                                                   Fuel, SCR, Regeneration, Engine
                                                                                   Running.
                                                                                   2- Relay Preheat A88
                                                                                   3- Exhaust Flap A88
  43      731    523925    4    Short circuit to ground actuator relais 3          Suspected components:                             Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                Overload at Pins O_V_RH3x: A88, K57                1- Pin A88:                                       threshold.
                                                                                   Preheat relay, Exhaust flap                       Check wiring harness and connected loads on
                                                                                   2- Pin K 57:                                      pinsA88, K57.
                                                                                   - control lamps:                                  If error is still present, exchange ECU.
                                                                                   - OBD, preheat lamp, warning temp., warning
                                                                                   oil, maintenance lamp, regeneration
                                                                                   indicator, alternator management, engine run-
                                                                                   ning, diagnostic
  44      732    523926    4    Short circuit to ground aktuator relais 4.         Suspected components:Fan, Wiring harness          Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                Overload at Pins O_V_PCV: A90                                                                        threshold.
                                                                                                                                     Check wiring harness and connected loads on
                                                                                                                                     pin A90.
                                                                                                                                     If error is still present, exchange ECU.
  40      733    523927    3    Short circuit to battery error of actuator relay Suspected Components:                               Check wiring harness and connected loads on
                                2. Components on Pin A04, A05 cannot be          1- Urea Pump A04                                    pins A04, A05.
                                activated.                                       2- SCR Heater A05
                                Internal ECU power stage switched off.
  168     763    523935   12    Timeout Error of CAN-Transmit-Frame                Fault is detected if a TimeOut of the EEC3VOL1    Check wiring harness and customer nodes
                                EEC3VOL1; Engine send messages                     frame has occured.
  169     764    523936   12    Timeout Error of CAN-Transmit-Frame                Timeout Error (Missing CAN Bus message)           Check wiring harness and customer nodes
                                EEC3VOL2; Engine send messages
3121171                                                                                                                                                                       3-177
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                  Description                                   Possible Cause                                       Action
 Code    Code
  133    766     523938    9    Timeout Error (BAM to packet) for CAN-        Failure of the CAN Bus message                   NOX sensor and sensor connection check
                                Receive-Frame AT1IGCVol1 information;
                                factors & Sensorcalibration for NOX Sensor
                                (SCR-system upstream cat; DPF-system
                                downstream cat)
  134    766     523939    9    Broadcast Announce Message of the calibra- Defective Nox sensor, faulty parameterization       NOX sensor and sensor connection check
                                tion message
                                of the upstream catalytic NOx sensor has
                                failed.
                                Timeout Error (BAM to BAM) for CAN-
                                Receive-Frame AT1IGCVol1 information.
                                factors & Sensorcalibration for NOX Sensor
                                (SCR-system upstream cat, DPF-system
                                downstream cat).
  135    766     523940    9    Timeout Error (PCK2PCK) for CAN-Receive-      Failure of the CAN Bus message                   NOX sensor and sensor connection check
                                Frame AT1IGCVol1 information; factors &
                                Sensorcalibration for NOX Sensor (SCR-sys-
                                tem upstream cat; DPF-system
                                downstream cat)
  140    767     523941    9    Timeout Error (BAM to packet) for CAN-        Timeout Error (Missing CAN Bus message)          NOX downstream sensor and sensor connection
                                Receive-Frame AT1OGCVol2 information;                                                          check
                                factors & Sensorcalibration for NOX Sensor
                                (SCR-system downstream cat; DPF-system
                                downstream cat)
  141    767     523942    9    Timeout Error (BAM to BAM) for CAN-           Defective Nox sensor, faulty parameterization.   NOX downstream sensor and sensor connection
                                Receive-Frame AT1OGCVol2 information,                                                          check.
                                Calibration message 1 of the after catalyst
                                NOx sensor has failed.
                                Factors & Sensorcalibration for NOX Sensor
                                (SCR-system downstream cat, DPF-system
                                downstream cat)
  142    767     523943    9    Timeout Error (PCK2PCK) for CAN-Receive-      The fault is detected when a timeout error in    NOX downstream sensor and sensor connection
                                Frame AT1OGCVol2 information; factors &       packet 2 of NOxSenVol2Rx frame occurs.           check
                                Sensorcalibration for NOX Sensor (SCR-sys-
                                tem downstream cat; DPF-system
                                downstream cat)
 1011    771     523960    0    Physical range check high for EGR cooler      Sensed temperature downstream EGR-cooler         EGR-Valve blocked open
                                downstream temperature.                       > limit.                                         EGR-Valve actuator defect
                                                                                                                               EGR-cooler defect (check for coolant water)
                                                                                                                               Reed Valve defect
                                                                                                                               Intake throttle blocked in closed position
                                                                                                                               Exhaust pressure too high
                                                                                                                               Check Nox-sensor upstream SCR catalyst
                                                                                                                               dp venturi sensor defect
 1012    771     523960    1    Physical range check low for EGR cooler       sensor voltage > lower limit                     EGR-Valve blocked open
                                downstream temperature.                                                                        EGR-Valve actuator defect
                                                                                                                               EGR-cooler defect (check for coolant water)
                                                                                                                               Reed Valve defect
                                                                                                                               Intake throttle blocked in closed position
                                                                                                                               Exhaust pressure too high
                                                                                                                               Check Nox-sensor upstream SCR catalyst
                                                                                                                               dp venturi sensor defect
3-178                                                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                                                 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                   Description                                 Possible Cause                                         Action
 Code    Code
  360     737    523982    0    Powerstage diagnosis disabled; Indicating    Powerstage diagnostic can be deactivated due    Check wiring, check alternator, check cables and
                                that battery voltage is not high.            to too high battery voltage.                    repair or replace if necessary.
  361     737    523982    1    Powerstage diagnosis disabled; Indicating    Powerstage diagnostic can be deactivated due    Check wiring, check alternator, check cables and
                                that battery voltage is not low.             to too low battery voltage.                     repair or replace if necessary.
 1239     788    523984    3    Actuator relay 5: the voltage measured by    Short-Circuit to battery to component           Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                ECU is out of the target range                                                               threshold.
                                                                                                                             Check wiring, component, ECU
 1241     176    523986    4    Actuator relay 4: the voltage measured by    Short-Circuit to ground to component            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                ECU is out of the target range                                                               threshold.
                                                                                                                             Check wiring, component, ECU
 1242     791    523987    4    Actuator relay 5: the voltage measured by    Short-Circuit to ground to component            Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                ECU is out of the target range                                                               threshold.
                                                                                                                             Check wiring, component, ECU
 1434    8-3-6   524050   11    CAN; not used                                not used                                        not used
 1435    8-3-7   524051   11    CAN; not used                                not used                                        not used
 1505    8-4-3   524057    2    Low fuel pressure: the low fuel pressure cal- Fuel pressure below warning threshold          Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                culated by ECU is underneath the target                                                      threshold.
                                range; the ECU activates a system reaction                                                   Check low fuel pressure system (fuel feed
                                                                                                                             pump, relay , fuse, wiring, sensor) and if
                                                                                                                             necessary repair or replace it.
 1558     869    524063    3    SCR heater mainrelay; short circuit to battery Short-Circuit to battery on wiring to component Check wiring, component
                                Threshold 1 <
                                SCRHtr_rUHtrMeasRatio_mp < Threshold
                                2
 1559     869    524063    4    Connection between heating valve (Y31) on Faulty wiring, faulty heater relay (K27-K31),      Disconnect plug from heating valve (Y31) and
                                the control unit Pin A:92 and              defective heating valve (Y31),                    reset fault.
                                Load side SCR heater main relay (K31) is a broken element in heating.                        If fault is still present you have to look in the wir-
                                short cut to ground.                                                                         ing of Y31 to the control unit Pin A:92.
                                Threshold 1 <                                                                                If error is no longer present, you have to check
                                SCRHtr_rUHtrMeasRatio_mp < Threshold                                                         the wiring of Y31 via relay K31
                                2                                                                                            and possibly the heating cables and relay (K27-
                                                                                                                             K30).
 1555     869    524063    5    Urea backflow line heater: broken wiring     Open Load on wiring to component                Check wiring, component
                                detected
                                Threshold 1 <
                                SCRHtr_rUHtrMeasRatio_mp < Threshold
                                2
 1556     869    524063    5    Urea main relay: broken wiring detected      relay defect                                    Check wiring, component
                                Threshold 1 <                                relay not connected
                                SCRHtr_rUHtrMeasRatio_mp < Threshold         wiring harness broken
                                2                                            problems with supply voltage
 1557     869    524063    5    Urea pressure line heater: broken wiring     Open load on wiring to component                Check wiring, component
                                detected
                                Threshold 1 <
                                SCRHtr_rUHtrMeasRatio_mp < Threshold
                                2
 1560     869    524063    5    SCR relay for suction line not connected     relay defect                                    Check wiring, component
                                Threshold 1 <                                relay not connected
                                SCRHtr_rUHtrMeasRatio_mp < Threshold         wiring harness broken
                                2                                            problems with supply voltage
3121171                                                                                                                                                                   3-179
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                   Description                                    Possible Cause                                        Action
 Code    Code
 1561    869     524063    5    Open load on wiring to component                 Open load on wiring to component                Check wiring, component
                                Threshold 1 <
                                SCRHtr_rUHtrMeasRatio_mp < Threshold
                                2
 1562    869     524063    5    SCR heater tank; open load                       Open load on wiring to component                Check wiring, component
 1646    869     524063   12    SCR supply module temperature is not             Suspected components:                           Check
                                reaching a threshold before a calibratable       Enviroment temperature sensor defect            Environment temperature sensor
                                time is exceeded.                                SCR supply module temperature sensor defect     SCR supply module temperature sensor
                                Corresponding to the environmental Tem-          SCR supply module electrical heater defect      SCR supply module electrical heater
                                perature a specific defrosting time is given.
                                After starting the defrosting a clock counter
                                is starting. Does the counter reach the given
                                defrosting time limit, an error will be
                                detected. Is the temperature reached in time
                                the clock counter will be reset
                                Example: by using the calibrated tempera-
                                ture/time curve --> environmental temper-
                                ature 0°C --> defrosting time limit 6000s --
                                > if the clock counter reaches 6000s the error
                                will
                                be detected
 1565    892     524065    0    The relativ pressure value of the exhaust gas    sensed presure upstream SCR catalyst > physi-   Check for crystallisation in exhaust line
                                from the urea cat upstream                       cal high range limit f(exhaust volume           upstream SCR and dwnstream of urea injector
                                sensor is greater than an applicable maxi-       flow)                                           Check correct connection from exhaust line to
                                mum pressure threshold                           UCatUsP_pRelFlt_mp > UCatUsP_pMax_mp            pressure sensor upstream SCR catalyst:
                                                                                                                                 syphons?, water in tube?, water in sensor?
                                                                                                                                 Check that exhaust pipe outlet is free (down-
                                                                                                                                 stream SCR catalyst)
                                                                                                                                 Check wiring of pressure sensor upstream SCR
                                                                                                                                 catalyst
                                                                                                                                 Check pressure sensor upstream SCR catalyst:
                                                                                                                                 sensor has no connection to vehicle body? =>
                                                                                                                                 Ensure that sensor is free
                                                                                                                                 Does sensor oscillate heavely at engine low idle
                                                                                                                                 / high idle? => try to supress the
                                                                                                                                 oscillating
                                                                                                                                 Exchange pressure sensor upstream SCR cata-
                                                                                                                                 lyst
                                                                                                                                 Check calculated exhaust volume flow of
                                                                                                                                 engine within EDC: SCR_dvolSCRUs
                                                                                                                                 pausible? If not:
                                                                                                                                 Check T sensor upstream SCR catalyst, check
                                                                                                                                 complete engine air path: EGR-Valve,
                                                                                                                                 Intake throttle, turbocharger, piping for leak-
                                                                                                                                 age and function
                                                                                                                                 Check SCR catalyst: Broken? Exchange SCR-Cat-
                                                                                                                                 alyst
3-180                                                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                                                   SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                   Description                                   Possible Cause                                       Action
 Code    Code
 1566     892    524065    1    The relativ pressure value of the exhaust gas   sensed presure upstream SCR catalyst > physi-   Check correct connection from exhaust line to
                                from the urea cat upstream sensor is less       cal high range limit f(exhaust volume           pressure sensor upstream SCR catalyst:
                                than an applicable minimum pressure             flow)                                           leakage?
                                threshold                                       UCatUsP_pRelFlt_mp < UCatUsP_pMin_mp            Check electric connector: 4h pin open / new
                                                                                                                                connector type used? pressure exchange
                                                                                                                                from inside electrical connector with the envi-
                                                                                                                                ronemt possible
                                                                                                                                Check exhaust line: any leakages upstream of
                                                                                                                                SCR catalyst?
                                                                                                                                Check wiring of pressure sensor upstream SCR
                                                                                                                                catalyst
                                                                                                                                Exchange pressure sensor upstream SCR cata-
                                                                                                                                lyst
                                                                                                                                Check calculated exhaust volume flow of
                                                                                                                                engine within EDC: SCR_dvolSCRUs
                                                                                                                                pausible? If not:
                                                                                                                                Check T sensor upstream SCR catalyst, check
                                                                                                                                complete engine air path: EGR-Valve,
                                                                                                                                Intake throttle, turbocharger, piping for leak-
                                                                                                                                age and function
                                                                                                                                Check SCR catalyst: Broken? Exchange SCR-Cat-
                                                                                                                                alyst
 1598     892    524065    2    Comparison of urea cat upstream exhaust         absolut value of difference between sensed      Check electric connector: 4h pin open / new
                                gas- and environment pressure, the differ-      pressure upstream SCR catalyst and              connector type used?
                                ence should not exceed a certain limit          environmental pressure > limit                  pressure exchange from inside electrical con-
                                abs(UCatUsP_pDiffEnvCat_mp) > Thresh-           abs(UCatUsP_pDiffEnvCat_mp) > Threshold         nector with the environemt possible?
                                old                                                                                             water in sensor?
                                                                                                                                sensor frozen?
                                                                                                                                Check wiring of pressure sensor upstream SCR
                                                                                                                                catalyst
                                                                                                                                Exchange pressure sensor upstream SCR cata-
                                                                                                                                lyst
                                                                                                                                Check intake manifold pressure sensor
                                                                                                                                (Air_pCACDs)
                                                                                                                                Check ambient pressure sensor (EnvP_p)
 1569     892    524065    3    voltage of pressure sensor upstream SCR >       voltage of pressure sensor upstream SCR > volt- Check wiring of pressure sensor upstream SCR
                                voltage high limit                              age high limit                                  catalyst
                                                                                                                                Check pressure sensor upstream SCR catalyst
                                                                                                                                Exchange pressure sensor upstream SCR cata-
                                                                                                                                lyst
 1570     892    524065    4    voltage of pressure sensor upstream SCR <       voltage of pressure sensor upstream SCR < volt- Check wiring of pressure sensor upstream SCR
                                voltage low limit                               age low limit                                   catalyst. Check pressure sensor
                                                                                                                                upstream SCR catalyst. Exchange pressure sen-
                                                                                                                                sor upstream SCR catalyst
3121171                                                                                                                                                                3-181
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                  Description                                   Possible Cause                                        Action
 Code    Code
 1581    894     524067    0    Filtered urea supply module heater temper- sensed temperature of supply module heater >         Compare SCR_tSMT with SCR_tSMHtrT. Both
                                ature value is above an applicable maximum physical high range limit                            show the same value?
                                heater temperature threshold of the supply                                                      Check urea tank temperature
                                module                                                                                          (SCR_tAdapUTnkT). Very hot (> 70°C), urea
                                The temperature is read out via the PWM sig-                                                    tank heater
                                nal of the urea pump. That is only possible in                                                  permanet on?
                                status init of the SCR-system short after igni-                                                 Does the pump never stop working? Check wir-
                                tion was switched on. When that state is                                                        ing to supply module
                                left the sensed temperature value is frozen.                                                    Compare SCR_tSMT with SCR_tSMHtrT. Both
                                                                                                                                show different values or urea tank
                                                                                                                                temperature (SCR_tAdapUTnkT) is cold:
                                                                                                                                exchange urea pump unit
                                                                                                                                Supply module heater temperature sensor
                                                                                                                                defect
                                                                                                                                Supply module heater defect
                                                                                                                                Supply module defect
 1585    894     524067    0    Filtered urea supply module temperature         sensed temperature of urea within supply mod-   Compare SCR_tSMT with SCR_tSMHtrT. Both
                                value (SCR_tSMT) is above an applicable         ule > physical high range limit                 show the same value?
                                maximum temperature threshold of the                                                            Check urea tank temperature
                                supply module                                                                                   (SCR_tAdapUTnkT). Very hot (> 70°C), ure tank
                                The temperature is read out via the PWM sig-                                                    heater
                                nal of the urea pump. That is only possible in                                                  permanet on?
                                status init of the SCR-system short after igni-                                                 Does the pump never stop working? Check wir-
                                tion was switched on. When that state is                                                        ing to supply module
                                left the sensed temperature value is frozen.                                                    Compare SCR_tSMT with SCR_tSMHtrT. Both
                                                                                                                                show different values or urea tank
                                                                                                                                temperature (SCR_tAdapUTnkT) is cold:
                                                                                                                                exchange urea pump unit
                                                                                                                                Supply module temperature sensor defect
                                                                                                                                Supply module heater defect
                                                                                                                                Supply module defect
 1582    894     524067    1    Filtered urea supply module heater temper- sensed temperature of supply module heater <         Check ambient temperature EnvT_t < Thresh-
                                ature value is below an applicable minimum threshold                                            old?
                                heater temperature threshold of the supply                                                      Compare SCR_tSMT with SCR_tSMHtrT
                                module                                                                                          Check wiring with regard to supply modul
                                The temperature is read out via the PWM sig-                                                    heater
                                nal of the urea pump. That is only possible in                                                  exchange urea pump unit
                                status init of the SCR-system short after igni-                                                 Supply module heater temperature sensor
                                tion was switched on. When that state is                                                        defect
                                left the sensed temperature value is frozen.                                                    Supply module defect
 1586    894     524067    1    Filtered urea supply module temperature         sensed temperature of urea within supply mod-   Check ambient temperature EnvT_t < thresh-
                                (SCR_tSMT) value is below an applicable         ule < physical low range limit                  old?
                                minimum temperature threshold of the sup-                                                       Compare SCR_tSMT with SCR_tSMHtrT
                                ply module                                                                                      Check wiring with regard to supply modul
                                The temperature is read out via the PWM sig-                                                    heater
                                nal of the urea pump. That is only possible in                                                  exchange urea pump unit
                                status init of the SCR-system short after igni-                                                 Supply module temperature sensor defect
                                tion was switched on. When that state is                                                        Supply module defect
                                left the sensed temperature value is frozen.
3-182                                                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                                                    SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                  Description                                    Possible Cause                                      Action
 Code    Code
 1867     894    524067    2    absolute diference of sensed temperature of   absolute diference of sensed temperature of     Compare SCR_tSMT with SCR_tSMHtrT, EnvT_t
                                supply module heater temperature and          supply module heater temperature and            and CEngTds_t and
                                ambient temperature                           ambient temperature                             SCR_tAdapUTnkT => All identical? If not:
                                UPmpT_tDiffPmpHtrAmb_mp > threshold           UPmpT_tDiffPmpHtrAmb_mp > threshold             Has the machine been brought from cold envi-
                                                                                                                              ronment into a warm one or vice versa
                                                                                                                              without engine running, e.g. at workshop?
                                                                                                                              Environment temperature sensor defect
                                                                                                                              Coolant temperature sensor defect
                                                                                                                              Supply module temperature sensor defect
                                                                                                                              Problem at Supply module unit (broken?) =>
                                                                                                                              exchange supply module
 1868     894    524067    2    absolute diference of sensed temperature of absolute diference of sensed temperature of       Compare SCR_tSMT with SCR_tSMHtrT, EnvT_t
                                supply module temperature and ambient       supply module temperature and ambient             and CEngTds_t and
                                temperature > threshold                     temperature UPmpT_tDiffPmpAmb_mp >                SCR_tAdapUTnkT => All identical? If not:
                                                                            threshold                                         Has the machine been brought from cold envi-
                                                                                                                              ronment into a warm one or vice versa
                                                                                                                              without engine running, e.g. at workshop?
                                                                                                                              Environment temperature sensor defect
                                                                                                                              Coolant temperature sensor defect
                                                                                                                              Supply module temperature sensor defect
                                                                                                                              Problem at Supply module unit (broken?) =>
                                                                                                                              exchange supply module
 1533     246    524074    9    Open load sensor internally at NOx-sensor     Open load sensor internally at NOx-sensor       Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                downstream SCR                                downstream SCR                                  threshold.
                                                                                                                              Check NOx-Sensor downstream SCR catalyst:
                                                                                                                              water inside? Shake out sensor after
                                                                                                                              dismounting. => If water inside, replace sen-
                                                                                                                              sor.
                                                                                                                              Check mounting position of sensor and judge it
                                                                                                                              regarding condense water formation /
                                                                                                                              agglomeration.
                                                                                                                              Check wiring harness
                                                                                                                              Exchange sensor
 1534     247    524075   11    Short circuit sensor internally at NOx-sensor Short circuit sensor internally at NOx-sensor   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                downstream SCR                                downstream SCR                                  threshold.
                                                                                                                              Check NOx-Sensor downstream SCR catalyst:
                                                                                                                              water inside? Shake out sensor after
                                                                                                                              dismounting. => If water inside, replace sen-
                                                                                                                              sor.
                                                                                                                              Check mounting position of sensor and judge it
                                                                                                                              regarding condense water formation /
                                                                                                                              agglomeration? Rearrange if critical and possi-
                                                                                                                              ble
                                                                                                                              Check wiring harness
                                                                                                                              Exchange sensor
3121171                                                                                                                                                               3-183
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                  Description                                    Possible Cause                                      Action
 Code    Code
 1535    248     524076    9    Open line sensor internally at NOx-sensor Open line sensor internally at NOx-sensor           Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                downstream SCR                            downstream SCR                                      threshold.
                                NOx Sensors are CAN Sensors --> no HW Pin                                                     Check NOx-Sensor upstream SCR catalyst:
                                on the ECU                                                                                    water inside? Shake out sensor after
                                                                                                                              dismounting. => If water inside, replace sen-
                                                                                                                              sor.
                                                                                                                              Check mounting position of sensor and judge it
                                                                                                                              regarding condense water formation /
                                                                                                                              agglomeration.
                                                                                                                              Check wiring harness
                                                                                                                              Exchange sensor
 1536    249     524077   11    Short circuit sensor internally at NOx-sensor Short circuit sensor internally at NOx-sensor   Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                downstream SCR                                downstream SCR                                  threshold.
                                NOx Sensors are CAN Sensors --> no HW Pin                                                     Check NOx-Sensor upstream SCR catalyst:
                                on the ECU                                                                                    water inside? Shake out sensor after
                                                                                                                              dismounting. => If water inside, replace sen-
                                                                                                                              sor.
                                                                                                                              Check mounting position of sensor and judge it
                                                                                                                              regarding condense water formation /
                                                                                                                              agglomeration.
                                                                                                                              Check wiring harness
                                                                                                                              Exchange sensor
 1537    255     524078    9    Lambda value of NOx-Sensor downstream sensed lambda value of Nox-sensor down-                 Check whether NOx-sensor downstream SCR
                                SCR is out of range.                    stream SCR catalyst is > physical high limit          catalyst is physically mounted within the
                                When the filtered Lambda concentration  ComRxSCR_rCanLamDs_mp > threshold                     exhaust line
                                value at the sensor                                                                           Check Lambda values of NOx-sensor down-
                                (ComRxSCR_rFltLamDs_mp) is greater than                                                       stream SCR catalystat at idle conditions,
                                the physical range check max. lambda                                                          ComRxSCR_rCanLamDs_mp > threshold?
                                threshold                                                                                     Compare to ComRxSCR_rCanLamUs_mp. Val-
                                                                                                                              ues must be almost identical
                                                                                                                              Check CANBus of NOx-sensor downstream SCR
                                                                                                                              catalyst
                                                                                                                              Check NOx-sensor downstream SCR catalyst
                                                                                                                              wiring
                                                                                                                              Check NOx-sensor downstream SCR catalyst
                                                                                                                              itself
                                                                                                                              Replace NOx-sensor downstream SCR catalyst
3-184                                                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                                                   SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                  Description                                   Possible Cause                                    Action
 Code    Code
 1538     256    524079    9    sensed lambda value of NOx-sensor down-       sensed lambda value of NOx-sensor down-       Compare to ComRxSCR_rCanLamUs_mp.
                                stream SCR catalyst is < physical low limit   stream SCR catalyst is < physical low limit   ComRxSCR_rCanLamDs_mp must be
                                ComRxSCR_rCanLamDs_mp < threshold             ComRxSCR_rCanLamDs_mp < threshold             almost identical!
                                                                                                                            If almost identical,
                                                                                                                            Check air path of engine: EGR-Valve, Intake-
                                                                                                                            Throttle, Turbocharger and Piping each
                                                                                                                            for leakage and correct function
                                                                                                                            Check injection system of engine. Injector
                                                                                                                            stuck?
                                                                                                                            if sensed lambda upstream SCR higher
                                                                                                                            (ComRxSCR_rCanLamUs_mp) : Diesel in
                                                                                                                            Urea-tank?
                                                                                                                            Check CANBus of NOx-sensor downstream SCR
                                                                                                                            catalyst
                                                                                                                            Check NOx-sensor downstream SCR catalyst
                                                                                                                            wiring
                                                                                                                            Check NOx-sensor downstream SCR catalyst
                                                                                                                            itself
                                                                                                                            Replace NOx-sensor downstream SCR catalyst
 1539     257    524080    9    sensed lambda value of Nox-sensor             sensed lambda value of Nox-sensor upstream    Check whether NOx-sensor upstream SCR cata-
                                upstream SCR catalyst is > physical high      SCR catalyst is > physical high limit         lyst is physically mounted within the
                                limit                                         ComRxSCR_rCanLamUs_mp > Threshold             exhaust line
                                ComRxSCR_rCanLamUs_mp > Threshold                                                           Check Lambda values of NOx-sensor upstream
                                                                                                                            SCR catalystat at idle conditions,
                                                                                                                            ComRxSCR_rCanLamUs_mp < Threshold?
                                                                                                                            Compare to ComRxSCR_rCanLamDs_mp. Must
                                                                                                                            be almost identical
                                                                                                                            Check CANBus of NOx-sensor upstream SCR cat-
                                                                                                                            alyst
                                                                                                                            Check NOx-sensor upstream SCR catalyst wiring
                                                                                                                            Check NOx-sensor upstream SCR catalyst itself
                                                                                                                            Replace NOx-sensor upstream SCR catalyst
 1540     258    524081    9    sensed lambda value of Nox-sensor             sensed lambda value of Nox-sensor upstream    Check air path of engine: EGR-Valve, Intake-
                                upstream SCR catalyst is < physical low limit SCR catalyst is < physical low limit          Throttle, Turbocharger and Piping each
                                ComRxSCR_rCanLamUs_mp < Threshold ComRxSCR_rCanLamUs_mp < Threshold                         for leakage and correct function
                                                                                                                            Check injection system of engine. Injector
                                                                                                                            stuck?
                                                                                                                            Check CANBus of NOx-sensor upstream SCR cat-
                                                                                                                            alyst
                                                                                                                            Check NOx-sensor upstream SCR catalyst wiring
                                                                                                                            Check NOx-sensor upstream SCR catalyst itself
                                                                                                                            Replace NOx-sensor upstream SCR catalyst
 1542     261    524083    9    sensed NOx-value of NOx-sensor down-          sensed Nox-value of Nox-sensor downstream     Check CANBus of NOx-sensor downstream SCR
                                stream SCR catalyst < Threshold               SCR catalyst < physical low limit             catalyst
                                                                                                                            Check NOx-sensor downstream SCR catalyst
                                                                                                                            wiring
                                                                                                                            Check NOx-sensor downstream SCR catalyst
                                                                                                                            itself
                                                                                                                            Replace NOx-sensor downstream SCR catalyst
3121171                                                                                                                                                          3-185
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                  Description                                   Possible Cause                                          Action
 Code    Code
 1544    912     524085    9    sensed Nox-value of Nox-sensor upstream       sensed Nox-value of Nox-sensor upstream SCR       Check CANBus of NOx-sensor upstream SCR cat-
                                SCR catalyst < Threshold                      catalyst < physical low limit                     alyst
                                                                                                                                Check NOx-sensor upstream SCR catalyst wiring
                                                                                                                                Check NOx-sensor upstream SCR catalyst itself
                                                                                                                                Replace NOx-sensor upstream SCR catalyst
 1666    924     524100    9    Timeout error of CAN-Transmit-Frame Com- Open load on CANBUS wiring.                            Check wiring, component.
                                DPFHisDat.
 1676    928     524104    9    Timeout error of CAN-Receive-Frame Com-       Time out of Check CANBUS EAT Control Receive      Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                RxDPFCtl. CM1 Module Customer Recieve         Message, PGN65348.                                threshold.
                                Message.                                      The message is not received.                      Check CANBUS EAT Control Receive Message,
                                                                                                                                PGN65348.
                                                                                                                                CM1 Module Customer Recieve Message.
 1672    9-4-2   524118    9    Timeout error of CAN-Receive-Frame            If the frame CM1 message is not transmitted       Check CAN Bus cabling (Bus sheduling, polarity,
                                ComRxCM1                                      successfully                                      short circuit, power interrupt), test
                                                                                                                                protocol of receiver, check CAN functional
                                                                                                                                range.
 1683    9-4-5   524121    9    Timeout error of CAN-Receive-Frame Com-       Timeout Error (Missing CAN Bus message)           Check CAN Bus cabling (Bus sheduling, polarity,
                                RxTrbChActr                                                                                     short circuit, power interrupt), test
                                                                                                                                protocol of receiver, check CAN functional
                                                                                                                                range.
 1687    9-4-9   524125    9    Timeout error of CAN-Receive-Frame Com-       Timeout Error (Missing CAN Bus message)           Check CAN Bus cabling (Bus sheduling, polarity,
                                TxTrbChActr                                                                                     short circuit, power interrupt), test
                                                                                                                                protocol of receiver, check CAN functional
                                                                                                                                range.
 1827    192     524141    7    DEF dosing valve is blocked with crystalized While SCR system is starting up and fter urea      Check electrical connection of urea injector:
                                urea or other deposits.                      pressure reaches 10000 hPa, the DEF                - wiring harness
                                                                             dosing module is tested. Expectation is that       - connector
                                                                             urea pressure drops below 1500 hPa if              Conduct SERDIA use-case "injection test". If it is
                                                                             injector works properly. The test is repeated up   faulty:
                                                                             to 3 times before an error is set.                 - remove urea injector from exhaust line:
                                                                             SCRSysPresMon_stPresDropDet_mp = 0 while           - check for crystallisation direct on injector noz-
                                                                             SCRCo_stStatus_mp = 16.                            zle / plate
                                                                             Suspected component:                               - rinse it thoroughly in water
                                                                             wiring harness                                     - remount urea injector and conduct SERDIA
                                                                             DEF dosing valve                                   use-case "injection test"
                                                                             The error is stored into the EEPROM of the ECU     If the error is still active, then exchange urea
                                                                             and status at ECU shut down is                     injector.
                                                                             regained at ignition on.
 1858    192     524141    7    DEF dosing valve is blocked with crystalized While SCR system is starting up and fter urea      Check electrical connection of urea injector:
                                urea or other deposits.                      pressure reaches 10000 hPa, the DEF                - wiring harness
                                                                             dosing module is tested. Expectation is that       - connector
                                                                             urea pressure drops below 1500 hPa if              Conduct SERDIA use-case "injection test". If it is
                                                                             injector works properly. The test is repeated up   faulty:
                                                                             to 3 times before an error is set.                 - remove urea injector from exhaust line:
                                                                             SCRSysPresMon_stPresDropDet_mp = 0 while           - check for crystallisation direct on injector noz-
                                                                             SCRCo_stStatus_mp = 16.                            zle / plate
                                                                             Suspected component:                               - rinse it thoroughly in water
                                                                             wiring harness                                     - remount urea injector and conduct SERDIA
                                                                             DEF dosing valve                                   use-case "injection test"
                                                                             The error is stored into the EEPROM of the ECU     If the error is still active, then exchange urea
                                                                             and status at ECU shut down is                     injector.
                                                                             regained at ignition on.
3-186                                                                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                                                    SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                  Description                                    Possible Cause                                         Action
 Code    Code
 1639     966    524147   13    No proper urea pressure level could be build   This error shows up, if no proper urea pressure   Make sure that frozen lines, pump or tank can be
                                up within the SCR system state "Fill Lines"    level could be build up within the SCR            excluded!
                                => SCRCo_stStatus_mp = 1 within some           system state "Fill Lines" =>                      Check whether there is urea in the urea tank
                                miuntes                                        SCRCo_stStatus_mp = 1 within some minutes         Check urea lines:
                                                                               Once the urea pump pressure has exceeded the      All lines connected? The right lines connected to
                                                                               threshold the error is declared as                the correct places?
                                                                               okay.                                             Suction line blocked?
                                                                               Suspected components:                             No leakage? Not also urea to the outside but also
                                                                               Suction line blocked                              air into the lines, especially in the
                                                                               PWM Powerstage has a defect and a default         suction line!
                                                                               value which leads not to a rising pressure        Perform service routine "pressure test":
                                                                               Pump Pressure sensor defect                       Does the urea pump work? => check wiring
                                                                               pump filter contains dirty parts                  harness & PWM signal for pump
                                                                               reverting valve continously open                  Does the urea pressure rise?
                                                                                                                                 DFC already healed?
                                                                                                                                 If all unsuccessful so far:
                                                                                                                                 Check urea pressure sensor: At ignition on and
                                                                                                                                 SCR system state = 0 ("Init check"),
                                                                                                                                 SCR_pAbsAdapUPmpP shall be identical to
                                                                                                                                 EnvP_p. Fulfilled: Sensor okay!
                                                                                                                                 Check reverting valve => see
                                                                                                                                 DFC_SCRCoRevVlvBlk
                                                                                                                                 Check pump filter: dirt inside?
                                                                                                                                 Suspected components:
                                                                                                                                 Urea pump broken
                                                                                                                                 Reverting valve continously open
                                                                                                                                 Urea suction line, backflow line broken or con-
                                                                                                                                 nection swapped
                                                                                                                                 PWM Powerstage has a defect
                                                                                                                                 Pump Pressure sensor broken
 1874     971    524152    2    CAN message is not received fora definite    CAN message is not received for a definite time     Check eletrical connection oif urea quality sen-
                                time => error is set. As soon as the message => error is set. As soon as the                     sor
                                is received the error heals.                 message is received the error heals.                Check engine CAN bus
                                                                                                                                 Check urea quality sensor itself
                                                                                                                                 Exchange urea quality sensor
 1875     997    524153    2    CAN message is not reseived for a definite   CAN message is not reseived for a definite time     Check eletrical connection of suction unit sen-
                                time => error is set. As soon as the message => error is set. As soon as the                     sor (combined sensor with tank level and
                                is received the error heals.                 message is received the error heals.                tank temperature)
                                                                                                                                 Check engine CAN bus
                                                                                                                                 Check level sensor itself
                                                                                                                                 Exchange suction unit
 1705     972    524156    9    Timeout error of CAN-Receive-Frame             Timeout Error (Missing CAN Bus message)           Check CAN Bus cabling (Bus sheduling, polarity,
                                ComRxEBC2 from wheel speed sensor.             Defect on wheel speed sensor.                     short circuit, power interrupt), test
                                                                                                                                 protocol of receiver, check CAN functional
                                                                                                                                 range.
                                                                                                                                 Replace the wheel speed sensor.
3121171                                                                                                                                                                   3-187
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                  Description                                     Possible Cause                                        Action
 Code    Code
 1863    995     524177    7    The error shows up, if no proper urea presure   This error shows up, if no proper urea presure   Make sure that DEF lines, pump and tank are not
                                could be build up within the SCR system         could be build up within the SCR system          frozen.
                                state "Fill Lines" => SCRCo_stStatus_mp =       state "Fill Lines" => SCRCo_stStatus_mp = 1.     Check for DEF level in the tank.
                                1.                                              3 cases can lead to the error:                   Check DEF lines:
                                                                                Case A: increasing pressure is detected within   Are all DEF lines connected?
                                                                                15s the check has passed => no error             Is the suction line blocked?
                                                                                Case B: The pressure threshold was not reached   Is ther any leakage? Not only urea to the outside
                                                                                within the 60s but case A was not                but also air into the lines, especially in
                                                                                positiv.                                         the suction line!
                                                                                Case C: The minimum pressure of 3000 hPa was     Perform SERDIA usecase "pressure test":
                                                                                not reached within the 60s.                      Does the DEF pump work? => check wiring har-
                                                                                                                                 ness & PWM signal for pump.
                                                                                                                                 Does the urea pressure increase?
                                                                                                                                 All errors are already healed?
                                                                                                                                 If still unsuccessful so far:
                                                                                                                                 Check urea pressure sensor: At ignition on and
                                                                                                                                 SCR system state = 0 ("Init check"),
                                                                                                                                 SCR_pAbsAdapUPmpP shall be identical to
                                                                                                                                 EnvP_p. Fulfilled: Sensor okay!
                                                                                                                                 Check DEF pump filter: Is any dirt inside?
                                                                                                                                 Suspected components:
                                                                                                                                 Suction line
                                                                                                                                 PWM Powerstage has a defect and a default
                                                                                                                                 value which leads not to a rising pressure
                                                                                                                                 DEF pump pressure sensor defect
                                                                                                                                 DEF pump filter contains dirty parts
3-188                                                                                                                                                                 3121171
                                                                                                                    SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                   Description                                   Possible Cause                                           Action
 Code    Code
 1864     996    524178    7    The urea pump is not able to control the urea The urea pump controller is not able to control     Make sure that DEF lines, pump and tank are not
                                pressure between 9bar and 11 bar.             the urea pressure between 9bar and 11               frozen.
                                                                              bar due to malfunction in the SCR system.           Check for DEF level in the tank
                                                                              Suspected components:                               Check DEF lines:
                                                                              - DEF pump broken                                   All lines connected? The right lines connected to
                                                                              - Reverting valve continously open                  the correct places?
                                                                              - Urea suction line, backflow line broken or con-   Suction line blocked?
                                                                              nection swapped                                     Is there any leakage? Not also urea to the out-
                                                                              - PWM Powerstage has a defect                       side but also air into the lines, especially
                                                                              - Pump Pressure sensor broken                       in the suction line!
                                                                                                                                  Perform SERDIA usecase "pressure test":
                                                                                                                                  Does the DEF pump work properly? => check
                                                                                                                                  wiring harness & PWM signal for pump
                                                                                                                                  Does the DEF pressure rise?
                                                                                                                                  Is the error healed?
                                                                                                                                  If still unsuccessful so far:
                                                                                                                                  - Check DEF pressure sensor: At ignition on and
                                                                                                                                  SCR system state = 0 ("Init check"),
                                                                                                                                  SCR_pAbsAdapUPmpP shall be identical to
                                                                                                                                  EnvP_p. Fulfilled: Sensor okay!
                                                                                                                                  - Check reverting valve
                                                                                                                                  - Check DEF pump filter: dirt inside?
                                                                                                                                  Suspected components:
                                                                                                                                  DEF pump broken
                                                                                                                                  Reverting valve continously open
                                                                                                                                  DEF suction line, backflow line broken or con-
                                                                                                                                  nection swapped
                                                                                                                                  PWM Powerstage has a defect
                                                                                                                                  DEF pump pressure sensor broken
 1891     272    524190   14    Not enough urea in tank or low urea quality Low DEF tank level                                    Check DEF level in tank. If there is no DEF, refill
                                or hardware tampering failure is detected or Low DEF quality                                      up to volume above the warning
                                hardware failure is detected                 Hardware Tampering is active                         threshold.
                                                                             Hardware Failure is active                           Check the DEF quality in the tank. If wrong fluid
                                                                                                                                  is filled, refill with proper DEF.
                                                                                                                                  Check other errors based on hardware malfunc-
                                                                                                                                  tions.
 1892     273    524191   14    A low DEF tank level or a low DEF quality is   Low DEF tank level                                 Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                detected or hardware tampering(system          Low DEF quality                                    threshold.
                                components are pinched off) or hardware        Hardware Tampering is active                       Check the DEF level in tank. If there is no DEF,
                                failures as shortcut to battery, shortcut to   Hardware Failure is active                         refill up above the warning level.
                                ground                                                                                            Check DEF quality filled in the tank.
                                etc. are detected.                                                                                Check other errors based on hardware tamper-
                                                                                                                                  ing or failure.
3121171                                                                                                                                                                     3-189
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                   Description                                  Possible Cause                                        Action
 Code    Code
 1893    275     524193    8    The total time in standstill-regeneration      Stand-still mode is very often aborted by the   Read out stand-still statistics => see service
                                mode exceeds the long-limit threshold          operator.                                       manual:
                                within last 500h total engine run time.        Stand-still mode does not reach required tem-   Stand-still operation finished or often inter-
                                The error is activated if the engine runs to   perature level and regeneration level is        rupted by driver / engine shut-off? => Run
                                many times in Standstill regeneartion.         therefore reached after a short time again      stand-still and instruct operator
                                                                                                                               Stand-still operation required often by soot
                                                                                                                               load => Check dp DPF pressure sensor
                                                                                                                               Stand-still mode does not reach required tem-
                                                                                                                               perature level:
                                                                                                                               Check engine air path: Intake Trottle, EGR-Valve
                                                                                                                               and turbocharger okay?
                                                                                                                               Any leakage in engine air intake sytem or
                                                                                                                               exhaust gas system?
                                                                                                                               Check temperature sensors within exhaust sys-
                                                                                                                               tem: upstream DOC, downstream DOC
                                                                                                                               If soot load level of DPf allow it:
                                                                                                                               Perform Stand-still and check reached temper-
                                                                                                                               ature level upstream and downstream
                                                                                                                               DOC: T upstream DOC in the range of 480-
                                                                                                                               550°C? Downstream DOC after 25 min
                                                                                                                               stand-still main phase 590°C are reached?
                                                                                                                               Temerature traces are steady and even?
                                                                                                                               Temperature downstream DOC higher than
                                                                                                                               upstream DOC but difference does not
                                                                                                                               exceed 100 K?
                                                                                                                               Very small difference (< 10 K after 25 min
                                                                                                                               stand-still main phase, 590 °C downstream
                                                                                                                               DOC are not reached) => exchange DOC
                                                                                                                               Very big difference (>100 K after 25 min stand-
                                                                                                                               still main phase, 590 °C downstream
                                                                                                                               DOC exceeded) => check injection system of
                                                                                                                               engine & engine air path
3-190                                                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                                                      SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN     FMI                  Description                                     Possible Cause                                           Action
 Code    Code
 1894     276    524194    8    The total time in standstill-regeneration      Stand-still mode is aborted / interrupted too        Read out stand-still statistics => see service
                                mode exceeds the long-limit threshold: 2,5h    often by the operator                                manual:
                                stand-still operation within 50h total motor   Stand-still is required too often due to miscalcu-   Stand-still operation finished or often inter-
                                run time.                                      lation in the soot model                             rupted by driver / engine shut-off? => Run
                                The error is activated if the engine runs to   Stand-still mode does not reache temperature         stand-still and instruct operator
                                much time in short Standstill regeneartion.    level and regeneration level is therefore            Stand-still operation required often by soot
                                                                               reached after a short time again.                    load => Check dp DPF pressure sensor
                                                                                                                                    Stand-still mode does not reach required tem-
                                                                                                                                    perature level:
                                                                                                                                    Check engine air path: Intake Trottle, EGR-Valve
                                                                                                                                    and turbocharger okay?
                                                                                                                                    Any leakage in engine air intake sytem or
                                                                                                                                    exhaust gas system?
                                                                                                                                    Check temperature sensors within exhaust sys-
                                                                                                                                    tem: upstream DOC, downstream DOC
                                                                                                                                    If soot load level of DPF allows it:
                                                                                                                                    Perform Stand-still and check reached temper-
                                                                                                                                    ature level upstream and downstream
                                                                                                                                    DOC: T upstream DOC in the range of 480-
                                                                                                                                    550°C? Downstream DOC after 25 min
                                                                                                                                    stand-still main phase 590°C are reached?
                                                                                                                                    Temerature traces are steady and even?
                                                                                                                                    Temperature downstream DOC higher than
                                                                                                                                    upstream DOC but difference does not
                                                                                                                                    exceed 100 K?
                                                                                                                                    Very small difference (< 10 K after 25 min
                                                                                                                                    stand-still main phase, 590 °C downstream
                                                                                                                                    DOC are not reached) => exchange DOC
                                                                                                                                    Very big difference (>100 K after 25 min stand-
                                                                                                                                    still main phase, 590 °C downstream
                                                                                                                                    DOC exceeded) => check injection system of
                                                                                                                                    engine & engine air path
3121171                                                                                                                                                                     3-191
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Deutz   Blink
                  SPN      FMI                   Description                                       Possible Cause                                             Action
 Code    Code
 1900    279     524195    14    The standstill request of detected crystalli-     Back pressure upstream SCR catalyst has               Dismount urea injector from exhaust line and
                                 zation is ignored for more than                   reached a level which indicates                       inspect visually the injector and the
                                 5h(>300min)                                       crystallisation inside of exhaust line.               exhaust line for urea crystallisation upstream of
                                 This will be activated if there is a standstill   The error detection depends on the sensed pres-       SCR catalyst:
                                 request activated by Crystalisation Monitor-      sure upstream of the SCR catalyst and                 If crystallisation can be clearly seen, then stand-
                                 ing.                                              the calculated exhaust volume flow through            still must be processed.
                                                                                   the mixer pipe.                                       Has the engine been operated in low load for
                                                                                   In case of error is set, but no crystallisation can   longer time? If yes, then it could be the
                                                                                   be found in the mixing pipe, a possible               reaoson for crystallisation.
                                                                                   reason can be the defect sensors:                     Does the NOx-Sensors work properly? Compare
                                                                                   - exhaust pressure & temperature upstream of          ComRxSCR_rNOxUs to
                                                                                   the SCR catalyst,                                     ComRxSCR_rNOxDs, when
                                                                                   - the ambient pressure                                ComRxSCR_stNOxRdyUs = 1 &
                                                                                   - the exhaust mass flow => Check air path sys-        ComRxSCR_stNOxRdyDs = 1 (Warm engine
                                                                                   tem at the engine.                                    and EAT-system,
                                                                                                                                         SCRT_tCatAvrgExhGs_mp > 250°C,
                                                                                                                                         SCR_stStatus = "Dosing" = 8): sensed NOx
                                                                                                                                         upstream of SCR catalyst must be higher than
                                                                                                                                         downstream of SCR catalyst.
                                                                                                                                         Go to idle and wait until SCR system enters sta-
                                                                                                                                         tus "stand-by" (no dosing),
                                                                                                                                         SCRT_tCatAvrgExhGs_mp < 225°C:
                                                                                                                                         ComRxSCR_rNOxUs = ComRxSCR_rNOxDs
                                                                                                                                         Clean urea injector: rinse it thourougly under
                                                                                                                                         water
                                                                                                                                         Check EGR-Path: difference pressure sensor at
                                                                                                                                         venturi tube, EGR cooler, EGR-Valve,
                                                                                                                                         Reed-Valve, Intake throttle regarding function
                                                                                                                                         and leakage. Does the EGR-cooler leak
                                                                                                                                         water in the exhaust?
                                                                                                                                         Check air path for leakage
                                                                                                                                         Check turbocharger
                                                                                                                                         No crystallisation can be seen in the mixing
                                                                                                                                         pipe:
                                                                                                                                         Check exhaust pressure sensor upstream of SCR
                                                                                                                                         catalyst (SCR_pSensUCatUsP):
                                                                                                                                         tube, water in sensor?
                                                                                                                                         Check environmental pressure sensor
                                                                                                                                         (EnvP_p): plausible?
                                                                                                                                         Check exhaust temperature sensor upstream of
                                                                                                                                         SCR-catalyst (SCR_tSensUCatUsT):
                                                                                                                                         plausible compared to Exh_tOxiCatUs &
                                                                                                                                         Exh_tOxiCatDs e.g. when engine has idled for
                                                                                                                                         20 minutes?
                                                                                                                                         => Run stand-still to remove crystallisation
                                                                                                                                         and to reset the DFC
 1108    672     5232719    3    Urea supply module heater: the current            Short circuit to battery                              Threshold for error detection is an internal ECU
                                 drain measured by ECU is above the target         If this error detected during the heating phase it    threshold
                                 range                                             is a result error:KWP 1089                            Check wiring
                                                                                   Broken wiring                                         Check cabling, if necessary replace supply mod-
                                                                                   Heating element in supply module defect               ule
3-192                                                                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                                               SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3.32 CAT DGC DIAGNOSTIC SUPPORT AND TROUBLE This section is organized in the following manner:
     CODE DEFINITIONS                                                        1st page of Diagnostic Information for a Given Fault (See Fig-
                                                                             ure 3-93.) then:
 This section defines the diagnostics and recommended trou-
 bleshooting procedures associated with the engine control                   2nd Page of Diagnostic Information for a Given Fault (See Fig-
 module (ECM) on the CAT 3.4 engine.                                         ure 3-94.)
                            External Hardware Input/Output- This identifies the hardware that either sends an input
                            to the ECM or is driven by and ECM output.
                            Check Condition- This defines what condition to troubleshoot the fault condition.
                            Fault Condition(s)- This identifies the condition(s) that set the fault.
                            Corrective Action(s)- This identifies the RECOMMENED corrective action(s) that the
                            ECM is generally programmed to perform. In some instances, the calibration
                            engineer(s) may choose to perform a different action.
                            Emissions or Non-emissions related fault
Text to identify the circuit of interest and its use for control.
3121171                                                                                                                             3-193
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                                Yes
                                                                   Troubleshooting flow
                                                                   chart
                         No
3-194                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                              SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
EGO Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor, typically heated GCP Global Control Platform
EMWT                   Exhaust Manifold Water Temperature               HDGCP                   Heavy-Duty Global Control Platform
                                                                                                (On-Road Heavy-Duty)
EPR                    Electronic Pressure Regulator
                                                                        HEGO                    Heated Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor (same as HO2S)
ERWT                   Exhaust Manifold Riser Temperature
                                                                        HO2S                    Heated Oxygen Sensor (same as HEGO)
ETB                    Electronic Throttle Body
                                                                        IAC                     Idle Air Control
ETC                    Electronic Throttle Control
                                                                        IAT                     Intake Air Temperature
FDR                    Flight Data Recorder
                                                                        ICAV                    Instant Crank Angle Velocity
FMI                    Failure Mode Indicator
                                                                        IVS                     Idle Validation Switch
FO                     Firing Order
                                                                        LDGCP                   Light-Duty Global Control Platform (Industrial, Smart/
LED                    Light Emitting Diode                                                     Logic Coil)
LPG                    Liquefied Propane Gas                            UEGO                    Universal Exhaust Gas Oxygen Sensor
MAP                    Manifold Absolute Pressure                                               (also called wide-range EGO)
MGCP                   Marine Global Control Platform                   VDC                     Voltage, Direct Current
μP                     Microprocessor                                   VR                      Variable Reluctance
Mfg                    Manufacture                                      Vsw                     Switched, Ignition Voltage
MIL                    Malfunction Indicator Lamp                       WGP                     Waste-Gate Pressure
NG                     Natural Gas
OBD                    On-Board Diagnostics
OEM                    Original Equipment Manufacture
PC                     Personal Computer
PCU                    Powertrain Control Unit
PFI                    Port Fuel Injection
PGN                    Parameter Group Number
3121171                                                                                                                                        3-195
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 Diagnostic Trouble Codes                                           Resetting active and previously active DTCs is handled
                                                                    through DM11 and DM3, respectively DM1 and DM2 lamp
 The numeric diagnostic trouble codes assigned to the faults in
                                                                    indicators are assigned to each fault based on the fault.s diag-
 this section are cross-referenced to SAE’s “Recommended
                                                                    nostic action as defined in the calibration. The lamps are
 Practice for Diagnostic Trouble Code Definitions” (SAE J2012).
                                                                    assigned based on the configuration outlined in Table 3-10.
 While these codes are recommended, the manufacturer may
 define their own codes by assigning a new number to the flash
 code in the diagnostic calibration. This will assign both the           Table 3-10. J1939 Diagnostic Lamp Configuration
 DTC as displayed in EDIS as well as the flash code output on
 the MIL output pin. EDIS may be used to connect to the DGC               ECI DIAGNOSTIC ACTION                       J1939 LAMP
 ECM via CAN.
                                                                   MIL                                   MIL
 CAN
                                                                   Soft Warning                          Amber
 The DGC supports SAE J1939 CAN based diagnostic support.
 This includes:                                                    Hard Warning, Low Rev Limit, Shutdown Red Stop
  • DM1: Active Diagnostic Trouble Codes
                                                                   Power Derate 1 & 2                    Protect
  • DM2: Previously Active Diagnostic Trouble Codes
  • DM3: Diagnostic Data Clear/Reset of Previously Active                                                None (use in combination with other
                                                                   Forced Idle
    DTCs                                                                                                 action)
3-196                                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
TAN/WHITE
BLACK/GREEN
3121171                                                                                                                          3-197
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
TAN/WHITE
BLACK/GREEN
  • Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor                                         The Engine Coolant Temperature sensor is a thermistor (tem-
                                                                              perature sensitive resistor) located in the engine coolant.
  • Check Condition-Engine Running
                                                                              Some engines use an ECT sensor that is located in the coolant
  • Fault Condition-CHT/ECT sensor voltage less than the limit                near the thermostat. Some engines use a CHT (Cylinder Head
    defined in the diagnostic calibration                                     Temperature) sensor that is located in the coolant in the cylin-
  • Corrective Action(s)- Sound audible warning or illuminate                 der head. If the engine is equipped with an ECT sensor then
    secondary warning lamp, disable adaptive learn fueling                    the CHT value is estimated. If equipped with a CHT sensor then
    correction during active fault, or any combination thereof                the ECT value is estimated. The ECM provides a voltage divider
    as defined in calibration. Recommend a power derate 1/2                   circuit so that when the coolant is cool, the signal reads higher
    to reduce the possibility of engine damage due to the                     voltage, and lower when warm.
    inability to sense temperature.                                           This fault will set if the signal voltage is less than the limit
  • Non-emissions related fault                                               defined in the diagnostic calibration anytime the engine is
                                                                              running. The limit is generally set to 0.10 VDC. The ECM will
                                                                              use a default value for the CHT/ECT sensor in the event of this
                                                                              fault.
                     . !
/&
                     . "	#$/&
%
                                                            
                         	
    -     
 
                           
 
                          	
	
*
           !
                                                            "	#$	%
                        +
,*                                                    
                                                                    	
                 )
&
                                                                    
                 
                                                                          
                                                           
&
 	&	!
                                                             '(
 
&	 
                                                           )
&"
3-198                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
TAN/WHITE
BLACK/GREEN
  • Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor                                  This fault will set if the signal voltage is higher than the high
                                                                       voltage limit as defined in the diagnostic calibration anytime
  • Check Condition-Engine Running
                                                                       the engine is running. The limit is generally set to 4.90 VDC. In
  • Fault Condition-CHT/ECT sensor voltage higher than the             many cases, this condition is caused by the CHT/ECT sensor
    limit defined in the diagnostic calibration                        being disconnected from the engine harness, an open-circuit
  • Corrective Action(s)- Sound audible warning or illuminate          or short-to-power of the CHT/ECT circuit in the wire harness,
    secondary warning lamp, disable adaptive learn fueling             or a failure of the sensor. The ECM will use a default value for
    correction during active fault, or any combination thereof         the CHT/ECT sensor in the event of this fault.
    as defined in calibration. Recommend a power derate 1/2
    to reduce the possibility of engine damage due to the
    inability to sense temperature.
  • Non-emissions related fault
 The Engine Coolant Temperature sensor is a thermistor (tem-
 perature sensitive resistor) located in the engine coolant.
 Some engines use an ECT sensor that is located in the coolant
 near the thermostat. Some engines use a CHT (Cylinder Head
 Temperature) sensor that is located in the coolant in the cylin-
 der head. If the engine is equipped with an ECT sensor then
 the CHT value is estimated. If equipped with a CHT sensor then
 the ECT value is estimated. The ECM provides a voltage divider
 circuit so that when the coolant is cool, the signal reads higher
 voltage, and lower when warm.
3121171                                                                                                                         3-199
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-200                              3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
4 PINK/WHITE
3 TAN/ORANGE
5 GREEN/RED
1 PURPLE/BLUE
2 BLACK/GREEN
  • Throttle Position Sensor 1                                           condition while the engine is cranking or running. The limit is
                                                                         generally set to 4.90 VDC. In many cases, this condition is
  • Check Condition-Key On, Engine Off
                                                                         caused by the TPS sensor being disconnected from the engine
  • Fault Condition-TPS1 sensor voltage lower than the limit             harness, an open-circuit or short-to-ground of the TPS circuit
    defined in the diagnostic calibration                                in the wire harness, or a failure of the sensor. This fault should
  • Corrective Action(s): Sound audible warning or illuminate            be configured to trigger an engine shutdown and the engine
    secondary warning lamp, shutdown engine                              will not start with this fault active.
3121171                                                                                                                            3-201
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-202                              3121171
                                                                                            SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
4 PINK/WHITE
3 TAN/ORANGE
5 GREEN/RED
1 PURPLE/BLUE
2 BLACK/GREEN
  • Throttle Position Sensor 1                                           There are two types of throttle actuators, 1) actuator with ana-
                                                                         log position feedback and 2) actuator with digital position
  • Check Condition-Key On, Engine Off
                                                                         feedback. The first type, with analog position feedback, pro-
  • Fault Condition-TPS1 sensor voltage higher than the limit            vides an analog return signal between 0 and 5 volts that is pro-
    defined in the diagnostic calibration                                portional to the throttle actuator position. The second type,
  • Corrective Action(s): Sound audible warning or illuminate            with digital position feedback, provides a serial data signal to
    secondary warning lamp, shutdown engine                              the ECM with the throttle actuator position voltage level
                                                                         encoded in the data stream.
  • Non-emissions related fault
                                                                         This fault will set if TPS1 voltage is higher than the limit set in
 In the case of a diesel engine, an actuator controls a fuel injec-      the diagnostic calibration at any operating condition while the
 tion pump, directly affecting the fueling level into the cylin-         engine is cranking or running. The limit is generally set to 4.90
 ders. This may be by direct manipulation of the fuel injection          VDC. In many cases, this condition is caused by a short-to-
 pump rack or by manipulation of the mechanical governor                 power of the TPS circuit in the wire harness or a failure of the
 control level or “throttle arm.” In the DGC ECM and EDIS, refer-        sensor. This fault should be configured to trigger an engine
 ences to the throttle and throttle position sensor refer to these       shutdown and the engine will not start with this fault active.
 fuel injection pump control actuators and their position feed-
 back sensors. When the fuel injection pump is electronically
 controlled it can be used to control the idle stability and limit
 engine speed based on operating conditions.
 The Throttle Position Sensor uses either;
 1) a variable resistor and voltage divider circuit or
 2) a non-contact hall-effect sensor to determine throttle actu-
 ator position, and is located within the throttle actuator.
3121171                                                                                                                             3-203
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-204                              3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
TAN/WHITE
BLACK/GREEN
3121171                                                                                                                         3-205
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
4 PINK/WHITE
3 TAN/ORANGE
5 GREEN/RED
1 PURPLE/BLUE
2 BLACK/GREEN
3-206                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                             SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
2 WHITE/PURPLE PURPLE/WHITE
                                                                                            WHITE/PURPLE
                                                               1 PURPLE/WHITE
  • Crankshaft Position sensor                                             The ECM must see a valid crankshaft position signal while run-
                                                                           ning. If no signal is present, the signal amplitude is too high
  • Check Condition- Key On, Engine On
                                                                           (due to improper air gap with respect to trigger wheel), or an
  • Fault Condition- Electrical noise or irregular crank pattern           irregular crank pattern is detected causing the ECM to resyn-
    detected causing x number of crank resynchronization                   chronize x times for y ms or longer as defined in the diagnostic
    events as defined in the diagnostic calibration                        calibration, this fault will set. Irregular crank patterns can be
  • Corrective Action(s)- Illuminate MIL and/or sound audible              detected by the ECM due to electrical noise, poor machining
    warning or illuminate secondary warning lamp and disable               of trigger wheel, or trigger wheel runout and/or gear lash.
    adaptive fueling correction for remainder of key-cycle.                Ensure crank circuit used with VR/magnetic pick-up sensors
  • Emissions related fault                                                are properly twisted.
3121171                                                                                                                             3-207
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
                      No                                            Yes
                                                                                                                                No
                                                                                                    Is the wiring OK?                 Repair wireharness
          Intermittent fault
                                                                                                               Yes
           Faulty wireharness              No          Is wiring between sensor
           (twist circuit)                            and ECM properly twisted?
                                                                                             • Poor system ground
                                                                                             • Bad crankshaft position sensor
                                                                                             • Bad ECM
                                                                    Yes
                                           Yes
    Increase the air gap between                       Does fault only occur at
    sensor and trigger wheel                           high operating speeds?
No
                                                 No
                Repair wireharness                        Is the wiring OK?
Yes
3-208                                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                             SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
2 WHITE/PURPLE PURPLE/WHITE
                                                                                            WHITE/PURPLE
                                                               1 PURPLE/WHITE
  • Crankshaft Position sensor                                             The ECM must see a valid crankshaft position signal while run-
                                                                           ning. If no signal is present while x cam pulses continue the
  • Check Condition- Key On, Engine On
                                                                           fault will set. The engine typically stalls or dies as a result of
  • Fault Condition- Loss of crankshaft position signal while              this fault condition due to the lack of crankshaft speed input
    valid camshaft position signals continue for x number of               resulting in the inability to control ignition timing.
    cam pulses as defined in the diagnostic calibration
                                                                           DTC 337- Loss of Crank Input Signal (continued)
  • Corrective Action(s)- Illuminate MIL and/or sound audible
    warning or illuminate secondary warning lamp                           Diagnostic Aids
  • Emissions related fault                                                 • Check that crankshaft position sensor is securely con-
                                                                              nected to harness
 The crankshaft position sensor is a magnetic sensor (variable
 reluctant/magnetic pick-up or hall effect) installed in the                • Check that crankshaft position sensor is securely installed
 engine block adjacent to a “coded trigger wheel located on                   into engine block
 the crankshaft. The sensor-trigger wheel combination is used               • Check crankshaft position sensor circuit wiring for open cir-
 to determine crankshaft position (with respect to TDC cylinder               cuit
 #1 compression) and the rotational engine speed. Determina-
 tion of the crankshaft position and speed is necessary to prop-
 erly activate the ignition, fuel injection, and throttle governing
 systems for precise engine control.
3121171                                                                                                                              3-209
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 DTC 521- Oil Pressure Sender/Switch High                                      The ECM can be configured to monitor oil pressure through a
                                                                               proportional transducer or through a switch. Oil pressure
 Pressure                                                                      monitoring is important to prevent engine damage due to low
                                                                               oil pressure resulting in higher friction and lack of lubrication.
                                        19                                     In addition, high oil pressure can be undesirable because it
                                         BLACK/GREEN                           can cause oil to leak past seals and rings, can be a result of a
             2          1      BLUE                                            restriction in the oil flow path, or can be a sign of a malfunc-
                                                                               tioning oiling system.
                                                                               Additionally for normally-open type oil pressure switches, a
                                                                               high pressure indication while the engine is off is a symptom
                                                                               of a failed oil pressure switch. The ECM can monitor oil pres-
  • Engine Oil Pressure                                                        sure indication when the engine is stopped for this failure
                                                                               mode.
  • Check Condition- Key on, Engine on (or Engine off )
  • Fault Condition- For sender types, oil pressure higher than                For sender types, this fault sets if the engine oil pressure is
    x psia while engine speed is greater that y RPM. For switch                higher than x psia and engine speed greater than y RPM as
    types, oil pressure is indicating high when the engine has                 defined in the diagnostic calibration. For switch types, this
    been stopped for more than n seconds.                                      fault sets if the engine oil pressure is indicating high when the
                                                                               engine is stopped for more than n seconds. Recommend a
  • Corrective Action(s)- Illuminate MIL and/or sound audible                  power derate and/or low rev limit to help prevent possible
    warning or illuminate secondary warning lamp, possibly                     engine damage and reduce oil pressure.
    configure for power derate 1 or low rev limit
  • Non-emissions related fault
                                            • Key Off
                                No          • Disconnect harness from Oil Pressure switch
         Does DTC 524                       • Check continuity through switch to ground.
            reset ?
Yes
Intermittent Problem
Yes
3-210                                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                        SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
 DTC 524- Oil Pressure Low                                            For systems that use a transducer, this fault sets if the engine
                                                                      oil pressure is less than x psia and engine speed is greater than
                                                                      y RPM after the engine has been running for z seconds as
                                          19
                                                                      defined in the diagnostic calibration. For systems that use a
                                           BLACK/GREEN
          2      1        BLUE                                        switch this fault can be configured two different ways. It may
                                                                      use a normally closed switch or a normally open switch. If the
                                                                      switch is normally open, the fault will set if the circuit becomes
                                                                      grounded. If the switch is normally closed, the fault will set if
                                                                      the circuit becomes open. Go to the Faults page in EDIS to
                                                                      determine how the input is configured. (“Open=OK” is nor-
                                                                      mally open and “Ground=OK” is normally closed). The engine
  • Engine Oil Pressure
                                                                      will should be configured to derate or force idle and/or shut
  • Check Condition- Key on, Engine on                                down in the event of this fault to help prevent possible dam-
  • Fault Condition- Engine oil pressure lower than expected          age.
    while engine has been running for a minimum amount of
    time while engine speed is above some limit as defined in
    the diagnostic calibration
  • Corrective Action(s)- Illuminate MIL and/or sound audible
    warning or illuminate secondary warning lamp, generally
    configured to derate the engine and trigger an engine
    shutdown
  • Non-emissions related fault
 The ECM can be configured to monitor oil pressure through a
 proportional transducer or through a switch. Oil pressure
 monitoring is important to prevent engine damage due to low
 oil pressure resulting in higher friction and lack of lubrication.
 In addition, high oil pressure can be undesirable because it
 can cause oil to leak past seals and rings, can be a result of a
 restriction in the oil flow path, or can be a sign of a malfunc-
 tioning oiling system.
3121171                                                                                                                         3-211
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
    • Key-On, Engine On
    • System Mode= “Running”
                                     • Key Off
                                     • Disconnect harness from Oil Pressure switch
                                     • Jumper Oil Pressure signal wire to ground
  • Warm engine at idle to normal    • Clear DTC 524
    operating temperature            • Key On, Engine On
  • Increase RPM above limit set     • System Mode= “Running”
    in diagnostic calibration        • Operate engine et idle for at least one minute
                                     • Increase RPM above limit set in diagnostic calibration
No
                                                                                                              • Faulty harness
                                                                                                                (open circuit)
3-212                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
BLACK
RED/TAN
  • System voltage to ECM                                            The battery voltage powers the ECM and must be within limits
                                                                     to correctly operate throttle actuator, power supplies, and
  • Check Condition- Key on, Engine on
                                                                     other powered devices that the ECM controls.
  • Fault Condition- Battery voltage to ECM less than x volts        This fault will set if the ECM detects system voltage less than x
    while the engine is operating at y RPM or greater as             volts while the engine is operating at y RPM as defined in the
    defined in the diagnostic calibration                            diagnostic calibration as the alternator should be charging the
  • Corrective Action(s)- Illuminate MIL and/or sound audible        system.
    warning or illuminate secondary warning lamp, disable
    adaptive fueling correction for remainder of key cycle
  • Non-emissions related fault.
3121171                                                                                                                       3-213
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-214                              3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
BLACK
RED/TAN
  • System voltage to ECM                                               The battery voltage powers the ECM and must be within limits
                                                                        to correctly operate throttle actuator, power supplies, and
  • Check Condition- Key on, Engine Cranking or Running
                                                                        other powered devices that the ECM controls.
  • Fault Condition- Battery voltage to ECM greater than x
    volts while the engine is running as defined in the diagnos-        This fault will set if the ECM detects system voltage greater
    tic calibration                                                     than x volts while the engine is running or cranking as defined
                                                                        in the diagnostic calibration.
  • Corrective Action(s)- Illuminate MIL and/or sound audible
    warning or illuminate secondary warning lamp, disable
    adaptive fueling correction for remainder of key cycle
  • Non-emissions related fault.
3121171                                                                                                                         3-215
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-216                              3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
ECM
Microprocessor
RAM
  • Engine Control Module- Flash Memory                            The ECM has checks that must be satisfied each time an
                                                                   instruction is executed. Several different things can happen
  • Check Condition- Key on
                                                                   within the microprocessor that will cause this fault.
  • Fault Condition- Internal microprocessor error
                                                                   If this fault sets, the ECM will reset itself and log the code. The
  • Corrective Action(s)- Illuminate MIL and/or sound audible      fault should be configured to never forget and will not self-
    warning or illuminate secondary warning lamp, disable          erase and will not clear until a technician performs diagnostics
    adaptive fueling correction for remainder of key cycle, rec-   and manually clears the code. This fault should be configured
    ommend power derate 2 and low rev limit to reduce possi-       to set a power derate 2 and low rev limit to reduce possible
    ble engine damage and/or overspeed condition                   engine damage and reduce possibility of an overspeed condi-
  • Non-emissions related fault                                    tion. A fault of flash memory can occur for any calibration vari-
                                                                   able set and thus could cause undesirable operation.
3121171                                                                                                                       3-217
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-218                              3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
ECM
Microprocessor
RAM
  • Engine Control Module- Random Access Memory                     This fault will set if the ECM detects a problem accessing or
                                                                    writing information to RAM and should be configured to set a
  • Check Condition- Key on
                                                                    power derate 2 and low rev limit to reduce possible engine
  • Fault Condition- Internal ECM microprocessor memory             damage and reduce possibility of an overspeed condition. If
    access failure                                                  this fault sets, the ECM will reset itself and log the code. This
  • Corrective Action(s)- Illuminate MIL and/or sound audible       fault should be erased by a technician after diagnostics are
    warning or illuminate secondary warning lamp, disable           performed. The fault should be configured to never forget and
    adaptive fueling correction for remainder of key cycle, rec-    will not self-erase.
    ommend power derate 2 and low rev limit to reduce possi-
    ble engine damage and/or overspeed condition
  • Non-emissions related fault
 Random Access Memory is located within the microprocessor
 and can be read from or written to at any time. Data stored in
 RAM include DTCs (when fault configuration is set to “Battery
 Power Retained”), adaptive fuel learn tables, octane adapta-
 tion table, misfire adaption tables, and closed loop fuel multi-
 pliers. The ECM has checks that must be satisfied each time an
 instruction is executed.
3121171                                                                                                                      3-219
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-220                              3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
ECM
Microprocessor
RAM
  • Engine Control Module                                          The ECM has checks that must be satisfied each time an
                                                                   instruction is executed. Several different things can happen
  • Check Condition- Key on
                                                                   within the microprocessor that will cause this fault.
  • Fault Condition- Internal microprocessor error
                                                                   If this fault sets, the ECM will reset itself and log the code. The
  • Corrective Action(s) - Illuminate MIL and/or sound audible     fault should be configured to never forget and will not self-
    warning or illuminate secondary warning lamp, disable          erase and will not clear until a technician performs diagnostics
    adaptive fueling correction for remainder of key cycle, rec-   and manually clears the code. This fault should be configured
    ommend power derate 2 and low rev limit to reduce possi-       to set a power derate 2 and low rev limit to reduce possible
    ble engine damage and/or overspeed condition                   engine damage and reduce possibility of an overspeed condi-
  • Non-emissions related fault                                    tion.
3121171                                                                                                                       3-221
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-222                              3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
4 PINK/WHITE
3 TAN/ORANGE
5 GREEN/RED
1 PURPLE/BLUE
2 BLACK/GREEN
3121171                                                                                                                        3-223
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
4 PINK/WHITE
3 TAN/ORANGE
5 GREEN/RED
1 PURPLE/BLUE
2 BLACK/GREEN
3-224                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                  SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
ECM
Microprocessor
RAM
  • Engine Control Module                                      The ECM has checks that must be satisfied each time an
                                                               instruction is executed. Several different things can happen
  • Check Condition- Key on
                                                               within the microprocessor that will cause this fault. The ECM
  • Fault Condition- Internal microprocessor error             will reset itself in the event this fault is set, and the MIL will be
  • MIL- On until code is cleared by technician                on until the code is cleared. This fault should be erased after
                                                               diagnosis by removing battery power. It will not self-erase.
  • Adaptive- Disabled for the remainder of the key-on cycle
                                                               During this active fault, Power Derate (level 2) will be enforced.
  • Closed Loop- Enabled                                       When this is enforced, maximum throttle position will be 20%.
  • Power Derate (level 2 until fault is cleared manually)     This is enforced until the fault is manually cleared.
3121171                                                                                                                     3-225
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
ECM
Microprocessor
RAM
  • Engine Control Module                                      The ECM has checks that must be satisfied each time an
                                                               instruction is executed. Several different things can happen
  • Check Condition- Key on
                                                               within the microprocessor that will cause this fault. The ECM
  • Fault Condition- Internal microprocessor error             will reset itself in the event this fault is set, and the MIL will be
  • MIL- On until code is cleared by technician                on until the code is cleared. This fault should be erased after
                                                               diagnosis by removing battery power. It will not self-erase.
  • Adaptive- Disabled for the remainder of the key-on cycle
                                                               During this active fault, Power Derate (level 2) will be enforced.
  • Closed Loop- Enabled                                       When this is enforced, maximum throttle position will be 20%.
  • Power Derate (level 2 until fault is cleared manually)     This is enforced until the fault is manually cleared.
3-226                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                             SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
No
No
Fault is intermittent
                                       Repair wiring to
                                       ECM and retest
3121171                                                                                    3-227
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
ECM
Microprocessor
RAM
  • Engine Control Module                                      The ECM has checks that must be satisfied each time an
                                                               instruction is executed. Several different things can happen
  • Check Condition- Key on
                                                               within the microprocessor that will cause this fault. The ECM
  • Fault Condition- Internal microprocessor error             will reset itself in the event this fault is set, and the MIL will be
  • MIL- On until code is cleared by technician                on until the code is cleared. This fault should be erased after
                                                               diagnosis by removing battery power. It will not self-erase.
  • Adaptive- Disabled for the remainder of the key-on cycle
                                                               During this active fault, Power Derate (level 2) will be enforced.
  • Closed Loop- Enabled                                       When this is enforced, maximum throttle position will be 20%.
  • Power Derate (level 2 until fault is cleared manually)     This is enforced until the fault is manually cleared.
3-228                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Yes
No
No
Fault is intermittent
                                              Repair wiring to
                                              ECM and retest
3121171                                                                                                3-229
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
ECM
Microprocessor
RAM
  • Engine Control Module                                      The ECM has checks that must be satisfied each time an
                                                               instruction is executed. Several different things can happen
  • Check Condition- Key on
                                                               within the microprocessor that will cause this fault. The ECM
  • Fault Condition- Internal microprocessor error             will reset itself in the event this fault is set, and the MIL will be
  • MIL- On until code is cleared by technician                on until the code is cleared. This fault should be erased after
                                                               diagnosis by removing battery power. It will not self-erase.
  • Adaptive- Disabled for the remainder of the key-on cycle
                                                               During this active fault, Power Derate (level 2) will be enforced.
  • Closed Loop- Enabled                                       When this is enforced, maximum throttle position will be 20%.
  • Power Derate (level 2 until fault is cleared manually)     This is enforced until the fault is manually cleared.
3-230                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                         SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Yes
                       No
                                                        No
Fault is intermittent
                                             Repair wiring to
                                             ECM and retest
3121171                                                                                              3-231
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
ECM
Microprocessor
RAM
  • Engine Control Module                                      The ECM has checks that must be satisfied each time an
                                                               instruction is executed. Several different things can happen
  • Check Condition- Key on
                                                               within the microprocessor that will cause this fault. The ECM
  • Fault Condition- Internal microprocessor error             will reset itself in the event this fault is set, and the MIL will be
  • MIL- On until code is cleared by technician                on until the code is cleared. This fault should be erased after
                                                               diagnosis by removing battery power. It will not self-erase.
  • Adaptive- Disabled for the remainder of the key-on cycle
                                                               During this active fault, Power Derate (level 2) will be enforced.
  • Closed Loop- Enabled                                       When this is enforced, maximum throttle position will be 20%.
  • Power Derate (level 2 until fault is cleared manually)     This is enforced until the fault is manually cleared.
3-232                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                          SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
Yes
                        No
                                                        No
Fault is intermittent
                                              Repair wiring to
                                              ECM and retest
3121171                                                                                                3-233
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
BLUE/RED or PINK
BLUE/WHITE
3-234                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
BLUE/RED or PINK
BLUE/WHITE
3121171                                                                                                                       3-235
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
BLUE/RED or PINK
BLUE/WHITE
3-236                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                  SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
BLUE/RED or PINK
BLUE/WHITE
3121171                                                                                                                 3-237
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-238                              3121171
                                                                                     SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
BLUE/RED or PINK
BLUE/WHITE
3121171                                                                                                                      3-239
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
4 PINK/WHITE
3 TAN/ORANGE
5 GREEN/RED
1 PURPLE/BLUE
2 BLACK/GREEN
3-240                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                            SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
4 PINK/WHITE
3 TAN/ORANGE
5 GREEN/RED
1 PURPLE/BLUE
2 BLACK/GREEN
  • Throttle Position Sensor                                              The Throttle Position Sensor uses either 1) a variable resistor
                                                                          and voltage divider circuit or 2) a non-contact hall-effect sen-
  • Check Condition-Cranking or Running
                                                                          sor to determine throttle actuator position, and is located
  • Fault Condition-Throttle command is 20% less than throttle            within the throttle actuator.
    position for 200ms or longer
                                                                          There are two types of throttle actuators, 1) actuator with ana-
  • MIL-On during active fault                                            log position feedback and 2) actuator with digital position
  • Engine Shut Down                                                      feedback. The first type, with analog position feedback, pro-
                                                                          vides an analog return signal between 0 and 5 volts that is pro-
 In the case of a diesel engine, an actuator controls a fuel injec-       portional to the throttle actuator position. The second type,
 tion pump, directly affecting the fueling level into the cylin-          with digital position feedback, provides a serial data signal to
 ders. This may be by direct manipulation of the fuel injection           the ECM with the throttle actuator position voltage level
 pump rack or by manipulation of the mechanical governor                  encoded in the data stream.
 control level or “throttle arm.” In the DGC ECM and EDIS, refer-
 ences to the throttle and throttle position sensor refer to these        This fault will set if the throttle command is 20% less than the
 fuel injection pump control actuators and their position feed-           actual throttle position. During this active fault the MIL light
 back sensors. When the fuel injection pump is electronically             will be on and the engine will shut down.
 controlled it can be used to control the idle stability and limit
 engine speed based on operating conditions.
3121171                                                                                                                           3-241
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-242                              3121171
                                                                                            SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
4 PINK/WHITE
3 TAN/ORANGE
5 GREEN/RED
1 PURPLE/BLUE
2 BLACK/GREEN
  • Throttle Position Sensor                                              The Throttle Position Sensor uses either 1) a variable resistor
                                                                          and voltage divider circuit or 2) a non-contact hall-effect sen-
  • Check Condition-Cranking or Running
                                                                          sor to determine throttle actuator position, and is located
  • Fault Condition-Throttle command is 20% more than                     within the throttle actuator.
    actual throttle position
                                                                          There are two types of throttle actuators, 1) actuator with ana-
  • MIL-On during active fault                                            log position feedback and 2) actuator with digital position
  • Engine Shut Down                                                      feedback. The first type, with analog position feedback, pro-
                                                                          vides an analog return signal between 0 and 5 volts that is pro-
 In the case of a diesel engine, an actuator controls a fuel injec-       portional to the throttle actuator position. The second type,
 tion pump, directly affecting the fueling level into the cylin-          with digital position feedback, provides a serial data signal to
 ders. This may be by direct manipulation of the fuel injection           the ECM with the throttle actuator position voltage level
 pump rack or by manipulation of the mechanical governor                  encoded in the data stream.
 control level or “throttle arm.” In the DGC ECM and EDIS, refer-
 ences to the throttle and throttle position sensor refer to these        This fault will set if the throttle command is 20% or more than
 fuel injection pump control actuators and their position feed-           the actual throttle position. During this active fault the MIL
 back sensors. When the fuel injection pump is electronically             light will be on and the engine will shut down.
 controlled it can be used to control the idle stability and limit
 engine speed based on operating conditions.
3121171                                                                                                                           3-243
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
4 PINK/WHITE
3 TAN/ORANGE
5 GREEN/RED
1 PURPLE/BLUE
2 BLACK/GREEN
3-244                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                             SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3121171                                                                                                        3-245
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
3-246                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                                                   SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
B. Apply JLG Threadlocker PN 0100019 to Bolt Threads and to Threads in Counterweight. Torque to 400 ft. lbs. (542 Nm). Typical Four Places.
3121171                                                                                                                                                 3-247
 SECTION 3 - CHASSIS & TURNTABLE
NOTES:
3-248                              3121171
                                                                                                SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  Platform controls use a time dependent enable circuit to limit          • Beyond Transport - Drive Speed Cutback System.
  the time availability of “live” or enabled controls. To operate         • Drive/Steer - Boom Function Interlock System - CE Only
  any directional function, the footswitch must be depressed
                                                                          • Jib Stow System
  before activation of the function. When the footswitch is
  depressed, the controls are enabled and the operator has 7              • Electrical Retrieval System
  seconds to operate any function. The controls will remain
                                                                          • Swing Speed Proportioning System
  enabled as long as the operator continues to use any function
  and will remain enabled 7 seconds after the last function has           • Axle Extension System
  been used. While the controls are “live”, the enable light will be      • Oscillating Axle System
  illuminated in the platform display panel. When the time limit
  has been reached, the enable light will turn off and the con-        NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-
  trols will be “dead” or disabled. To continue use of the machine           ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-
  the controls must be re-enabled to start the timer system over             tem.
  again. This is done by releasing all functions, then releasing
  and re-depressing the footswitch.                                    4.3 BEYOND TRANSPORT - DRIVE SPEED CUTBACK
NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-              SYSTEM
      ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-          When boom is positioned beyond the transport position as
      tem.                                                               described in Section 4.2, Transport Position Sensing System,
                                                                         the drive motors are automatically restricted to their maxi-
4.2 TRANSPORT POSITION SENSING SYSTEM                                    mum displacement position (slow speed). See Section 3.24,
  The Transport Position Sensing System uses the following sen-          Chassis Tilt Indicator System for interaction with the tilt sensor.
  sors to sense when the boom is in the position associated with
                                                                       NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-
  high speed travel.
                                                                             ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-
   • Main boom angle sensors (mounted at the tower to main                   tem.
     boom pivot pin).
                                                                       4.4 DRIVE/STEER – BOOM FUNCTION INTERLOCK
   • The main boom angle limit switch will be used in the event
     of a main boom angle sensor fault.                                    SYSTEM (CE ONLY)
   • Four main boom length limit switches (mounted on the                The Drive/Steer – Boom Function Interlock System uses the
     main base boom).                                                    Transport Position Sensing System to sense when the boom is
                                                                         out of the transport position. All controls are simultaneously
   • Tower lift cylinder angle sensor (mounted at the tower lift
                                                                         functional when the booms are within the transport position
     cylinder pivot to the turntable).
                                                                         as on the standard machine. When the boom is beyond the
   • The tower angle sensors in conjunction with the chassis tilt        transport position, the control functions are interlocked to
     sensor will be used in the event of a tower lift cylinder           prevent simultaneous operation of any boom function with
     angle sensor fault.                                                 drive/steer. The first function set to be operated while in this
   • Tower boom length sensors (mounted in the pivot end of              mode, becomes the master function set. In other words, while
     the tower base boom).                                               operating drive/steer functions the boom functions are inop-
                                                                         erable. Likewise, while operating boom functions drive/steer
   • The tower length switch will be used in the event of a              functions are inoperable.
     tower length sensor fault.
                                                                       NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-
   • The position of the articulated jib is not considered.                  ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-
                                                                             tem.
3121171                                                                                                                                 4-1
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4.5 JIB STOW SYSTEM                                                      This system uses two gravitationally based angle sensors and
                                                                         two length sensors to continuously measure the position of
  This machine is equipped with a full function side swing rota-         the tower boom in addition to two rotary angle sensors to
  tor that is mechanically limited to 55 degree rotation to the          continuously measure the position of the main boom. Each
  left and electrically limited to 70 degrees to the right through       pair of sensors are continuously monitored for mutual agree-
  the use of a positive action limit switch mounted on the rota-         ment, proper response to command, and for correlation to a
  tor assembly. The machines stowed length can be reduced to             main boom angle limit switch, a tower boom length limit
  facilitate transportation on standard trailers by swinging the         switch, and a tower rotary angle sensor. Recognized faults
  jib further to the right using the hydraulic power of the side         within this system will result in control by the Electrical
  swing rotator. The control system will prevent swinging the jib        Retrieval System (Section 4.9, Electrical Retrieval System),
  past the 70 degree position unless the axles are retracted, the        reduced function speeds, and BCS warning light illumination.
  boom is in the transport position (see Section 4.2, Transport          After retrieval the boom will be restricted from leaving the
  Position Sensing System), and the jib stow override button on          transport position (see Section 4.2, Transport Position Sensing
  the platform control panel is held in combination with the jib         System) until the fault is resolved.
  swing function switch. When the jib is stowed, automatic plat-
  form leveling is disabled, the boom is restricted to the trans-        Boom position violations outside of the allowable envelope
  port position, and axle extension is disabled. This system is          will result in reduced function speeds, BCS warning light illu-
  functional only in the 500# (230 kg) mode of the Dual Capacity         mination, restriction of functions, and sounding of the plat-
  System (see Section 4.13, Dual Capacity System).                       form alarm and the flashing of the BCS light with attempts to
                                                                         operate restricted functions.
NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-
                                                                         Normally, the tower lift function switch on the ground and
      ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-
                                                                         platform control panels automatically activates both tower lift
      tem.
                                                                         and tower telescope as described in the tower path control
4.6 ENVELOPE CONTROL SYSTEM                                              system (see Section 4.7, Tower Path Control System). Violations
                                                                         of the tower envelope will result in the suspension of this
  The Envelope Control System is the primary means of control-           automatic feature. In an otherwise healthy control system, vio-
  ling the working positions of the tower and main boom within           lations of the tower envelope can be corrected by actuating
  the stability and structural requirements of the machine.              either of the tower lift up or tower lift down directions of the
  Although the machine includes a load pin capable of measur-            tower lift switch regardless of the direction of the violation.
  ing the changing forces on the boom, it is used exclusively for        The control system will telescope or lift the tower in a singular
  boom retrieval as described in the electrical retrieval system         manner to correct the tower position.
  (see Section 4.9, Electrical Retrieval System) and is not used for
                                                                         The restricted functions due to backward tower envelope vio-
  controlling the stability of the machine until a fault is detected
                                                                         lations are disallowing automatic tower lift down with tower
  within the primary envelope control system. The control sys-
                                                                         lift down commands, automatic tower telescope out with
  tem is therefore not considering the load on the machine but
                                                                         tower lift up commands, main lift up and down, main tele-
  rather the measured position of the boom within the enve-
                                                                         scope in, jib, swing, drive and steer.
  lope.
                                                                         The restricted functions due to forward tower envelope viola-
  The main boom must be controlled in maximum angle and
                                                                         tions are disallowing automatic tower lift up with tower lift up
  minimum angle to avoid entering a position that could com-
                                                                         commands, automatic tower telescope in with tower lift down
  promise backward stability and avoid main boom to tower
                                                                         commands, main lift up and down, main telescope out, jib,
  boom interference. The tower boom must be controlled by
                                                                         swing, drive and steer.
  permitting only specific combinations of tower length and
  tower angle to avoid entering a position that could compro-            The restricted functions due to maximum main boom enve-
  mise forward and backward stability (see Section 4.7, Tower            lope violations are disallowing tower lift up and down, main
  Path Control System).                                                  lift up, main telescope in, jib, swing and drive.
                                                                         The restricted functions due to minimum main boom enve-
                                                                         lope violations are disallowing main lift down, swing and
                                                                         drive.
4-2                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                            SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4.7 TOWER PATH CONTROL SYSTEM                                       4.8 AUTOMATIC MAIN BOOM CONTROL SYSTEM
  (see Figure 4-1., Tower Path vs. Main Boom Angle)                   The Automatic Main Boom Control System uses the envelope
                                                                      control sensors to enhance the control of the main boom dur-
  The Tower Path Control System uses the envelope control sen-        ing tower lift functions. Due to the mechanical joining of the
  sors to enhance the control of the tower boom for increased         main and tower booms, changes in tower boom angle would
  user efficiency and is used as an integral part of the envelope     normally have an opposite effect on the main boom angle. To
  control system (see Section 4.6, Envelope Control System).          compensate for this, when the tower is raised the control sys-
  Both the ground and platform control panels use one function        tem automatically introduces main lift up. Similarly, when the
  switch to control the tower. User commands for tower lift up or     tower is lowered the control system automatically introduces
  tower lift down causes the control system to automatically          main lift down. This is done to keep the platform moving in
  introduce the correct combination of tower telescope and            the same direction as the user command and to increase user
  tower lift for the tower boom to follow a pre-described path or     efficiency during tower lift functions.
  trajectory of the tower nose.
  The tower path is a fixed relationship of tower length and          The interaction of the main boom and the tower boom is
  tower angle (relative to gravity) and is variable only by the       slightly different when the main boom is above or below 60°
  angle of the main boom. With main boom angles below +15°,           relative to gravity.
  the tower boom will reach maximum angles of 68° (at full            During tower lift up or tower lift down movements with the
  tower boom extension) and with main boom angles above               main boom below 60°, the control system will maintain the
  +65° the tower boom will reach maximum angles of 72° (at full       angle of the main boom (relative to gravity) read at the start of
  tower boom extension).                                              the tower lift command or as read at the conclusion of main
  Movement of the main boom will cause the control system to          lift during combined tower and main lift commands.
  adjust the tower path accordingly. A fully raised tower boom
                                                                      During tower lift down movements with the main boom ini-
  will automatically vary in angle from 72° to 68° as the main
                                                                      tially above 60°, the control system will lower the main boom
  boom is lowered from its maximum angle to the ground and
                                                                      to approximately 60° before initiating tower movement. The
  conversely be raised from 68° to 72° as the main boom is
                                                                      control system will then control the main boom to 60° for the
  raised from the ground to maximum angle. The amount of
                                                                      remainder of the tower lift down command.
  tower angle variation during main boom movements dimin-
  ishes as the tower is lowered.                                      During tower lift up movements with the main boom initially
                                                                      above 60°, the control system will delay automatic compensa-
NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-         tion of the main boom angle during the tower lift movement
      ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-       until the main boom reaches approximately 60°. The control
      tem.                                                            system will then control the main boom to 60° until the tower
                                                                      boom has reached its maximum height. Continuing to operate
                                                                      the tower lift up function when the tower reaches its maxi-
                                                                      mum height, will cause the control system to automatically
                                                                      raise the main boom to its original angle.
3121171                                                                                                                           4-3
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4-4                                                                                        3121171
                                                                       SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                      MAIN BOOM
                                    FULLY EXTENDED
            TOWER BOOM
          FULLY LOWERED TO
            FULLY RAISED
                        TURNTABLE ROTATED
                         90 DEGREES FROM
                         STOWED POSITION
3121171                                                                                                     4-5
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
JIB ELEVATED
                                           MAIN BOOM
                                         FULLY ELEVATED
                                     TOWER BOOM
                                    FULLY LOWERED
                                    TO FULLY RAISED
                                                                               TURNTABLE ROTATED
                                                                                90 DEGREES FROM
                                                                                STOWED POSITION
4-6                                                                                                3121171
                                                                      SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
JIB ELEVATED
                                           MAIN BOOM
                                         FULLY ELEVATED
                                                        TOWER BOOM
                                                      FULLY LOWERED TO
                                                        FULLY RAISED
             TURNTABLE ROTATED
              90 DEGREES FROM
              STOWED POSITION
3121171                                                                                       4-7
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4.9 ELECTRICAL RETRIEVAL SYSTEM                                              Although the envelope control system (see Section 4.6, Enve-
                                                                             lope Control System) remains active during the hydraulic
  The Electrical Retrieval System provides a backup means of                 retrieval, the tower lift functionality will follow the tower path
  retrieving an elevated boom in the event of a failure of any               (see Section 4.7, Tower Path Control System) in an approxi-
  sensor used in the envelope control system (see Section 4.6,               mated fashion. Rather than the normal combined movements
  Envelope Control System). Although the system is continu-                  of tower lift, tower telescope, and main lift, the tower lift
  ously monitored for its viability, it is not active until a failure of     movements will move in an alternating sequence between
  the envelope control system is detected.                                   tower lift and tower telescope with the automatic main lift sys-
  The system uses a load cell pin to attach the tower lift cylinder          tem (see Section 4.8, Automatic Main Boom Control System)
  to the turntable. This pin is instrumented with gauges allow-              disabled.
  ing the forces in the pin to be monitored. The control system              Operating in this mode will result in reduced function speeds,
  uses these force readings to select one of two sequences of                and restriction of functions. Attempts to operate restricted
  retrieving the boom in a manner necessary to maintain the                  functions will flash the BCS light and sound the platform
  stability and structural integrity of the machine.                         alarm.
  The two sequences of boom retrieval are determined based
                                                                           NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-
  on the boom being closest to a position of forward stability
                                                                                 ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-
  concern or closest to a position of backward stability concern
                                                                                 tem.
  (See Figure 4-2., Figure 4-3., and Figure 4-4.). Regardless of the
  sequence selected by the control system, the control system              4.11 CONTROLLED BOOM ANGLE SYSTEM
  must recognize successive positions of the main and tower
  booms before continuing with the sequence.                                 The Controlled Boom Angle System uses the envelope control
  While operating in this mode, the positions of the booms are               sensors to enhance the control of the boom by minimizing the
  determined by sensors not used by the primary envelope con-                interaction of swing and drive functions with the envelope
  trol system. These include the tower length switch, tower cyl-             edges. This interaction is due to two factors. First, the envelope
  inder angle sensor, main boom angle switch, and main boom                  is controlled relative to gravity regardless of ground slope and
  length switches.                                                           second, the turntable/boom mounting is effected by swing
                                                                             and drive functions when the ground slope varies. This can
  Operating in this mode will result in reduced function speeds,
                                                                             cause the boom position to vary within the envelope or even
  BCS warning light illumination, and restriction of functions.
                                                                             violate the envelope edges when swinging or driving without
  Attempts to operate restricted functions will flash the BCS
                                                                             intentionally moving the boom. The controlled boom angle
  light and sound the platform alarm.
                                                                             system minimizes this effect by automatically introducing
NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-                either the tower or main boom lift up or down during swing
      ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-              and drive commands to maintain a constant boom angle rela-
      tem.                                                                   tive to gravity.
                                                                             When the tower is below the tower transport angle and the
4.10 HYDRAULIC RETRIEVAL SYSTEM                                              main boom is 25 degrees above the tower boom, the angle of
                                                                             the main boom is controlled. When the tower is above the
  The Hydraulic Retrieval System provides a backup means of
                                                                             tower transport angle, the angle of the tower is controlled
  retrieving an elevated boom in the event of a recognized fail-
                                                                             regardless of main boom position.
  ure within the primary hydraulic control system related to the
  main lift, tower lift, and tower telescope functions. The control          Just as the booms are controlled during swing and drive func-
  system monitors the primary hydraulic control system for                   tions, the tower angle is also controlled during main boom lift
  short and open circuits, unexpected boom sensor response to                and main boom telescope functions.
  command, control valve spool position faults, internal valve               Controlled boom angle is disabled with any envelope violation
  control module faults, and CAN BUS communication faults.                   or failure.
  When a fault is detected, the control system automatically
                                                                           NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-
  bypasses the appropriate hydraulic components and using
                                                                                 ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-
  alternative valves and control logic allows the operator to
                                                                                 tem.
  return the boom to the ground. In some cases the boom will
  be allowed to move only to the extent gravity is capable of
  assisting and in other cases the boom will be powered to allow
  complete retrieval to the transport position.
4-8                                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                              SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4.12 SLOW DOWN SYSTEM                                                 NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-
                                                                            ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-
  To reduce the machine dynamics and improve operator con-                  tem.
  trol, the control system uses the envelope control sensors to
  automatically slow down the tower lift up, main lift up, and        4.14 HYDRAULIC SYSTEM WARM UP
  main lift down function speeds as the minimum and maxi-
  mum angles of the working envelope are approached. The                For optimal life and performance of the hydraulic system in
  control system indicates to the operator this automatic intro-        extremely cold temperatures, the control system monitors the
  duction of slow down by flashing the creep light on the plat-         hydraulic system temperature and automatically limits the
  form display panel. This feature applies to both platform and         function speeds of the high demand functions.
  ground controls, however, no indication is made on the                While the system is cold and in the warm up mode, the tower
  ground control panel.                                                 lift, main lift, and main telescope functions are limited to creep
                                                                        speeds and is indicated to the operator by flashing the creep
NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-           light on the platform control panel.
      ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-
                                                                        Operating the machine while in the warm up mode will gener-
      tem.
                                                                        ate sufficient heat to bring the hydraulic temperature up to
4.13 DUAL CAPACITY SYSTEM                                               allowable temperatures and the warm up mode will be auto-
                                                                        matically turned off. Although operating any function will
  The Dual Capacity System is a multiple envelope control sys-          generate heat, the tower lift function will warm the hydraulic
  tem as opposed to a capacity indication system. The control           system temperature the fastest as this function will operate
  system changes the allowable working envelope to match the            tower lift, tower telescope, and main lift function automati-
  capacity select mode to either the 500# (230 kg) mode or the          cally.
  1000# (450 kg) mode. It then displays the capacity mode on            Functions being operated when the warm up mode turns off
  the platform and ground display panel and controls the posi-          will remain in the creep speed until the function is re-initiated.
  tions of the main boom within the allowable envelope for that
  mode. This mode is selectable by the operator with the dual         NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-
  capacity select switch on the platform control panel.                     ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-
  The 500# (230 kg) mode has the largest envelope and allows                tem.
  the use of the side swing jib. The 1000# (450 kg) mode has a
  smaller envelope and requires the jib to be fixed in the cen-
                                                                      4.15 REDUCED PLATFORM HEIGHTS
  tered position.                                                       The control system allows the maximum platform height of
  The control system uses the envelope control sensors (item16)         the machine to be restricted to a selectable reduced height to
  in addition to the 4 limit switches and cams mounted on the           allow increased versatility in the rental market. The selection
  main base and fly booms to restrict the main boom length              of 125, 100, and 80 ft maximum platform heights are available
  between the main boom angles of +55° and –45° for the 1000#           in the dealer mode - machine set up menu on the analyzer.
  envelope.                                                             The reduced platform heights are implemented by restricting
  To select the 1000# (450 kg) mode the boom must already be            the travel of the tower boom up the tower path (see Section
  in the smaller 1000# (450 kg) envelope and the jib must be            4.7, Tower Path Control System) while maintaining all other
  centered (+/-10 degrees) verified to the control system by the        aspects of the envelope control system (see Section 4.6, Enve-
  jib centered limit switch mounted on the side swing rotator.          lope Control System). The limits and functionality of the main
                                                                        boom are unaffected by the selection.
  When the operator selects the 1000# (450 kg) mode and these
  conditions are met, the capacity light changes from 500# (230
  kg) to 1000# (450 kg), jib swing is disallowed, and the enve-
  lope is changed accordingly.
  When the operator selects the 1000# mode and these condi-
  tions are not met, both capacity lights will flash, the platform
  alarm will sound, and all functions except jib swing will be dis-
  abled until the capacity select switch is put back into the 500#
  (230 kg) position. Operation of jib swing in this condition can
  be used to find the center position of the jib as the jib swing
  function will stop when the center position is reached.
  When in the 1000# (450 kg) mode, attempts to telescope, lift
  or lower the main boom into the restricted area will cause that
  function to be prevented.
3121171                                                                                                                              4-9
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4-10                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                                     SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
   5. Remove the bolts and washers securing the support to      Support Installation
      the rotator.
                                                                 1. Using a suitable lifting device, support the platform sup-
                                                                    port and position it on the rotator.
MAE17170
MAE17180
MAE17180
MAE17170
                                                                 4. Torque the nut on the rotator center bolt to 586 ft. lbs.
                                                                    (795 Nm). Torque the retaining bolts to 40 ft. lbs.
                                                                    (55 Nm).
3121171                                                                                                                  4-11
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
   5. Position the platform on the platform support and                        6. Remove tag and reconnect the hydraulic lines to the
      install the bolts securing the platform to the platform                     rotator.
      support.
                                                                               7. Connect the electrical cables to the platform control
                                                                                  console.
MAE17160
A, B, D
                                                             C, D
          NOTE: If any rotator bolts are replaced, replace all
                bolts on the rotator and torque them
4-12                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
           A,B,D                       NOTE: If any rotator bolts are replaced, all bolts on the
                                             rotator should be retorqued.
C,D
3121171                                                                                            4-13
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4.18 ROTATOR                                                            4. Remove the hardware from pin #2. Using a suitable
                                                                           brass drift and hammer, remove pin #2 and remove the
                                                                           rotator.
  Removal
    1. Remove the Platform and Platform Support. Refer to             Installation
       Section 4.17, Platform.
                                                                    NOTE: The rotator approximately weighs 60 lbs. (27 kg).
    2. Tag and disconnect hydraulic lines to rotator. Use suit-
       able container to retain any residual hydraulic fluid. Cap       1. Supporting the rotator and jib assembly, align rotator
       or plug all openings of hydraulic lines and ports.                  with jib assembly mounting point and jib. Using a soft
                                                                           head mallet, install pin #1 to the jib assembly. Install
NOTE: The rotator approximately weighs 60 lbs. (27 kg).
                                                                           hardware securing pin #1.
    3. Supporting the rotator and jib assembly, remove hard-            2. Using a soft head mallet install pin #2 to jib assembly
       ware from pin #1. Using a suitable brass drift and ham-             and install the rotator. Install hardware securing pin #2.
       mer remove pin #1.
JIB ASSEMBLY
ROTATOR
                                                                                             2
                                                                                                                              MAE37980
4-14                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4.19 MAIN BOOM                                                         8. Remove the cover from the top of the main boom to
                                                                          gain access to the telescope cylinder attaching hard-
                                                                          ware.
Disassembly
NOTE: The following procedure allows the boom base section to
      remain attached to the machine.
3121171                                                                                                                       4-15
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  11.   If necessary, remove the shoulder screws, retaining           13.   If necessary, remove the shoulder screws, retaining ring,
        rings, and pin that secures the rod end of the telescope            and pin that secures the barrel end of the level cylinder
        cylinder to the main boom fly section and remove the                to the main boom fly section and remove the level cylin-
        telescope cylinder from the fly section.                            der from the fly section.
  12.   If necessary, remove the bolt, keeper pin, and pivot pin     Assembly
        securing the upper link to the boom nose and remove
                                                                       1. If removed during assembly, install the level cylinder
        the upper and lower links as an assembly. If necessary,
                                                                          into the fly section. Install the shoulder screws, retaining
        remove the bolt (screw prior to S/N 80869), pin retainer
                                                                          ring, and pin that secures the barrel end of the level cyl-
        sleeve, and nut securing the lower link to the upper link.
                                                                          inder to the main boom fly section.
4-16                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
        upper link to the boom nose and secure in place with       4. Install the bolt, keeper pin, and retaining pin that
        the pivot pin, keeper pin, and bolt.                          secures the barrel end of the telescope cylinder to the
                                                                      main boom base section.
3121171                                                                                                                4-17
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4-18                                                                3121171
3121171
          See Figure 4-9., Main Boom Assembly - Sheet 2 of 4                        See Figure 4-9., Main Boom Assembly - Sheet 2 of 4
4-19
                                                                                                                                         SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4-20
                                                                                              SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
3121171
3121171
          ALIGN ENDS OF ALL FIBERGLASS BARS
              TO BE FLUSH WITH HOLES IN SIDE
                 OF FLY BOOM AS SHOWN HERE
          CENTER FIBERGLASS BARS VERTICALLY
              OVER HOLES IN SIDE OF FLY BOOM
                             AS SHOWN HERE
4-21
                                                                             SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4-22
                                                                                                                                                                    SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
          1.   Pivot Assembly         5.   Bolt                    9. Shoulder Screw  13. Bolt           17. Upper Jib Link     21.   Fly Boom Section    25. Pin
          2.   Upper Front Wear Pad   6.   Level Cylinder Pin      10. Level Cylinder 14. Jib Rotator    18. Platform Rotator   22.   Base Boom Section
          3.   Shim                   7.   Tele Cylinder Pin       11. Side Wear Pad  15. Lower Jib Link 19. Level Link Pin     23.   Bolt
          4.   Bolt                   8.   Retaining Ring          12. Shim           16. Jib Cylinder   20. Retaining Ring     24.   Keeper
                                                                Figure 4-11. Main Boom Assembly - Sheet 4 of 4
3121171
                                                                                        SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
     NOTE: If any rotator bolts are replaced, all bolts on the rota-
           tor should be retorqued. Check torque on the bolts
           every 150 hours of operation.
                                                                                         Ft-Lbs.     Nm
                                                                             A            85         115
                                                                             B            300        410
                                                                             C            480        650
                                                                             D            85         115
                                                                             E            190        260
3121171                                                                                                        4-23
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                                                     4. Lift the tower base section up and extend the lift cylin-
                                                                        der to align it with the attachment lugs. Refer to the Ser-
                                                                        vice Mode procedure in Section 4.26, Tower Lift Cylinder.
4-24                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                   SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
FLY TO MID
                                                      FLY TO BASE
                    VIEW A - A                                                                FLY TO BASE
                                                                                                  0801370-E
                                                                                                 MAE38700E
3121171                                                                                                       4-25
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
18
                                                                                                                       0801370-E
                                                                                                                      MAE38710E
        1.   Tower Fly               6.   Bolt                  10.   Screw           14.   Front Lower Wear Pad
        2.   Tower Mid               7.   Washer                11.   Shoulder Bolt   15.   Wear Pad Shim
        3.   Tower Base              8.   Front Side Wear Pad   12.   Snap Ring       16.   Bolt
        4.   Front Upper Wear Pad    9.   Wear Pad Shim         13.   Retaining Pin   17.   Washer
        5.   Wear Pad Shim                                                            18.   Cover (Prior to SN 0300120859)
4-26                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                               SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
17
                                                                                                               0801370-E
                                                                                                              MAE38720E
          1.   Upper Rear Wear Pad   5.   Rear Side Wear Pad      9.    Keeper Shim     13.     Wear Pad Shim
          2.   Wear Pad Shim         6.   Wear Pad Shim           10.   Bolt            14.     Bolt
          3.   Bolt                  7.   Screw                   11.   Tower Tele Cylinder
                                                                                        15.     Washer
          4.   Washer                8.   Trunnion Keeper Block   12.   Bottom Rear Wear Pad
                                                                                        16.     Hose Loop
                                                                                        17.     Cover (Prior to SN 0300120859)
                                          Figure 4-14. Tower Boom Assembly - Sheet 3 of 3
3121171                                                                                                                          4-27
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                                                          Ft-Lbs.     Nm
                                                                A          85         115
                                                                B          35         47.5
4-28                                                                                         3121171
                                                                          SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
              Ft-Lbs.           Nm
          A    85               115
          B    35               47.5
3121171                                                                                          4-29
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                                                                                            DETAIL A
                      PIVOT PIN
DETAIL E
DETAIL A
DETAIL D
0272979-M
4-30                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                            SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
LOCK NUT
DRIVE HUB
SECTION A-A
A A
                                                                                                1001138811-G
                                                                                                1001120653-H
                                                                                                   MAE37830
Figure 4-18. Boom & Cylinder Installation (SN 0300144623 to Present) - Sheet 2 of 5
3121171                                                                                                        4-31
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
SCREW
PIVOT PIN
PIVOT PIN
4-32                                                                                                    3121171
                                                               SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                                                                                0272979-M
                                                                                             1001120653-H
                                                                                             1001138811-G
3121171                                                                                             4-33
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
            NOTE: If space is available install one thrust washer on each side of the boom assembly between the
                  tower fly boom section and the main base boom section. If space only allows for the use of
                  one thrust washer, install it on the same side as the proximity sensor. (Same as the left side or
                  powertrack side of the machine.)
THRUSTWASHER THRUSTWASHER
                                                                                                                0272979-M
                                                                                                             1001120653-H
                                                                                                             1001138811-G
4-34                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                       SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                           Bolt #      Ft-Lbs.          Nm
                             1          675             915
                             2          285             386
                             3          190             260
                             4          600             813
                             5          200             271
                                                                                             0272979-M
                                                                                          1001120653-H
                                                                                          1001138811-G
3121171                                                                                            4-35
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                                                                                 0272979-M
                                                                                              1001120653-H
                                                                                              1001138811-G
4-36                                                                                               3121171
                                                                                 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
          Bolt #   Ft-Lbs.         Nm
            1       675            915
            2       285            386
            3       190            260
            4       600            813
            5       200            271
                                                                                                    0272979-M
                                                                                                 1001120653-H
                                                                                                 1001138811-G
3121171                                                                                                         4-37
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
0273513 E
                      1.   Bar
                      2.   Blade
                      3.   Plate
                      A    Apply JLG Threadlocker PN 0100011 & torque to 85 ft.lbs. (115 Nm)
                      B    Apply JLG Threadlocker PN 0100011 & torque to 35 ft.lbs. (47 Nm)
                      C    Adjust all blades 0.000 to 0.063" (0 to 1.6 mm) from side boom plate
4-38                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
    1. Install the tower mid section into the tower base sec-
       tion. Install the wear pads in the tower base section.
NOTE: Keep the tower fly section out of the tower mid section
      enough to allow for installation of the telescope cylinder
      retaining pin.
    2. Install the tower fly section into the tower mid section.   6. Connect all hoses and electrical lines as tagged during
       Install the wear pads in the tower mid section.                disassembly.
    3. Extend the telescope cylinder so the rod will be            7. Install the power track to the side of the tower boom.
       extended enough to install the retaining pin holes in the      Connect all hoses as tagged during disassembly.
       tower fly section. It may be necessary to secure one end
       to make sure the desired rod end extends. Install the
       telescope cylinder into the tower boom. Refer to the Ser-
       vice Mode procedure in Section 4.25, Tower Telescope
       Cylinder.
3121171                                                                                                                  4-39
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                                                         9. Install the pivot pin. Install the keeper pin and apply JLG
                                                                            Threadlocker PN 0100019 to the retaining bolt. Torque
                                                                            the bolt to 285 ft.lbs. (386Nm).
NOTE: The lower link weighs approximately 659 lbs. (299 kg).
                                                                       10.   Lift the main lift cylinder into position with the lower
                                                                             link. Install the pivot pin in part way. Lift the upper link
                                                                             to align the pivot pin bushings in the lower link, lift cyl-
                                                                             inder, and upper link.
4-40                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                                SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  11.   Install the pivot pin. Install the keeper pin and apply JLG   Pin Clamp Installation Procedure
        Threadlocker PN 0100019 to the retaining bolt. Torque
        the bolt to 675 ft. lbs. (915 Nm).                               1. Install the main boom pivot pin and loosely install the
                                                                            cross bolt and nut.
                                                                         2. Install the pin clamp bar. Clamp the bolts and washers.
                                                                            Tighten the clamp bolts enough to hold the pin clamp in
                                                                            position for the following steps (5 ft. lbs. [7 Nm] maxi-
                                                                            mum).
                                                                         3. Install the jack screws and jam nuts. Torque the jack
                                                                            screws to 600 ft. lbs. (813 Nm). Torque the jam nuts to
                                                                            200 ft. lbs. (271 Nm).
                                                                         4. Torque the clamp bolts to 190 ft. lbs. (260 Nm).
                                                                         5. Torque the cross bolt and nut to 190 ft. lbs. (260 Nm).
  12.   Lift the main boom in position to align the pivot pin
        bushings in the main boom and tower boom. Install the
        main boom pivot pin as described in the Pin Clamp
        Installation Procedure below.
  13.   Lift the upper link into position to align the pivot pin
        holes in the main boom with the pivot pin bushings in
        the upper link. Install the keeper pin and apply JLG
        Threadlocker PN 0100019 to the retaining bolt. Torque
        the bolt to 285 ft.lbs. (386Nm).
                                                                                           1.   Pivot Pin
                                                                                           2.   Cross Bolt
                                                                                           3.   Nut
                                                                                           4.   Pin Clamp Bar
                                                                                           5.   Clamp Bolt
                                                                                           6.   Jack Screw
                                                                                           7.   Jam Nut
3121171                                                                                                                         4-41
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                          *
                                                                                                               *
       *
                                                               *
                                                  **
                                     **
                                                           *
                                                       *
                                                                   * JLG Threadlocker PN 0100011
                                                                   ** JLG Threadlocker PN 0100019
MAE38250
4-42                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                      SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                       *
                         *
                                               *
                                   *
                                                   *
                                                           * JLG Threadlocker PN 0100011
                                           *
MAE38460
3121171                                                                                               4-43
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                         *
                                               *
                                                             *
                                                     *
                                                                                                 *
                                     *
4-44                                                                                                            3121171
                                                                            SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
3121171                                                                                             4-45
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                                                                       *
           * JLG Threadlocker PN 0100019
MAE38490
4-46                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                                                         SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
SEE DETAIL A
SEE DETAIL B
DETAIL A
DETAIL B
                                                                                                                                                          0273360-F
                                                                                                                                                         MAE37840F
                         Figure 4-32. Tower Boom Powertrack Installation - Sheet 1 of 3
3121171                                                                                                                                                        4-47
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                      PLATFORM
        GENERATOR CABLE               CONTROL
        OR WELD LEAD                  CABLE
                                                      BOOM
           MAIN LIFT CYL                              SENSOR
                                                      CABLE
                AIRLINE
            PLATFORM                                                                                                       DETAIL C
            SUPPLY
PLATFORM RETURN
ELECTRICAL CABLES
                               GENERATOR CABLE
                               OR WELD LEAD
DETAIL C
                                                                                                                                  0273360-F
                                                                                                                                 MAE37850F
4-48                                                                                                                               3121171
                                                                                                   SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
SEE DETAIL D
                                                 AIRLINE
                                                                                                       PLATFORM RETURN
                                    GENERATOR CABLE
                                    OR WELD LEAD
                                                                                                       MAIN LIFT CYL
                                                                                         CABLE
                                                MAIN LIFT CYL
                                                                      DETAIL D
                                                                                                                          0273360-F
                                                                                                                         MAE37860F
3121171                                                                                                                         4-49
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                  1.   Tower Lift Cylinder Angle Sensor (1)   7. Main Boom Transport Length Switch (2)
                  2.   Load Pin(1)                            8. Dual Capacity Length Switch (2)
                  3.   Tower Angle Sensors (2)                9. Main Boom Transport Angle Switch (1)
                  4.   Tower Length Sensors (2)               10. Jib Stow Switch (1)
                  5.   Tower Transport Length Switch (1)      11. Dual Capacity Jib Position Switch (1)
                  6.   Main Boom Angle Sensor (2)
4-50                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                                                            SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
3121171                                                                                                                                                                    4-51
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
               1.   Sensor Cover
               2.   Washer
               3.   Ring
               4.   Bolt
               5.   Sensor Arm
               6.   Sensor Switch
               7.   Lift Cylinder
SECTION A-A
0273121-P
Figure 4-37. Boom Sensor Locations - Tower Lift Cylinder Angle Sensor
4-52                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                                                               SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                           ROUTE SWITCH HARNESS AROUND COVER MOUNT            TO AVOID DAMAGE: SWITCH LEVER TRAVEL LIMIT MUST BE
                                                           AS SHOWN                           EQUAL IN BOTH DIRECTIONS. ORIENT SWITCH LEVER AT
                                                                                              SPLINE INDEX LOCATION CLOSEST TO 90°
                                                                                                                                 DUAL CAPACITY
                                                                                                                              LENGTH SWITCH DETAIL
             ENSURE THAT DUAL CAPACITY
          LENGTH SWITCH LEVERS AND HEADS
              ARE ORIENTED AS SHOWN                                       2X 90°
0273121-P
Figure 4-38. Boom Sensor Locations - Dual Capacity, Length, & Main Boom Transport
3121171                                                                                                                                                              4-53
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
              LEVER FULLY
               EXTENDED
90°
0273121-P
4-54                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                                                                                 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
          PUSH NUT
                                                                        PUSH NUT DETAIL
          MOUNTING
            BOLT
Figure 4-40. Boom Sensor Locations - Level & Jib Position Switches
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                              4-55
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
0273121-P
Figure 4-41. Boom Sensor Locations - Upper Length, Lower Length, & Tower Boom Angle - Sheet 1 of 2
4-56                                                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                            SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
HOSE LOOP
0273121-P
Figure 4-42. Boom Sensor Locations - Upper Length, Lower Length, & Tower Boom Angle - Sheet 2 of 2
3121171                                                                                                                                          4-57
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                 TYPICAL
       LEFT & RIGHT SIDES OF BOOM
Figure 4-43. Boom Sensor Locations - Rotary Angle & Proximity Sensor - Sheet 1 of 2
4-58                                                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                                                                                          SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
DETAIL C
PROXIMITY SENSOR
MEASUREMENT SURFACE
SEE DETAIL C
                                                            SECTION B-B
                                                          FROM Figure 4-36.
                                                                                                                                                                                        0273121-P
Figure 4-44. Boom Sensor Locations - Rotary Angle & Proximity Sensor - Sheet 2 of 2
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                         4-59
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
Analyzer Readings
 The analyzer reading for these switches can be found in the           In the OUT of transport position, the screen should read
 Diagnostics menu under Transport Data.
4-60                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                           SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                                   Analyzer Readings
                                                    The analyzer reading for these switches can be found in the
                                                    Diagnostics menu under Transport Data.
Possible Faults
   1. Stuck Switch
  • 8/4 Fault Code
  • MAIN BOOM TRN AGL SW/SENSOR DISAGREEMENT
    Analyzer message.
   2. Wire Broken/Disconnected
  • 8/4 Code Fault Code
  • MAIN BOOM TRN AGL SW FAILED Analyzer message
3121171                                                                                                          4-61
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
and and
4-62                                                                                3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
   1. Stuck Switch
  • 8/4 Fault Code
  • TWR LEN SW/SENSOR DISAGREEMENT Analyzer
    message.
   2. Wire Broken/Disconnected
  • 8/4 Code Fault Code
  • TWR LEN SW DISAGREEMENT Analyzer message
Analyzer Readings
 The analyzer reading for these switches can be found in the
 Diagnostics menu under Transport Data.
3121171                                                                                                         4-63
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                                                  The Dual Capacity Switches are located on the left side of the
                                                                  Main Base boom underneath the cover. The Dual Capacity
                                                                  Switches along with the Main Boom Transport Length
                                                                  Switches run on a series of cams mounted on the fly boom to
                                                                  determine the length of the main boom. These switches
                                                                  restricts the main boom length between the main boom
                                                                  angles of +55° and -45° for the 1000 lb (450 kg) envelope.
                                                                 Analyzer Readings
                                                                  The analyzer reading for these switches can be found in the
                                                                  Diagnostics menu under Transport Data.
Possible Faults
   1. Stuck Switch
  • 8/4 Fault Code
  • TRANS SW SW DISAGREEMENT* Analyzer message
    *This fault will not show up until telescope is activated.
   2. Wire Broken/Disconnected
  • 8/4 Code Fault Code
  • TRANS SW SW DISAGREEMENT Analyzer message
4-64                                                                                                                    3121171
                                            SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
 Switch #1 on cam:
                     Possible Faults
                        1. Stuck Switch
                       • 8/4 Fault Code
                       • CAP LEN SW DISAGREEMENT* Analyzer message
                         *This fault will not show up until telescope is activated.
                        2. Wire Broken/Disconnected
                       • 8/4 Code Fault Code
                       • CAP LEN SW DISAGREEMENT Analyzer message
3121171                                                                          4-65
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4-66                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                                                SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
 #1 MAIN BOOM TRANSPORT LIMIT SWITCH, MOUNTED ON THE RIGHT                     #2 MAIN BOOM TRANSPORT LIMIT SWITCH, MOUNTED ON THE RIGHT
 SIDE OF THE MAIN BOOM (TOP SWITCH). THIS SWITCH IS IN THE N.C.                SIDE OF MAIN BOOM (BOTTOM SWITCH). THIS SWITCH IS OPEN
 POSITION WHEN THE MAIN BOOM IS FULLY RETRACTED.                               WHEN THE MAIN BOOM IS FULLY RETRACTED.
                      When Switch #2 (bottom switch) is on cam:                         When Switch #2 (bottom switch) is off cam:
                         9 volts on white                                                  12 volts on white
                         12 volts on black                                                 12 volts on black
  #1 DUAL CAPACITY LIMIT SWITCH, MOUNTED ON LEFT SIDE OF                           #2 DUAL CAPACITY LIMIT SWITCH, MOUNTED ON LEFT SIDE OF
  BOOM (TOP SWITCH). THIS SWITCH IS IN THE N.C. POSITION                           BOOM (BOTTOM SWITCH). THIS SWITCH IS OPEN
  WHEN THE MAIN BOOM IS FULLY RETRACTED.                                           WHEN THE MAIN BOOM IS FULLY RETRACTED.
                           When Switch #1 (top switch) is off cam:                       When Switch #1 (top switch) is on cam:
                              12 volts on white                                             12 volts on white
                              12 volts on black                                             9 volts on black
                           When Switch #2 (bottom switch) is on cam:                     When Switch #2 (bottom switch) is off cam:
                              9 volts on white                                              12 volts on white
                              12 volts on black                                             12 volts on black
3121171                                                                                                                                     4-67
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4.25 TOWER TELESCOPE CYLINDER                                            5. Position the Platform/Ground select switch to the
                                                                            Ground position.
Removal
    1. Place the machine on a firm, level surface with the axles
       fully extended or the turntable centered between the
       rear wheels.
    2. Select lift up and raise the tower boom until it is in a hor-
       izontal position.
4-68                                                                                                                 3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
3121171                                                                                                                       4-69
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  13.   Press ENTER. The analyzer will read:                                 If the main boom angle sensors are calibrated and
                                                                             working properly the control system will verify the
                                                                             main boom angle readings are between +0.0 and
                                                                             +15.0 (ref tower boom). If they are calibrated and
                                                                             working properly and outside the angle limits, the
                                                                             analyzer will read:
  14.   Press the ENTER key, the control system will perform the
        following checks:                                          15.   After the successful completion of the checks, the ana-
                                                                         lyzer will read:
        The axles must be extended or the DOS (Direction of
        Steering) switch must indicate the turntable is between
        the rear tires, otherwise the analyzer will read:
4-70                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
WHEN THE STABILITY CONTROL IS OFF THE MACHINE WILL TIP IF USED       20.   At the rear of the tower boom, tag and disconnect the
INCORRECTLY.                                                               wires going to the angle sensors. Remove the bolts and
                                                                           washers that fasten the angle sensors to the boom sec-
  17.   Press the ENTER key to acknowledge the stability control           tion and remove the angle sensors.
        is turned off. The analyzer should read:
  18.   The control system will now allow only tower telescope
        using the tower lift switch on the ground console.
3121171                                                                                                                         4-71
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                                                  Installation
                                                                     1. Place blocking for support under the tower telescope
                                                                        cylinder and begin pushing the cylinder into the boom
                                                                        using an adequate lifting device. Reposition the blocks
                                                                        and lifting straps as needed to prevent the cylinder from
                                                                        dropping and to keep it balanced.
4-72                                                                                                                   3121171
                                                                                     SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
   4. Connect the length sensor cables to the tower boom fly     7. Secure the angle sensors to the boom section with the
      section.                                                      retaining bolts and washers. At the rear of the tower
                                                                    boom, connect the wires going to the angle sensors as
                                                                    tagged during removal.
3121171                                                                                                                  4-73
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4.26 TOWER LIFT CYLINDER                                                  4. If the Boom Control System allows tower telescope, skip
                                                                             to step 18. If not, continue with step 6.
Removal                                                                   5. Plug the analyzer into the connector inside the Ground
                                                                             control box.
    1. Place the machine on a firm, level surface with the axles
       fully extended or the turntable centered between the
       rear wheels.
    2. Select lift up and raise the tower boom until it is in a hor-
       izontal position.
4-74                                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                            SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
    7. The analyzer screen should read:                                11.   Scroll through the menu until "TWR LIFT ONLY?" is dis-
                                                                             played as shown below.
THE SERVICE MODE MENU WILL BE SELECTABLE AT THE TOP LEVEL OF THE
ANALYZER MENU STRUCTURE. “SERVICE MODE” WILL BE DISPLAYED ON THE
TOP LINE OF THE ANALYZER WITH THE CURRENT SUB-MENU SELECTION ON
THE BOTTOM LINE. THE SUB-MENUS WILL SCROLL WITH THE LEFT AND RIGHT
ARROW KEYS.
3121171                                                                                                                       4-75
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  13.   Press the ENTER key. The control system will perform the       15.   After the successful completion of the checks, the ana-
        following checks:                                                    lyzer will read:
  14.   If the main boom angle sensors are calibrated and work-
        ing properly the control system will verify the main
        boom angle readings are between +0.0 and +15.0 (ref
        tower boom). If they are calibrated and working prop-
        erly and outside the angle limits, the analyzer will read:
                                                                     WHEN THE STABILITY CONTROL IS OFF THE MACHINE WILL TIP IF USED
                                                                     INCORRECTLY.
4-76                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  17.   Press the ENTER key to acknowledge the stability control      22.   At the rod end of the cylinder, remove the retaining bolt
        is turned off. The analyzer should read:                            and pivot pin that secures that end of the cylinder to the
                                                                            tower boom.
  18.   The control system will allow only tower lift (without
        auto tower telescope) using the tower lift switch on the
        ground console.
  19.   Activate tower lift enough to gain access to the tower lift
        cylinder.
                                                                      24.   Loosen and remove the bolt that secures the retaining
  20.   Use a crane or other suitable supporting device to sup-             pin and remove the retaining pin.
        port the weight of the tower and main boom assem-
        blies.
NOTE: The tower lift cylinder weighs approximately 644 lbs. (292
      kg).
3121171                                                                                                                         4-77
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  25.   Disconnect the wiring harness from the strain relief con-       2. When installing a new load sensing pin, make sure all of
        nector at the opposite side of the load sensing pin.               the holes in the turntable and lift cylinder are aligned. If
                                                                           the new load sensing pin does not push 1/2 to 3/4 of the
  26.   Use the Load Pin Removal Tool (JLG PN 4846765) to pre-
                                                                           way in by hand, remove the pin and align the holes bet-
        vent the pin from being damaged, and use a hammer to
                                                                           ter. Also make sure the pin is installed with the strain
        remove the pin. To make the tool refer to Figure 4-52.,
                                                                           relief connector opposing the pin orientation bar as
        Load Pin Removal Tool, JLG PN 4846765. If the Load Pin
                                                                           shown.
        Removal Tool is not available, use an arbor of the proper
        size (as shown below). If excessive force is necessary to
        move the pin, it may be necessary to carefully activate
        lift using the auxiliary power switch to relieve lift cylin-
        der weight from the load sensing pin.
    1. Put a nylon strap capable of supporting the weight of                    DO NOT TAP ON THE CENTER OF THE PIVOT PIN.
       the lift cylinder around the cylinder. Carefully position
       the lift cylinder in place, repositioning the lifting strap as   4. Connect the wiring harness to the strain relief connector
       necessary.                                                          as shown in Figure 4-51., Load Sensing Pin Harness
                                                                           Installation and re-calibrate the boom sensors.
4-78                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
          Pin Harness
          PN 4922826
3121171                                                                                                 4-79
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
   5. Secure the pin in place with the retaining pin and retain-    7. Cycle the cylinder in and out several times to purge air
      ing pin bolt on the other end. Torque the bolt to 285            from the cylinder. If necessary, refer to Removal and use
      ft.lbs. (386 Nm).                                                the analyzer Service Mode.
                                                                    8. At the rod end of the cylinder, install the retaining bolt
                                                                       and pivot pin that secures that end of the cylinder to the
                                                                       tower boom. It may be necessary to use the analyzer
                                                                       Service Mode to align the pin. Torque the bolt to 285
                                                                       ft.lbs. (386 Nm).
   6. Install the sensor pin, sensor arm, and angle sensor. Con-
      nect the wiring harness to the sensor and install the sen-
      sor cover.
4-80                                                                                                                   3121171
                                                          SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
3121171                                                                          4-81
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
Removal
   1. Place the machine on a firm, level surface with the axles
      fully extended or the turntable centered between the
      rear wheels. The tower boom must also be fully lowered
      and retracted.
   2. Connect the JLG Control System Analyzer to the connec-
      tor at the ground control box.
   3. Start the engine.
   4. Position the Platform/Ground select switch to the
      Ground position.
                                                                  THE SERVICE MODE MENU WILL BE SELECTABLE AT THE TOP LEVEL OF THE
                                                                  ANALYZER MENU STRUCTURE. “SERVICE MODE” WILL BE DISPLAYED ON THE
                                                                  TOP LINE OF THE ANALYZER WITH THE CURRENT SUB-MENU SELECTION ON
                                                                  THE BOTTOM LINE. THE SUB-MENUS WILL SCROLL WITH THE LEFT AND RIGHT
                                                                  ARROW KEYS.
4-82                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  10.   Scroll through the analyzer menu until SERVICE MODE is   12.   Press the ENTER key. The control system will perform
        displayed. Press the ENTER key.                                several tests to make sure the machine is in the proper
                                                                       position. If the axles are not extended or the turntable is
                                                                       not centered between the rear wheels, the screen will
                                                                       read:
  11.   Scroll through the menu until the "MAIN LIFT?" is dis-
        played as shown below.
                                                                       If the tower boom angle sensors are calibrated and
                                                                       operating properly, the control system will verify the
                                                                       tower boom angle readings are less than +5°. If the
                                                                       tower boom angle is outside the limit, the screen will
                                                                       read:
3121171                                                                                                                     4-83
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
        If the tower boom length sensors are calibrated and           14.   Enter code 55050. The analyzer will read:
        operating properly, the control system will verify the
        tower boom length readings are less than 6 in. (15.2 cm).
        If the tower boom length is not within the limits, the
        screen will read:
                                                                    WHEN THE STABILITY CONTROL IS OFF THE MACHINE WILL TIP IF USED
                                                                    INCORRECTLY.
  13.   When the machine passes all the configuration checks,
        the screen will read:
                                                                      15.   Press the ENTER key to acknowledge the stability control
                                                                            is turned off. The analyzer should read:
4-84                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                             SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  16.   If the main boom angle sensors are calibrated and oper-      Installation
        ating properly, the control system will now allow main
        lift up/down below main boom angles of +65°.                     1. Using an adequate lifting device, position the main lift
                                                                            cylinder in place on the machine.
  17.   Activate main lift and elevate the boom enough to gain
        access to remove the main lift cylinder.                     NOTE: The main lift cylinder weighs approximately 785 lbs. (356
                                                                           kg).
  18.   Use a crane or other suitable supporting device to sup-
        port the weight of the main boom assembly.                       2. Install the retaining bolt, keeper pin, and pivot pin
                                                                            securing the barrel end of the lift cylinder to the lower
NOTE: The main boom assembly weighs approximately 6500 lbs.
                                                                            link.
      (2950 kg).
NOTE: The main lift cylinder weighs approximately 785 lbs. (356
      kg).
  22.   At the rod end of the cylinder, remove the retaining bolt,
        keeper pin, and pivot pin securing the rod end of the lift
        cylinder to the boom.
3121171                                                                                                                          4-85
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4.28 MAIN BOOM TELESCOPE CYLINDER 8. The analyzer screen should read:
Removal
   1. Place the machine on a firm, level surface with the axles
      fully extended or the turntable centered between the
      rear wheels. The tower boom must also be fully lowered
      and retracted.
   2. Connect the JLG Control System Analyzer to the connec-
      tor at the ground control box.
   3. Start the engine.
   4. Position the Platform/Ground select switch to the
      Ground position.
4-86                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  11.   Scroll through the analyzer menu until SERVICE MODE is   13.   Press ENTER. The control system will perform several
        displayed. Press the ENTER key.                                tests to make sure the machine is in the proper position.
                                                                       If the axles are not extended or the turntable is not cen-
                                                                       tered between the rear wheels, the screen will read:
3121171                                                                                                                    4-87
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
        If the tower boom length sensors are calibrated and         15.   Enter code 69286. The analyzer will read:
        operating properly, the control system will verify the
        tower boom length is less than 6 in. (15.2 cm). If the
        tower boom is outside the length limit, the screen will
        read:
                                                                  WHEN THE STABILITY CONTROL IS OFF THE MACHINE WILL TIP IF USED
                                                                  INCORRECTLY.
  14.   When the machine passes all the configuration checks,
        the screen will read:
                                                                    16.   Press the ENTER key to acknowledge the stability control
                                                                          is turned off. The analyzer should read:
                                                                    17.   The control system will now allow main telescope using
                                                                          the telescope control switch on the ground console.
4-88                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  18.   Telescope the main boom out until the retaining pin at       23.   Remove the bolts securing the rear boom cover and
        the end of the telescope cylinder rod can be accessed.             remove the cover.
3121171                                                                                                                       4-89
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  27.   Support the upper link using a nylon strap or blocking.    Installation
        Remove the bolt, keeper, and pin securing the upper
        link to the base boom. Carefully lower the upper link      NOTE: The telescope cylinder weighs approximately 663 lbs. (300
        enough to allow the telescope cylinder to be removed.            kg).
4-90                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                     SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
   5. Install the shoulder screws, retaining rings, and pin       7. Install the rear boom cover and secure it in place with
      securing the end of the telescope cylinder. It may be          the retaining bolts.
      necessary to use the analyzer Service Mode to align the
      pin.
3121171                                                                                                                 4-91
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4.29 POWERTRACK MAINTENANCE                                3. Remove the screws from the flat bar on the other side of
                                                              the powertrack.
4-92                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                          SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
5. Slide the poly roller off of the round bar. 7. Slide the flat bar out.
6. Hold the round bar to remove the other screw. 8. Remove the snap ring from one side of the bracket.
9. Remove the snap ring from the other side of the bracket.
3121171                                                                                                    4-93
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  10.   Push down with slight pressure on the link and slide the   Two Piece Bracket Maintenance
        bracket side up and over the extrusion on the link.
                                                                    1. Loosen the screw.
4-94                                                                                                                 3121171
                                                                                    SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4. Hold the flat bar and remove the screws. 7. Slide the link out.
5. Remove the snap rings and pins. Snap Rings and Screws
   6. Remove the screws from the bar. Remove the snap ring
      and pin.                                                      LOOSE SCREW                        TIGHT SCREW
3121171                                                                                                              4-95
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
Make sure that all snap rings are closed and seated. A seated and closed snap ring is shown below.
CLOSED
OPEN
10-24 x 0.812 button torx socket head with blue locking patch:
 An open snap ring is shown below.                      • Tighten to 45-50 in.lbs. (5-5.6 Nm).
                                                        • Use T-25 torx bit.
                                                        • Do not reuse this screw. After removing replace with a new
                                                          one.
4-96                                                                                                        3121171
3121171
                                                                          0273361-G
4-97
                                                                                      SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                                                             LOCATE (2) TIES 1.0 ± 0.25” FROM EACH END
4-98
                                          DO NOT ROUTE LEVEL CYLINDER        EQUALLY DISTRIBUTE REMAINING (2) TIES
                                          HOSES OR RIGHT LEVEL SENSOR                               LOCATE END 1.0 ± 0.5
                                          HARNESS THROUGH HOSE GUIDE                                PAST HOSE LOOP AS SHOWN   ROUTE LEVEL CYLINDER HOSES
                                          ROD ON TOP OF PIVOT WELDMENT                                                        THROUGH TWO HOSE LOOPS INSIDE
                                                                                                             (1.000)
                                                                                                                              FLY BOOM, THROUGH THE PLASTIC
                                          JOIN RIGHT LEVEL SENSOR HARNESS                                                     INSERT, THROUGH THE HOSE LOOP
                                          WITH LEVEL CYLINDER HOSES HERE                                                      ON THE OUTSIDE OF THE FLY NOSE,
                                                                                                                              AND UP TO THE JIB ROTATOR PIVOT
                                                                             PLATFORM RETURN
                                                                            PLATFORM SUPPLY
                                                                          AC CABLE
                                                                         CONTROL CABLE
3121171
3121171
                                                                                                                               Table 4-1. Hose/Cable Pull Chart
                                                                                                                         LETTER                    DESCRIPTION                   DIM "Z"
                                                                                                                            J          LEVEL UP HOSE (PORT L1)             64"       162.5 cm
                                                                                                                            K          LEVEL DOWN HOSE (PORT L2)           64"       162.5 cm
                    Table 4-1. Hose/Cable Pull Chart                                                                        L          SWING RIGHT HOSE (PORT S1)          62"       157.5 cm
                                                                                                                           M           SWING LEFT HOSE (PORT S2)           62"       157.5 cm
           LETTER                        DESCRIPTION                     DIM "X"
                                                                                                                           N           JIB LIFT UP HOSE (PORT J1)          60"       152.5 cm
             A           BOOM CONTROL CABLE                        12"        30.5 cm
                                                                                                                           O           JIB LIFT DOWN HOSE (PORT J2)        60"       152.5 cm
             B           AC CABLE (10/3)                           12"        30.5 cm
                                                                                                                           P           PLATFORM SUPPLY (PORT P)            58"       147.5 cm
              C          HARNESS, DUAL CAPACITY SWITCHES (18/3)    72"         183 cm
                                                                                                                           Q           TANK (PORT T)                       55"       140.0 cm
             D           HARNESS, TRANSPORT POS. SWITCHES (18/3)   72"         183 cm
                                                                                                                        NOTE: ALL CABLE/HOSE LENGTHS TO BE ± 1" (2.5 cm)
              E          WELD LEAD (3/0 CABLE)(OPTIONAL)           12"        30.5 cm
              F          7500W GENERATOR (8/5 CABLE)(OPTIONAL)     12"        30.5 cm
             G           AIRLINE (8LOLA)(OPTIONAL)                 12"        30.5 cm
          NOTE: ALL CABLE/HOSE LENGTHS TO BE ± 1" (2.5 cm)
0273361-G
4-99
                                                                                                                                                                                                        SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
        Main Transport Switch #1                               Off Cam    Disagree   On Cam      On Cam     On Cam    Disagree   Off Cam      Off Cam       Disagree
        Main Transport Switch #2                               On Cam     Disagree   Off Cam     Off Cam    Off Cam   Disagree   On Cam       On Cam        Disagree
        Control System Conclusion of Main Transport Switches    A/D       Disagree    B/C         B/C        B/C      Disagree        A/D       A/D         Disagree
Control System Conclusion of Main Boom Length A A/B B B/C C C/D D Switch Fault Switch Fault
4-100                                                                                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                              SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  For proper hose routing and cable wrap placement and                  The platform specific valves are located in a manifold at the
  clamping, refer to Figure 4-32., Figure 4-33., Figure 4-34., Fig-     platform.
  ure 4-53., Figure 4-54., and Figure 4-55. It is important to peri-    There are individual proportional control valves that control
  odically inspect hoses, wraps and clamps for proper slack             each of the four platform functions; Platform Level, Platform
  adjustments and clamping integrity (pull check). Any                  Rotate, Jib Lift, and Jib Swing.
  changes as a result of inspection should be verified by per-
  forming full strokes of boom functions especially lift, tele-         There is also a Platform Dump Valve, located in the platform
  scope, jib, and platform rotate.                                      valve manifold, which is used to hydraulically isolate the con-
                                                                        trol valves and to improve hydraulic response.
4.31 ELECTRONIC PLATFORM LEVELING                                       The Ground Module controls this valve to provide manual
                                                                        platform leveling in the event that the Platform Module is
NOTE: For more detailed information concerning system adjust-
                                                                        inoperable.
      ment and operation, refer to Section 6 - JLG Control Sys-
      tem.                                                              In ground mode, the platform dump valve is turned on when-
                                                                        ever any platform or jib valve output is turned on. Whenever
Description                                                             all platform and jib valves are turned off, the platform dump
                                                                        valve is turned off.
  Electronic platform leveling replaces the conventional hydrau-
  lic method of platform leveling.                                      In platform mode, the platform dump valve is turned on
                                                                        whenever the footswitch is depressed.
  To control electronic platform leveling the platform is
  equipped with a pair of tilt sensors, one primary and one sec-       Normal Operation
  ondary, mounted to the non-rotating portion of the platform
  rotator. The tilt sensors are monitored regularly and the plat-       AUTOMATIC LEVELING
  form level up and down valves are automatically controlled to         Two tilt sensors, mounted on either side of the platform sup-
  maintain set point as the machine is operated.                        port, are used to measure the incline of the platform with
  PRIMARY AND SECONDARY TILT SENSOR INTERACTION                         respect to gravity and control the automatic leveling function,
                                                                        one is used as the primary sensor and one as a secondary
  The secondary tilt sensor is used as a backup to the primary tilt     backup sensor.
  sensor. Any time a tilt set point is reset, a value from each sen-
  sor shall be set.                                                     The level system shall assume a new fixed set point (fixed
                                                                        incline of the platform with respect to gravity) each time the
  If a fault occurs with the primary sensor, control will revert to     control system is powered up (cycling of the EMS).
  the secondary sensor. (This is discussed in more detail in the
  error response section.)                                              Automatic platform leveling only functions while operating
                                                                        drive, telescope, lift or swing. It does not operate while operat-
  Because of the mounting orientation of the tilt sensors, the          ing any other function (e.g. rotate, jib, or steer).
  primary tilt sensor will output ascending voltage values with
  increases in positive platform tilt angle. The backup or second-      The proportional control for these valves varies. This is depen-
  ary tilt sensor will output descending voltage values with            dant on the tilt variance from target as well as on the impact
  increases in positive platform angle.                                 coil temperature is having on the current to the valves.
                                                                        If a command from the Platform Level Up and Down toggle
                                                                        switch on either the platform or the ground is received, auto-
                                                                        matic platform leveling will cease and the appropriate output
                                                                        will be commanded to turn on.
                                                                        When the toggle switch is released, after ¼ second, the current
                                                                        filtered value of tilt angle will be taken as the new set point.
3121171                                                                                                                           4-101
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
 In order to obtain acceptable performance while performing         During the power-up procedure, function enable, in both Plat-
 all hydraulic functions, five sets of parameters are used. These   form and Ground Mode, is delayed during the 1.5 second
 “zones” allow compensation for differences in how the basket       startup lamp test. During this 1.5 second startup period, the
 level changes when doing different functions. These zones are      basket level up valve will be energized at 100% duty cycle for
 as follows:                                                        0.5 second, and then the basket level down valve energized at
                                                                    100% duty cycle for 0.5 second. This will help to keep the
   1. Lift up
                                                                    valves from sticking.
   2. Lift down
                                                                    PLATFORM LEVEL MANUAL OVERRIDE
   3. Other boom functions
                                                                    In addition to automatic leveling the operator is able to manu-
   4. Drive                                                         ally adjust the platform level position by means of the level
                                                                    override switches located at the platform and ground control
   5. Auxiliary                                                     positions (similar to a Master/Slave hydraulic system).
 The other boom functions zone includes Swing, Telescope, Jib       The level system assumes a new set point after a level over-
 swing (It is not necessary to level with jib lift, since the       ride switch is operated. In other words the operator can chose
 mechanical linkage keeps the basket level).                        a platform level incline other than level with gravity and the
 These zones are prioritized when multiple functions are active.    system will maintain this set point during automatic leveling.
 The priorities are as follows.
   1. Auxiliary power and any other function, zone = auxiliary
      power
   2. Drive and any other function, zone = Drive
   3. Lift up and any other function, zone = Lift up
   4. Lift down and any other function, zone = Lift down
   5. Other boom functions, zone = Other boom functions
4-102                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4.32 TOWER BOOM DRIFT TEST 5. While still in the DIAGNOSTICS/BOOM SENSORS menu
3121171                                                                                                                     4-103
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
JIB BOOM
4-104                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                                 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
3121171                                                                                                                             4-105
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4-106                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                     SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
3121171                                                                                                    4-107
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
If the pin will not come out with the “Easy Out”, use 5/1
4-108                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                   SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
   6. Remove the end cap (4) and set aside for later inspec-    8. Every actuator has timing marks for proper engage-
      tion.                                                        ment.
3121171                                                                                                             4-109
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  10.   Remove the shaft (2). It may be necessary to strike the       13.   At the point when the piston gear teeth come out of
        threaded end of the shaft with a rubber mallet.                     engagement with the housing gear teeth, mark the pis-
                                                                            ton and housing with a marker as shown.
  11.   Before removing the piston (3), mark the housing (1)
        ring gear in relation to the piston O.D. gear. There should   14.   Remove the o-ring (204) and backup ring (207) from end
        now be timing marks on the housing (1) ring gear, the               cap (4) and set aside for inspection.
        piston (3) and the shaft (2).
                                                                      15.   Remove the wear guides (302) from the end cap (4) and
  12.   To remove the piston (3) use a rubber mallet and a plas-            shaft (2).
        tic mandrel so the piston is not damaged.
4-110                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  16.   To remove the main pressure seals (205), it is easiest to   19.   Remove the piston O.D. seal (202).
        cut them using a sharp razor blade being careful not to
        damage the seal groove.
                                                                    20.   Remove the piston I.D. seal (200). You may now proceed
                                                                          to the inspection process.
  17.   Remove the thrust washers (304), from the end cap (4)
        and shaft (2).
  18.   Remove the wiper seal (304.1) from its groove in the end
        cap (4) and shaft (2).
3121171                                                                                                                  4-111
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                                                      Assembly
                                                                        1. Gather all the components and tools into one location
                                                                           prior to re-assembly. Use the cut away drawing to refer-
                                                                           ence the seal orientations.
   2. Inspect the thrust washers (304) for rough or worn
      edges and surfaces. Measure it’s thickness to make sure
      it is within specifications (Not less than 0.092” or 2.34
      mm).
4-112                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
   2. Install the thrust washer (304) onto shaft (2) and end cap     4. Using a seal tool install the main pressure seal (205) onto
      (4).                                                              shaft (2) and end cap (4). Use the seal tool in a circular
                                                                        motion.
   3. Install the wiper seal (304.1/green 0-ring) into it’s groove   5. Install the wear guide (302) on the end cap (4) and shaft
      on the shaft (2) and end cap (4) around the outside edge          (2).
      of the thrust washer (304).
                                                                     6. Install the inner T-seal (200) into the piston (3) using a
                                                                        circular motion.
3121171                                                                                                                     4-113
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
        Each T-seal has 2 backup rings (see drawing for orienta-     7. Insert the piston (3) into the housing (1) as shown, until
        tion).                                                          the outer piston seal (202) is touching inside the hous-
                                                                        ing bore.
        Beginning with the inner seal (200) insert one end of b/u
        ring in the lower groove and feed the rest in using a cir-   8. Looking from the angle shown, rotate the piston (3) until
        cular motion. Make sure the wedged ends overlap cor-            the marks you put on the piston and the housing (1)
        rectly.                                                         during disassembly line up as shown. Using a rubber
        Repeat this step for the outer seal (202).                      mallet, tap the piston into the housing up to the point
                                                                        where the gear teeth meet.
4-114                                                                                                                   3121171
                                                                                             SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
   9. Looking from the opposite end of the housing (1) you             11.   Looking from the view shown, use the existing timing
      can see if your timing marks are lining up. When they do,              marks to line up the gear teeth on the shaft (2) with the
      tap the piston (3) in until the gear teeth mesh together.              gear teeth on the inside of the piston (3). Now tap the
      Tap the piston into the housing the rest of the way until              flange end of the shaft with a rubber mallet until the
      it bottoms out.                                                        gear teeth engage.
  10.   Install the shaft (2) into the piston (3). Be careful not to   12.   Install 2 bolts in the threaded holes in the flange. Using a
        damage the seals. Do not engage the piston gear teeth                bar, rotate the shaft in a clockwise direction until the
        yet.                                                                 wear guides are seated inside the housing bore.
                                                                       13.   Install the stop tube onto the shaft end. Stop tube is an
                                                                             available option to limit the rotation of an actuator.
3121171                                                                                                                          4-115
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
  14.   Coat the threads on the end of the shaft with anti-seize    17.   Tighten the end cap (4). In most cases the original holes
        grease to prevent galling.                                        for the lock pins will line up.
                                                                    18.   Place the lock pins (109) provided in the Helac seal kit in
  15.   Install the 0-ring (204) and backup ring (207) into the
                                                                          the holes with the dimple side up. Then, using a punch,
        inner seal groove on the end cap (4).
                                                                          tap the lock pins to the bottom of the hole.
  16.    Thread the end cap (4) onto the shaft (2) end. Make sure
        the wear guide stays in place on the end cap as it is       19.   Insert the set screws (113) over the lock pins. Tighten
        threaded into the housing (1).                                    them to 25 in. lbs. (2.825 Nm).
4-116                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
3121171                                                                                                                      4-117
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4-118                                                                      3121171
                                                                                                 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
Bleeding After Installation                                                  1. Connect a 5 foot (1.5 m) long 3/16" inside diameter, 5/
                                                                                16" outside diameter clear vinyl drain tube to each of
NOTE: Bleeding will be necessary if excessive backlash is displayed             the two bleeder valves. Secure the tubes in place with
      after the actuator is installed. To do this, bleeder valves               hose clamps.
      must be installed in the actuator at the locations shown
                                                                             2. Place the end of the tubes in a clean 5 gallon (19 L) con-
      below. The following steps are recommended when a mini-
                                                                                tainer to collect the purged oil. The oil can be returned
      mum of two gallons (8 liters) is purged.
                                                                                to the reservoir when the procedure is complete.
                                                                             3. Open both bleeder valves 1/4 turn. Using the hydraulic
                                                                                system, rotate the platform to the end of rotation and
                                                                                maintain hydraulic pressure. Oil with small air bubbles
                                                                                should be seen flowing through the tubes. Allow 1/2
                                                                                gallon (2 L) of oil to be purged from the actuator.
                                                                             4. Keep the bleeder valves open and rotate the platform in
                                                                                the opposite direction to the end of rotation. Maintain
                                                                                hydraulic pressure until an additional 1/2 gallon (2 L) of
                                                                                oil is pumped out.
                                                                             5. Repeat steps 3 and 4. After the last 1/2 gallon (2 L) of oil
                                                                                is purged, close both bleed nipples before rotating away
                                                                                from the end of rotation.
3121171                                                                                                                             4-119
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
4.34 BOLT-ON EXTERNAL FALL ARREST                                     • Cable: Inspect cable for proper tension, broken strands,
                                                                        kinks, or any signs of corrosion.
  The bolt-on external fall arrest system is designed to provide a
  lanyard attach point while allowing the operator to access                                     GAP
                                                                                                  GAPSHOWING:
                                                                                                       SHOWING:
  areas outside the platform. Exit/Enter the platform through                                     INCORRECT
                                                                                                 INCORRECT
  the gate area only. The system is designed for use by one per-
  son.
  Personnel must use fall protection at all times. A full body har-
  ness is required with lanyard not to exceed 6 ft. (1.8 M) in
  length, that limits the maximum arrest force to 900 lbs. (408
  kg).                                                                                            NO GAP:
                                                                                                 NO GAP: CORRECT
                                                                                                  CORRECT
  Bolt-on external fall arrest system capacity is 310 lb (140 kg) -
  one (1) person maximum.
                                                                      • Fittings & Brackets: Ensure all fittings are tight and there are
                                                                        no signs of fractures. Inspect brackets for any damage.
IF THE BOLT-ON EXTERNAL FALL ARREST SYSTEM IS USED TO ARREST A FALL   • Attachment Ring: No cracks or signs of wear are accept-
OR IS OTHERWISE DAMAGED, THE ENTIRE SYSTEM MUST BE REPLACED AND         able. Any signs of corrosion requires replacement.
THE PLATFORM FULLY INSPECTED BEFORE RETURNING TO SERVICE. REFER TO
                                                                      • Attaching Hardware: Inspect all attaching hardware to
THE SERVICE MANUAL FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION PROCEDURES.
                                                                        ensure there are no missing components and hardware is
THE BOLT-ON EXTERNAL FALL ARREST SYSTEM REQUIRES AN ANNUAL INSPEC-      properly tightened.
TION AND CERTIFICATION. THE ANNUAL INSPECTION AND CERTIFICATION
                                                                      • Platform Rails: No visible damage is acceptable.
MUST BE PERFORMED BY A QUALIFIED PERSON OTHER THAN THE USER.
4-120                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                               SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
Installation                                                                  nuts onto the cable finger tight so the mark on the cable
                                                                              does not move.
   1. Install the retaining hardware (bolts, nuts, and washers)
      and secure the brackets to the platform rail. Tighten the                       WASHER
      nuts but do not torque them yet.                                                            BELLEVILLE
                                                                                NUT               WASHER
                                  BOLT
WASHER
JAM NUT
                                                                          5. Use the two jam nuts to prevent the cable from rotating
                                                                             while the nut is tightened. Tighten the nut until the bel-
                                                                             leville washers are fully compressed and no gap is pres-
                                                                             ent at the outside diameter of the washers. Ensure the
                                   WASHER                                    cable has not rotated during tightening.
                                  NUT
                                    BOLT
                                                         NUT
3121171                                                                                                                         4-121
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
                                          7
                  1,2,3,4
                        1.   Belleville Washer
                        2.   Washer
                        3.   Hex Nut
                        4.   Jam Nut
                        5.   LH Bracket
                        6.   Attachment Ring                                    8
                        7.   Cable
                        8.   RH Bracket
                        9.   Decal
MAE38500
4-122                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                            SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
     Consult the following illustrations to determine which type        1. Operate the telescope out function, then activate Sky-
     of SkyGuard the machine is equipped with. Regardless of               Guard sensor.
     the type, SkyGuard function according to the SkyGuard              2. Once sensor has been activated, ensure telescope out
     Function Table does not change.                                       function stops then telescope in function operates for a
                                                                           short duration. Additionally, verify Soft Touch/SkyGuard
                                                                           indicator light flashes and horn sounds. If machine is
                                                                           equipped with SkyGuard beacon, ensure it flashes when
                                                                           sensor activates.
                                                                        3. With SkyGuard sensor still engaged, press and hold yel-
                                                                           low Soft Touch/SkyGuard override button. Operate a
                                                                           function to verify operation can be resumed.
                                                                        4. Disengage SkyGuard sensor, release controls, and recy-
                                                                           cle footswitch. Ensure normal operation available.
                                           0"$
                                                                      In Ground Mode:
                           SkyGuard
                                                                        1. Operation is allowed regardless of SkyGuard activation.
                                                0"$
                                                                      In Ground Mode:
                      SkyGuard SkyEye™                                  1. Operation is allowed regardless of SkyGuard activation.
3121171                                                                                                                        4-123
 SECTION 4 - BOOM & PLATFORM
 SOFT TOUCH ONLY                                                                                    Engage the SkyGuard sensor and observe the Analyzer to
 If Soft Touch only is selected in machine setup                                                    determine if the switch/relay closes.
 (refer to Table 6-2), machine will treat the Soft Touch/SkyGuard
                                                                                                    If the status of the switch/relay remains OPEN while the Sky-
 override switch as if it is a Soft Touch switch.
                                                                                                    Guard sensor is actively engaged, it is possible the sensor has
                                                                                                    failed and should be replaced immediately.
 SKYGUARD NOT SELECTED IN MACHINE SETUP
 If the SkyGuard system is installed on the machine, but no                                         If the status of the switch/relay remains CLOSED while the Sky-
 option is selected in the machine setup (refer to Table 6-2),                                      Guard sensor is actively engaged, a power or ground wire may
 SkyGuard sensor status will be ignored. No function cutout or                                      not be making good contact or may be loose or broken. Addi-
 reversal will be implemented.                                                                      tionally, there is a low probability that both relays may have
                                                                                                    failed.
Diagnostics & Troubleshooting
                                                                                                    If the switch/relay status is in disagreement, then one may
 If SkyGuard does not function when the sensor is engaged,                                          have failed or is not installed correctly. In this case, the
 first verify the configuration under the                                                           machine will be inoperable.
 MACHINE SETUP: SKYGUARD OPTION menu using the hand-
 held Analyzer. Ensure the selected configuration matches the                                       FAULT CODES
 actual system installed on the machine. If not, select the cor-                                    Refer to Table 6-11 for more fault code information
 rect configuration, then verify operation.
                                                                                                        • 0039 - SkyGuard switch activation fault
 Additionally, use the handheld analyzer to navigate to the                                             • 2563 - switch disagreement fault
 DIAGNOSTICS: FEATURES  SKYGUARD INPUTS menu to
 determine additional SkyGuard fault information.
4-124                                                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                       SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
      1. Hold the fitting in one hand while using the brush with
         the other hand to dip into the container. Remove excess
         hydraulic oil from the brush so an even film of oil is
         applied on the o-ring.
3121171                                                                                                                               5-1
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                        Brush-on Method
                                                                         This method requires a sealed bottle brush.
5-2                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                             SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5.2 HYDRAULIC CONNECTION ASSEMBLY AND SAE = 45° flare per SAE J512
    TORQUE SPECIFICATION
Tapered Thread Types
 NPTF = national tapered fuel (Dry Seal) per SAE J476/J512
                    60°
                                             30°                                     Figure 5-4. SAE Thread
                        55°
                                                                                  Figure 5-5. ORFS Thread
                                                                  MBTL = metric flareless bite type fitting, pressure rating L
                                                                  (medium) per ISO 8434, DIN 2353
                                                                  MBTS = metric flareless bite type fitting, pressure rating S
                                                                  (high) per ISO 8434, DIN 2353
                                         Thread
                                          O.D.
Straight Thread Types, Tube and Hose Connections BH = bulkhead connection – JIC, ORFS, MBTL, or MBTS types
3121171                                                                                                                   5-3
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                   Tightening Methods
                                                                    Torque = Application of a twisting force to the applicable con-
                Figure 5-8. ORB-MPP Thread                          nection by use of a precise measurement instrument (i.e.
                                                                    torque wrench).
 MFF = metric flat face port per ISO 9974-1
                                                                    Finger Tight = The point where the connector will no longer
 BSPP = British standard parallel pipe per ISO 1179-1, DIN 3852-    thread onto the mating part when tightened by hand or fin-
 2                                                                  gers. Finger Tight is relative to user strength and will have
                                                                    some variance. The average torque applied by this method is 3
                                                                    ft-lbs [4 N-m] Also referred to as ‘Hand Tight.’
                                                                    TFFT = Turns From Finger Tight; Application of a preload to a
                                                                    connection by first tightening the connection by hand (fin-
                                                                    gers) and applying an additional rotation counted by a
                                                                    defined number of turns by use of a tool.
                                                                    FFWR = Flats from Wrench Resistance; Application of a pre-
                                                                    load to a connection by tightening to the point of initial
                                                                    wrench resistance and turning the nut a described number of
                                                                    ‘flats’. A ‘flat’ is one side of the hexagonal tube nut and
                                                                    equates to 1/6 of a turn. Also referred to as the ‘Flats Method.’
5-4                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                  SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Assembly And Torque Specifications                                      4. Take care to identify the material of parts to apply the
                                                                           correct torque values.
 Prior to selecting the appropriate torque from the tables
 within this section, it is necessary to properly identify the con-          a. Verify the material designation in the table head-
 nector being installed. Refer to the Figures and Tables in this                ings.
 section.                                                                    b. If specifications are given only for steel fittings and
                                                                                components, the values for alternate materials shall
 GENERAL TUBE TYPE FITTING ASSEMBLY                                             be as follows: Aluminum and Brass- reduce steel val-
 INSTRUCTIONS                                                                   ues by 35%; Stainless Steel- Use the upper limit for
                                                                                steel.
   1. Take precautions to ensure that fittings and mating
      components are not damaged during storage, handling               5. To achieve the specified torque, the torque wrench is to
      or assembly. Nicks and scratches in sealing surfaces can             be held perpendicular to the axis of rotation.
      create a path for leaks which could lead to component
      contamination and/or failure.
   2. When making a connection to tubing, compression or
      flare, inspect the tube in the area of the fitting attach-
      ment to ensure that the tube has not been damaged.
   3. The assembly process is one of the leading causes for
      contamination in air and hydraulic systems. Contamina-
      tion can prevent proper tightening of fittings and adapt-
      ers from occurring.
        a. Avoid using dirty or oily rags when handling fittings.
        b. If fittings are disassembled, they should be cleaned
           and inspected for damage. Replace fittings as nec-
           essary before re-installing.
        c. Sealing compounds should be applied where speci-                       Figure 5-11. Torque Wrench Angle
           fied; however, care should be taken not to introduce
           sealant into the system.                                     6. Refer to the appropriate section in this manual for more
        d. Avoid applying sealant to the area of the threads               specific instructions and procedures for each type of fit-
           where the sealant will be forced into the system.               ting connection
           This is generally the first two threads of a fitting.
        e. Sealant should only be applied to the male threads.
        f. Straight thread fittings do not require sealants. O-
           rings or washers are provided for sealing.
        g. When replacing or installing an O-ring, care is to be
           taken while transferring the O-ring over the threads
           as it may become nicked or torn. When replacing an
           O-ring on a fitting, the use of a thread protector is
           recommended.
        h. When installing fittings with O-rings, lubrication
           shall be used to prevent scuffing or tearing of the O-
           ring. See O-ring Installation (Replacement) in this
           section.
3121171                                                                                                                           5-5
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Assembly Instructions for American Standard Pipe                                                             NEVER BACK OFF (LOOSEN) PIPE THREADED CONNECTORS TO ACHIEVE ALIGN-
                                                                                                             MENT. MEET THE MINIMUM REQUIRED TURNS AND USE THE LAST TURN FOR
Thread Tapered (NPTF) Connections.                                                                           ALIGNMENT.
      1. Inspect components to ensure male and female port
                                                                                                                 5. Rotate male fitting the number of turns per Table 5-1,
         threads are free of rust, splits, dirt, foreign matter, or
                                                                                                                    NPTF Pipe Thread. See FFWR and TFFT Methods for TFFT
         burrs.
                                                                                                                    procedure requirements.
      2. Apply a suitable thread sealant, such as Loctite 567, to
         the male pipe threads if not already applied. Ensure the                                            NOTE: TFFT values provided in Table 5-1, NPTF Pipe Thread are
         first 1 to 2 threads are uncovered to prevent system con-                                                 applicable for the following material configurations:
         tamination.                                                                                                    • STEEL fittings with STEEL mating components
      3. Assemble connection hand tight.                                                                                • STEEL fittings with ALUMINUM or BRASS mating com-
      4. Mark fittings, male and female.                                                                                  ponents
                                                                                                                        • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with STEEL mating com-
                                                                                                                          ponents
OVER TIGHTENING MAY CAUSE DEFORMATION OF THE PIPE FITTING AND                                                           • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with ALUMINUM or
DAMAGE TO THE JOINING FITTING, FLANGE OR COMPONENT MAY OCCUR.                                                             BRASS mating components.
                                                                              TYPE/FITTING IDENTIFICATION
                                                                                                                                                  Turns From Finger
                                                                                          Thread Size                       ØA*
                           Material                                   Dash Size                                                                     Tight (TFFT)**
                                                                                             (UNF)               (in)                (mm)
                                                                         2                  1/8 - 27             0.40                 10.24             2 to 3
                            STEEL, ALUMINUM, OR BRASS FITTINGS WITH
                              STEEL, ALUMINUM, OR BRASS MATING C
5-6                                                                                                                                                                   3121171
                                                                                                     SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Assembly Instructions for British Standard Pipe                                                              5. Rotate male fitting the number of turns per Table 5-2,
                                                                                                                BSPT Pipe Thread. See FFWR and TFFT Methods for TFFT
Thread Tapered (BSPT) Connections                                                                               procedure requirements.
    1. Inspect components to ensure male and female port                                                 NOTE: TFFT values provided in Table 5-2, BSPT Pipe Thread are
       threads are free of rust, splits, dirt, foreign matter, or                                              applicable for the following material configurations:
       burrs.
                                                                                                                   • STEEL fittings with STEEL mating components
    2. Apply a suitable thread sealant, such as Loctite 567, to
       the male pipe threads if not already applied. Ensure the                                                    • STEEL fittings with ALUMINUM or BRASS mating com-
       first 1 to 2 threads are uncovered to prevent system con-                                                     ponents
       tamination.                                                                                                 • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with STEEL mating com-
    3. Assemble connection hand tight.                                                                               ponents
                                                                                                                   • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with ALUMINUM or
    4. Mark fittings, male and female.
                                                                                                                     BRASS mating components.
                                                                             TYPE/FITTING IDENTIFICATION
                                                                                                                                 Turns From
                                                                                        Thread Size                ØA*           Finger Tight
                               MATERIAL                                  Dash Size                                                 (TFFT)**
                                                                                          (BSPT)            (in)         (mm)
                                                                            2             1/8 - 28         0.38          9.73        2 to 3
                               STEEL, ALUMINUM, OR BRASS FITTINGS WITH
3121171                                                                                                                                                            5-7
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Assembly Instructions for 37° (JIC) Flare Fittings                          3. Torque assembly to value listed in Table Table 5-3, 37°
                                                                               Flare (JIC)Thread - Steel or Table 5-4, 37° Flare
      1. Inspect the flare for obvious visual squareness and con-              (JIC)Thread - Aluminum/Brass while using the Double
         centricity issues with the tube OD. Ensure surface is                 Wrench Method per Double Wrench Method. Refer to
         smooth, free of rust, weld and brazing splatter, splits,              FFWR and TFFT Methods for procedure requirements if
         dirt, foreign matter, or burrs. If necessary replace fitting          using the FFWR method.
         or adapter.
                                                                        NOTE: Torque values provided in Table Table 5-3, 37° Flare
                                                                              (JIC)Thread - Steel and Table 5-4, 37° Flare (JIC)Thread -
                                                                              Aluminum/Brass are segregated based on the material
DO NOT FORCE A MISALIGNED OR SHORT HOSE/TUBE INTO ALIGNMENT. IT               configuration of the connection.
PUTS UNDESIRABLE STRAIN ONTO THE JOINT EVENTUALLY LEADING TO LEAK-
AGE.                                                                      ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR ALUMINUM/BRASS MATING
                                                                          COMPONENTS’ indicate either the following material configu-
      2. Align tube to fitting and start threads by hand.                 rations:
                                                                               • STEEL fittings with ALUMINUM or BRASS mating com-
                                                                                 ponents
THE TORQUE METHOD SHOULD NOT BE USED ON LUBRICATED OR OILY FIT-                • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with STEEL mating com-
TINGS. NO LUBRICATION OR SEALANT IS REQUIRED. THE LUBRICATION                    ponents
WOULD CAUSE INCREASED CLAMPING FORCE AND CAUSE FITTING DAMAGE.
                                                                               • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with ALUMINUM or
                                                                                 BRASS mating components.
5-8                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                                                   SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Thread OD
                                                                                                             A
                                                                                                                                                         B
37°
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                  5-9
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Thread OD
                                                                                                                A
                                                                                                                                                             B
37°
5-10                                                                                                                                                                              3121171
                       SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                           5-11
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Assembly Instructions for 45° SAE Flare Fittings                        Torque fitting to value listed in Table 5-5, 45° Flare (SAE) - Steel
                                                                        and Table 5-6, 45° Flare (SAE) - Aluminum/Brass while using
    1. Inspect the flare for obvious visual squareness and con-         the Double Wrench Method outlined in this section. Refer to
       centricity issues with the tube OD. Ensure surface is            FFWR and TFFT Methods for procedure requirements if using
       smooth, free of rust, weld and brazing splatter, splits,         the TFFT method.
       dirt, foreign matter, or burrs. If necessary replace fitting
       or adapter.                                                    NOTE: Torque values provided in Table 5-5, 45° Flare (SAE) - Steel
                                                                            and Table 5-6, 45° Flare (SAE) - Aluminum/Brass are segre-
                                                                            gated based on the material configuration of the connec-
                                                                            tion.
DO NOT FORCE A MISALIGNED OR SHORT HOSE/TUBE INTO ALIGNMENT. IT
PUTS UNDESIRABLE STRAIN ONTO THE JOINT EVENTUALLY LEADING TO LEAK-      ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR ALUMINUM/BRASS MATING
AGE.                                                                    COMPONENTS’ indicate either the following material configu-
                                                                        rations:
    2. Align tube to fitting.                                                • STEEL fittings with ALUMINUM or BRASS mating com-
    3. Tighten fitting by hand until hand tight.                               ponents
                                                                             • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with STEEL mating com-
                                                                               ponents
THE TORQUE METHOD SHOULD NOT BE USED ON LUBRICATED OR OILY FIT-              • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with ALUMINUM or
TINGS. NO LUBRICATION OR SEALANT IS REQUIRED. THE LUBRICATION                  BRASS
WOULD CAUSE INCREASED CLAMPING FORCE AND CAUSE FITTING DAMAGE.
                                                                        mating components.
5-12                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                    SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                                                                                                 5-13
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Assembly Instructions for O-Ring Face Seal (ORFS)                                                       5. Torque nut to value listed in Table 5-7, O-ring Face Seal
                                                                                                           (ORFS) - Steel or Table 5-8, O-ring Face Seal (ORFS) - Alu-
Fittings                                                                                                   minum/Brass while using the Double Wrench Method.
                                                                                                           Refer to FFWR and TFFT Methods for procedure require-
           1. Ensure proper O-ring is installed. If O-ring is missing
                                                                                                           ments if using the FFWR method.
              install per O-ring Installation (Replacement).
           2. Ensure surface is smooth, free of rust, weld and brazing                            NOTE: Torque values provided in Table 5-7, O-ring Face Seal
              splatter, splits, dirt, foreign matter, or burrs. If necessary                            (ORFS) - Steel and Table 5-8, O-ring Face Seal (ORFS) - Alu-
              replace fitting or adapter.                                                               minum/Brass are segregated based on the material config-
                                                                                                        uration of the connection.
                                                                                                                                                      Tube
                            Dash Size                                                                                                                           Hose
                                            (UNF)      (in)     (mm)        (in)         (mm)    Min       Nom      Max        Min   Nom     Max      Nuts
                                                                                                                                                                Ends
                               4           9/16-18     0.51         13.00   0.56         14.20   18         19      20         25     26      27    1/4 to 1/2 1/2 to 3/4
                               6          11/16-16     0.63         15.90   0.69         17.50   30         32      33         40     43      45    1/4 to 1/2 1/2 to 3/4
 STEEL MATING COMPONENTS;
5-14                                                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                                        SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                                                                                                        5-15
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-16                                                                  3121171
                                                                                                                                                SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                                 28      M36 x 2     33.90      36.00   7.50       28.20          characteristics of the connection.          1.5 to 1.75
                                                                                                 35      M45 x 2     42.90      45.00   10.50      35.30                                                      1.5 to 1.75
                                                                                                                                                                    Refer to the specific procedure
                                                                                                 42      M52 x 2     49.90      52.00   11.00      42.30                         in the                       1.5 to 1.75
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                 5-17
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-18                                                                  3121171
                                                                                                      SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                  Thread Size
                           TYPE
                                                                         6         11/16-16      25           27           28              34    37      38
                                                                         8         13/16-16      55           58           61              75    79      83
                                                                         10          1-14        85           90           94              115   122     127
                                                                         12        1 3/16-12     135         142          149              183   193     202
                                                                         14        1 5/16-12     170         179          187              230   243     254
                                                                         16        1 7/16-12     200         210          220              271   285     298
                                                                         20       1 11/16-12     245         258          270              332   350     366
                                                                                                                                  Torque
                                                                                  Thread Size
     STEEL FITTINGS
TYPE
                                                                         6          9/16-18      25           27           28              34    37      38
                                                                         8          3/4-16       50           53           55              68    72      75
                                                                         10         7/8-14       85           90           94              115   122     127
                                                                         12        1 1/16-12     135         142          149              183   193     202
                                                                         14        1 3/16-12     170         179          187              230   243     254
                                                                         16        1 5/16-12     200         210          220              271   285     298
                                                                         20        1 5/8-12      245         258          270              332   350     366
                                                                         24        1 7/8-12      270         284          297              366   385     403
                                                                         32        2 1/2-12      310         326          341              420   442     462
3121171                                                                                                                                                        5-19
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                        Connecting                                                       Torque
                                                                                                      Thread M Size
   MATERIAL                   TYPE                                                       Tube O.D.                                [Ft-Lb]                               [N-m]
                                                                                          (mm)           (metric)      Min         Nom          Max               Min   Nom     Max
                                                                                            6           M12 x 1.5      14           15             16             19     20      22
                                                                                            8           M14 x 1.5      17           18             19             23     24      26
                           DIN 24° CONE FLARELESS BITE
                            (MBTL) BULKHEAD FITTING
                                                                                            10          M16 x 1.5      22           23             24             30     31      33
                                                                                            12          M18 x 1.5      35           37             39             47     50      53
                                                                                            15          M22 x 1.5      44           47             50             60     64      68
                                                                                            18          M26 x 1.5      70           75             80             95     102    108
                                                                                            22           M30 x 2       115         120             125            156    163    169
                                                                                            28           M36 x 2       150         157             164            203    213    222
                                                                                            35           M45 x 2       155         162             169            210    220    229
                                                                                            42           M52 x 2       220         230             240            298    312    325
       STEEL FITTINGS
                                                                                        Connecting                                                       Torque
                                  DIN 24° CONE FLARELESS BITE (MBTS) BULKHEAD FITTING
                                                                                                      Thread M Size
                                                                                         Tube O.D.                                [Ft-Lb]                               [N-m]
                                                                                          (mm)           (metric)      Min         Nom          Max               Min   Nom     Max
                                                                                            6           M14 x 1.5      17           15             16             23     20      22
                                                                                            8           M16 x 1.5      22           18             19             30     24      26
                                                                                            10          M18 x 1.5      35           23             24             47     31      33
                                                                                            12          M20 x 1.5      40           35             37             54     47      50
                                                                                            14          M22 x 1.5      44           47             50             60     64      68
                                                                                            16          M24 x 1.5      70           75             80             95     102    108
                                                                                            20           M30 x 2       115         120             125            156    163    169
                                                                                            25           M36 x 2       150         157             164            203    213    222
                                                                                            30           M42 x 2       155         162             169            210    220    229
                                                                                            38           M52 x 2       220         230             240            298    312    325
5-20                                                                                                                                                                            3121171
                       SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                           5-21
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Assembly Instructions for O-Ring Boss (ORB)                              6. Torque the fitting or nut to value listed in Table 5-12 thru
                                                                            Table 5-17 while using the Double Wrench Method.
Fittings
                                                                              a. The table headings identify the straight thread O-
    1. Inspect components to ensure that male and female                         ring port and the type on the other side of the fit-
       port threads are free of rust, splits, dirt, foreign matter, or           ting. The torque will be applied to the straight
       burrs.                                                                    thread O-ring port.
    2. Ensure proper O-ring is installed. If O-ring is missing                b. Torque values provided in Table 5-12 thru Table 5-17
       install per O-ring Installation (Replacement).                            are segregated based on the material configuration
                                                                                 of the connection. ‘ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR
                                                                                 ALUMINUM/BRASS MATING COMPONENTS’ indi-
                                                                                 cate either the following material configurations:
CARE TO BE TAKEN WHEN LUBRICATING O-RING. AVOID ADDING OIL TO THE
                                                                            • STEEL fittings with ALUMINUM or BRASS mating com-
THREADED CONNECTION OF THE FITTING. THE LUBRICATION WOULD CAUSE
                                                                              ponents
INCREASED CLAMPING FORCE AND CAUSE FITTING DAMAGE.
                                                                            • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with STEEL mating com-
    3. Pre-lubricate the O-ring with Hydraulic Oil.                           ponents
    4. For Non-Adjustable and Plugs, thread the fitting by                  • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with ALUMINUM or
       hand until contact.                                                    BRASS mating components.
    5. For Adjustable fittings, refer to Adjustable Stud End             7. Inspect to ensure the O-ring is not pinched and the
       Assembly for proper assembly.                                        washer is seated flat on the counter bore of the port.
5-22                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                                                           SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                  5-23
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                                                                                  STUD ENDS
                                                         TYPE/FITTING IDENTIFICATION
                                                                                                                               with (ORFS) or S series DIN (MBTS) opposite end
                                                              Thread Size                  ØA*                                                     Torque
   MATERIAL                                      Dash Size
                                                                 (UNF)            (in)           (mm)        Min             Nom             Max            Min           Nom    Max
                                                    2           5/16-24           0.31           7.93         --               --             --            --             --    --
                                                    3            3/8-24           0.37           9.52         --               --             --            --             --    --
                                                    4           7/16-20           0.44           11.11        26              27              28            35             37    38
     COMPONENTS; UN-LUBRICATED THREADS
       STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
5-24                                                                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                                           SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                  5-25
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-26                                                                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                                           SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                                                                                                                    5-27
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-28                                                                                                                                                                                            3121171
                       SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                           5-29
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Assembly Instructions for Adjustable Port End                         6. Torque the fitting or nut to value listed in Table 5-18,
                                                                         Table 5-19, Table 5-20, Table 5-21, Table 5-22, or Table 5-
Metric (MFF) Fittings                                                    23 while using the Double Wrench Method.
    1. Inspect components to ensure that male and female                   a. The table headings identify the Metric port and the
       threads and surfaces are free of rust, splits, dirt, foreign           type on the other side of the fitting. The torque will
       matter, or burrs.                                                      be applied to the Metric port.
    2. If O-ring is not pre-installed, install proper size, taking         b. Torque values provided in Table 5-18, Table 5-19,
       care not to damage it. See O-ring Installation (Replace-               Table 5-20, Table 5-21, Table 5-22, and Table 5-23
       ment) for instructions.                                                are segregated based on the material configuration
                                                                              of the connection. ‘ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR
                                                                              ALUMINUM/BRASS MATING COMPONENTS’ indi-
                                                                              cate either the following material configurations:
CARE TO BE TAKEN WHEN LUBRICATING O-RING. AVOID ADDING OIL TO THE
                                                                         • STEEL fittings with ALUMINUM or BRASS mating com-
THREADED CONNECTION OF THE FITTING. THE LUBRICATION WOULD CAUSE
                                                                           ponents
INCREASED CLAMPING FORCE AND CAUSE FITTING DAMAGE.
                                                                         • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with STEEL mating com-
    3. Pre-lubricate the O-ring with Hydraulic Oil.                        ponents
    4. For Non-Adjustable Fittings and Plugs, thread the fitting         • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with ALUMINUM or
       by hand until contact.                                              BRASS mating components.
    5. For Adjustable fittings, refer to Adjustable Stud End          7. Inspect to ensure the O-ring is not pinched and the
       Assembly for proper assembly.                                     washer is seated flat on the counter bore of the port.
5-30                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                                                  SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                              M12x1.5        8        15         16          17             20       22          23    22         23          24             30       31          33
    STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
                                              M14x1.5        10       26         28          29             35       38          39    33         35          36             45       47          49
                                              M16x1.5        12       33         35          36             45       47          49    48         51          53             65       69          72
                                              M18x1.5        15       41         43          45             55       58          61    59         62          65             80       84          88
                                              M22x1.5        18       48         51          53             65       69          72    103        108         113            140      146         153
                                               M27x2         22       66         70          73             90       95          99    140        147         154            190      199         209
                                               M33x2         28       111        117         122            150      159         165   251        264         276            340      358         374
                                               M42x2         35       177        186         195            240      252         264   369        388         406            500      526         550
                                               M48x2         42       214        225         235            290      305         319   465        489         512            630      663         694
                                              M12x1.5        8        10         11          11             14       15          15    14         15          16             19       20          22
                                              M14x1.5        10       17         18          19             23       24          26    21         22          23             28       30          31
                                              M16x1.5        12       21         22          23             28       30          31    31         33          34             42       45          46
                                              M18x1.5        15       27         28          29             37       38          39    38         40          42             52       54          57
                                              M22x1.5        18       31         33          34             42       45          46    67         70          73             91       95          99
                                               M27x2         22       43         45          47             58       61          64    91         96          100            123      130         136
                                               M33x2         28       72         76          79             98       103         107   163        171         179            221      232         243
                                               M42x2         35       115        121         127            156      164         172   240        252         264            325      342         358
M48x2 42 139 146 153 188 198 207 302 318 332 409 431 450
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                           5-31
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                              M12x1.5        8        18         19          20             25       26          27    18         19          20             25       26          28
    STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
                                              M14x1.5        10       33         35          36             45       47          49    30         31          32             40       42          44
                                              M16x1.5        12       41         43          45             55       58          61    41         43          45             55       58          61
                                              M18x1.5        15       52         55          57             70       75          77    52         54          57             70       74          77
                                              M22x1.5        18       92         97          101            125      132         137   66         70          73             90       95          99
                                               M27x2         22       133        140         146            180      190         198   133        139         146            180      189         198
                                               M33x2         28       229        241         252            310      327         342   229        240         252            310      326         341
                                               M42x2         35       332        349         365            450      473         495   332        348         365            450      473         495
                                               M48x2         42       398        418         438            540      567         594   398        418         438            540      567         594
                                              M12x1.5        8        12         13          13             16       18          18    12         13          13             16       18          18
                                              M14x1.5        10       21         22          23             28       30          31    19         20          21             26       27          29
                                              M16x1.5        12       27         28          29             37       38          39    26         28          29             36       38          39
                                              M18x1.5        15       34         36          37             46       49          50    34         35          37             46       48          50
                                              M22x1.5        18       60         63          66             81       85          89    43         45          47             59       61          64
                                               M27x2         22       86         91          95             117      123         129   86         91          95             117      123         129
                                               M33x2         28       149        157         164            202      213         222   149        157         164            202      213         222
                                               M42x2         35       216        227         237            293      308         321   216        227         237            293      308         321
M48x2 42 259 272 285 351 369 386 259 272 285 351 369 386
5-32                                                                                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                                                       SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                     BANJO FITTINGS                            HIGH PRESSURE BANJO FITTINGS                    FORM E (EOLASTIC SEALING RING)
       TYPE/FITTING IDENTIFICATION
                                                                          with L series DIN (MBTL) opposite end             with L series DIN (MBTL) opposite end                   HOLLOW HEX PLUGS
                                             M12x1.5        8        26        28      29      35      38         39   33        35      36      45      47         49   18      19      20     25      26       27
   STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
                                             M14x1.5        10       37        39      41      50      53         56   41        43      45      55      58         61   26      28      29     35      38       39
                                             M16x1.5        12       44        46      48      60      62         65   59        62      65      80      84         88   41      43      45     55      58       61
                                             M18x1.5        15       59        62      65      80      84         88   74        78      81     100     106     110      48      51      53     65      69       72
                                             M22x1.5        18       89        94      98     120     127     133      103       108     113    140     146     153      66      70      73     90      95       99
                                             M27x2          22       96        101     106    130     137     144      236       248     260    320     336     353      100     105     110    135    142       149
                                             M33x2          28       --        --      --      --      --         --   266       280     293    360     380     397      166     175     183    225    237       248
                                             M42x2          35       --        --      --      --      --         --   398       418     438    540     567     594      266     280     293    360    380       397
                                             M48x2          42       --        --      --      --      --         --   516       542     568    700     735     770      266     280     293    360    380       397
                                             M12x1.5        8        17        18      19      23      24         26   21        22      23      28      30         31   12      13      13     16      18       18
                                             M14x1.5        10       24        26      27      33      35         37   27        28      29      37      38         39   17      18      19     23      24       26
                                             M16x1.5        12       29        30      31      39      41         42   38        40      42      52      54         57   27      28      29     37      38       39
                                             M18x1.5        15       38        40      42      52      54         57   48        51      53      65      69         72   31      33      34     42      45       46
                                             M22x1.5        18       58        61      64      79      83         87   67        70      73      91      95         99   43      45      47     58      61       64
                                             M27x2          22       62        66      69      84      89         94   153      161      169    207     218     229      65      69      72     88      94       98
                                             M33x2          28       --        --      --      --      --         --   173      182      190    235     247     258      108     114     119   146     155      161
                                             M42x2          35       --        --      --      --      --         --   259      272      285    351     369     386      173     182     190   235     247      258
                                             M48x2          42       --        --      --      --      --         --   335      352      369    454     477     500      173     182     190   235     247      258
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                         5-33
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                              M14x1.5        8        26        28          29             35      38         39    41        43          45            55       58         61
    STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
                                              M16x1.5        10       33        35          36             45      47         49    52        55          57            70       75         77
                                              M18x1.5        12       41        43          45             55      58         61    81        85          89            110      115        121
                                              M20x1.5        14       41        43          45             55      58         61    111       117        122            150      159        165
                                              M22x1.5        16       48        51          53             65      69         72    125       132        138            170      179        187
                                               M27x2         20       66        70          73             89      95         99    199       209        219            270      283        297
                                               M33x2         25       111       117         122            150     159        165   302       317        332            410      430        450
                                               M42x2         30       177       186         195            240     252        264   398       418        438            540      567        594
                                               M48x2         38       214       225         235            290     305        319   516       542        568            700      735        770
                                              M14x1.5        8        17        18          19             23      24         26    27        28          29            37       38         39
                                              M16x1.5        10       21        22          23             28      30         31    34        36          37            46       49         50
                                              M18x1.5        12       27        28          29             37      38         39    53        56          58            72       76         79
                                              M20x1.5        14       27        28          29             37      38         39    72        76          79            98       103        107
                                              M22x1.5        16       31        33          34             42      45         46    81        86          90            110      117        122
                                               M27x2         20       43        45          47             58      61         64    129       136        142            175      184        193
                                               M33x2         25       72        76          79             98      103        107   196       206        216            266      279        293
                                               M42x2         30       115       121         127            156     164        172   259       272        285            351      369        386
M48x2 38 139 146 153 188 198 207 335 352 369 454 477 500
5-34                                                                                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                                                 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                              M12x1.5        8        33        35          36             45       47        49     41         43         45            55     58         61
    STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
                                              M14x1.5        10       52        55          57             70       75        77     52         55         57            70     75         77
                                              M16x1.5        12       66        70          73             90       95        99     66         70         73            90     95         99
                                              M18x1.5        15       92        97          101            125      132       137    92         97        101            125    132       137
                                              M22x1.5        18       100       105        110             135      142       149    100       105        110            135    142       149
                                               M27x2         22       133       140         146            180      190       198    133       140        146            180    190       198
                                               M33x2         28       229       241         252            310      327       342    229       241        252            310    327       342
                                               M42x2         35       332       349         365            450      473       495    332       349        365            450    473       495
                                               M48x2         42       398       418         438            540      567       594    398       418        438            540    567       594
                                              M12x1.5        8        21        23          23             29       31        32     27         28         29            37     38         39
                                              M14x1.5        10       34        36          37             46       49        50     34         36         37            46     49         50
                                              M16x1.5        12       43        45          47             58       61        64     43         45         47            58     61         64
                                              M18x1.5        15       60        63          66             81       85        89     60         63         66            81     85         89
                                              M22x1.5        18       65        69          72             88       94        98     65         69         72            88     94         98
                                               M27x2         22       86        91          95             117      123       129    86         91         95            117    123       129
                                               M33x2         28       149       157         164            202      213       222    149       157        164            202    213       222
                                               M42x2         35       216       227         237            293      308       321    216       227        237            293    308       321
M48x2 42 259 272 285 351 369 386 259 272 285 351 369 386
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                   5-35
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                     BANJO FITTINGS                         HIGH PRESSURE BANJO FITTINGS                    FORM E (EOLASTIC SEALING RING)
       TYPE/FITTING IDENTIFICATION
                                                                          with S series DIN (MBTS) opposite end          with S series DIN (MBTS) opposite end                   HOLLOW HEX PLUGS
                                             M12x1.5        8        37        39      41      50      53     56       41      43      45     55      58     61       --       --     --     --      --      --
   STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
                                             M14x1.5        10       44        46      48      60      62     65       59      62      65     80      84         88   --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M16x1.5        12       59        62      65      80      84     88       74      78      81     100    106     110      --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M18x1.5        15       81        85      89     110     115     121      92      97      101    125    132     137      59      62      65     80      84      88
                                             M22x1.5        18       89        94      98     120     127     133      100    105      110    135    142     149      --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M27x2          22       100       105     110    135     142     149      236    248      260    320    336     353      --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M33x2          28       --        --      --      --      --         --   266    280      293    360    380     397      --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M42x2          35       --        --      --      --      --         --   398    418      438    540    567     594      --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M48x2          42       --        --      --      --      --         --   516    542      568    700    735     770      --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M12x1.5        8        24        26      27      33      35     37       27      28      29     37      38     39       --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M14x1.5        10       29        30      31      39      41     42       38      40      42     52      54     57       --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M16x1.5        12       38        40      42      52      54     57       48      51      53     65      69     72       --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M18x1.5        15       53        56      58      72      76     79       60      63      66     81      85     89       38      40      42     52     54       57
                                             M22x1.5        18       58        61      64      79      83     87       65      69      72     88      94     98       --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M27x2          22       65        69      72      88      94     98       153    161      169   207     218     229      --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M33x2          28       --        --      --      --      --         --   173    182      190   235     247     258      --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M42x2          35       --        --      --      --      --         --   259    272      285   351     369     386      --       --     --     --      --      --
                                             M48x2          42       --        --      --      --      --         --   335    352      369   454     477     500      --       --     --     --      --      --
5-36                                                                                                                                                                                                 3121171
                       SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                           5-37
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Assembly Instructions for Metric ISO 6149 (MPP)                       6. Torque the fitting or nut to value listed in Table 5-24
                                                                         while using the Double Wrench Method.
Port Assembly Stud Ends
                                                                          a. The table headings identify the Metric port and the
    1. Inspect components to ensure that male and female                     type on the other side of the fitting. The torque will
       threads and surfaces are free of rust, splits, dirt, foreign          be applied to the Metric port.
       matter, or burrs.                                                  b. Torque values provided in Table 5-24 are segregated
    2. If O-ring is not preinstalled, install proper size, taking            based on the material configuration of the connec-
       care not to damage it. See O-ring Installation (Replace-              tion. ‘ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR ALUMINUM/
       ment) for instructions.                                               BRASS MATING COMPONENTS’ indicate either the
                                                                             following material configurations:
                                                                         • STEEL fittings with ALUMINUM or BRASS mating com-
                                                                           ponents
CARE TO BE TAKEN WHEN LUBRICATING O-RING. AVOID ADDING OIL TO THE
THREADED CONNECTION OF THE FITTING. THE LUBRICATION WOULD CAUSE          • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with STEEL mating com-
INCREASED CLAMPING FORCE AND CAUSE FITTING DAMAGE.                         ponents
                                                                         • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with ALUMINUM or
    3. Pre-lubricate the O-ring with Hydraulic Oil.
                                                                           BRASS mating components.
    4. For Non-Adjustable Fittings and Plugs, thread the fitting
                                                                      7. Inspect to ensure the O-ring is not pinched and the
       by hand until contact.
                                                                         washer is seated flat on the counter bore of the port.
    5. For Adjustable fittings, refer to Adjustable Stud End
       Assembly for proper assembly.
5-38                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                                                          SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                    M12 x 1.5        8       18           19         20             25      26          27    26          28         29            35     38          39
                                                    M14 x 1.5       10       26           28         29             35      38          39    33          35         36            45     47          49
                                                    M16 x 1.5       12       30           32         33             40      43          45    41          43         45            55     58          61
             UN-LUBRICATED THREADS
                                                    M18 x 1.5       15       33           35         36             45      47          49    52          55         57            70     75          77
                                                    M20 x 1.5        --      --           --         --             --       --         --    59          62         65            80     84          88
                                                    M22 x 1.5       18       44           46         48             60      62          65    74          78         81            100    106         110
                                                     M27 x 2        22       74           78         81             100     106         110   125         132       138            170    179         187
                                                     M30 x 2         --      95           100        105            130     136         142   175         184       193            237    249         262
                                                     M33 x 2        25       120          126        132            160     171         179   230         242       253            310    328         343
                                                     M38 x 2         --      135          142        149            183     193         202   235         247       259            319    335         351
                                                     M42 x 2        30       155          163        171            210     221         232   245         258       270            330    350         366
                                                     M48 x 2        38       190          200        209            260     271         283   310         326       341            420    442         462
                                                     M60 x 2        50       230          242        253            315     328         343   370         389       407            500    527         552
                                                     M8 x 1          4        4            5          5             5        7           7     5           6         6              7      8           8
 ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR ALUMINUM/BRASS MATING
                                                     M10 x 1         6        7            8          8             9       11          11    10          11         11            14     15          15
                                                    M12 x 1.5        8       12           13         13             16      18          18    17          18         19            23     24          26
        COMPONENTS; UN-LUBRICATED THREADS
                                                    M14 x 1.5       10       17           18         19             23      24          26    21          22         23            28     30          31
                                                    M16 x 1.5       12       20           21         21             27      28          28    27          28         29            37     38          39
                                                    M18 x 1.5       15       21           22         23             28      30          31    34          36         37            46     49          50
                                                    M20 x 1.5        --      --           --         --             --       --         --    30          40         42            41     54          57
                                                    M22 x 1.5       18       29           30         31             39      41          42    48          51         53            65     69          72
                                                     M27 x 2        22       48           51         53             65      69          72    81          86         90            110    117         122
                                                     M30 x 2         --      62           65         68             84      88          92    114         120       125            155    163         169
                                                     M33 x 2        25       78           82         86             106     111         117   150         157       164            203    213         222
                                                     M38 x 2         --      88           93         97             119     126         132   153         161       168            207    218         228
                                                     M42 x 2        30       101          106        111            137     144         150   159         168       176            216    228         239
                                                     M48 x 2        38       124          130        136            168     176         184   202         212       222            274    287         301
                                                     M60 x 2        50       150          157        164            203     213         222   241         253       265            327    343         359
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                               5-39
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Assembly instructions for Adjustable Port End                         6. Torque the fitting or nut to value listed in Table 5-25,
                                                                         Table 5-26, Table 5-27, Table 5-28, Table 5-29, or Table 5-
(BSPP) Fittings                                                          30 while using the Double Wrench Method.
    1. Inspect components to ensure that male and female                   a. The table headings identify the BSPP port and the
       threads and surfaces are free of rust, splits, dirt, foreign           type on the other side of the fitting. The torque will
       matter, or burrs.                                                      be applied to the BSPP port.
    2. If O-ring is not preinstalled, install proper size, taking          b. Torque values provided in Table 5-25, Table 5-26,
       care not to damage it. See O-ring Installation (Replace-               Table 5-27, Table 5-28, Table 5-29, and Table 5-30 are
       ment) for instructions.                                                segregated based on the material configuration of
                                                                              the connection. ‘ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR
                                                                              ALUMINUM/BRASS MATING COMPONENTS’ indi-
                                                                              cate either the following material configurations:
CARE TO BE TAKEN WHEN LUBRICATING O-RING. AVOID ADDING OIL TO THE
                                                                         • STEEL fittings with ALUMINUM or BRASS mating com-
THREADED CONNECTION OF THE FITTING. THE LUBRICATION WOULD CAUSE
                                                                           ponents
INCREASED CLAMPING FORCE AND CAUSE FITTING DAMAGE.
                                                                         • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with STEEL mating com-
    3. Pre-lubricate the O-ring with Hydraulic Oil.                        ponents
    4. For Non-Adjustable Fittings and Plugs, thread the fitting         • ALUMINUM or BRASS fittings with ALUMINUM or
       by hand until contact.                                              BRASS mating components.
    5. For Adjustable fittings, refer to Adjustable Stud End          7. Inspect to ensure the O-ring is not pinched and the
       Assembly for proper assembly.                                     washer is seated flat on the counter bore of the port.
5-40                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                                                      SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Table 5-25. British Standard Parallel Pipe Port (BSPP) - L Series - Table 1 of 3
                                                G 1/4A        8           26         28          29             35       38          39    26         28          29             35       38          39
     STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
                                                G 1/4A        10          26         28          29             35       38          39    26         28          29             35       38          39
                                                G 3/8A        12          33         35          36             45       47          49    52         55          57             70       75          77
                                                G 1/2A        15          48         51          53             65       69          72    103        108         113            140      146         153
                                                G 1/2A        18          48         51          53             65       69          72    74         78          81             100      106         110
                                                G 3/4A        22          66         70          73             90       95          99    133        140         146            180      190         198
                                                 G 1A         28          111        117         122            150      159         165   243        255         267            330      346         362
                                               G 1-1/4A       35          177        186         195            240      252         264   398        418         438            540      567         594
                                               G 1-1/2A       42          214        225         235            290      305         319   465        489         512            630      663         694
                                                 BSPP                                                  Torque                                                           Torque
                                                          Connecting
                                               Thread G
 MATERIAL                                                  Tube O.D.               [Ft-Lb]                              [N-m]                       [Ft-Lb]                              [N-m]
                                                 Size
                                               (metric)     (mm)         Min        Nom         Max             Min     Nom          Max   Min       Nom         Max             Min     Nom          Max
                                                G 1/8A        6            4          5           5              5        7           7     8          9           9             11       12          12
   ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR ALUMINUM/BRASS
    MATING COMPONENTS; UN-LUBRICATED THREADS
                                                G 1/4A        8           17         18          19             23       24          26    17         18          19             23       24          26
                                                G 1/4A        10          17         18          19             23       24          26    17         18          19             23       24          26
                                                G 3/8A        12          21         22          23             28       30          31    34         36          37             46       49          50
                                                G 1/2A        15          31         33          34             42       45          46    67         70          73             91       95          99
                                                G 1/2A        18          31         33          34             42       45          46    48         51          53             65       69          72
                                                G 3/4A        22          42         45          47             57       61          64    86         91          95             117      123         129
                                                 G 1A         28          72         76          79             98       103         107   158        166         174            214      225         236
                                               G 1-1/4A       35          115        121         127            156      164         172   259        272         285            351      369         386
G 1-1/2A 42 139 146 153 188 198 207 302 318 333 409 431 451
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                               5-41
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Table 5-26. British Standard Parallel Pipe Port (BSPP) - L Series - Table 2 of 3
                                                                                       FORM E* (EOLASTIC SEALING RING)                     FORM G/H*** (O-RING W/ RETAINING RING) STUD ENDS & ADJUSTABLE
                    TYPE/FITTING IDENTIFICATION                                                      STUD ENDS                                                          STUD ENDS
                                                                                with 37° (JIC) or L series DIN (MBTL) opposite end                 with 37° (JIC) or L series DIN (MBTL) opposite end
                                                 BSPP                                                  Torque                                                           Torque
                                                          Connecting
                                               Thread G
 MATERIAL                                                  Tube O.D.               [Ft-Lb]                              [N-m]                         [Ft-Lb]                          [N-m]
                                                 Size
                                               (metric)     (mm)         Min        Nom         Max             Min     Nom          Max     Min       Nom        Max            Min   Nom        Max
                                                G 1/8A        6           13         14          14             18       19          19       13        14         14            18     19         19
   COMPONENTS; UN-LUBRICATED THREADS
                                                G 1/4A        8           26         28          29             35       38          39       26        28         29            35     38         39
     STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
                                                G 1/4A        10          26         28          29             35       38          39       26        28         29            35     38         39
                                                G 3/8A        12          52         55          57             70       75          77       52        55         57            70     75         77
                                                G 1/2A        15          66         70          73             90       95          99       66        70         73            90     95         99
                                                G 1/2A        18          66         70          73             90       95          99       66        70         73            90     95         99
                                                G 3/4A        22          133        140         146            180      190         198     133        140       146            180    190       198
                                                 G 1A         28          229        241         252            310      327         342     229        241       252            310    327       342
                                               G 1-1/4A       35          332        349         365            450      473         495     332        349       365            450    473       495
                                               G 1-1/2A       42          398        418         438            540      567         594     398        418       438            540    567       594
                                                 BSPP                                                  Torque                                                           Torque
                                                          Connecting
                                               Thread G
 MATERIAL                                                  Tube O.D.               [Ft-Lb]                              [N-m]                         [Ft-Lb]                          [N-m]
                                                 Size
                                               (metric)     (mm)         Min        Nom         Max             Min     Nom          Max     Min       Nom        Max            Min   Nom        Max
                                                G 1/8A        6            8          9           9             11       12          12       8          9         9             11     12         12
   ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR ALUMINUM/BRASS
    MATING COMPONENTS; UN-LUBRICATED THREADS
                                                G 1/4A        8           17         18          19             23       24          26       17        18         19            23     24         26
                                                G 1/4A        10          17         18          19             23       24          26       17        18         19            23     24         26
                                                G 3/8A        12          34         36          37             46       49          50       34        36         37            46     49         50
                                                G 1/2A        15          43         45          47             58       61          64       43        45         47            58     61         64
                                                G 1/2A        18          43         45          47             58       61          64       43        45         47            58     61         64
                                                G 3/4A        22          86         91          95             117      123         129      86        91         95            117    123       129
                                                 G 1A         28          149        157         164            202      213         222     149        157       164            202    213       222
                                               G 1-1/4A       35          216        227         237            293      308         321     216        227       237            293    308       321
G 1-1/2A 42 259 272 285 351 369 386 259 272 285 351 369 386
5-42                                                                                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                                                    SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Table 5-27. British Standard Parallel Pipe Port (BSPP) - L Series - Table 3 of 3
                                                                                  BANJO FITTINGS                             HIGH PRESSURE BANJO FITTINGS                    FORM E (EOLASTIC SEALING RING)
        TYPE/FITTING IDENTIFICATION
                                                                       with L series DIN (MBTL) opposite end              with L series DIN (MBTL) opposite end                   HOLLOW HEX PLUGS
           BSPP                                                                          Torque                                             Torque                                          Torque
                  Connecting
         Thread G
MATERIAL           Tube O.D.                                              [Ft-Lb]                   [N-m]                    [Ft-Lb]                   [N-m]                 [Ft-Lb]                     [N-m]
           Size
                                              (metric)   (mm)    Min       Nom      Max      Min    Nom     Max     Min       Nom      Max      Min    Nom     Max     Min    Nom      Max      Min      Nom     Max
                                               G 1/8A     6       13        14      14        18     19        19    13        14      14        18     19        19   10      11      11        13       15      15
  COMPONENTS; UN-LUBRICATED THREADS
                                               G 1/4A     8       30        32      33        40     43        45    33        35      36        45     47        49   22      23      24        30       31      33
    STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
                                               G 1/4A     10      30        32      33        40     43        45    33        35      36        45     47        49   22      23      24        30       31      33
                                               G 3/8A     12      48        51      53        65     69        72    52        55      57        70     75        77   44      46      48        60       62      65
                                               G 1/2A     15      66        70      73        90     95        99    89        94      98        120    127    133     59      62      65        80       84      88
                                               G 1/2A     18      66        70      73        90     95        99    89        94      98        120    127    133     59      62      65        80       84      88
                                               G 3/4A     22      92        97      101       125    132    137     170        179     187       230    243    254     103     108     113       140      146    153
                                                G 1A      28      --        --      --        --     --        --   236        248     260       320    336    353     148     156     163       200      212    221
                                              G 1-1/4A    35      --        --      --        --     --        --   398        418     438       540    567    594     295    313.5    332       400      425    450
                                              G 1-1/2A    42      --        --      --        --     --        --   516        542     568       700    735    770     332     349     365       450      473    495
           BSPP                                                                          Torque                                             Torque                                          Torque
                  Connecting
         Thread G
MATERIAL           Tube O.D.                                              [Ft-Lb]                   [N-m]                    [Ft-Lb]                   [N-m]                 [Ft-Lb]                     [N-m]
           Size
                                              (metric)   (mm)    Min       Nom      Max      Min    Nom     Max     Min       Nom      Max      Min    Nom     Max     Min    Nom      Max      Min      Nom     Max
                                               G 1/8A     6       8          9       9        11     12        12    8          9       9        11     12        12    6       7       7            8     9      9
  ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR ALUMINUM/BRASS
   MATING COMPONENTS; UN-LUBRICATED THREADS
                                               G 1/4A     8       20        21      21        27     28        28    21        22      23        28     30        31   14      15      16        19       20      22
                                               G 1/4A     10      20        21      21        27     28        28    21        22      23        28     30        31   14      15      16        19       20      22
                                               G 3/8A     12      31        33      34        42     45        46    34        36      37        46     49        50   29      30      31        39       41      42
                                               G 1/2A     15      43        45      47        58     61        64    58        61      64        79     83        87   38      40      42        52       54      57
                                               G 1/2A     18      43        45      47        58     61        64    58        61      64        79     83        87   38      40      42        52       54      57
                                               G 3/4A     22      60        63      66        81     85        89   111        117     122       150    159    165     67      70      73        91       95      99
                                                G 1A      28      --        --      --        --     --        --   153        161     169       207    218    229     96      101     106       130      137    144
                                              G 1-1/4A    35      --        --      --        --     --        --   259        272     285       351    369    386     216     227     237       293      308    321
G 1-1/2A 42 -- -- -- -- -- -- 335 352 369 454 477 500 216 227 237 293 308 321
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                          5-43
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Table 5-28. British Standard Parallel Pipe Port (BSPP) - S Series - Table 1 of 3
                                                                                                                     Bonded Washer
                                                                                                                         Seal
                                                                                                          Bonded
                                                                                                          Washer
                                                                                       Bonded Washer
                                                                                      (e.g. Dowty) Seal
                                                G 1/4A        8           26        28           29            35           38       39    41        43          45            55       58         61
     STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
                                                G 3/8A        10          33        35           36            45           47       49    66        70          73            90       95         99
                                                G 3/8A        12          33        35           36            45           47       49    66        70          73            90       95         99
                                                G 1/2A        14          48        51           53            65           69       72    111       117        122            150      159        165
                                                G 1/2A        16          48        51           53            65           69       72    96        101        106            130      137        144
                                                G 3/4A        20          66        70           73            90           95       99    199       209        219            270      283        297
                                                 G 1A         25          111       117         122            150          159      165   251       264        276            340      358        374
                                               G 1-1/4A       30          177       186         195            240          252      264   398       418        438            540      567        594
                                               G 1-1/2A       38          214       225         235            290          305      319   516       542        568            700      735        770
                                                 BSPP                                                 Torque                                                          Torque
                                                          Connecting
                                               Thread G
 MATERIAL                                                  Tube O.D.              [Ft-Lb]                                  [N-m]                   [Ft-Lb]                             [N-m]
                                                 Size
                                               (metric)     (mm)         Min       Nom          Max            Min         Nom       Max   Min      Nom         Max            Min     Nom         Max
                                                G 1/4A        6           17        18           19            23           24       26    27        28          29            37       38         39
   ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR ALUMINUM/BRASS
    MATING COMPONENTS; UN-LUBRICATED THREADS
                                                G 1/4A        8           17        18           19            23           24       26    27        28          29            37       38         39
                                                G 3/8A        10          21        22           23            28           30       31    43        45          47            58       61         64
                                                G 3/8A        12          21        22           23            28           30       31    43        45          47            58       61         64
                                                G 1/2A        14          31        33           34            42           45       46    72        76          79            98       103        107
                                                G 1/2A        16          31        33           34            42           45       46    62        66          69            84       89         94
                                                G 3/4A        20          43        45           47            58           61       64    129       136        142            175      184        193
                                                 G 1A         25          72        76           79            98           103      107   163       171        179            221      232        243
                                               G 1-1/4A       30          115       121         127            156          164      172   259       272        285            351      369        386
G 1-1/2A 38 139 146 153 188 198 207 335 352 369 454 477 500
5-44                                                                                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                                                     SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Table 5-29. British Standard Parallel Pipe Port (BSPP) - S Series - Table 2 of 3
                                                                                       FORM E* (EOLASTIC SEALING RING)                  FORM G/H*** (O-RING W/ RETAINING RING) STUD ENDS & ADJUSTABLE
                    TYPE/FITTING IDENTIFICATION                                         STUD ENDS AND HEX TYPE PLUGS                                                STUD ENDS
                                                                                with (ORFS) or S series DIN (MBTS) opposite end                  with (ORFS) or S series DIN (MBTS) opposite end
                                                 BSPP                                                 Torque                                                         Torque
                                                          Connecting
                                               Thread G
 MATERIAL                                                  Tube O.D.              [Ft-Lb]                              [N-m]                       [Ft-Lb]                          [N-m]
                                                 Size
                                               (metric)     (mm)         Min       Nom         Max             Min     Nom        Max     Min       Nom        Max            Min   Nom        Max
                                                G 1/4A        6           41        43          45             55       58        61       26        28         29            35     38         39
   COMPONENTS; UN-LUBRICATED THREADS
                                                G 1/4A        8           41        43          45             55       58        61       26        28         29            35     38         39
     STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
                                                G 3/8A        10          59        62          65             80       84        88       52        55         57            70     75         77
                                                G 3/8A        12          59        62          65             80       84        88       52        55         57            70     75         77
                                                G 1/2A        14          85        90          94             115      122       127      66        70         73            90     95         99
                                                G 1/2A        16          85        90          94             115      122       127      66        70         73            90     95         99
                                                G 3/4A        20          133       140         146            180      190       198     133        140       146            180    190       198
                                                 G 1A         25          229       241         252            310      327       342     229        241       252            310    327       342
                                               G 1-1/4A       30          332       349         365            450      473       495     332        349       365            450    473       495
                                               G 1-1/2A       38          398       418         438            540      567       594     398        418       438            540    567       594
                                                 BSPP                                                 Torque                                                         Torque
                                                          Connecting
                                               Thread G
 MATERIAL                                                  Tube O.D.              [Ft-Lb]                              [N-m]                       [Ft-Lb]                          [N-m]
                                                 Size
                                               (metric)     (mm)         Min       Nom         Max             Min     Nom        Max     Min       Nom        Max            Min   Nom        Max
                                                G 1/4A        6           27        28          29             37       38        39       17        18         19            23     24         26
   ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR ALUMINUM/BRASS
    MATING COMPONENTS; UN-LUBRICATED THREADS
                                                G 1/4A        8           27        28          29             37       38        39       17        18         19            23     24         26
                                                G 3/8A        10          38        40          42             52       54        57       34        36         37            46     49         50
                                                G 3/8A        12          38        40          42             52       54        57       34        36         37            46     49         50
                                                G 1/2A        14          55        58          61             75       79        83       43        45         47            58     61         64
                                                G 1/2A        16          55        58          61             75       79        83       43        45         47            58     61         64
                                                G 3/4A        20          86        91          95             117      123       129      86        91         95            117    123       129
                                                 G 1A         25          149       157         164            202      213       222     149        157       164            202    213       222
                                               G 1-1/4A       30          216       227         237            293      308       321     216        227       237            293    308       321
G 1-1/2A 38 259 272 285 351 369 386 259 272 285 351 369 386
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                        5-45
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Table 5-30. British Standard Parallel Pipe Port (BSPP) - S Series - Table 3 of 3
                                               G 1/4A     8       30        32      33      40      43     45       33      35      36     45      47     49
    STEEL FITTINGS WITH STEEL MATING
                                               G 3/8A     10      48        51      53      65      69     72       52      55      57     70      75         77
                                               G 3/8A     12      48        51      53      65      69     72       52      55      57     70      75     77
                                               G 1/2A     14      66        70      73      90      95     99       89      94      98     120    127     133
                                               G 1/2A     16      66        70      73      90      95     99       89      94      98     120    127     133
                                               G 3/4A     20      92        97      101    125     132     137      170    179      187    230    243     254      Fitting type not typically specified on JLG
                                                G 1A      25      --        --      --      --      --         --   236    248      260    320    336     353      applications. Refer to the specific proce-
                                                                                                                                                                          dure in this Service Manual.
                                              G 1-1/4A    30      --        --      --      --      --         --   398    418      438    540    567     594
                                              G 1-1/2A    38      --        --      --      --      --         --   516    542      568    700    735     770
           BSPP                                                                       Torque                                          Torque                                           Torque
                  Connecting
         Thread G
MATERIAL           Tube O.D.                                              [Ft-Lb]                 [N-m]                   [Ft-Lb]                [N-m]                    [Ft-Lb]                     [N-m]
           Size
                                              (metric)   (mm)    Min       Nom      Max    Min    Nom      Max      Min    Nom      Max   Min    Nom      Max      Min     Nom      Max      Min       Nom     Max
                                               G 1/4A     6       20        21      21      27      28     28       22      22      23     30      30         31
  ALUMINUM/BRASS FITTINGS OR ALUMINUM/BRASS
   MATING COMPONENTS; UN-LUBRICATED THREADS
                                               G 1/4A     8       20        21      21      27      28     28       22      22      23     30      30     31
                                               G 3/8A     10      31        33      34      42      45     46       34      36      37     46      49         50
                                               G 3/8A     12      31        33      34      42      45     46       34      36      37     46      49     50
                                               G 1/2A     14      43        45      47      58      61     64       58      61      64     79      83         87
                                               G 1/2A     16      43        45      47      58      61     64       58      61      64     79      83     87
                                               G 3/4A     20      60        63      66      81      85     89       111    117      122    150    159     165      Fitting type not typically specified on JLG
                                                G 1A      25      --        --      --      --      --         --   153    161      169    207    218     229      applications. Refer to the specific proce-
                                              G 1-1/4A    30      --        --      --      --      --         --   259    272      285    351    369     386             dure in this Service Manual.
5-46                                                                                                                                                                                                        3121171
                       SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                           5-47
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-48                                                            3121171
                                                                                                  SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                Bolt     Fastener Torque for Flanges Equipped with    Fastener Torque for Flanges Equipped with
                                  Inch
                                           Flange Size           A*            Thread                 GRADE 5 Screws                               GRADE 8 Screws
                                 Flange
 TYPE                                                                           Size
                                SAE Dash                                                       [Ft-Lb]                [N-m]                 [Ft-Lb]                [N-m]
                                  Size
                                           (in)   (mm)    (in)        (mm)     (UNF)     Min    Nom      Max   Min    Nom     Max    Min     Nom      Max   Min    Nom     Max
                                   8       0.50    13     1.50        38.10    5/16-18   18      19      19     24      25     26     24        25    26     32      34     35
                                   12      0.75    19     1.88        47.75    3/8-16    32      33      35     43      45     47     44        46    49     60      63     66
  CODE 61 SPLIT FLANGE (FL61)
                                                                                Bolt     Fastener Torque for Flanges Equipped with    Fastener Torque for Flanges Equipped with
                                  Inch
                                           Flange Size           A*            Thread                 GRADE 5 Screws                               GRADE 8 Screws
                                 Flange
 TYPE                                                                           Size
                                SAE Dash                                                       [Ft-Lb]                [N-m]                 [Ft-Lb]                [N-m]
                                  Size
                                           (in)   (mm)    (in)        (mm)     (UNF)     Min    Nom      Max   Min    Nom     Max    Min     Nom      Max   Min    Nom     Max
                                   8       0.50    13     1.59        40.39    5/16-18   --      --      --     --      --      --    24        25    26     32      34     35
  CODE 62 SPLIT FLANGE (FL62)
32 2.00 51 3.81 96.77 3/4-10 -- -- -- -- -- -- 332 348 365 450 473 495
3121171                                                                                                                                                                     5-49
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                 Bolt        Fastener Torque for Flanges Equipped with   Fastener Torque for Flanges Equipped with
                                  Inch
                                           Flange Size            A*            Thread                    CLASS 8.8 Screws                           CLASS 10.9 Screws
                                 Flange
 TYPE                                                                            Size
                                SAE Dash                                                           [Ft-Lb]                [N-m]                [Ft-Lb]                [N-m]
                                  Size
                                           (in)   (mm)     (in)        (mm)     (Metric)     Min    Nom      Max   Min    Nom     Max    Min       Nom   Max   Min    Nom     Max
                                   8       0.50     13     1.50        38.10     (Metric)    Min    Nom      Max   Min    Nom     Max    Min       Nom   Max   Min    Nom     Max
                                   12      0.75     19     1.88        47.75    M8 x 1.25    18      19      19     24     25      26    18        19    19     24     25      26
  CODE 61 SPLIT FLANGE (FL61)
                                                                                 Bolt        Fastener Torque for Flanges Equipped with   Fastener Torque for Flanges Equipped with
                                  Inch
                                           Flange Size            A*            Thread                    CLASS 8.8 Screws                           CLASS 10.9 Screws
                                 Flange
 TYPE                                                                            Size
                                SAE Dash                                                           [Ft-Lb]                [N-m]                [Ft-Lb]                [N-m]
                                  Size
                                           (in)   (mm)     (in)        (mm)     (Metric)     Min    Nom      Max   Min    Nom     Max    Min       Nom   Max   Min    Nom     Max
                                   8       0.50     13     1.59        40.39    M8 x 1.25     --     --      --     --      --     --    24        25    26     32     34      35
  CODE 62 SPLIT FLANGE (FL62)
32 2.00 51 3.81 96.77 M20 x 2.5 -- -- -- -- -- -- 406 426 446 550 578 605
5-50                                                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                             SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Double Wrench Method                                              the ‘layline’ printed on the hose is a good indicator of proper
                                                                  hose installation. A twisted lay-line usually indicates the hose
 To prevent undesired hose or connector rotation, two             is twisted. See Figure 5-12. for double wrench method require-
 wrenches must be used; one torque wrench and one back- up        ments.
 wrench. If two wrenches are not used, inadvertent component
 rotation may occur which absorbs torque and causes
 improper joint load and leads to leaks. For hose connections,
3121171                                                                                                                     5-51
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-52                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                   SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Locknut
                                                                     O-Ring
                                                                                      Back-up Washer
3121171                                                                                                                                5-53
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5.3 CYLINDER REPAIR 4. Place the cylinder barrel into a suitable holding fixture.
NOTE: The following are general procedures that apply to all of                        	
      the cylinders on this machine. Procedures that apply to a
      specific cylinder will be so noted.                                                          	
	
Disassembly                                                                                                     
5-54                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                       SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                            1
                                                                                                     18**
19
                           17*
                                   16
                                                   3
                                                                                 18
                                                          9                                     19
           17
                                            10
          14                                             11
               15
                    14
                                                                 13
                                                                      12
                                                                                 4        5
                                                                                                6
                                                                                                     7
                                                                                                                  8
3121171                                                                                                                                     5-55
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                          8
                                                              6
                                                              20*
                                                                                                               20*
                                                    8
                                                                                                                          1
                                         7
                                                    4
                                                                  3
7 15
                                                                                                16
                                                                                                     12
                                                                                                                      5
                                                          14
                  13                                                  11
                                                                                                                              19
                        18
                                 13                                                                                                    17
10
                                               21                                                               2
                                                                                                                              8
5-56                                                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                               SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                                                       11
                                                                                           6****
19 19***
11 1
                                                                  4
                                              18**                                                 12
                                                                                 3
                                                                                             14
                                                                                                  15
                                                                                                       14
                               17
                                                                                                  13
                                              16
                                                             17                                               10
                                                                                                                            9
                                                                     5
                                                                                                                                 8
                                                                                                                                         7
20*
                                                                                                                   2
                                                                                                                                 11
                                                                                                             11
   * Torque to 84 ft. lbs. (114 Nm)
   ** Torque to 9.5 ft. lbs. (13 Nm)
   *** Torque to 12.5 - 15 ft. lbs. (17 - 20 Nm)                                                                                                      1001228019-A
                                                                                                                                                        MAE35830A
   **** Torque to 30 - 35 ft. lbs. (41 - 47 Nm)
                1.   Barrel              5.   Head                       9.    Backup Ring             13.    Wear Ring         17.   Lock Ring
                2.   Rod                 6.   Counterbalance Valve       10.   O-Ring                  14.    Backup Ring       18.   Capscrew
                3.   Piston              7.   Wiper                      11.   Bushing                 15.    O-Ring            19.   Bleeder Valve
                4.   Tapered Bushing     8.   Rod Seal                   12.   O-Ring Plug             16.    Seal              20.   Capscrew
3121171                                                                                                                                                              5-57
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                 10
                                                       28
13
12
                                                                                                                                                   5
                                                                                                                                               6
                                                                                                                                          19
                                                                                29
                                                                                                                                 27
                                                                                                                       16
                                                                                                             27
                                                                                                        19
                                                                                                   20
                                                                                               20 22
                                                                                          23
                                                                                     18
                                                                                17
                                                                           17
                                                                   9
                                                             25                  11
                                                      26
                                               21
                                       24
                                            15
1684343-D
       1.   JLG Threadlocker PN 0100011 (Not Shown)    7.    Bearing             13.   O-Ring Plug           19.   Lock Ring          25.   Rod Seal
       2.   JLG Threadlocker PN 0100019 (Not Shown)    8.    Bushing             14.   Not Used              20.   Backup Ring        26.   Rod Wiper
       3.   Locking Primer (Not Shown)                 9.    Head                15.   Roll Pin              21.   Washer Ring        27.   Guide Ring
       4.   Rod Link                                   10.   Barrel              16.   Piston                22.   O-Ring             28.   Holding Valve
       5.   Capscrew                                   11.   Rod                 17.   Wear Ring             23.   O-Ring             29.   Holding Valve
       6.   Tapered Bushing                            12.   O-Ring Plug         18.   Backup Ring           24.   Capscrew
5-58                                                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                  SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                                                           7
                                                              30
12
                                                                                                                                                   5
                                                                                        28                                                     6
                                                                      29                                                          19
13 27
16
                                                                                                      27
                                                                                             19
                                                                                    20
                                                                                20 22                  24
                                                                           23
                                                                 18                                                                                25
                                                         17                                                                                 26
                                                    17
                                           9
                                                                                                                                 21
                                                                       11
15
                                           4
                                                                                                                                            1684430-B
    1.    JLG Threadlocker PN 0100011 (Not Shown)         7.    Bearing           13.   O-Ring Plug         19.   Guidelock           25.    Polyseal
    2.    JLG Threadlocker PN 0100019 (Not Shown)         8.    Bushing           14.   Not Used            20.   Backup Ring         26.    Wiper Seal
    3.    Primer #7471                                    9.    Head              15.   Roll Pin            21.   Washer Ring         27.    Hydrolock
    4.    Rod End Block                                   10.   Barrel            16.   Piston              22.   O-Ring              28.    Counterbalance Valve
    5.    Capscrew                                        11.   Rod               17.   Wear Ring           23.   O-Ring              29.    Orifice
    6.    Tapered Bushing                                 12.   O-Ring Plug       18.   Backup Ring         24.   Capscrew            30.    Counterbalance Valve
3121171                                                                                                                                                             5-59
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
22
19**
                                             1
                                                                                                                   22
23
                                                                                                                                             15
                                                                               18*                                                         14
                                                       20**                                                                       11
                                           24                                                                           10
                                                                                            10
                                                                                     11
                                                                               13                   16
                                                                          12
                                                                     13
                                                             7
                                                   8
                                                                                                                                            5
                                         6                                                                                             4
3 2 17
                                             26
                                                                               * Torque to 30 - 35 ft. lbs. (41 - 47 Nm)
                            21                                                 ** Torque to 20 - 25 ft. lbs. (27 - 34 Nm)
                                                                                                                                        1684430-E
                             25                                                                                                        MAE38540E
          1.   Barrel       7.    O-ring               13.   Backup Ring                  19.   Counterbalance Valve    25. Link
          2.   Rod          8.    Backup Ring          14.   Tapered Ring                 20.   Orifice Valve           26. Roll Pin
          3.   Head         9.    Piston               15.   Capscrew                     21.   Bushing
          4.   Wiper Seal   10.   Hydrolock Seal       16.   Capscrew                     22.   Bushing
          5.   Rod Seal     11.   Guidelock Seal       17.   Washer Ring                  23.   Plug
          6.   Wear Ring    12.   O-ring               18.   Counterbalance Valve         24.   Plug
5-60                                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                   SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
26**
                                                         7
                                                                                                                           4
                                                                                                                                                        2
                                                                                        24*                                                         3
                                                               25**
                                                                                                                                          15
                                                     10
                                                                                                                                  23
                                                                                                                   12
                                                                                                      23
                                                                                              15
                                                                                        16
                                                                                   18                      20
                                                                              16
                                                                        19
                                                             14
                                                                                                                                                    21
                                                  13                                                                                           22
                                                                                                                                        17
                                     6                                    8
11
                                 5
                                                                              * Torque to 30 - 35 ft. lbs. (41 - 47 Nm)
                                                                              ** Torque to 20 - 25 ft. lbs. (27 - 34 Nm)
                                                                                                                                           1001138813-C
                                                                                                                                             MAE38600C
          1.   Rod End Block         7.    Barrel                 13.   Wear Ring             19.   O-ring                     25. Orifice
          2.   Capscrew              8.    Rod                    14.   Backup Ring           20.   Capscrew                   26. Counterbalance Valve
          3.   Tapered Bushing       9.    O-ring Plug            15.   Guide Lock            21.   Rod Seal
          4.   Bearing               10.   O-ring Plug            16.   Backup Ring           22.   Wiper Seal
          5.   Bushing               11.   Roll Pin               17.   Washer Ring           23.   Hydro Lock
          6.   Head                  12.   Piston                 18.   O-ring                24.   Counterbalance Valve
3121171                                                                                                                                                     5-61
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                                                     22
                                                      19*
23
                                                                                                                                             15***
                                                                            18*                                                         14
                                                       20**
                                                                                                                              11
                                              24                                                                     10
                                                                                                          9
                                                                                           10
                                                                                  11
                                                                            13
                                                                          12
                                                                     13                    16****
                                                              7
                                                       8
                                                                                                                                         5
                                              6                                                                                     4
                                          6
                               3                                                                                             17
                                                              2
26
                                                                                                                                   1001228034-B
                          25                                                                                                         MAE33950B
            1.   Barrel            7.    O-ring               13.   Backup Ring                 19.   Counterbalance Valve    25. Link Rod
            2.   Rod               8.    Backup Ring          14.   Tapered Ring                20.   Orifice Valve           26. Rollpin
            3.   Head              9.    Piston               15.   Capscrew                    21.   Bushing
            4.   Wiper Seal        10.   Hydrolock Seal       16.   Capscrew                    22.   Bushing
            5.   Rod Seal          11.   Guidelock Ring       17.   Washer Ring                 23.   Plug
            6.   Wear Ring         12.   O-ring               18.   Counterbalance Valve        24.   Plug
5-62                                                                                                                                                 3121171
                                                                                     SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                      10
                                                                             16*
                                                                                                  11
                                  6
                                                                    17*                           10
                                                                                                       18**           7
                                                                       10                                10
                                                                                   11
                                                                                                                                      12
                                                                    13        102
                                                                                     105
                                                                                        102
                             3
101
                                                                                                                          108
                             104
                               109
                                               109                           103
                                                  104                           106
                                                                                                          107
                                                                                                                       15
                                                                                                                                                 5
                                                                         8
          1.   JLG Threadlocker PN 0100011      7.    Barrel                 13.   Piston                       100. Not Used              105. O-ring
          2.   Locking Primer                   8.    Rod                    14.   Not Used                     101. Wear Ring             106. O-ring
          3.   Capscrew                         9.    Head                   15.   Capscrew                     102. Backup Ring           107. Wiper Seal
          4.   Tapered Bushing                  10.   O-ring Plug            16.   Counterbalance Valve         103. Backup Ring           108. Rod Seal
          5.   Bushing                          11.   O-ring Plug            17.   Shuttle Valve                104. Guidelock Ring        109. Hydrolock
          6.   Bushing                          12.   O-ring Plug            18.   Counterbalance Valve
3121171                                                                                                                                                      5-63
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                    23
                                                        18** 17**              24
                    20
                                                                                       23
                                                                                        23 19*
                                                                                                          1
                                                   23***
                                                            24***
                                                                                                                             22
14
                                                    9        13
                                                                  12
                                                                        13
               15
                                                                                                               5
                11
                         10
                               10                             8
                                                                    7
                                      11
                                                                                             4
                                                                                                          16
                                                                                                                         1001165507-C
                                                                                                                           MAE37450C
                                                                                                 21
5-64                                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                   SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                              18****      23
                                  20                               17****                24
                                                                                           23
                                                                                           23
                                                                                                19***
                                                                                                                   1
                                                              24                                                               22
                                                                   23
                             14
                                        11
                                                  10
          15*
                                                              9
                                                                        10
                                                                                 11
                                                                                      13
                                                                                           12
                                                                                                    13
                                                                                                               8
                                                                                                                       7
                                                                                                                             6
                                                                                                                                        5
                                                                                                                                                 4
16**
                                                                                                                                            21
                                                                             2
3121171                                                                                                                                              5-65
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
       1.   JLG Threadlocker PN 0100011   6.    Rod           9.    Not Used      13. Capscrew      103. Backup Ring   107. O-Ring
       2.   Capscrew                      6A.   Bushing       10.   Piston        14. Valve Block   104. Wear Ring     108. Hydrolock
       3.   Tapered Bushing               7.    O-Ring Plug   11.   Washer Ring   101. Lock Ring    105. Backup Ring   109. Wiper Ring
       4.   Barrel                        8.    O-Ring Plug   12.   Capscrew      102. Wear Ring    106. O-Ring        110. Rod Seal
       5.   Head
Figure 5-28. Main Boom Lift Cylinder (SN 0300201017 through SN 0300211613)
5-66                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                  SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
11
13
                                      7
                                  1
                                          14
                                                   21                                            8
                                                         15
                                                                  21
                                                                       14
                   17
                        20                                                         9
                                                                                           18
                             16
                                      23                                                        19
                                                                                                     18
22
10
12
                                                                                                           1001165510-D
                                                                                            6                MAE37470D
Figure 5-29. Main Boom Lift Cylinder (SN 0300211614 through 0300239976)
3121171                                                                                                                     5-67
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
11
7 13
14
                                                21
           1**                                         15
                                                                        21                              8
                                                                                   14
                                                                                        18
                                                                                             19
                                                                                                  18
                                                                                                       17
                                                                                                            20
                                                                                                                      16
                                                                                                                                   4
           10
                                                                                                                                       23
                      12 *                                                                                                                  22
5-68                                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
9 14
14
                      9
                                                                          4
                                4
                                                                                                     1
                           14
                                                   14          10
                                                                                                                                    15
                              13
                                                    5
                                                               19
                 13
                          8                                          20
                                                                                       21
                                                                                            24
                                                                                                 17
                16
                      25                                  18                                             6
                              16
                                                                 7
                                                                                                             22
                                                                                                                   23
                                                                                                                          11
                                                                                   2
                                                                                                                     12
                                                                                                                                1684173-H
                                                                                                                             1001138803-B
                                                                                                         3                      MAE38520
3121171                                                                                                                                          5-69
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                             9****
                                           14***               4
                                                       14***
9**** 14***
                                14***
                                    10
                                                      14
                         8                                                                                                            15
                                16
                                           25
                                                 16
            13**
                                                           5
                                                                   19
                                                                        18
                                                                             20
                                                                                  18
                                                                                       20   7
                                                                                                    21
                                                                                                           24
                                                                                                                  17
                                                                                                                             6
                                                                                                                                 22
                                                                                                                                      23         11
                                                                                                                                                        12*
                                                                                                                                               1001228025-E
                                                                                                                 3                               MAE37490E
5-70                                                                                                                                                          3121171
                                            SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                                  5-71
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                            7
                                                                                         1
                                                                   10
                                                      4
5* 10
                                                                                                       9
                                                                                         3
                                                                                                                      16
            11                                  15
12
13
                                                              14
                                                                                8
                                                                                                                   1684314-F
                                                                                                                  MAE38530F
                                                                                6
5-72                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                         SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                       7
                      7                                                        1
17
5** 11
17
                                               4
                                                                                   8
                                                            10
16*
12 15
13
                                                    14
                                                                       9
2 6
3121171                                                                                                         5-73
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                                                   8
                                                                                   9
                                              15
                                              17                         8
                                                32
                                                  31
                           19                            7                                                                   27
                                   35                          28                                                       16        29
                                    2                                                               21                                  27
                                                                14
                                                                         3 35 15                                                       1
                                        26                                                          33                                 13
                                              30 35 3                                                        34          4
                                                                                         5                         33
                                               15
                                         33
                                   4          34
                                                   33                                                   28 30
                     13                                                                                           26         31
                          1
                              16                   20
                    3           27                                                       14
                                                                                                                                  19
                   35                   29 27
                                                                                                         7
                              15                                              6
                                                                                                                  32
                                                                                                                             10              11
                                                                                                                   24             25
                                                             6                                               23
                                                                                                              37
                                                                                                   36                                     18
                                                                                              12
                                                                                                                  22
                                                                                                                                   1684320-H
                                                                                                                                  MAE38610H
         1. JLG Threadlocker PN 0100011         7. Barrel        12.   Fitting     18.   Bracket             23A. Valve                 104. O-Ring
         2. Locking Primer                      8. Rod           13.   Fitting     19.   Capscrew            23B. Valve                 105. O-Ring
         3. Capscrew                            9. Head          14.   Plug        20.   Capscrew            23C. Valve                 106. Seal
         4. Screw                               10. Rod          15.   Plug        21.   Spacer              101. Backup Ring           107. Rod Wiper
         5. Screw                               10A. Bushing     16.   Wear Pad    22.   Spacer              102. Backup Ring           108. Wear Ring
         6. Tapered Bushing                     11. Fitting      17.   Piston      23.   Valve               103. Wear Ring             109. Seal
         * Torque to 30 ft. lbs. (40.6 Nm)
Figure 5-36. Tower Boom Telescope Cylinder (SN 0300201017 through 0300243458)
5-74                                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                    SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                                      9
                                                                                                                       6
                                                                                   9
                                      19     15
                                                                  6
                                                  32                                                              21
                                                       31                                                                  27
                                                            7
                                 17                              26                                                               34
                                                                       30                                                              16
                                                                            28 14                            29                               4
                                      2
                                                                                                                   33                              1
                                                            13                                     15                      33
                                                                                             3
                                                            3                                             5
                                                      15
                                                                  3
15
                                                  5                                      13
                            4
                                                                                             28
                 1                     33                                                               26
                                                 33                                                           32
                                                      29                    14                                         7
                                                                                                                            19
                         16                                 20
                                  34                                                    30
                                                                                                 31
                                                 27                                                                                      10         11
                                                                                    8
                                                                                                                                  24
                                                                                                                                              25
                                                                                                                        23
                                                                                                               36
                                                                                                              35
                                             8
                                                                                                              12            22
                                                                                                                                       18
                                                                                                                                              1001228032-A
                                                                                                                                                MAE37540A
          1.   Barrel                      8.    Rod             15.    Wear Pad             22.   Valve                    29.   O-ring                 36. O-ring
          2.   Screw                       9.    Bushing         16.    Piston               23.   Valve                    30.   O-ring
          3.   Screw                       10.   Fitting         17.    Bracket              24.   Valve                    31.   Seal Rod
          4.   Tapered Bushing             11.   Fitting         18.    Capscrew             25.   Valve                    32.   Rod Wiper
          5.   Barrel                      12.   Fitting         19.    Capscrew             26.   Backup Ring              33.   Wear Ring
          6.   Rod                         13.   Plug            20.    Spacer               27.   Backup Ring              34.   Seal
          7.   Head                        14.   Plug            21.    Spacer               28.   Wear Ring                35.   O-ring
3121171                                                                                                                                                               5-75
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
       1. JLG Threadlocker PN 0100011    6.    Head      9.    O-Ring Plug   14.   Foot Plate   101. Wear Ring     106. O-Ring
       2. Capscrew                       7.    Barrel    10.   O-Ring Plug   15.   Capscrew     102. Backup Ring   107. Seal
       3. Bolt                           7A.   Bushing   11.   Wear Pad      16.   Capscrew     103. Backup Ring   108. Rod Wiper
       4. Bolt                           8.    Rod       12.   Piston        17.   Spacer       104. Wear Ring     109. Seal
       5. Tapered Bushing                8A.   Bushing   13.   Bracket       18.   Valve        105. O-Ring
       * Torque to 50 ft. lbs. (68 Nm)
5-76                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                                              30
                                                                                               16
                                                                                                                       29        34
                                                                                       34
                                                                                         33
                                                                                                                          31
                                                                                         19
                                                                                                                        32
                                                                                      10    34
                                                                                      7                                     7
                                                                                                                                             6
15
                                                                                               11
                                                 6
                                                                                                                                                    12
                                                                                                                       23
                                                                                                                                 26
                                                                                                                                                         2
                                                                                                                                                    14
                                                         22                                                                                              17
                                                              24                               25                  5
                                                  13               22
                                                                                                    21
                           1                                                                                    27
                                                              24                                                            2
                                 4
                                                                         18
                         20                                                                                                  12
                                                                                          24
                              28
                                     20
                                                                                                      18
24
                                                                                                                                         8
                                                                    8
                                                                                9
                                                                                                                                                 1001175888-D
                                                                                                                                                   MAE37520D
          1.   Capscrew                   7.    Bushing            13.   Piston                     19.   Valve Assembly         25.   O-ring                   31.   Valve
          2.   Bolt                       8.    Rod                14.   Bracket                    20.   Wear Ring              26.   Seal                     32.   Valve
          3.   Bolt                       9.    Bushing            15.   Foot Plate                 21.   Backup Ring            27.   Rod Wiper                33.   Valve
          4.   Tapered Bushing            10.   O-ring Plug        16.   Capscrew                   22.   Backup Ring            28.   Seal                     34.   Valve
          5.   Head                       11.   O-ring Plug        17.   Capscrew                   23.   Wear Ring              29.   Fitting
          6.   Barrel                     12.   Wear Pad           18.   Spacer                     24.   O-ring                 30.   Fitting
Figure 5-39. Main Boom Telescope Cylinder (SN 0300201017 through 0300243463)
3121171                                                                                                                                                                       5-77
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                                   33
                                                                                             32
                                                                               31                 26
                                                                   30                                        30
                                                                        29                               27****
                                                                          30                           28****
                                                                   24
                                                                                                   28
                                                                                                                       1
19
22
                                                                                                       18
                                                                                             25
                                            13
                                                     13                  1
                                                                                                                              11
                                                                                                                                     10
                        9**                                             14
                                                                                                                                              11
                                                                                                        20***
                                 12
                                                                                        12                      15
                                            12
                                                                                                        14
                                  8                                                                                  12
                                            7
                                                          3
                                                                                                                                          2
                    6
6 16
                                                     5
                                                              4
17 23*
       1.   Barrel                    7.        O-ring            13.    Backup Ring              19.    Bushing            25.   O-ring Plug       31. Fitting
       2.   Rod                       8.        Backup Ring       14.    Spacer                   20.    Capscrew           26.   Valve Assembly    32. Fitting
       3.   Head                      9.        Piston            15.    Tapered Bushing          21.    Bolt               27.   Valve             33. Capscrew
       4.   Wiper                     10.       Seal              16.    Wear Pad Plate           22.    Bolt               28.   Valve
       5.   Rod Seal                  11.       Wear Ring         17.    Wear Pad                 23.    Capscrew           29.   Valve
       6.   Wear Ring                 12.       O-ring            18.    Telefoot Plate           24.    O-ring Plug        30.   Valve
5-78                                                                                                                                                               3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
R.010 MIN
R.010 MIN
                                                                                                                   7X
                                                                                                                   R.020    .010
SECTION A-A
A A
                                           1.125     .030                                                          2X
                                                                                                              15        2
                                                               8.000    .030                                                HEAD INSTALLATION SLEEVE
                                                                9.000    .060
                                                                                                                                     JLG P/N 1001107143
4.500 .060
                                                    2X
                               .005/.015 X 45
                  2.130       .010                                                                   2.015    .010
                                                                                                      2X
                                                                                                      R.010       .005
3121171                                                                                                                                                   5-79
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
2.250 .125
1.755 .010
R.030 MAX
                                              2.020    .010
          1.250    .250                                        3.000
                                                                 STK
                      3X
  .030/.100 X 45
                                                                       GO (PISTON) GAUGE
                                                                        JLG P/N 1001107146
3.875 .125
3.357 .010
R.030 MAX
                                                   2.020      .010
  1.250     .250                                                     3.000
                                                                       STK
  .030/.100 X 45
                                                                             GO (PISTON) GAUGE
                                                                             JLG P/N 1001107147
5-80                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                                     SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
4.965 .010
                                                                                                2X
                    4.770        .010
                                                                                        4.874        .020
                                                                                       2X
                                                                                  15        2
             6X R.020        MIN
                                                      3.000     .060
                                                                                                                              HEAD INSTALL SLEEVE
                                                                                                                               JLG P/N 1001107000
5.000 .060
                                                 2X
                                    .005/.015 X 45
                                                                                                                       2X
                                                                                                                       R.010    .005
                                                                                                                                       PISTON INSTALL SLEEVE
                                                                                                                                         JLG P/N 1001107001
3.000 .125
2.438 .010
R.030 MAX
4.520 .010
           .030/.100 X 45
                                                                                                            GO (PISTON) GAUGE
                                                                                                            JLG P/N 1001107002
3121171                                                                                                                                                        5-81
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3.965 .010
                                                                                 2X
                                                                            15        2
          6X R.020        MIN
                                              3.000   .060
3.500 .060
                                         2X
                            .060/.100 X 45
                                                                                                   2X
                                                                                                   R.125          .030
2.000 .125
1.688 .010
R.030 MAX
3.020 .010
                                                                                          GO (PISTON) GAUGE
                                                                                          (Tower Lift Cylinder Only)
               .030/.100 X 45
                                                                                            JLG P/N 1001106848
Figure 5-44. Special Tools for Main Lift Cylinder and Tower Lift Cylinder
5-82                                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                                SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                     	
                                                                     14.   Screw the piston CCW, by hand, and remove the piston
                                                                           from cylinder rod.
                                                                     15.   Remove and discard the piston o-rings, seal rings, and
                                                                           backup rings.
                                                                     16.   Remove piston spacer, if applicable, from the rod.
                                                                     17.   Remove the rod from the holding fixture. Remove the
                                                                           cylinder head gland and retainer plate, if applicable. Dis-
              Figure 5-45. Cylinder Rod Support                            card the o-rings, backup rings, rod seals, and wiper seals.
    9. Using suitable protection, clamp the cylinder rod in a       Cleaning and Inspection
       vise or similar holding fixture as close to the piston as
       possible.                                                      1. Clean all parts thoroughly in an approved cleaning sol-
                                                                         vent.
NOTE: Step 10 applies only to the steer cylinder.
                                                                      2. Inspect the cylinder rod for scoring, tapering, ovality, or
                                                                         other damage. If necessary, dress rod with Scotch Brite
  10.   Loosen and remove nut which attaches the piston to the
                                                                         or equivalent. Replace rod if necessary.
        rod, and remove the piston.
                                                                      3. Inspect threaded portion of rod for excessive damage.
  11.   Loosen and remove the capscrew(s), if applicable, which
                                                                         Dress threads as necessary.
        attach the tapered bushing to the piston.
  12.   Insert the capscrew(s) in the threaded holes in the outer
        piece of the tapered bushing. Progressively tighten the
        capscrew(s) until the bushing is loose on the piston.
  13.   Remove the bushing from the piston.
3121171                                                                                                                         5-83
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
   4. Inspect inner surface of cylinder barrel tube for scoring      13.   If applicable, inspect rod and barrel bearings for signs of
      or other damage. Check inside diameter for tapering or               correct excessive wear or damage. Replace as necessary.
      ovality. Replace if necessary.
                                                                            a. Thoroughly clean hole, (steel bushing) of burrs, dirt
   5. Inspect threaded portion of barrel for damage. Dress                     etc. to facilitate bearing installation.
      threads as necessary.                                                 b. Inspect steel bushing for wear or other damage. If
   6. Inspect piston surface for damage and scoring and for                    steel bushing is worn or damaged, rod/barrel must
      distortion. Dress piston surface or replace piston as nec-               be replaced.
      essary.                                                               c. Lubricate inside of the steel bushing with WD40
                                                                               prior to bearing installation.
   7. Inspect threaded portion of piston for damage. Dress
      threads as necessary.                                                 d. Using an arbor of the correct size, carefully press the
                                                                               bearing into steel bushing.
   8. Inspect seal and o-ring grooves in piston for burrs and
      sharp edges. Dress applicable surfaces as necessary.         NOTE: Install pin into the composite bearing dry. Lubrication is
                                                                         not required with nickel plated pins and bearings.
   9. Inspect cylinder head inside diameter for scoring or
      other damage and for ovality and tapering. Replace as
      necessary.
  10.   Inspect threaded portion of head for damage. Dress
        threads as necessary.
  11.   Inspect seal and o-ring grooves in head for burrs and
        sharp edges. Dress applicable surfaces as necessary.
  12.   Inspect cylinder head outside diameter for scoring or
        other damage and ovality and tapering. Replace as nec-
        essary.
                                                                           Figure 5-47. Composite Bearing Installation
5-84                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                      SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Assembly                                                                    2. Use a soft mallet to tap a new wiper seal into the appli-
                                                                               cable cylinder head gland groove. Install a new wear
NOTE: Prior to cylinder assembly, ensure that the proper cylinder              ring into the applicable cylinder head gland groove.
      seal kit is used. See your JLG Parts Manual.
WHEN INSTALLING ‘POLY-PAK’ PISTON SEALS, ENSURE SEALS ARE INSTALLED                 Figure 5-50. Wiper Seal Installation
PROPERLY. REFER TO WIPER SEAL INSTALLATION FOR CORRECT SEAL ORIEN-
TATION. IMPROPER SEAL INSTALLATION COULD RESULT IN CYLINDER LEAK-
AGE AND IMPROPER CYLINDER OPERATION.
3121171                                                                                                                           5-85
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
   3. Place a new “o”ring and backup seal in the applicable         NOTE: The backup rings for the solid seal have a radius on one
      outside diameter groove of the cylinder head.                       side. This side faces the solid seal.(See magnified insert in
                                                                          Figure 5-52.)The split of seals and backup rings are to be
                                                                          positioned so as not to be in alignment with each other.
5-86                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                    SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
  10.    Thread piston onto rod until it abuts the spacer end and               b. Tap each space once; this means the tapered bush-
         install the tapered bushing.                                              ing is tapped 3 times as there are 3 spaces between
                                                                                   the capscrews.
NOTE: When installing the tapered bushing, piston and mating
      end of rod must be free of oil.
WHEN REBUILDING THE TELESCOPE, LIFT, JIB, LEVEL, AXLE LOCKOUT OR AXLE
EXTENSION CYLINDERS, TIGHTEN SECURELY. (SEE TABLE 5-33)
3121171                                                                                                                               5-87
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
  20.   Secure the cylinder head gland using the washer ring              Table 5-33. Cylinder Head and Tapered Bushing Torque
        and socket head bolts. (See Table 5-33, Cylinder Head                                  Specifications
        and Tapered Bushing Torque Specifications and Table 5-
        34, Holding Valve Torque Specifications)                                                                                 Tapered
                                                                                                          Head Torque Value
                                                                              Description                                     Bushing Torque
                                                                                                                (Wet)
                                                                                                                               Value (Wet)
5-88                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                             SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5.4 COUNTERBALANCE VALVE CHECK                                       7. After applying the torque to the valve, examine the
                                                                        valve for hydraulic oil leaks. If the valve leaks, replace the
   1. Position the machine on a firm level surface.                     counterbalance valve, see Step #10. If the valve does not
                                                                        leak, proceed to Step #13.
   2. Ensure the tower boom and main booms are on their
      respective boom rests.                                         8. To replace the counterbalance valve:
   3. Swing the turntable to the side about 35-45° to gain                a. Remove the valve cartridge.
      access to the counterbalance valve.                                 b. Examine the removed cartridge for completeness of
   4. Access the Tower Lift Cylinder Counterbalance Valve                    the valve, the o-rings and seals.
      through the access hole in the bottom plate of the turn-            c. If the valve, seals and o-rings are complete and
      table.                                                                 accounted for, proceed to the next step.
                                                                          d. If any portion of the valve, o-rings or seals are miss-
                                                                             ing, quarantine the machine. Do NOT allow the
                                                                             tower boom to be raised. Contact a certified service
                                                                             technician and make sure the missing parts are
                                                                             accounted for.
     1/8”
   (3 mm)
3121171                                                                                                                         5-89
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-90                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                  SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5.6 HYDRAULIC RETURN FILTER                                            Replace the filter element before the indicator reaches the red
                                                                       filter restricted area or every 300 hours, whichever comes first.
 Check the hydraulic return filter indicator with the hydraulic oil
 at normal operating temperature and the engine running.
3121171                                                                                                                           5-91
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                               2
                                                                  4
                                   1.   Return Filter
                                   2.   Vented Fill Cap
                                   3.   Sight/Temperature Gauge
                                   4.   Filter Mounting Bracket
                                   5.   Magnetic Drain Plug
5-92                                                                  3121171
                                   SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                       5-93
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
             1.   Level Up         5.   Jib Down          9.    Platform Dump        13.   Main Pressure Check Port
             2.   Rotate Right     6.   Jib Swing Left    10.   Level Up Relief      14.   Level Up Test Port
             3.   Level Down       7.   Jib Up            11.   Jib Up/Down Relief   15.   Level Down Test Port
             4.   Rotate Left      8.   Jib Swing Right   12.   Level Down Relief    16.   Jib Up/Down Test Port
5-94                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                          SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
          1.   Level Up          5.   Jib Down          9.    Platform Dump        13.   Main Pressure Check Port
          2.   Rotate Right      6.   Jib Swing Left    10.   Level Up Relief      14.   Level Up Test Port
          3.   Level Down        7.   Jib Up            11.   Jib Up/Down Relief   15.   Level Down Test Port
          4.   Rotate Left       8.   Jib Swing Right   12.   Level Down Relief    16.   Jib Up/Down Test Port
3121171                                                                                                             5-95
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
10
                                                                                                                                     6
                                                                                        6
                                                                              5
                                                                 15                                                                                5
                                                       11
                                                                                                                                               9
                                                  16
                                                                                                                                                   7
11
                                                            4
                                                                                                                                               1
                                                                     14                                                                  9
                                                   1                      6
                                                                                  5
                                                                                                                            2
                                                                 7                          11                       8
       3
                                                                                                           12
                                                                                                      11
11
                                                                                                                                    MAE38690
                                                            11
                                13
                                         7
               1.   Flow Divider Valve       5.    Brake and lockout Valve            9.    Fitting        13.   Orifices Fitting
               2.   Shuttle Valve            6.    Coil                               10.   Fitting        14.   Pressure Check
               3.   Relief Valve             7.    Shuttle Valve                      11.   Fitting        15.   Plug
               4.   Orifice                  8.    Check Valve                        12.   Fitting        16.   Pressure Switch
5-96                                                                                                                                                   3121171
                                                                   SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
12
                                                                                                                       11
                                             10
                                                                                                                        6
                                             11
10 8
                                                                                                              2
                                                                                            10         3
                                                                                  8
                                                             1
                                                                                      9
                         14
               6                                                                      7
11
10
10 MAE38680
          1.       Brake and Axle Lockout Valve   5.   Shuttle Valve        9.    Fitting          13. Plug
          2.       Relief Valve                   6.   Flow Divider Valve   10.   Fitting          14. Coil
          3.       Pilot Valve                    7.   Check Valve          11.   Fitting
          4.       Pressure Switch                8.   Fitting              12.   Pressure Check
3121171                                                                                                                      5-97
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
       1.   Tower Lift                6.    Swing Right Relief           11.   Main Tele Extend Port            16. Temperature Switch
       2.   Tower Tele                7.    Main Tele Extend Relief      12.   Main Tele Retract Port           17. Port to Platform Valve
       3.   Main Lift                 8.    Main Tele Extend Check       13.   Main Tele Differential Sensing
       4.   Main Tele Exhaust Port    9.    Main Tele Retract Check      14.   Main Tele Retract Relief
       5.   Main Tele Exhaust Check   10.   Swing Differential Sensing   15.   Aux Port to Main Lift
5-98                                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                            SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
          1.   Main Tele Exhaust Check       6.    Main Lift Solenoid             11.   Main Pressure Port         16. Swing Left Test Port
          2.   Swing Right Test Port         7.    Pressure from Aux Pump         12.   Tower Lift Solenoid        17. Swing Left Relief
          3.   Main Tele Extend Test Port    8.    Return (Swivel)                13.   Main Dump Solenoid
          4.   Main Tele Retract Test Port   9.    Pressure from Function Pump    14.   Swing Check Valve
          5.   Pressure Switch               10.   Tower Tele Solenoid            15.   Proportional Swing Valve
3121171                                                                                                                                       5-99
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-100                                                                                          3121171
                                                SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                                       5-101
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-102                                                                               3121171
                                                                   SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
          1.   Inlet Compensator   7.    Orifice   12.   Spool    17.   Thrust Pad        22.   Plug           27. Relief Valve
          2.   Plug                8.    Plug      13.   O-ring   18.   Spring            23.   Seal           28. Conversion Kit
          4.   Plug                9.    Plug      14.   Plug     19.   O-ring            24.   Screw
          5.   Washer              10.   Spring    15.   Filter   20.   Adjusting Screw   25.   Plug
          6.   Housing             11.   Cone      16.   Seat     21.   Plug              26.   Pilot Supply
                                                   Figure 5-70. PVP Pump Side Module
3121171                                                                                                                             5-103
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                                      6
                                                                                                                 25 ± 3 Nm
                                                                                                              (221 ± 27 in.lb.)
                                                                                                      6
                                         20 ± 3 Nm
                                      (177 ± 27 in.lb.)           6
                                     8 ± 1 Nm
                                   (71 ± 9 in.lb.)
24
                                45 ± 5 Nm
                             (398 ± 44 in.lb.)
                                                                                                                          4 ± 1 Nm
                                                                                                                        (35 ± 9 in.lb.)
                          8 ± 1 Nm
                                                                                                                  2.5
                        (71 ± 9 in.lb.)
                                          4       4 ± 1 Nm
       35 ± 3 Nm
                                                (35 ± 9 in.lb.)
    (308 ± 27 in.lb.)
                                                          2.5
                    6
                                                                                                                                             6
                                                                                                                                 35 ± 3 Nm
                                                                                                                              (308 ± 27 in.lb.)
                               3
               4 ± 1 Nm
             (35 ± 9 in.lb.)
Figure 5-71. PVP Pump Side Module Torque Values & Tool Size
5-104                                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                     SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
          1.   Compensator Valve   6.   O-ring              10.   Check Valve   14.   O-ring   18.   PVLP         22. Relief Valve
          2.   Housing             7.   Adjusting Screw     11.   Shuttle       15.   Screw    19.   O-Ring
          4.   Thrust Pad          8.   Plug                12.   Shuttle       16.   Washer   20.   PVLA valve
          5.   Spring              9.   Plug                13.   Pipe          17.   Plug     21.   PVLA Plug
                                                      Figure 5-72. PVB Basic Module
3121171                                                                                                                              5-105
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                                             6        40 ± 3 Nm
                                                                                   (354 ± 27 in.lb.)
                    40 ± 3 Nm          13
                 (354 ± 27 in.lb.)
                                        10 ± 1 Nm
                                      (88.5 ± 9 in.lb.)
                                                                10
                                               35 ± 3 Nm
                                            (308 ± 27 in.lb.)
                                                         6
                                 Figure 5-73. PVB Basic Module Torque Values & Tool Size
5-106                                                                                                  3121171
                                              SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                    22 + 3,-0 Nm
                 (195 + 44, -0 in.lb.)
          13
                                         1.    Nut
                                         2.    Washer
                                         3.    Stay Bolt
                                         4.    O-ring
                                         5.    O-ring
                                         6.    O-ring
                                         7.    O-ring
               Figure 5-74. Assembly Kit & Torque for PVP Section
3121171                                                                                 5-107
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                          A. 5.2 Ohm ± 5%
                                          B. 7.2 Ohm
                                          C. 8.7 Ohm ± 5%
                                          D. 4.7 Ohm ± 5%
                               Figure 5-75. Main Valve Ohm Values
5-108                                                               3121171
                                 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                Ft-Lbs.        Nm
                       A          14           19
                       B        20-25         27-34
                       C         8-10         10-15
                       D        30-35         41-47
                       E        90-100       122-136
                    Coil Nuts    4-6           5-8
3121171                                                                    5-109
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                                  Ft-Lbs.       Nm
                                       A        354 in.lbs.     40
                                       B          20-25        27-34
                                       C          35-40        47-54
                                       D            50          68
                                       E         90-100       122-136
                                    Coil Nuts      4-6          5-8
5-110                                                                              3121171
                                     SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
                                    Ft-Lbs.       Nm
                         A        195 in.lbs.     22
                         B            50          68
                         C          50-55        68-75
                         D          8-10         10-15
                         E         90-100       122-136
                      Coil Nuts      4-6          5-8
3121171                                                                        5-111
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5.7 ENABLE VALVES                                                           7. Tag and disconnect the electrical harness from each
                                                                               enable valve solenoid.
Removal                                                                     8. Remove the existing hardware securing the enable
                                                                               valves to the turntable and remove the three enable
   1. Make sure the machine is on a firm level surface.                        valves.
   2. Extend the axles until the axle locked light is illumi-
      nated.                                                           Installation
   3. Position the machine with the booms on suitable boom                  1. Install the enable valves onto the turntable using the
      rests.                                                                   mounting hardware.
   4. Shut off the engine; remove the key and tag out the                   2. Connect all hoses and electrical lines as tagged during
      machine.                                                                 removal.
   5. Locate and identify the three enable valves on the left               3. If coils were removed, reinstall and torque to 5 foot
      side of the machine. Mark the function that the valve                    pounds (6.8 Nm) maximum.
      controls on the valve, i.e. tower lift, tower tele, main lift.
                                                                            4. Check the hydraulic oil level in the tank and replenish as
   6. Position a drain pan to catch any hydraulic spills and tag               necessary.
      and disconnect the hydraulic hoses going to the three
                                                                            5. Remove the tag out from the machine.
      enable valves. Cap or plug all hoses to prevent contami-
      nation of the hydraulic system and loss of hydraulic oil.             6. Proceed to next test procedure.
5-112                                                                                                                          3121171
                                                               SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Air Purge Procedure for Non-Calibrated Machines                    Air Purge Procedure for Calibrated Machines
   1. Loosen the hoses on Port #2 (side) of Tower Lift and            1. Loosen the hoses on Port #2 (side) of Tower Lift and
      Tower Telescope enable valves. This is not necessary on            Tower Telescope enable valves. It is not necessary on
      Main Lift Enable Valve because the orientation of the              Main Lift Enable Valve because the orientation of the
      valve allows the air to escape.                                    valve allows the air to escape.
   2. Operate the Main Telescope in until oil appears at Port         2. Operate the Main Telescope in until oil appears at Port
      #2 of both valves.                                                 #2 of both valves.
   3. Tighten both hoses.                                             3. Tighten both hoses.
   4. Raise the Main Boom to approximately 10° above hori-            4. Operate Tower Lift up until Tower Booms begins to Tele-
      zontal.                                                            scope.
   5. Operate the Tower Lift for 25 of the following cycles:          5. If an ENABLE VALVE STUCK OPEN fault occurs;
        a. Raise the Tower Boom approximately 18”                          a. Cycle power.
        b. Pause for approximately 2 seconds.                              b. Use Auxiliary Power to raise the Tower Boom until
        c. Lower the Tower Boom to the boom rest.                             the Tower Telescope starts to move.
        d. Pause for approximately 2 seconds.                         6. Under engine power, operate the Tower Lift for 25 of the
                                                                         following cycles:
   6. Operate the Tower Telescope for 25 of the following
      cycles:                                                              a. Raise the Tower Boom approximately 18”.
        a. Extend the Tower Booms approximately 2’                         b. Pause for approximately 2 seconds.
        b. Pause for approximately 2 seconds                               c. Lower the Tower Boom 18”.
        c. Fully retract the Tower Booms.                          NOTE: Do not pause at this reversal. Quickly switch from Tower
        d. Pause for approximately 2 seconds.                            down to Tower up.
                                                                      7. Raise the Tower Boom 18”, then lower it and stop before
                                                                         the boom is on the boom rest.
                                                                      8. Command Tower Boom up until boom moves.
                                                                      9. Check for faults.
                                                                     10.   If there are faults, continue cycling as in Step #6 until
                                                                           there are no faults after completing Steps #7 and #8.
                                                                     11.   If there are no faults, position the machine in the stowed
                                                                           position.
3121171                                                                                                                      5-113
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5.8 PRESSURE SETTING PROCEDURE                                         stand by adjustment is the outside adjustment, closest
                                                                       to the turntable.
 Cold temperatures have a significant impact on pressure read-
 ings. JLG Industries Inc. recommends operating the machine
 until the hydraulic system has warmed to normal operating
 temperatures prior to checking pressures. JLG Industries Inc.
 also recommends the use of a calibrated gauge. Pressure read-
 ings are acceptable if they are within ± 5% of specified pres-
 sures.
SAUER PUMP
   3. To make an adjustment to this pressure, go to the            5. After adjusting the pressure, tighten the jam nut and the
      engine compartment, locate the function pump. The               cover nut if applicable.
                                                                   6. Start the engine and verify the gauge reads 425-475 psi
                                                                      (29.3-32.75 bar).
5-114                                                                                                                3121171
                                                            SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
SAUER PUMP
                                                                  5. After adjusting the pressure, tighten the jam nut and the
                                                                     cover nut if applicable. This is the maximum relief pres-
                                                                     sure for all the functions governed by this pump.
REXROTH PUMP
3121171                                                                                                                  5-115
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5. Install high pressure gauge at "M14". 5. Install high pressure relief at "M2".
   7. Swing left relief is located to the left of "M14". The          7. Main telescope retract is on top surface of valve directly
      adjustment is below the outer cap. Turn CW to increase             behind "M2". The adjustment is below the outer plug.
      pressure.                                                          Turn CW to increase pressure.
MAIN TELESCOPE 2200 PSI (151.6 BAR) PVG VALVE (MAIN LIFT, TOWER LIFT, AND TOWER TELE)
   1. Cap ports 1 and 2.                                            Because of an internal shuttle network in the PVG valve, all
                                                                    port pressures can be measured at the "LS" quick connect on
   2. Install high pressure gauge at "M1".                          the top surface of the valve to the extreme left.
5-116                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
         c. The analyzer screen should read:                           2. In this level, enter the "service mode" menu then scroll
                                                                          left or right to "set pressure" submenu as shown below.
THE SERVICE MODE MENU WILL BE SELECTABLE AT THE TOP LEVEL OF THE
ANALYZER MENU STRUCTURE. “SERVICE MODE” WILL BE DISPLAYED ON THE
TOP LINE OF THE ANALYZER WITH THE CURRENT SUB-MENU SELECTION ON
THE BOTTOM LINE. THE SUB-MENUS WILL SCROLL WITH THE LEFT AND RIGHT
ARROW KEYS.
3121171                                                                                                                    5-117
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
   5. When the operator enters access code 146005, "SET                 play "SERVICE FAILED" on the top line and "VALVE FAULT"
      PRESSURES" will be displayed on the top line and cur-             on the bottom line as shown below.
      rent sub-menu on the bottom line. The sub-menus will
      scroll with the left and right arrow keys.
   6. Pressure setting sub-menus will include the following:
        • "MAIN LIFT?"
        • "TWR LIFT?"
        • "TWR TELE?"
   7. When the operator presses the ENTER key, "SET PRES-
      SURES" will be displayed on the top line of the analyzer
      and the bottom line will display the following: "WARN-
      ING" flashed on a 0.5 hertz rate for 3 cycles followed by
      the scrolling of "MOVEMENT POSSIBLE". This flashing
      and scrolling will repeat until the ENTER key is pressed.
5-118                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                  SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Adjustments Made at the Frame Valve Bank                                1. Position machine with front and rear axles fully
                                                                           extended.
  AXLE EXTEND AND RETRACT, FRONT AND REAR - 2500 PSI
  (172.3 BAR)
                                                                        2. Install the Analyzer in the platform control box and scroll
    1. To extend axles, drive machine back and forth until                 menu’s to Access Level 2 and insert password (33271) to
       extended. A machine that cannot be driven must be                   get into Access Level 1.
       jacked up.
    2. On both the front and rear frame valve banks, install a
       high pressure gauge on ports MA1 for extend and MA2
       for retract. The gauge should read 2500 psi (172.3 Bar) in
       both directions.
    3. The axle extend/retract cylinders are connected hydrau-
       lically in parallel. In order to get the correct pressure of
       the circuit being adjusted, unscrew the solenoid coil
       from the circuit not being adjusted and pull it away from
       the valve.
    4. Turn clockwise to increase, counterclockwise to
       decrease.
  STEERING, FRONT AND REAR
NOTE: The following procedure requires 2 people to perform. One         3. Scroll to the calibration mode. Once in the calibration
      is needed for verifying / adjusting pressure readings and            mode, press “ENTER” and scroll to steer. Once in the
      wheel spindle alignment the other for operating the steer            steer calibration mode, the Analyzer is going to ask to
      functions and using the Analyzer from the platform.                  calibrate the steer sensors, this is going to allow extend-
                                                                           ing and retracting each steer cylinder individually dur-
  The Analyzer is required to perform the pressure check proce-            ing this process. The JLG control system will ask to
  dure through access of the calibration menu. The calibration             calibrate the left front sensor, the left rear sensor, the
  menu will allow for extending and retracting the steer cylin-            right front sensor and finally the right rear sensor in that
  ders individually, verifying pressures, and proper steer sensor          order. During this calibration mode each individual steer
  calibration. Verification of the steer sensor calibration will           cylinder will be extended and retracted to verify correct
  require one of two types of measuring methods; using a                   pressures with the marked MS (Measure Steer) ports on
  square and ruler or using string as explained in Section 6 - JLG         the steer / axle valve that pertains to that steer cylinder.
  Control System. The purpose of these measuring tools is to               Refer to the Hydraulic Schematic in Section 7 - Schemat-
  assure that the wheel spindle is aligned “straight” with the             ics.
  extended axle weldment.
3121171                                                                                                                        5-119
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-120                                                                   3121171
                                                                  SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
   4. Remove the circular covers at the side or square cover at         6. Remove the pressure gauge from MS2 port and install
      the top to gain access to the axle/steer valves.                     on the MS1 port, which is on the right side of the front
                                                                           axle/steer valve, closest to the right front wheel spindle.
                                                                           Position the steer switch to activate the left front steer
                                                                           cylinder until the rod is in the fully retracted position
                                                                           and hold the switch for a few seconds after the rod has
                                                                           stopped. The MS1 port should read 2600 psi (179 Bar). If
                                                                           the pressure is not correct, adjust relief valve next to
                                                                           MS1 port, CW to increase or CCW to decrease.
3121171                                                                                                                       5-121
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
   8. Checking the left rear steer cylinder is identical to the             mounted next to MS2 port CW to increase or CCW to
      procedure for left front steer cylinder, except now we are            decrease.
      checking pressures at the rear axle/steer valve location.
      Install pressure gauge at MS1 port. This should be
      located on the left side of the valve closest to the left
      rear wheel spindle. MS1 port should read 2600 psi (179
      Bar) when the left rear steer cylinder is activated with
      the rod in the fully retracted position. If the pressure is
      not 2600 psi (179 Bar) adjust relief valve mounted next
      to MS1 port CW to increase or CCW to decrease.
                                                                      10.   The next step is identical to the left front step men-
                                                                            tioned above. Make sure the left rear wheel spindle is
                                                                            straight and press “ENTER” to accept the new calibration
                                                                            settings, now press “ESC” (escape) and scroll to the right
                                                                            front steer calibration step.
                                                                      11.   Checking the right front steer cylinder is identical to the
                                                                            procedure laid out for the left front steer cylinder, except
                                                                            the pressures are now checked at MS3 port of the front
   9. Remove the gauge from MS1 port and install on MS2
                                                                            axle/steer valve. This should be at the right side of the
      port, which is on the right side of the rear axle/steer
                                                                            valve closest to the right front wheel spindle. Install the
      valve, closest to the right rear wheel spindle. Position
                                                                            gauge at MS3 port. Position the steer switch to activate
      the steer switch to activate the left rear steer cylinder
                                                                            the right front steer cylinder until the rod is in the fully
      until the rod is in the fully extended position and hold
                                                                            retracted position and hold the steer switch for a few
      the steer switch for a few seconds after the rod has been
                                                                            seconds after the rod has been fully retracted. If the
      fully extended. The MS2 port should read 2000 psi (179
                                                                            pressure is not 2600 psi (179 Bar), adjust the relief valve
      Bar). If the pressure is not correct, adjust the relief valve
                                                                            mounted next to the MS3 port CW to increase or CCW to
                                                                            decrease.
5-122                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                     SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
  12.   Remove the gauge from MS3 port and install on MS4                 16.   The next step is identical to the left front step men-
        port, which is on the left side of the front axle/steer                 tioned above, make sure the right rear wheel spindle is
        valve, closest to the left front wheel spindle. Position the            straight and press “ENTER” to accept the new calibration
        steer switch to activate the right front steer cylinder                 settings, now escape out of the calibration menu and
        until the rod is in the fully extended position and hold                remove the Analyzer and pressure gauge.
        the steer switch for a few seconds after the rod has
        stopped extending. The MS4 port should read 2000 psi             Adjustments Made at the Platform Valve Bank
        (138 Bar). If the pressure is not correct, adjust relief valve
        mounted next to the MS4 port CW to increase or CCW to             PLATFORM LEVEL UP - 3000 PSI (206.8 BAR)
        decrease.                                                          1. Install a high pressure gauge at the gauge port M1.
  13.   The next step is identical to the left front step men-             2. Activate level up to the end of stroke, it should read
        tioned above. Make sure the right front wheel spindle is              3000 psi (206.8 Bar).
        straight and press “ENTER” to accept the new calibration
        settings. Scroll over to right rear steer calibration step.        3. All the relief valves are located on the same face. The
                                                                              level up relief valve is located closest to the M1 gauge
  14.   Checking the right rear steer cylinder is identical to the            port. Turn clockwise to increase, counterclockwise to
        procedure laid out for the left rear steer cylinder. Install          decrease.
        gauge at MS4 port of the rear axle/steer valve. This
        should be at the right side of the valve closest to the           PLATFORM LEVEL DOWN - 2500 PSI (172.3 BAR)
        right rear wheel spindle. Position the steer switch to acti-       1. Install a high pressure gauge at gauge port M2.
        vate the right rear steer cylinder until the rod is in the
        fully extended position and hold the steer switch for a            2. Activate level down to the end of stroke, it should read
        few seconds after the rod has stopped extending. The                  2500 psi (172.3 Bar).
        MS4 port should read 2000 psi (138 Bar. If the pressure is         3. The level down relief valve is located to the left of the
        not correct, adjust relief valve next to the MS4 port CCW             level up relief valve. Turn clockwise to increase, counter-
        to increase or CCW to decrease.                                       clockwise to decrease.
  15.   Remove gauge from MS4 port and install on MS3 port,               ARTICULATING JIB UP AND DOWN - 2750 PSI (189.6 BAR)
        which is on the left side of the rear axle/steer valve, clos-
        est to the left rear wheel spindle. Position the steer             1. Install a high pressure gauge on gauge port M3. The jib
        switch to activate the right rear steer cylinder until the            relief valve is located below the level down relief valve.
        rod is in the fully retracted position and hold the steer             Activate jib up or down, it should read 2750 psi (189.6
        switch for a few seconds after the rod stops retracting. If           Bar). Turn clockwise to increase, counterclockwise to
        the pressure is not 2600 psi (179 Bar), adjust the relief             decrease.
        valve mounted next to the MS3 port CW to increase or
        CCW to decrease.
3121171                                                                                                                           5-123
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5.9 DRIVE PUMPS                                                            2. Transmission does not propel the machine, diesel
                                                                              engine running properly - Charge Pump/Relief Valve
Troubleshooting Procedure                                                       a. Is there any charge pressure at port G or indicated
                                                                                   by measuring pressure at Ma and Mb?
 To aid in troubleshooting, refer also to the pressure measuring
                                                                                   No - Proceed to step 2.d
 port connections for test gauge installation information as
                                                                                   Yes - Proceed to step 2.b
 shown on the hydraulic circuit diagram. Procedure assumes
 proper gauges are installed. (Minimum gauges required: (2) 0-                  b. Is the charge pressure at least 500 psi while running
 6000 psi, (1) 0-3000 psi & (1) 0-1000 psi [{2} 0-415 bar, {1} 0-210               at high engine speed?
 bar & {1} 0-70 bar]). This procedure was written to aid the trou-                 No - Proceed to step 2.c
 bleshooter in following a logical approach to a hydraulic sys-                    Yes - Proceed to step 3.a
 tem fault.                                                                     c. Can the charge pressure be raised by removing dirt/
                                                                                   debris from charge relief poppet or by adding or
   1. Transmission does not propel the machine, diesel
                                                                                   removing shims from the charge pressure relief
      engine running properly
                                                                                   valve mounted in the second pump of the triple?
        a. Is there oil in the reservoir?                                          No - Proceed to step 2.d
           No - Fill reservoir                                                     Yes - Adjust pressure to 500 psi +50 psi, -0 psi (34.4
           Yes - If yes, proceed to step 1.b                                       bar +3.4 bar, -0 bar)
        b. Is the pump input shaft connected to the engine             NOTE: The propulsion circuit uses a hot oil flushing valve to
           flex plate or rear of forward pump?                               obtain brake release pressure. The hot oil flushing valve
           No - Connect pump input shaft                                     cartridge (#120) is mounted in the Traction Control Mani-
           Yes - If yes, proceed to step 1.c                                 fold. The flushing valve receives its oil from the "left side"
        c. Are the hydraulic hoses and tubing connected in                   wheel drive pump; the middle pump of the triple. With the
           accordance with the hydraulic circuit diagram?                    engine running and propelling the machine forward or
                                                                             reverse, the "hot oil flushing valve" and the brake release
            No - Correct the hoses/tubing                                    pressure must be adjusted to 475 psi, +25 psi, -0 psi (32.7
            Yes - If yes, proceed to step 1.d                                bar, +1.7 bar, -0 bar), as set by adjusting pressure relief car-
        d. Is the pump direction of rotation correct? (clockwise             tridge (#130). The brake release pressure must be 25 psi
           as looking at the shaft)                                          less than the charge pump pressure. Measure pressure at
                                                                             port "MP" using a 0-1000 psi (0 - 70 bar) pressure gauge.
            No - Fit pump having the correct direction of rota-                 d. Is the transmission pumps suction hose pinched
            tion                                                                   shut?
            Yes - If yes, proceed to step 1.e                                      No - Proceed to step 2e
        e. Are there "O"-rings missing from fittings (as exam-                     Yes - Repair damaged hose
           ple - suction leak), pinched hoses, broken tubing,                   e. Is the charge pump suction pressure/vacuum within
           etc?                                                                    recommended limits? (0.8 bar absolute or 6.3 inches
                                                                                   of mercury)
            No - Proceed to step 1.f                                               No - Proceed to step 2.f
            Yes - Repair damage or fault                                           Yes - Proceed to step 2.g
        f. Are the electrical connectors/wiring intact and                      f. Is the suction strainer inside the reservoir blocked,
           secure to the pump control solenoids?                                   clogged, restricted?
           No - Repair damage or fault                                             No - Proceed to step 2.g
           Yes - If yes, proceed to step 1.g                                       Yes - Repair/replace with a clean suction strainer
        g. Does the engine "labor" when attempting drive, are                   g. Is the reservoir air breather blocked or restricted?
           the brakes released?                                                    No - Proceed to step 2.h
           No - Proceed to step 1.h                                                Yes - Clean or replace air breather
           Yes - Check brake release circuit, measure pressure
           at port "MP" on Traction Control manifold
        h. Are all four wheel drive planetary reduction gear-
           boxes engaged?
           No - Engage wheel drive(s)
           Yes - If yes, proceed to step 2.a
5-124                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
       h. Remove charge pressure relief valve from the mid-                    pressure to increase above charge pressure. Pro-
          dle pump and inspect. Is it damaged?                                 ceed to step 3.a
          No - Refit cartridge and proceed to step 2.i                         Yes - Proceed to step 3.g
          Yes - Clean & inspect cartridge, poppet, springs,                 g. Is it possible to adjust high pressure relief valves
          seals to determine cause of damage. Repair or fit a                  using 0-6000 psi (0 - 415 bar) gauges to monitor
          new cartridge and return to step 2.a                                 pressure at Ma & Mb? (Refer to relief valve adjust-
       i.   Remove and inspect charge pump assemblies. Are                     ment)
            they damaged?                                                      No - Replace high pressure relief valve and return to
            No - Proceed to step 2.j                                           step 3.c
            Yes - Repair and/or replace damaged components                     Yes - Adjust high pressure relief valves to 5000 psi
            and return to step 2.a                                             +50 psi, -0 psi (344.7 bar +3.4 bar, -0 bar)
       j.   Is the charge pump installed for the clockwise rota-            h. Actuate control in both directions. Does transmis-
            tion?                                                              sion operate?
            No - Refit charge pump. Return to step 2.a                         No - Check that minimum displacement stops on
            Yes - With proper charge pressure and transmission                 the wheel drive motors are adjusted properly, check
            still does not operate, proceed to step 3.a                        that the motors stroke between maximum to mini-
                                                                               mum.
   3. Transmission does not propel the machine, diesel
                                                                               Yes - Operate the transmission
      engine running properly - Pump Control: (Insure Gener-
      ator Drive option is not turned "on")                            4. Transmission Drive is Sluggish or Erratic
       a. Are the electrical connectors & wiring connected                  a. Does the "EP" proportional pump control current
          properly to the pump control solenoids?                              vary with joystick movement?
          No - Connect a ammeter in series with solenoid wir-                  No - Rectify the problem - broken wires, electrical
          ing. Is a current of 400 mA to 1060 mA being                         connector, open solenoid coil, etc.
          applied. (Current signal varies with joystick position)              Yes - Proceed to step 4.b
          Yes - Proceed to step 3.b
                                                                            b. Are all four (4) brakes fully released?
       b. Are all four of the two-speed motors, mounted in                     No - Check brake release pressure and insure each
          the wheel drive planetary reduction gearboxes,                       wheel receives correct release pressure.
          shifted to maximum displacement (high torque -                       Yes - Proceed to step 4.c
          low speed)?
                                                                            c. Are the pumps stroking time orifices installed tight
          No - Select maximum displacement
                                                                               and clean?
          Yes - Proceed to step 3.c
                                                                               No - Remove the Plugs in ports X1 and X2. Remove
       c. Actuate the pump control in both directions. Do
                                                                               orifices with a 3mm allen wrench. Check that ori-
          the pumps stroke? Do they go to full stroke?
                                                                               fices are clean & re-install.
          No - Refer to the pump service manual and then
                                                                               Yes - Proceed to step 4.d
          proceed to step 3.d
          Yes - Operate the transmission                                    d. Is an motor displacement stroking time orifice
                                                                               plugged or is the two-speed shift hose pinched?
       d. Remove stroking orifices in X1 and X2. Install pres-
                                                                               Yes - Inspect and clean stroking orifice, check two-
          sure gauges in X 1 and X 2 (0-500 psi [0 - 35 bar]).                 speed hose routing
          Stroke the pump in both directions. Do the pres-                  e. Is a flow divider/combiner cartridge stuck in the
          sures at X1 and X2 alternate between 30 & 250 psi (2                 Traction Control Manifold? Flow divider/combiner
          & 17 bar)?                                                           cartridge # 111 controls the right side wheels, # 112
          No - Remove the EP control module & replace it with                  controls the left side wheels. Also check to insure
          a new unit. Repeat step 3.c                                          bypass orifices #151 (right side) and # 152 (left side
          Yes - Proceed to step 3.e.                                           are not plugged.
       e. Is the pressure at port "R", case pressure, less than 15
          psi (1 bar) gauge pressure?
          No - Correct problem restricting case drain oil flow
          (oil cooler blockage, pinched hoses, etc)
          Yes - Proceed to step 3.f
       f. Stroke pump in both directions, while measuring
          pressure at Ma & Mb ports of the pump. Does any
          pressure greater than charge pressure alternate
          between ports Ma & Mb?
          No - Verify that loading the pump will cause system
3121171                                                                                                                      5-125
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5. Transmission Drives in one direction only 7. Transmission Does Not Find or Hold Neutral
        a. Are electrical connections to pump control propor-            a. Does pump remain in neutral with electrical con-
           tional solenoids correct, intact and without defects?            nectors removed?
           Yes - Proceed to step 5.b                                        No - proceed to step 7.b
           No - Rectify the problem                                         Yes - Check electrical system for signal problem
        b. Check hot oil flushing valve cartridge #120 located           b. With electrical connectors removed and machines
           in the Traction Control Manifold.                                wheels jacked off the ground and engine running,
           Remove and inspect flushing valve cartridge for                  momentarily apply 12 volt DC signal (battery volt-
           stuck spool or damaged cartridge "O"-ring seals &                age) to a pump control solenoid. Does the pump
           backup rings.                                                    return to neutral after the 12 volt signal is removed?
        c. Inspect "Make-Up" check valve cartridges, #190.1-                No - Apply 12 volts to opposite solenoid & recheck.
           190.4, installed in the Traction Control Manifold. Is a          No - Replace pump control module, repeat step 7.a
           cartridge "stuck" open with debris or is an "O"-ring             Yes - Possibly dirt was dislodged from control mod-
           failed?                                                          ule, re-check thoroughly to determine problem has
           No - Proceed to step 5.d                                         definitely been resolved.
           Yes - Clean/repair or replace Make-Up check car-              c. Check mechanical centering of the pumps
           tridge.
                                                                     8. Transmission Drives at a High Noise Level
        d. Swap high pressure relief valves in the transmission.
           Does the transmission drive in the other direction?           a. Are the wheel drive planetary reduction gearboxes
           No - Proceed to step 5.e                                         filled to the correct level and do they have the
           Yes - Repair/clean/adjust or replace high pressure               proper lubricant?
           relief valve on the non-driving side                             No - Fill gearbox with correct grade of oil to the pre-
                                                                            scribed level.
        e. Replace "EP" control module. Does pump operate
                                                                            Yes - Proceed to step 8.b
           properly?
           No - Replace or repair pump                                   b. Is the engine flex plate and drive coupling correctly
           Yes - Operate the transmission                                   installed and aligned with the transmission pump?
                                                                            No - Install flex plate and bell housing per manufac-
   6. Transmission Drives in Wrong Direction                                turer's instructions
                                                                            Yes - proceed to step 8.c
        a. Check to see if electrical connectors or wiring have
           been swapped on the pump.                                     c. Is a rigid item or object contacting the resilient
                                                                            mounted engine/pump assembly?
        b. Check to determine want end of the machine the                   No - Proceed to step 8.d
           boom is swung over.                                              Yes - Insure no item is contacting the unit, transmit-
                                                                            ting air borne noise.
                                                                         d. Is the suction pressure/vacuum at the charge
                                                                            pumps inlets within recommended limits?
                                                                            No - Return to step 1.h
                                                                            Yes - Proceed to step 8.e
                                                                         e. Is there air in the hydraulic fluid? This may be indi-
                                                                            cated by foaming or milky colored oil.
                                                                            No - Proceed to step 8.f
                                                                            Yes - De-aerate the oil and inspect system for cause
                                                                            of air induction. Check for loose or missing O-rings
                                                                            on face seal connections.
5-126                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                  SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
        f. Is a wheel drive hydraulic motor operating at exces-        11.   Transmission Pump(s) Do Not Develop Maximum Horse-
           sive speed?                                                       power (Flow & Pressure)
           Yes - Check minimum displacement stop screw
           adjustments on the motors. Should be 0.433" or                     a. Does the charge pump pressure meet specification?
           11mm above the stop screw lock nut. Is one or                         No - Return to step 2.a
           more motors "stuck" at minimum displacement,                          Yes - Proceed to step 11.b
           check for plugged/blocked two-speed stroking ori-                  b. Does the pump case pressure exceed 15 psi gauge
           fice(s).                                                              pressure?
                                                                                 No - Proceed to step 11.c
    9. Transmission Operates at a Higher than Normal Temper-
                                                                                 Yes - Check case drain hoses, oil cooler, etc. for
       ature
                                                                                 pinched or restricted oil flow
        a. Is the reservoir temperature above 195oF (90.5° C)?                c. Are the pump(s) high pressure cross port relief
           No - 195oF (90.5° C) is the upper limit. If tempera-                  valves adjusted to the required pressure (5000 psi)
           ture is over 195oF (90.5° C), the oil cooler may need                 so they do not bypass prematurely?
           to be cleaned.                                                        No - Inspect/clean/adjust and or replace valve car-
           Yes - Proceed to step 9.c                                             tridge
                                                                                 Yes - Replace the pump, after blocking the "A" & "B"
        b. Are the hydraulic motor(s) stalling (wheels not turn-                 ports, running the pump and measuring pressure
           ing) intermittently?                                                  developed at "A" & "B". This must be done to insure
           No - Proceed to step 9.c                                              that flow & pressure loss in not elsewhere in the sys-
           Yes - Hydraulic fluid is being heated through system                  tem. (motors, swivel coupling, etc)
           pressure relief valves. Shut down system and rectify
           the cause of motor stall.                                          d. Is the diesel engine capable of developing horse-
                                                                                 power at design rpm?
        c. Does oil temperature remain above 195oF (90.5° C),                    Follow recommended troubleshooting procedures
           after cleaning the oil cooler?                                        to insure the engine is developing full power at
           No - Operate transmission. Check oil cooler more                      specified rpms.
           often.
           Yes - Proceed to step 8.a                                  Charge Pressure Relief Valve Adjustment
  10.   Transmission Operates at a Higher than Normal Temper-
        ature
        a. Check for differential temperature across the oil
           cooler. Is there a temperature difference?
           No - Check to determine if the bypass check valve
           (10 psi [0.7 bar] crack pressure) is stuck open. Check
           to determine if the oil cooler is restricted internally,
           causing oil flow to pass across the bypass check
           valve.
           Yes - Proceed to step 8.b
3121171                                                                                                                           5-127
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
NOTE: Shim thickness 1 mm = 56 psi (3.86 bar). Shims are avail-    Hydraulic Centering of Control Modules
      able in 0.3, 0.5, and 1.0 mm thickness.
                                                                    PREPARATION FOR ADJUSTMENT
                                                                    When control modules are exchanged or replaced, it is gener-
                                                                    ally necessary to center the new module. This is done by run-
                                                                    ning the pump with gauges installed at ports X1, X2, MA, and
                                                                    MB Release the jam nut and turn the adjustment screw on top
                                                                    of the control module valve body.
  With pressure gages installed at MA, and MB, and with A and B
  ports blocked (or motor stalled), and with the pump running,      The adjustment screw is an eccentric, therefore, turning more
  loosen the jam nut. Turn the mechanical centering adjusting       than 90’ in either direction will have no further centering
  screw until 1000 psi is read on MA, or MB then turn screw         effect, and could cause damage to the eccentric pin.
  opposite direction until 1000 psi is read on other pressure           Pump Size           Tool Required            Wrench
  port. Turn the screw back, splitting the distance between the
  previous two positions. This should be the neutral position.             28               Screwdriver             10 mm
  Pressure on MA, and MB should be equal.
                                                                    CENTERING THE EP CONTROL MODULE
                                                                    With no electrical signal to solenoids A and B, (remove both
                                                                    plug-in connectors), the EP control module is correctly
                                                                    adjusted when any or all of the following conditions exist:
                                                                      1. Approximately, when equal control pressures are
                                                                         obtained at control pressure ports X1 and X2.
  Tighten jam nut, stop the pump drive, remove the hose con-
  necting ports X1 and X2.
5-128                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                  SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
 trol spring are correctly located in the grooves near the end of     Removal and inspection of charge pump
 the feedback lever arms.
                                                                       Before removing capscrews, mark the position of the charge
                                                                       pump housing and separator plate in relation to the port
                                                                       block.
3121171                                                                                                                        5-129
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
  sembly. Make sure 0-rings are completely seated in their           Routine Maintenance
  grooves.
                                                                      The Variable Displacement Hydrostatic Transmission Pumps
                                                                      are relatively maintenance free. Maintenance work is confined
                                                                      to the system, by way of maintaining hydraulic fluid condition,
                                                                      the "life blood" of the machine. Oil monitoring, changes and
                                                                      filter renewal promote system cleanliness. This will prevent
                                                                      premature breakdown and repairs. Under normal application
                                                                      conditions, the following maintenance intervals are sug-
                                                                      gested:
                                                                       1. Renewal of Filter Elements
                                                                            a. After commissioning or re-build.
                                                                            b. At every 500 operating hours or when filter indica-
                                                                               tor shows a dirty element.
                                                                            c. With the suction strainer, the strainer should be
                                                                               renewed as soon as charge pump inlet pressure is
                                                                               less than -3.2 psi, 6.3"Hg or 0.8 bar absolute.
                                                                            d. Only JLG recommended filter elements are to be
                                                                               used. Paper elements cannot be cleaned; use
  Withdraw pinion shaft and inspect gear teeth and bearing sur-                throwaway cartridges.
  faces for abnormal wear.
                                                                       2. Hydraulic Fluid Change
  When reassembling, make sure chamfer (on outer edge of
  driven gear and drive gear) is installed into housing per illus-          a. After 2000 operating hours (1st oil change)
  tration.                                                                  b. Thereafter, every 2000 operating hours or annually,
                                                                               irrespective of operating hours achieved.
                                                                            c. Oil change should be performed with the system in
                                                                               warm running condition. Before re-filling, the reser-
                                                                               voir interior should be inspected and cleaned to
                                                                               remove any sludge.
                                                                            d. Rags or threaded material must not be used.
                                                                            e. This machine has been designed & manufactured to
                                                                               operate on an Exxon-Mobil Oil Co. hydraulic fluid,
                                                                               Mobilfluid #424, Product #52233-4. Consult JLG
                                                                               Industries prior to introducing any other type of
                                                                               fluid to prevent interaction or possible contamina-
                                                                               tion.
                                                                            f. The recommended interval between oil changes is
  Torque value for bolts when replacing charge pump.                           based on various factors and should be carried out
                                                                               according to the degree of aging, contamination
                 Pump Size              Torque                                 and water content.
                    28             18 ft.lb. (24 Nm)
5-130                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                        SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                                                                              5-131
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Removal and Installation of Shaft Seal                           Press in shaft seal with bushing to the stop. Then replace snap
                                                                 ring.
 Remove the retaining ring with snap ring pliers.
 Screw in sheet metal screw into the holes fitted with rubber.
 Pull out shaft seal with pliers.
5-132                                                                                                                 3121171
                                                                          SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                                                             5-133
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-134                                                                                                       3121171
                                                            SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
   4. Rotary Group complete: 9 pistons, cylinder subassem-      Sealing the Drive Shaft
      bly, valve plate, retaining plate, and retaining ball.
5. Swash Plate.
3121171                                                                                                                  5-135
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
   4. Assemble the sealing ring, fitting tool holds the correct   2. Mark the position of the port plate and remove the
      position of the sealing ring in the pump housing.              socket screw of the port plate.
   5. Assemble the snap ring.                                     3. Remove the port plate together with the valve plate
                                                                     (hold the valve plate so the plate can’t fall down).
5-136                                                                                                               3121171
                                                               SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
6. Remove the adjustment shim. 10. Disassemble the rotary group in horizontal position.
7. Unscrew the cap nut and remove it. 11. Disassemble the stopper max flow.
   8. Loosen the fixing nut of the stopper max flow and disas-      12.   Remove the threaded pin.
      semble it.
3121171                                                                                                                    5-137
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
  14.   Disassemble the control piston while moving the swash        18.   Remove both bearing shells.
        plate.
5-138                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
  22.   The external front bearing ring is pulled out of the pump     25.   The spring has additional pretension while you disas-
        housing.                                                            semble the three pressure pins inside the cylinder.
  23.   Remove the o-ring. Lifting of the valve plate isn’t shown.   Assembly
                                                                       1. Measurement of the taper roller bearing pretention.
3121171                                                                                                                   5-139
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-140                                                                                                                                 3121171
                                      SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                         5-141
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
Pump Control Disassembly For Cleaning                                  5. Remove three (3) 0-rings (Parker # 2-011, Viton 90 shore)
                                                                          or the sealing plate.
  NOTE: If the Function Pump does not perform correctly after
  following pre-start procedures, it is possible that a contami-       6. Remove both the adjustment hex caps and bonded seal
  nate particle has lodged in the pump control preventing                 rings. (17 mm wrench)
  proper operation. The pump control’s internal parts are not          7. Remove both the adjustment lock nuts and bonded seal
  provided as spare parts due to the close tolerances required            rings. (17 mm wrench)
  between the mating parts. However, the control can be disas-
  sembled, cleaned and placed back in service should the only          8. Remove both the adjusting screws. (3-mm Allen
  problem prove to be contamination. Disassembly, inspection,             wrench)
  cleaning and reassembly MUST BE done in a clean well-illumi-         9. Remove spring cover hex cap for the ”outer” flow regula-
  nated area.                                                             tion adjustment this requires a 19-mm wrench.
  Pump Control removal:                                               10.   Remove the spring disc.
    1. Disconnect plug the hose attached to the pump control          11.   Remove the adjusting springs (two springs, one
       Port ”X”.                                                            ”nested” inside the other) and spring follower.
    2. Remove the four (4) socket head capscrews that attach          12.   The flow regulation spool should slide from the control
       the control to the pump. Insure that the three (3) ”0”-              housing, (a magnet should aid in removal). If it does not,
       rings are also removed with the control.                             remove the hollow hex head plug at the rear of the flow
    3. Hydraulic fluid may drip from the pump. Wiping the sur-              regulation spool and carefully push the spool from the
       face clean and installing some adhesive tape should pre-             housing - do not scratch/mar the spool’s bore.
       vent oil from seeping from the pump control.                   13.   Remove the spring cover hex cap for the ”inner” pres-
    4. Work on a clean, lint free area.                                     sure compensation adjustment – this requires a 30-mm
                                                                            wrench.
NOTE: The pump control can be equipped with either O-rings or a
      sealing plate. These components are NOT interchangeable.        14.   Remove the spring disc.
5-142                                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                     SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
   15.   Remove adjusting springs (two springs, one ”nested”             5.11 DRIVE & FUNCTION PUMP START UP
         inside the other).
   16.   Remove spring follower. Pressure compensation spool             Start-Up Procedure
         should slide from control housing, (a magnet should aid
                                                                          The machine utilizes a Triple Combination Pump coupled to
         in removal). If it does not, remove the hollow hex head
                                                                          the Deutz diesel engine. Pumps are connected in-line to each
         plug at rear of flow regulation spool. Carefully push
                                                                          other as follows:
         spool from housing. Do not scratch/mar spool bore.
                                                                           1. The front hydrostatic transmission pump, or drive pump,
NOTE: Spools are identical.                                                   is coupled directly to the diesel engine and provides oil
   17.   Wash housing and all parts in a clean JLG approved sol-              flow to operate the machine's right side wheels.
         vent such as non-chlorinated brake cleaner, Stoddard              2. The middle hydrostatic transmission pump, or drive
         solvent, etc.                                                        pump, is coupled to the back of the front pump and pro-
   18.   Blow off all parts with clean, dry compressed air.                   vides oil flow to operate the machine's left side wheels.
   19.   Blow out housing with clean compressed air. Inspect               3. The third or rear pump is the function pump. It is cou-
         housing for contamination or plugged orifices. Clean                 pled to the back of the middle pump and provides oil
         orifices carefully with a soft steel wire to ensure they are         flow to operate the boom, axle, steer and platform func-
         open. Inspect parts for burrs, scoring, debris, etc.                 tions.
                                                                          Transmission pumps share some common connections. Each
                                                                          pumps’ charge oil suction ports are connected by steel tubing.
ON CONTROL HOUSING MOUNTING SURFACE, BETWEEN OIL PORTS, IS WHAT           Discharge oil flows are connected and flow to a common
APPEARS TO BE A SLOTTED HEAD SCREW. IT IS NOT A SCREW. THIS IS A BLEED    charge pump inline oil filter. Cleaned & filtered oil flows back
ORIFICE, WHICH MUST BE ORIENTATED TO ALLOW PROPER CONTROL OPERA-          to the transmission pumps "G" ports. Case drain ports are con-
TION. THE SLOT IN THE HEAD SHOULD BE ORIENTED TO FALL IN-LINE WITH        nected (T1 & T2), oil flow from the middle pumps T1 port also
THE OIL PORTS, NOT PERPENDICULAR TO THE OIL PORTS. IF SLOT IS ORI-        provides flows to the oil cooler.
ENTED PERPENDICULAR TO THE THREE PORTS, PUMP PRESSURE WILL NOT            The charge pumps oil pressure is regulated by a single boost
RETURN FROM LOAD PRESSURE TO STAND-BY PRESSURE AT THE END OF              oil pressure relief valve installed in the middle pump. The front
OPERATING A FUNCTION! PUMP PRESSURE WILL REMAIN AT THE LAST HIGH-         pump has an orifice cartridge (0.047" diameter) installed in
EST PRESSURE GENERATED.)                                                  place of a charge oil pressure relief cartridge. This insures that
                                                                          only one valve controls charge pressure & provides an amount
   20.   After all parts are clean and dry, lightly oil a control         of charge oil flow to the front pump's case to insure flushing &
         spool and install in its bore. The spool must slide              removal of hot oil.
         smoothly and easily within the housing. If it does not,          Each pump has its own separate electrical proportional direc-
         check for contamination. If contamination cannot be              tional control valve to control oil flow and direction. The sig-
         found check for ”scoring” or ”burring” of the control            nals or command values to each pump are similar except
         housing. If spool does not slide smoothly & freely, the          when steering. During steering and propel of the machine the
         control must be replaced with a new unit.                        pump supplying oil to the "inside turning radius" has a com-
   21.   Lightly oil and check operation of the second spool. The         mand less than the pump supplying oil flow to the “outside
         spools are installed correctly when there ”pointed” end          turning radius” pump.
         faces the spring followers                                       “Posi-Traction” control, front to rear on a given side of the
                                                                          machine, is accomplished by a flow divider/combiner car-
   22.   Re-assemble in reverse order.
                                                                          tridge installed in the Traction Control Manifold. There is a flow
   23.   Bench set the pressure adjustments as described in ”C.           divider/combiner for each side. Each flow divider/combiner
         4” of the Operating Instructions.                                also has a “bleed orifice” to limit the amount of flow splitting
                                                                          or combining.
NOTE: The pump control can be equipped with either O-rings or a
                                                                          The middle transmission pump also supplies oil to a hot oil
      sealing plate. These components are NOT interchangeable.
                                                                          flushing valve cartridge, #120, in the Traction Control Mani-
   24.   Re-install Function Pump. Ensure 0-rings or sealing plate        fold. This cartridge provides a means to obtain brake release
         are installed properly. Tighten four (4) M6 socket head          oil pressure. The brake release pressure is controlled by a pres-
         capscrews to 105 in-lb.                                          sure relief valve cartridge # 130 and a solenoid operated brake
                                                                          release directional control cartridge, #170, also located in the
                                                                          Traction Control Manifold.
3121171                                                                                                                             5-143
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
    1. Insure all electrical checks have been performed & the             15.   Continue to monitor all pressure gauges & correct any
       machine is set up correctly with the JLG Analyzer.                       irregularities.
    2. Insure the machine has all four wheels jacked & blocked            16.   Remove brake coil (leaving electrical connection intact)
       off the ground per JLG procedures.                                       from brake release solenoid cartridge located on the
                                                                                Traction Manifold.
    3. Ensure the triple pump assembly is installed and con-
       nected correctly per the hydraulic circuit diagram.              NOTE: This disables machine's ability to release brakes.
    4. Disconnect the electrical connector from the diesel's              17.   Stroke transmission pumps slightly (less than 20%) and
       throttle actuator, to prevent engine start.                              check the setting of the high pressure cross port relief
                                                                                valves. Setting should be 5000 psi +50 psi, - 0 psi (344.7
    5. Crank the engine until charge pressure reaches 50 psi or
                                                                                bar +3.4 bar, -0 bar). Install 0-6000 psi (0 - 415 bar)
       more.
                                                                                gauges on Pump ports Ma & Mb.
    6. Re-connect throttle actuator electrical connector and
                                                                          18.   Check oil level & temperature.
       start engine. Allow engine to run at idle speed only for
       at least 5 minutes. This will allow the hydrostatic system         19.   Remove and inspect charge pressure oil filter. Replace
       to filled.                                                               with new element.
    7. Listen for any abnormal noises.                                    20.   Operate transmission under no load conditions for
                                                                                about 15 minutes to stabilize temperature and remove
    8. Check for oil leaks.
                                                                                any residual air from the fluid.
    9. Check charge pressure (500 psi +50psi, - 0 psi [34.4 bar
                                                                          21.   Set machine back on the ground. Operate transmissions
       +3.4 bar, - 0 bar]). Pressure can be measured at pump
                                                                                under full and normal conditions.
       ports Ma & Mb or by “teeing” into the inlet for the
       charge oil filter. Charge pressure is checked with the joy-        22.   Erratic operation may indicate there is still air trapped in
       stick in neutral. A 0-1000 psi (0-70 bar) pressure gauge                 the system. By working the pump controls forward and
       must be used. (If pressure gauges were installed in Ma &                 reverse the remaining air can be eliminated. The system
       Mb to check charge pressure, disconnect the gauges                       is free of air when all functions can be operated
       installed in Ma & Mb, as they will be damaged if loop                    smoothly and when the oil in the reservoir is no longer
       pressure rises above 1000 psi [34.4 bar].)                               aerated. (Usually less than one hour of operation)
  10.    Operate drive system in “turtle mode”, forward and             NOTE: If transmissions do not perform correctly after following
         reverse.                                                             pre-start & start-up procedures, refer to relevant sections of
                                                                              the trouble-shooting procedures.
  11.    De-aerate system by bleeding fluid from Ma & Mb ports.
  12.    Switch drive mode speed control from “turtle” to “rab-
         bit”. Gradually increase drive speed forward & reverse,
         still with no load - wheels off the ground.
5-144                                                                                                                              3121171
                       SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                          5-145
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-146                                                                           3121171
                              SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
1001110761 C
3121171                                                                    5-147
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-148                                                                        3121171
                             SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
1001110761 C
3121171                                                                   5-149
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-150                                                                         3121171
                              SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
1001110761 C
3121171                                                                    5-151
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
5-152                                                                         3121171
                              SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
1001110761 C
3121171                                                                      5-153
 SECTION 5 - HYDRAULICS AND HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS
NOTES:
5-154                                              3121171
                                                                                              SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
Analyzer Display
                                                                                                                   Enter Key
                             Escape Key
                                                                                                      Stores and selects Top Level, Sub Level,
                     To return home or access previ-
                                                                                                                 and item menus
                                ous menu
Figure 6-1. Hand Held Analyzer (Analyzer Controls and Display Similar)
3121171                                                                                                                                          6-1
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
Connect the JLG Control System Analyzer                              If you press ENTER, at the HELP: PRESS ENTER display, and a
                                                                     fault is present, the analyzer display will scroll the fault across
      1. Connect the cable supplied with the analyzer, to the        the screen. If there was no fault detected, the display will read:
         controller module located in the platform box or at the     HELP: EVERYTHING OK. If powered up at the ground station,
         controller module in the ground control box and con-        the display will read: GROUND OK.
         nect the remaining end of the cable to the analyzer.
                                                                     If ENTER is pressed again, the display moves to the following
NOTE: The cable has a four pin connector at each end of the cable;   display:
      the cable cannot be connected backwards.
                                                                            LOGGED HELP
                                                                            1: POWER CYCLE (2/1)
                                                                     At this point, the analyzer will display the last fault the system
                                                                     has seen, if any are present. You may scroll through the fault
                                                                     logs to view what the last 25 faults were. Use the right and left
                                                                     arrow keys to scroll through the fault logs. To return to the
                                                                     beginning, press ESC. two times. POWER CYCLE (2/1) indi-
                                                                     cates a power up.
                                                                     When a top level menu is selected, a new set of menu items
           HELP:                                                     may be offered: for example:
           PRESS ENTER
                                                                            DRIVE
  At this point, using the RIGHT and LEFT arrow keys, you can               BOOM
  move between the top level menu items. To select a displayed              SYSTEM
  menu item, press ENTER. To cancel a selected menu item,                   DATALOG
  press ESC.; then you will be able to scroll using the right and           VERSIONS
  left arrow keys to select a different menu item.
                                                                     Pressing ENTER with any of the above displayed menus, will
  The top level menus are as follows:                                display additional sub-menus within the selected menu. In
           HELP                                                      some cases, such as DRIVE, the next level is the parameter or
           DIAGNOSTICS                                               information to be changed. Refer to the flow chart for what
           SYSTEM TEST                                               menus are available within the top level menus. You may only
           ACCESS LEVEL                                              view the personality settings for selected menus while in
           PERSONALITIES                                             access level 2. Remember, you may always cancel a selected
           MACHINE SETUP                                             menu item by pressing the ESC. key.
           CALIBRATIONS (view only)
6-2                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
Changing Access Level of Hand Held Analyzer                          Once the correct password is displayed, press ENTER. The
                                                                     access level should display the following, if the password was
 When the analyzer is first connected, you will be in access level   entered correctly:
 2 which enables you to only view most settings which cannot
 be changed until you enter a password to advance to a lower
 level. This ensures that a setting cannot be accidentally
 altered. To change the access level, the correct password must
 be entered. To enter the password, scroll to the ACCESS LEVEL
 menu. For example:
                                                                            MENU:
                                                                            ACCESS LEVEL 1
                                                                     Repeat the above steps if the correct access level is not dis-
                                                                     played or you can not adjust the personality settings.
          MENU:
          ACCESS LEVEL 2
 Press ENTER to select the ACCESS LEVEL menu.
 Using the UP or DOWN arrow keys, enter the first digit of the
 password, 3.
 Then using the RIGHT arrow key, position the cursor to the
 right one space to enter the second digit of the password.
 Use the UP or DOWN arrow key to enter the second digit of
 the password which is 33271.
 Continue using the arrow keys until all the remaining digits of
 the password is shown.
3121171                                                                                                                        6-3
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                              GROUND ALARM:
        PERSONALITIES:                                                        2 = LIFT DOWN
        DRIVE ACCEL 1.0s
                                                                       The effect of the machine digit value is displayed along with
 There will be a minimum and maximum for the value to                  its value. The above display would be selected if the machine
 ensure efficient operation. The Value will not increase if the UP     was equipped with a ground alarm and you wanted it to
 arrow is pressed when at the maximum value nor will the               sound when lifting down. There are certain settings allowed to
 value decrease if the DOWN arrow is pressed and the value is          install optional features or select the machine model.
 at the minimum value for any particular personality. If the
                                                                       When selection the machine model to match the size of the
 value does not change when pressing the up and down
                                                                       machine, the personality settings will all default to the factory
 arrows, check the access level to ensure you are at access level
                                                                       recommended setting.
 1.
                                                                     NOTE: Refer to Table 6.2, Machine Personality Settings and Func-
                                                                           tion Speeds in this Service Manual for the recommended
                                                                           factory settings.
                                                                     NOTE: Password 33271 will give you access to level 1, which will
                                                                           permit you to change all machine personality settings.
6-4                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                     SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                                     6-5
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-6                                                                          3121171
                                                                                                                              SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                                                                                                     Default
      Configuration Digit             Number                                                          Description
                                                                                                                                                     Number
    NOTE: The machine configuration must be completed before any personality settings can be changed. Changing the personal-
          ity settings first and then changing the model number of the machine configuration will cause the personality settings
          to return to default
Note: The default settings (bold) will vary depending on the model selection with selection # 5 being the initial default setting.
3121171                                                                                                                                                        6-7
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                                                                                                                           Default
        Configuration Digit              Number                                                         Description
                                                                                                                                                                           Number
      STARTER LOCKOUT: 6                      0           DISABLED: Automatic pre-glow time determined by ambient air temperature; engine start                        0
                                                          can be attempted at any time during pre-glow.
                                              1           ENABLED: Automatic pre-glow time determined by ambient air temperature; engine start is NOT permit-
                                                          ted until pre-glow is finished.
                                              1           ENABLED: Shutdown engine when coolant temperature is greater than 110 deg. C or oil pres-
                                                          sure is less than 8 PSI.
FUEL CUTOUT: 8 0 RESTART: Engine allowed to be restarted multiple times when very low fuel is reached. 0
1 ONE RESTART: Engine allowed to be restarted once for 2 minutes when very low fuel is reached.
2 ENGINE STOP: Engine not able to restart when very low fuel is reached.
* This menu item is only visible if non dual fuel engines are selected.
      CHASSIS TILT: 9                         1           5 DEGREES: Reduces the maximum speed of all boom functions to creep when tilted more                         1
                                                          than 5 degrees and above elevation; also reduces drive speed to creep.
                                              2           4 DEGREES: Reduces the maximum speed of all boom functions to creep when tilted more than 4 degrees
                                                          and above elevation; also reduces drive speed to creep.
                                              3           3 DEGREES: Reduces the maximum speed of all boom functions to creep when tilted more than 3 degrees
                                                          and above elevation; also reduces drive speed to creep.
                                              4           5 DEGREES + CUT: Reduces the maximum speed of all boom functions to creep when tilted more than 5
                                                          degrees and above elevation; also disallows tower lift up, tower telescope out, drive, main telescope out,
                                                          and main lift up.
                                              5           4 DEGREES + CUT: Reduces the maximum speed of all boom functions to creep when tilted more than 4
                                                          degrees and above elevation; also disallows tower lift up, tower telescope out, drive, main telescope out
                                                          and main lift up.
                                              6           3 DEGREES + CUT: Reduces the maximum speed of all boom functions to creep when tilted more than 3
                                                          degrees and above elevation; also disallows tower lift up, tower telescope out, drive, main telescope out
                                                          and main lift up.
Note: Any of the selections above will light the tilt lamp when a tilted condition occurs and will sound the platform alarm when the machine is also above elevation.
6-8                                                                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                                                  SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                                                                                         Default
      Configuration Digit               Number                                                      Description
                                                                                                                                         Number
    GEN SET CUTOUT: 15*                     0            MOTION ENABLED: Motion enabled when generator is ON.                        0
                                            1            MOTION CUTOUT: Motion cutout in platform mode only.
3121171                                                                                                                                            6-9
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                                                                                                                        Default
         Configuration Digit              Number                                                          Description
                                                                                                                                                                        Number
       LOAD TYPE: 18                           0           NON CAN LSS: Non CAN based LSS is installed.                                                             1
                                               1           CAN LSS: CAN based LSS is installed.
6-10                                                                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                                                                                                  Default
      Configuration Digit             Number                                                         Description
                                                                                                                                                  Number
    PLAT LVL OVR CUT: 28                  0           NO: Platform Level Override will always be functional.                                  0
                                          1           YES: Platform Level Override will only be functional when in Transport.
    WATER IN FUELSENSOR: 31               0           NO: The Water In Fuel Sensor option is not installed.                                   0
                                          1           YES: The Water in Fuel Sensor option is installed.
4150364-U
3121171                                                                                                                                                        6-11
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                                                                    ANSI Export
                                 ANSI Export
                                                                                                                                                   Australia
                                                                                                         ANSI USA
                      ANSI USA
Australia
                                                                                                                                                                 Japan
                                                                                                                                  CSA
                                                                      Japan
                                                                                    1250AJP
                                                                                                                                         CE
                                               CSA
       1250AJP
                                                     CE
Model Number           2          2            2     2     2          2       Function Cutout              0          0        0           0          0          0
Envelope Height        7          7            7     7     7          7                                    X          1        1           1          1          1
Market                 0          1            2     3     4          5                                    X          2        2           X          2          2
Engine                 3          3            3     3     3          3                                    X          3        3           X          3          3
Glow Plug              0          0            0     0     0          0       Ground Alarm                 0          0        0           0          0          0
                       1          1            1     1     1          1                                    1          1        1           1          1          1
                       2          2            2     2     2          2                                    2          2        2           2          2          2
Starter Lockout        0          0            0     0     0          0                                    3          3        3           3          3          3
                       1          1            1     1     1          1       Oscillating Axle             0          0        0           0          0          0
Engine Shutdown        0          0            0     0     0          0                                    1          1        1           1          1          1
                       1          1            1     1     1          1       Display Units                0          0        0           0          0          0
Fuel Cutout            0          0            0     0     0          0                                    1          1        1           1          1          1
                       1          1            1     1     1          1       Leveling Mode                0          0        0           0          0          0
                       2          2            2     2     2          2                                    1          1        1           1          1          1
Tilt                   1          1            1     1     1          1       Clearsky                     0          0        0           0          0          0
                       2          2            2     2     2          2                                    1          1        1           1          1          1
                       3          3            3     3     3          3       Fuel Tank                    0          0        0           0          0          0
                       4          4            4     4     4          4                                    1          1        1           1          1          1
                       5          5            5     5     5          5                                    2          2        2           2          2          2
                       6          6            6     6     6          6       Alert Beacon                 0          0        0           0          0          0
Jib                    0          0            0     0     0          0                                    1          1        1           1          1          1
                       1          1            1     1     1          1       Temp Cutout                  X          0        X           0          X          X
                       2          2            2     2     2          2                                    X          1        X           1          X          X
4 Wheel Steer          0          0            0     0     0          0       Plat Lvl Ovr Cut             0          0        0           0          0          0
                       1          1            1     1     1          1                                    1          1        1           1          1          1
Drive Type             0          0            0     0     0          0       HV Control                   0          0        0           0          0          0
                       1          1            1     1     1          1                                    1          1        1           1          1          1
Soft Touch\Skyguard    0          0            0     0     0          0       Cribbing Option              0          X        X           X          X          X
                       1          1            1     1     1          1                                    1          X        X           X          X          X
                       2          2            2     2     2          2       Water In Fuel Sensor         0          0        0           0          0          0
                       3          3            3     3     3          3                                    1          1        1           1          1          1
Gen Set / Welder       0          0            0     0     0          0       BOLD TEXT indicates the default setting. Plain text indicates another available selec-
                                                                              tion. ITALIC TEXT indicates the default when option is factory installed. SHADED CELLS
                       1          1            1     1     1          1
                                                                              indicates hidden menu or selection.
                       2          2            2     2     2          2                                                                                         4150364-U
Gen Set Cutout         0          0            0     0     0          0
                       1          1            1     1     1          1
Head & Tail lights     0          0            0     0     0          0
                       1          1            1     1     1          1
Load System            0          0            0     0     0          0
                       X          1            X     X     X          1
                       X          2            X     2     2          2
                       X          3            X     3     X          3
                       X          4            X     X     X          4
Load Type              0          0            0     0     0          0
                       1          1            1     1     1          1
6-12                                                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                                               SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                                                               6-13
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-14                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                              SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                                         6-15
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
GROUND MODE:
                  m. LIFT UP XXX%             Displays/adjusts fixed main lift up speed            0 to 100%    60
                  m. lift DN XXX%             Displays/adjusts main lift down speed                0 to 100%    60
                  SWING XXX%                  Displays/adjusts fixed swing speed                   0 to 65%     45
                  BASKET LVL XXX%             Displays/adjusts fixed basket level speed            0 to 100%   75
                  BASKET ROT XXX%             Displays/adjusts fixed basket rotate speed           0 to 100%    75
                  MAIN TELE XXX%              Displays/adjusts fixed main telescope speed          0 to 100%    65
6-16                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
 TOWER BOOM LIFT UP: From platform control, lowest eleva-             4. Platform speed knob must be at full speed (fully clock-
 tion up to maximum elevation, main boom retracted and hori-             wise). All test should be done with the oil temp above
 zontal.                                                                 100° F (38° C).
 TOWER BOOM LIFT DOWN: From platform control, maximum
 elevation down to minimum elevation, main boom retracted
 and horizontal.
 SWING RIGHT (Max): 360 Degrees, from platform control,
 main boom retracted, tower boom on boom rest.
 SWING LEFT (Max): 360 Degrees, from platform control, main
 boom retracted, tower boom on boom rest.
3121171                                                                                                                   6-17
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6.4 CANBUS COMMUNICATIONS                                             Interlocks: Any device that sends an electrical input. (For an
                                                                      example a limit switch, proximity switch, etc;)
 CANbus: CAN (Control Area Network) is a two wire differential
                                                                      Platform Level: The GROUND MODULE stores the default val-
 serial link between the Platform Module, Ground Module,
                                                                      ues and handles interlocks. The PLATFORM MODULE reads the
 Boom Length Angle Module and the Chassis Module provid-
                                                                      sensors mounted on the platform assembly and controls the
 ing bi-directional communications.
                                                                      Level Up / Down valves to maintain setpoint sent from the
 Two-wire: One wire (red) is driven high (5v) and the other low       GROUND MODULE.
 (black) (0v) to send a signal; both wires ”float” (2.5v) when no
                                                                      Steer: The GROUND MODULE stores crack points, sends
 signal is being sent.
                                                                      desired drive direction, sends steering mode and sends axle
                                                                      extend / retract commands. The PLATFORM MODULE reports
 Differential: Any electrical line noise can affect the high or the
                                                                      the steering switch position to the GROUND MODULE. The
 low wires but never both, so communications is not corrupted.
                                                                      CHASSIS MODULE modulates each steer left / right valve to
                                                                      maintain commanded wheel position.
 Serial Link: Messages are being sent bit by bit along the wires;
 the high bus speed allow all modules to be constantly                Drive: The GROUND MODULE stores crack points, sends com-
 updated around 20 times per second. Typical traffic is 300 -         mands for each drive pump to the BLAM. (Command is com-
 500 messages per second.                                             puted from drive joystick input, interlocks, wheel angle, etc).
                                                                      BLAM maintains proper current for the drive pumps by modu-
 A complete CANbus circuit is approximately 60 ohms, which            lating PWM outputs.
 can be verified at the ”T” fitting inside the ground station or
 below the BLAM. Each individual circuit from the modules is          Lift, Tele, & Swing: The GROUND MODULE stores default val-
 approximately 120 ohms.                                              ues, handles interlocks and calibration information. Lift, Tele-
                                                                      scope and Swing commands are dependent upon interlocks
 The GROUND MODULE is the master system controller. Most              through out the machine. Boom angle, length and swing are
 functions are dispatched and coordinated from this module,           controlled by the GROUND MODULE. The BLAM monitors and
 all other system modules (PLATFORM, BLAM L CHASSIS) han-             communicates (CANbus) to the GROUND MODULE boom
 dle sub-tasks. All characterized information (values) are stored     angle and boom length via two angle sensors, a length sensor
 into the ground module (i.e., Personalities or Calibrations).        and a load moment pin.
6-18                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                                  SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                                                               6-19
6-20
                         ACCESS LEVEL:
                         CODE 33271
                         MENU :             PERSONALITIES:   PERSONALITIES:   PERSONALITIES:     PERSONALITIES:   PERSONALITIES:   PERSONALITIES:    PERSONALITIES:        PERSONALITIES:         PERSONALITIES:     PERSONALITIES:
                         PERSONALITIES      DRIVE            STEER            MAIN LIFT          SWING            TOWER LIFT       MAIN TELESCOPE    TOWER TELESCOPE       PLATFORM LEVEL         PLATFORM ROTATE    JIB LIFT
                                            DRIVE:           STEER:           MAIN LIFT:         SWING:           TOWER LIFT:      MAIN TELESCOPE:   TOWER TELESCOPE:      PLATFORM LEVEL:        PLATFORM ROTATE:   JIB LIFT:
                                            ACCEL X.XS       MAX SPEED X%     ACCEL X.XS         ACCEL X.XS       ACCEL X.XS       ACCEL X.XS        ACCEL X.XS            ACCEL X.XS             ACCEL X.XS         ACCEL X.XS
                                            DRIVE:                            MAIN LIFT:         SWING:           TOWER LIFT:      MAIN TELESCOPE:   TOWER TELESCOPE:      PLATFORM LEVEL:        PLATFORM ROTATE:   JIB LIFT:
                                            DECEL X.XS                        DECEL X.XS         DECEL X.XS       DECEL MEDIUM     DECEL X.XS        DECEL X.XS            DECEL X.XS             DECEL X.XS         DECEL X.XS
                                            DRIVE:                            MAIN LIFT:         SWING:           TOWER LIFT:      MAIN TELESCOPE:   TOWER TELESCOPE:      PLATFORM LEVEL:        PLATFORM ROTATE:   JIB LIFT:
                                                                              MIN UP X%          MIN LEFT X%                                                                                      MIN LEFT X%        MIN UP X%
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                            DRIVE:                            MAIN LIFT:         SWING:           TOWER LIFT:      MAIN TELESCOPE:   TOWER TELESCOPE:      PLATFORM LEVEL:        PLATFORM ROTATE:   JIB LIFT:
                                            MIN REVERSE X%                    CREEP UP X%        CREEP LEFT X%    MIN UP X%        MIN OUT X%        MIN OUT X%            MIN DOWN X%            MIN RIGHT X%       MIN UP X%
                                            DRIVE:                            MAIN LIFT:         SWING:           TOWER LIFT:      MAIN TELESCOPE:   TOWER TELESCOPE:      PLATFORM LEVEL:        PLATFORM ROTATE:   JIB LIFT:
                                            MAX REVERSE X%                    MIN DOWN X%        MIN RIGHT X%     MAX DOWN X%      MAX OUT X%        MAX OUT X%            MAX DOWN X%            MAX RIGHT X%       MAX UP X%
                               TO
                              MENU:
                            MACHINE SETUP                                                                                                                 PERSONALITIES:        PERSONALITIES:         PERSONALITIES:       PERSONALITIES:
                                                                                                                                                          JIB SWING             GROUND MODE            GEN SET/WELDER       TEMPERATURE CUT
                                                                                                                                                          JIB LIFT:             GROUND MODE:           GEN SET WELDER:     LOW TEMPERATURE:
                                                                                                                                                          ACCEL X.XS            MAIN UP: XXX%          ENGINE 1800 RPM     CUTOUT SET: XXXC
                                                                                                                                                          JIB LIFT:             GROUND MODE:
                                                                                                                                                          DECEL X.XS            MAIN DOWN: XXX%
                                                                                                                                                          JIB LIFT:             GROUND MODE:
                                                                                                                                                          MIN LEFT X%           SWING: XXX%
                                                                                                                                                          JIB LIFT:             GROUND MODE:
                                                                                                                                                          MAX LEFT X%           PLT LEVEL: XXX%
                                                                                                                                                          JIB LIFT:             GROUND MODE:
                                                                                                                                                          MIN RIGHT X%          PLT ROTATE: XXX%
                                                                                                                                                          JIB LIFT:             GROUND MODE:
                                                                                                                                                          MAX RIGHT X%          MAIN TELE: XXX%
                                                                                                                                                                                GROUND MODE:
                                                                                                                                                                                TOWER TELE: XXX%
                                                                                                                                                                                GROUND MODE:
                                                                                                                                                                                TOWER UP: XXX%
                                                                                                                                                                                GROUND MODE:
                                                                                                                                                                                TOWER DOWN: XXX%
                                                                                                                                                                                GROUND MODE:
                                                                                                                                                                                JIB (U/D): XXX%
                                                                                                                                                                                GROUND MODE:
                                                                                                                                                                                JIB (L/R): XXX%
            MAE38550L
          1001119510-L
                                                                                           Figure 6-3. Analyzer Software P7.24 - Sheet 1 of 6
3121171
                            FROM
                            MENU:
                         PERSONALITIES
3121171
                MENU:                    MODEL NUMBER:       ENVELOPE HEIGHT:    MARKET:              ENGINE:             GLOW PLUG:           STARTER LOCKOUT:   ENGINE SHUTDOWN:      FUEL CUTOUT:        CHASSIS TILT:
                MACHINE SETUP            1250A               1250A: 125" MAX     ANSI USA             DEUTZ F4 TIER1      NO GLOW PLUGS        DISABLED           ENABLED               RESTART             5 DEG + DRV CUT
                                         MODEL NUMBER:       ENVELOPE HEIGHT:    MARKET:              ENGINE:             GLOW PLUG:           STARTER LOCKOUT:   ENGINE SHUTDOWN:      FUEL CUTOUT:        CHASSIS TILT:
                                         NO MODEL            1250A: 100" MAX     ANSI EXPORT          DEUTZ F4 TIER2      AIR INTAKE           ENABLED            DISABLED              ONE RESTART         4 DEG + DRV CUT
                                                             ENVELOPE HEIGHT:    MARKET:              ENGINE:             GLOW PLUG:                                                    FUEL CUTOUT:        CHASSIS TILT:
                                                             1250A: 80" MAX      CSA                  CAT ECM T4I         IN-CYLINDER*                                                  ENGINE STOP         3 DEG + DRV CUT
                                          STOUCH/SKYGUARD:     GEN SET/WELDER:      GEN SET CUTOUT:      H & T LIGHTS:       LOAD SYSTEM:          LOAD TYPE:        FUNCTION CUTOUT:      GROUND ALARM:        OSCILLATING
                                          NONE                 NO                   MOTION ENABLED       NO                  NO                    CAN LSS           NO                    NO                   AXLE: YES
                                          STOUCH/SKYGUARD:     GEN SET/WELDER:      GEN SET CUTOUT:      H & T LIGHTS:       LOAD SYSTEM:          LOAD TYPE:        FUNCTION CUTOUT:      GROUND ALARM:       OSCILLATING
                                          SOFT TOUCH           BELT DRIVE           MOTION CUTOUT        YES                 WARN ONLY             NON CAN LSS       BOOM CUTOUT           DRIVE               AXLE: NO
                                                                                                                             LOAD SYSTEM:
                                                                                                                             SPECIAL 1
                                          DISPLAY UNITS:       LEVELING MODE:      CLEARSKY:            FUEL TANK SIZE:     ALERT BEACON:        TEMP CUTOUT:       PLAT LVL OVR CUT     CRIBBING OPTION:      WATER IN FUEL
                                          IMPERIAL             LEVEL ALL           NO                   31 GALLON           OFF FOR CREEP        NO                 NO                   NO                    SENSOR: NO
                                          DISPLAY UNITS:       LEVELING MODE:      CLEARSKY:            FUEL TANK SIZE:     ALERT BEACON:        TEMP CUTOUT:       PLAT LVL OVR CUT     CRIBBING OPTION:      WATER IN FUEL
                                          METRIC               LEVEL LEFT          YES                  52 GALLON           20FPM FOR CREEP      YES                YES                  YES                   SENSOR: YES
                            TO
                           MENU:
                         CALIBRATION
            MAE38560L
          1001119510-L
                                                                                       Figure 6-4. Analyzer Software P7.24 - Sheet 2 of 6
6-21
                                                                                                                                                                                                                               SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-22
                              FROM
                              MENU:
                            MACHINE SETUP
                         MENU:               CALIBRATIONS:    CALIBRATIONS:    CALIBRATIONS:      CALIBRATIONS:     CALIBRATIONS:      CALIBRATIONS:      CALIBRATIONS:      CALIBRATIONS:   CALIBRATIONS:   CALIBRATIONS:
                         CALIBRATIONS        STEER            DRIVE            BOOM VALVES        LEVEL UP CRKPT    LEVEL DOWN CRKPT   MAIN LIFT CRKPT    MAIN TELE CRKPT    TILT SENSOR     BOOM SENSORS    UNLOCK BOOM
                                             CALIBRATE        CALIBRATE        CALIBRATE          CALIBRATE LEVEL   CALIBRATE LEVEL    CALIBRATE MAIN     CALIBRATE MAIN     POSITION 1:     POSITION 1:     UNLOCK BOOM:
                                             STEER?           DRIVE?           BOOM VALVES?       UP CRACKPOINT?    DOWN CRACKPOINT?   LIFT CRACKPOINT?   TELE CRACKPOINT?   CHECK SYSTEM?   CHECK SYSTEM?   CHECK SYSTEM?
                                             DEUTZ SETUP:
                                             SETUP 2
                                             DEUTZ SETUP:
                                             SETUP 3
                                             DEUTZ SETUP:
                                             SETUP 4
                         MENU:               SERVICE MODE:    SERVICE MODE:    SERVICE MODE:      SERVICE MODE:     SERVICE MODE:      SERVICE MODE:
                         SERVICE MODE        TWR TELE ONLY?   TWR LIFT ONLY?   MAIN LIFT?         MAIN TELE?        SET PRESSURES?     PRODUCTION TEST?
                         MENU:               HELP:
                         HELP: PRESS ENTER   GROUND MODE OK
                                TO
                               MENU:
                            DIAGNOSTICS
            MAE38570L
          1001119510-L
                                                                                            Figure 6-5. Analyzer Software P7.24 - Sheet 3 of 6
3121171
                               FROM
                               MENU:
                          HELP: PRESS ENTER
3121171
                         MENU:                DIAGNOSTICS:       DIAGNOSTICS:       DIAGNOSTICS:        DIAGNOSTICS:                             DIAGNOSTICS:        DIAGNOSTICS:       DIAGNOSTICS:
                                                                                                                                                                                                             TO
                                                                                    ENGINE
                                                                                                                                                                                                           DIAGNOSTICS:
                         DIAGNOSTICS          DRIVE              BOOM FUNCTIONS                         SYSTEM                                   TRANSPORT           BCS                ENVELOPE           BOOM SWITCHES
                                              JOYSTICK DRIVE:    JOYSTICK LIFT:     START SEQUENCE:     GROUND MODULE                            DIAGNOSTICS MODE:   BCS STATUS:        MAIN BOOM
                                              FORWARD XXX%       MAIN UP XXX%       NOT ACTIVE          BATTERY: XX.XV                           OUT OF TRANSPORT    NORMAL             LENGTH: XXX.X
                                              JOYSTICK STEER:    JOYSTICK SWING:    BATTERY VOLTAGE:    PLATFORM MODULE     ST/SG INPUTS:        TOWER LIFT          ELEC. RETRIEVAL:   MAIN BOOM
                                              LEFT XXX%          LEFT XXX%          XX.XV               BATTERY: XX.XV      OPEN                 STATUS: STOWED      NOT ACTIVE         ANGLE1: XX.X DEG
                                              DRIVE OUTPUT:      LIFT OUTPUT:       COOLANT             UGM                 ST/SG INPUT 1        TOWER TELESCOPE     HYD. RETRIEVAL:    MAIN BOOM
                                              FORWARD XXX%       MAIN UP XXX%       TEMPERATURE: XXXC   TEMPERATURE: XXXC   OPEN                 STATUS: RETRACTED   NOT ACTIVE         ANGLE2: XX.X DEG
                                              STEER OUTPUT:      SWING OUTPUT:      ENGINE OIL          PLATFORM SELECT     ST/SG INPUT 2        MAIN LIFT           MAIN ENVELOPE      MAIN BOOM A/D
                                              LEFT XXX%          LEFT XXX%          PRESSURE: XXXXPSI   KEYSWITCH: CLOSED   OPEN                 STATUS: ELEVATED    STATUS: NOMINAL    LENGTH: XXXXX
                                              STEER TYPE:        PLATFORM LEVEL:    AMBIENT             GROUND SELECT       ST OVERRIDE SW:      MAIN TELESCOPE      MAIN ENVELOPE      MAIN BOOM A/D
                                              NORMAL             UP XXX%            TEMPERATURE: XXXC   KEYSWITCH: OPEN     OPEN                 STATUS: RETRACTED   LOW: NOMINAL       ANGLE1: XXX.X
                                                                                                                            SG OVERRIDE SW:
                                              BRAKES STATUS:     PLATFORM ROTATE:   FUEL LEVEL          STATION CONTROL:                         MAIN IN LIMIT       TOWER ENVELOPE     MAIN BOOM A/D
                                                                                                                            OPEN
                                              LOCKED             LEFT XXX%          SENSOR: OK          GROUND                                   SWITCH 1: OPEN      STATUS: NOMINAL    ANGLE2: XXX.X
                                                                                                                            SG/ST OVERRIDE SW:
                                              CREEP SWITCH:      MAIN TELESCOPE:    STARTER             FOOTSWITCH INPUT                         MAIN IN LIMIT       MAIN BOOM ANGLE    BOOM CONTROL:
                                                                                                                            OPEN
                                              CLOSED             IN XXX%            CRANK TIME: XX S    GROUND: OPEN                             SWITCH 2: OPEN      ZONE: 4            AUTOMATIC
                                                                                                                            GENSET/WELDER
                                              CREEP MODE:        TOWER TELESCOPE:   ENGINE SPEED        FOOTSWITCH INPUT                         PLATFORM            MAIN BOOM LENGTH   BOOM CONTROL:
                                                                                                                            SWITCH: OPEN
                                              OFF                IN XXX%            ACTUAL: XXXX RPM    PLATFORM: CLOSED                         STOWED: NO          ZONE: A            MODE SW: OPEN
                                                                                                                            LIGHTS
                                              2-SPEED SWITCH:    TOWER LIFT:        ENGINE SPEED        TRANSPORT MODE:                          AXLE STATUS:
                                                                                                                            SWITCH: OPEN
                                              CLOSED             UP XXX%            TARGET: XXXX RPM    OUT OF TRANSPORT                         EXTENDED
                                                                                                                            PLATFORM TILT1
                                              2-SPEED VALVE      JIB LIFT:                              CABLE BREAK                              FRONT AXLE
                                                                                                                            ANGLE: XX.X DEG
                                              OUTPUT: OFF        UP XXX%                                SWITCH: CLOSED                           SWITCH: CLOSED
                                                                                                                            PLATFORM TILT2
                                              HIGH ENGINE        JIB SWING:                             CREEP                                    REAR AXLE
                                                                                                                            ANGLE: XX.X DEG
                                              SWITCH: OPEN       LEFT XXX%                              SWITCH: CLOSED                           SWITCH: CLOSED
                                                                                                                            PLATFORM TILT1
                                              DRIVE MODE:        PLATFORM CONTROL                       CREEP MODE:                              JIB STOWED LIMIT
                                                                                                                            RAW: XXXX
                                              MID ENGINE         VALVE: OFF                             OFF                                      SWITCH: CLOSED
                                                                                                                            PLATFORM TILT2
                                              L FRONT WHEEL      FUNCTION SPEED:                        CREEP TILT:                              JIB STOWED LIMIT
                                                                                                                            RAW: XXXX
                                              ANGLE: XX.X        PUMP POT XXX%                          XX.X DEGREES                             OVERRIDE: OPEN
                                                                                                                            OSCILLATING AXLE
                                              R FRONT WHEEL      CREEP SWITCH:                          CHASIS TILT:                             AXLE INPUT SW.:
                                                                                                                            PRES. SW.: OPEN
                                              ANGLE: XX.X        CLOSED                                 X-AXIS: X.X                              EXTENDED CLOSED
                                                                                                                            HYDRAULIC OIL
                                              L REAR WHEEL       CREEP MODE:                            CHASIS TILT:
                                                                                                                            TEMP. SW.: OPEN
                                              ANGLE: XX.X        OFF                                    Y-AXIS: X.X
                                                                                                                            HYDRAULIC OIL:
                                              R REAR WHEEL                                              AUXILLARY POWER     WARM UP NOT DONE
                                              ANGLE: XX.X                                               SWITCH: OPEN
                                                                                                                            MAIN LIFT PILOT
                                              DRV. ORIENTATION                                          HORN                PRES. SW.: OPEN
                                              SWITCH: CLOSED                                            SWITCH: OPEN
                                                                                                                            AMBIENT TEMP
                                              DRV. ORIENTATION                                          SKYGUARD INPUTS:
                                                                                                                            XXXC
                                              STATUS: REQUIRED                                          OPEN
            MAE38580L
          1001119510-L
                                                                                            Figure 6-6. Analyzer Software P7.24 - Sheet 4 of 6
6-23
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-24
                                                                                                                                         4- CELL             1- CELL
                                                                                                                                                                                TO
                      FROM                                                                     DIAGNOSTICS:       DIAGNOSTICS:     DIAGNOSTICS:        DIAGNOSTICS:
                                  DIAGNOSTICS:        DIAGNOSTICS:                                                                                                          DIAGNOSTICS:
                   DIAGNOSTICS:                                                                LOAD PIN           MOMENT           LOAD                LOAD
                    ENVELOPE      BOOM SWITCHES       BOOM SENSORS                                                                                                         CAN STATSTICS
                                                                                               LOAD PIN MOMENT    ACTUAL MOMENT    PLATFORM            PLATFORM
                                  MAIN BOOM LENGTH    TOWER LENGTH 1                           VALUE: XXXX        XXXXXXXX LB*IN   CAPACITY: 1000 LB   CAPACITY: 1000 LB
                                  SWITCH NC: OPEN     SENSOR: X.X
                                                                                               LOAD PIN RATIO     OVER MOMENT      DUAL CAPACITY       DUAL CAPACITY
                                  MAIN BOOM LENGTH    TOWER LENGTH 2        TOWER EXTENDED     VALUE: XX.XXX      XXXXXXXX LB*IN   SWITCH NC: OPEN     SWITCH NC: OPEN
                                  SWITCH NO: CLOSED   SENSOR: X.X          LENGTH 2: XXXXXX
                                                                                               LOAD PIN ANGLE     UNDER MOMENT     DUAL CAPACITY       DUAL CAPACITY
                                                      TOWER ANGLE 1         TOWER TRIP POINT   VALUE: XXX.X       XXXXXXXX LB*IN   SWITCH NO: CLOSED   SWITCH NO: CLOSED
                                  MAIN BOOM LENGTH
                                  ZONE: A/D           SENSOR: XX.X          LENGTH: XXXX.X
                                                                                               LOAD PIN VECTOR    UNDER MOMENT     DUAL CAPACITY       DUAL CAPACITY
                                                                                               FORCE: XXXXXX      CAL POINT: X     LENGTH ZONE: A/B    LENGTH ZONE: A/B
                                  DUAL CAPACITY       TOWER ANGLE 2         TOWER ANGLE 1
                                  SWITCH NC: OPEN     SENSOR: XX.X          LOW CAL: XXX.X     LOAD PIN MOMENT    YELLOW WITNESS                       JIB IN-LINE
                                                                                                                                   JIB IN-LINE
                                                                                               RAW: XXXXX         CAL: XXXXXXXX    SWITH: OPEN         SWITCH: OPEN
                                                      TOWER CYLINDER        TOWER ANGLE 2
                                  DUAL CAPACITY
                                                      ANGLE: XX.X           LOW CAL: XXX.X     LOAD PIN RATIO     GREEN WITNESS    PLATFORM LOAD       PLATFORM LOAD
                                  SWITCH NO: CLOSED
                                                                                               RAW: XX.XXX        CAL: XXXXXXXX    STATE: OK           STATE: OK
                                                                            TOWER ANGLE 1
                                  DUAL CAPACITY       MAIN ANGLE 1 TO
                                                                                                                                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                            HIGH CAL: XXX.X    LOAD PIN ANGLE     LOAD PIN RATIO                       PLATFORM LOAD
                                  LENGTH ZONE: A/B    TOWER: XX.X
                                                                                               RAW: XXX.X         VALUE: XX.XXX                        ACTUAL: XXXLBS
                                                                            TOWER ANGLE 2
                                  TOWER TELESCOPE     MAIN ANGLE 2 TO                          LOAD PIN V-FORCE   LOAD PIN ERROR                       PLATFORM LOAD
                                                                            HIGH CAL: XXX.X
                                  SWITCH NC: OPEN     TOWER: XX.X                              RAW: XXXXXXXX      FLAGS: 0X000                         GROSS: XXXLBS
                                                                            TOWER CYLINDER     LOAD PIN ANGLE
                                  TOWER TELESCOPE     MAIN ANGLE L TO                                             SKY WELDER                           PLATFORM LOAD
                                                                            LOW CAL: XXXXXX    CAL POINT: XXX.X
                                  SWITCH NO: CLOSED   GRAVITY: XXX.X                                              INSTALLED: NO                        OFFSET 1: XXXLBS
                                                      MAIN LIFT 2
                                                      ANGLE A/D: XXXXX
                                                      TOWER RETRACTED
                                                      LENGTH 1: XXXXXX
            MAE38590L
          1001119510-L
                                                      TOWER RETRACTED
                                                      LENGTH 2: XXXXXX
                                                      TOWER EXTENDED
                                                      LENGTH 1: XXXXXX
3121171
3121171
                            FROM          DIAGNOSTICS:      DIAGNOSTICS:       DIAGNOSTICS:
                         DIAGNOSTICS:                                                            DIAGNOSTICS:
                             LOAD         CAN STATISTICS    CALIBRATION DATA   DATALOG           VERSIONS
                                          CAN STATISTICS    PLATFORM UP        DATLOG:           GROUND MODULE
                                          RX/SEC: X         CAL: X             ON XXH XXM        SOFTWARE: PX.X
                                          CAN STATISTICS    PLATFORM DOWN      DATLOG:           GROUND MODULE
                                          TX/SEC: X         CAL: X             ENGINE XH XM      CNST DATA : PX.X
                                          CAN STATISTICS    LEFT FORWARD       DATLOG:           GROUND MODULE
                                          BUS OFF X         DRIVE CAL: XXXX    DRIVE XH XM       HARDWARE: REV X
                                          CAN STATISTICS    RIGHT FORWARD      DATLOG:           GROUND MODULE
                                          PASSIVE XXXXX     DRIVE CAL: XXXX    LIFT XH XM        S/N: XXXXXX
                                          CAN STATISTICS    LEFT REVERSE       DATLOG:           PLATFORM MODULE
                                          MSG ERROR: XXXX   DRIVE CAL: XXXX    SWING XH XM       SOFTWARE: PX.X
                                                            RIGHT REVERSE      DATLOG:           PLATFORM MODULE
                                                            DRIVE CAL: XXXX    TELE XH XM        HARDWARE: REV X
                                                            L FRONT STEER      DATLOG:           PLATFORM MODULE
                                                            CAL: XXXXX         MAX TEMP XXC      S/N: XXXXXX
                                                            R FRONT STEER      DATLOG:           CHASSIS MODULE
                                                            CAL: XXXXX         MIN TEMP XXC      SOFTWARE: PX.X
            MAE38670L
          1001119510-L
                                   Figure 6-8. Analyzer Software P7.24 - Sheet 6 of 6
6-25
                                                                                                                    SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-26                              3121171
                                               SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                  6-27
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                         J4
                           J1                         GREY                           PIN 1
                        GREY                        8 PIN                              J2
                     12 PIN
                                                                                       BLACK
                                                                                       12 PIN
PIN 1
                                 J3
                            GREEN                                                    PIN 1
                           12 PIN
                                                                             J5
                                     PIN 1                                   BROWN
                                                                             12 PIN
                       Figure 6-10. Chassis and Boom, Length, Angle Modules (BLAM)
6-28                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                                       6-29
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-30                                                                                                                        3121171
                                               SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                  6-31
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
J8
J1
J7
                                                                                           J12
       J2
J3 J4
                                                                           1001119508-P
                                                                             MAE37420P
6-32                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                              SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                                                   6-33
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-34                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                              6-35
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
J8
J7
J1
J2
J3
J4
                                                                              1600333-N
                                                                             MAE37410N
6-36                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                               SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                                                     6-37
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-38                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                              SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                 6-39
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
J5 J2
J6
J8
        J7
                                                                                      J1
                                                                          1600343-Q
                                                                         MAE37430Q
6-40                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                            SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                                                   6-41
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-42                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
PLATFORM CONNECTION
3121171                                                                                   6-43
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6.6 SYSTEM TEST                                                 3. Before proceeding, ensure that the switches on the plat-
                                                                   form console are in the following positions:
 The Control System Incorporates a built-in system test to
                                                                    a. Drive speed switch is in the Middle position. (Turtle
 check the system components and functions. To use this func-
                                                                       Icon)
 tion, use the following procedures.
                                                                    b. 4WS switch is in the Middle position. (2WS mode)
Test from the Platform                                              c. Capacity select switch in the 1000 lb. (450 kg) mode.
   1. Position the Platform/Ground select switch to the Plat-       d. Function speed potentiometer out of creep mode
      form position.                                                   switch.
                                                                    e. Generator (if equipped) switched to the off position.
                                                                    f. Head and Tail lights (if equipped) switched to the off
                                                                       position.
6-44                                                                                                               3121171
                                                                         SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
   4. Pull out the Emergency Stop switch and Start the   6. Use the arrow button to reach SYSTEM TEST. Hit Enter.
      engine.                                               The analyzer will prompt you asking if you want to acti-
                                                            vate the system test; hit Enter again to activate.
                                                         7. Follow the flow path in Figure 6-15., System Test Flow
                                                            Chart - Platform Tests and go through the component
                                                            tests. Hit the ESC key during any part of the test to
                                                            return to the main menu without completing all tests or
                                                            wait until all tests are complete. During the TEST ALL
                                                            INPUTS sequence, the analyzer allows control switches
                                                            to be operated and shows if they are closed (CL) or open
                                                            (OP).
3121171                                                                                                       6-45
6-46
                                                                 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171
                                                                               SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
Test from the Ground Station                                   3. Pull out the Emergency Stop switch. and Start the
                                                                  engine.
   1. Position the Platform/Ground select switch to the
      Ground position.
3121171                                                                                                               6-47
6-48
                                                                       SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171
                                                                                                    SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
RUNNING                                                       Initial display when system test is run; certain “critical” checks are made. Problems that can be
                                                              reported include below messages.
ONLY 1 ANALYZER! Do not connect two Analyzers while running the system test.
BATTERY TOO LOW The system test cannot run with battery voltage below minimum (9 V).
BATTERY TOO HIGH The system test cannot run with battery voltage above maximum. (16 V).
                             CHECK CAN WIRING                 The system test cannot run in platform mode unless data is being received from the platform and
                                                              ground modules. The system test cannot run in ground mode unless data is being received from
                                                              the platform module.
CHECK SPEED There is an open- or short- circuit in the speed encoder wiring. Check speed encoder.
BAD GROUND MODULE An internal problem was detected in the ground module.
HIGH TILT ANGLE The vehicle is very tilted (19.3°), or the tilt sensor has been damaged. Check tilt sensor.
HOT ENGINE The engine temperature exceeds 100C. This is only a warning.
                             BAD I/O PORTS                    The controller detected a problem with its internal circuits at switch on. If other problems are also
                                                              detected, the controller may need replacing.
                             SUSPECT EEPROM                   The controller detected a problem with its EEPROM stored personality settings at switch on.
                                                              Check and, if necessary correct, all personality settings.
OPEN FSW In platform mode, the footswitch must be open at the start of the test.
                             CLOSE FSW                        In platform mode, the footswitch must be closed when this message is displayed; the footswitch
                                                              MUST BE KEPT CLOSED during the valve & contactor tests.
                             BAD FSW                          The two footswitch signals are not changing together, probably because one is open-circuit. One
                                                              footswitch signal (“FSW1”) is routed to the power module, the other (“FSW2”) is routed to the
                                                              platform module. Check footswitch and wiring.
TESTING VALVES                                                Indicates that the valve test is beginning. Each valve is alternately energized and de-energized;
                                                              checks are made for open- and short- circuit valve coils.
                                                              NOTE: In platform mode, the footswitch must be closed.
                                                              NOTE: Tower lift valves are not tested if TOWER LIFT=NO. Tower telescope valves are not tested if
                                                              TOWER TELE=NO. Jib valves are not tested if JIB = NO. Extendable axle valves are not tested if EXT
                                                              AXLES=NO. Four wheel steer valves are not tested if 4WS=NO.
                                                              NOTE: Left/right jib valves are not tested unless JIB = SIDESWING.
                                                              Problems that can be reported include below messages.
                             CANT TEST VALVES                 There is a wiring problem, which prevents the valve test from functioning correctly. Check valve
                                                              wiring. Check ground alarm & hour meter wiring.
                             XXXXXXX S/C                      The named valve is drawing too much current so is presumed to be short-circuited. Check valve
                                                              wiring.
                             XXXXXXX O/C                      The named valve is drawing too little current so is presumed to be open-circuit. Check valve wir-
                                                              ing.
3121171                                                                                                                                                      6-49
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECKING INPUTS                                                Indicates that the inputs test is beginning. Every input is checked to ensure that it is in its “nor-
                                                               mal” position; function switches should be open, cutout switches should be closed, joysticks
                                                               should be in neutral.
                                                               In platform mode any non-neutral platform switch or joystick is reported; any active cutouts are
                                                               reported.
                                                               In ground mode any non-neutral ground switches is reported; any active cutouts are reported.
                                                               NOTE: Switches, which are not in use (due to the settings of machine digits), are not checked.
                                                               NOTE: The pump pot is checked only for a wire-off condition; it can be at any demand from creep
                                                               to maximum.
                                                               Problems that can be reported include below messages.
CHECK XXXXXXX The named switch is not in its “normal” position. Check switch & wiring.
CHECK XXXXXXX JOY The named joystick appears to be faulty. Check joystick.
TESTING LAMPS                                                  Indicates that the lamps test is beginning. Each lamp is energized in turn; a prompt asks for con-
                                                               firmation that the lamp is lit.
                                                               ENTER must be pressed or clicked to continue the test.
                                                               NOTE: Lamps, which are not in use (due to the settings of machine digits), are not checked.
                                                               NOTE: Platform Lamps are only tested in platform mode.
                                                               NOTE: The GM overload lamp and 500# capacity lamp are not tested.
                                                               NOTE: Head and tail lamps are tested in both platform and ground mode if enabled by a machine
                                                               digit.
TESTING ALARMS                                                 Indicates that the alarms test is beginning. Each alarm is energized in turn; a prompt asks for con-
                                                               firmation that the alarm is sounding.
                                                               ENTER must be pressed or clicked to continue the test.
                                                               NOTE: The platform alarm and the horn are only tested in platform mode.
                                                               NOTE: The ground alarm is not tested if GROUND ALARM = NO.
6-50                                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                                    SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
TEST ALL INPUTS?                                               Prompts whether to check every operator input. If ESC is pressed or clicked, the system test ends.
                                                               If ENTER is pressed or clicked, each operator input is prompted for in turn.
                                                               In platform mode every platform switch and joystick is tested.
                                                               In ground mode every ground switch is tested.
                                                               NOTE: Tower lift switches are not tested if TOWER LIFT=NO. Tower telescope switches are not
                                                               tested if TOWER TELE=NO. Jib switches are not tested if JIB = NO. Extendable axle switches are
                                                               not tested if EXT AXLES=NO. Four wheel steer switches are not tested if 4WS=NO.
                                                               NOTE: Left/right jib switches are not tested unless JIB = SIDESWING.
                                                               Prompts displayed during the operator input test below messages.
XXXXXXX XXXXXXX TO MAX The named joystick should be pushed to its full extent in the named direction.
XXXXXXX XXXXXXX TO MIN The named joystick should be returned to neutral from the named direction.
                              MULTIPLE CLOSURE                 More than one operator input is closed; if only one has been operated, there could be a short
                                                               between two inputs.
TESTS COMPLETE                                                 Indicates that the system test is complete. Any problems reported should have been noted and
                                                               should now be rectified. Press ESC/CANCEL to return to the RUN SYSTEM TEST Analyzer menu.
3121171                                                                                                                                                    6-51
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6.7 CALIBRATING STEER                                               1. Position the Platform/Ground select switch to the Plat-
                                                                       form position.
 When calibrating steering, each individual wheel must be cali-
 brated in order to make the tire and wheel parallel with the
 frame. Two methods to help ensure proper calibration are the
 use of a carpenter’s square to square the spindle to the axle or
 aligning the two wheels on one side using a stretched string.
6-52                                                                                                                 3121171
                                                                                  SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
   3. Pull out the Emergency Stop switch and Start the           8. Use the arrow keys to reach Steer. The screen will read:
      engine.
3121171                                                                                                                 6-53
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
10. Hit Enter. The screen will read: 13. Hit Enter. The screen will read:
  11.   Hit Enter again. The screen will read:                      14.   Repeat steps 10 thru 12 for left rear steer.
                                                                    15.   Left Rear Steer Calibration will be followed by Right For-
                                                                          ward Steer Calibration which will be followed by Right
                                                                          Rear Steer Calibration.
                                                                    16.   After completing all the Steer Calibrations, hit ESC twice
                                                                          to go back to CALIBRATIONS.
  12.   Activate the steer control until the tire and wheel are
        straight in relationship with the chassis, then leave off
        the control. The display will read FRT LEFT = and show
        the numeric calibration value for that wheel.
6-54                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6.8 CALIBRATING DRIVE                                           3. Pull out the Emergency Stop switch and Start the
                                                                   engine.
   1. Position the Platform/Ground select switch to the Plat-
      form position.
3121171                                                                                                              6-55
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
8. Use the arrow keys to reach DRIVE. 10. Hit Enter again. The screen will read:
9. Hit Enter. The screen will read: 11. Hit Enter again. The screen will read:
                                           12.   Activate the Drive Joystick forward full stroke until the
                                                 machine just begins to move, then leave off the joystick
                                                 immediately. The display will read CRK PT = and show
                                                 the numeric crack point value.
6-56                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                    SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
  13.   Hit Enter. The number displayed will be the value that   14.   Hit Enter. The screen will read:
        the crack point is set to. The screen will show:
3121171                                                                                                                    6-57
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-58                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                    SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
   8. Use the arrow keys to reach Boom Valves. The screen will   10.   Hit Enter. The screen will read:
      read:
3121171                                                                                                                  6-59
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
  12.   If the tower lift wiring and hosing is properly installed     14.   The control system will next calibrate the LIFT, TWR LIFT,
        and not damaged, hit enter. The screen will read:                   and TWR TELE valves. This can be confirmed by watch-
                                                                            ing the LED’s on the respective valves as they are being
                                                                            calibrated. When the valves are calibrated, the screen
                                                                            will read:
6-60                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                                      6-61
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
Diagnostic Menu                                                                           Press the LEFT and RIGHT Arrow keys to view the displays and
                                                                                          select the various sub-menus. To access a sub-menu, press the
  The Diagnostic Menu is another troubleshooting tool for the                             ENTER key. Once in a sub-menu, press the LEFT and RIGHT
  Load Sensing System. Sensor and status information is pre-                              Arrow keys to view the various displays (just like a Top Level
  sented in real-time for the technician. Several sub-menus exist
  to organize the data.
                                                                                          menu). To exit a sub-menu, press the ESC key                        .
                                                                                          Table 6-6, Diagnostic Menu Descriptions details the structure
  To access the Diagnostic Menu, use the LEFT                        and RIGHT            of the Diagnostic Menu, and describes the meaning of each
                                                                                          piece of information presented.
           Arrow keys to select DIAGNOSTICS from the Top Level
6-62                                                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
Calibration Procedure
                                                                        5. Press the ENTER key        to view the menu. Upon entry
   1. Remove everything from the platform, except perma-                   to the Calibration Menu, the JLG Control System will link
      nently fixed JLG Accessories, to allow the Load Sensing              to the Analyzer and the screen will read:
      System to record its’ weight during calibration. This
      includes all tools, debris, and customer-installed devices.
   2. Plug the JLG Analyzer into the Machine at the Ground
      Station and enter Service Access Password 33271.
   3. The platform should be approximately level for calibra-
      tion. Level the platform from ground control (if neces-
      sary) to within +/- 5°.
   4. To access the Calibration Menu, use the LEFT and RIGHT
      Arrow keys to select CALIBRATION from the Top Level
      Menu. The screen will read:
                                                                    NOTE: Calibration will auto fail if LSS DTC's are active (443, 444,
                                                                          4479, 4480, 663, 821, 822, 823, 824, 8218, 8222 -> 8238,
                                                                          991, 992, 993, 994 or 99285).
3121171                                                                                                                          6-63
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                     NOTE: Accessory weight will reset to 0 lbs. each time the machine
       Pressing the ESC key        after starting calibration and          is re-calibrated and will need to be re-entered.
       before calibration is complete will display the CAL FAILED
       message. This will not disturb the prior calibration infor-   NOTE: The Accessory weight will be temporarily stored in the Con-
       mation.                                                             trol System until calibration has been completed success-
                                                                           fully.
                                                                                     Accessory                               Weight
                      LOAD SENSING:                                   SkyWelder (stick welder)                                            70 lb (32 kg)
                      accessory xxxlbs:                               SkyWelder Prep                                          Prep only = 15 lb (7 kg)
                                                                                                                            Full install = 70 lb (32 kg)
                                                                      SkyCutter (plasma cutter)                                           70 lb (32 kg)
                                                                      SkCutter / SkyWelder Combo                                        140 lb (64 kg)
                                                                      Fire Extinguisher                                                   45 lb (20 kg)
                                                                      Overhead SoftTouch                                                  80 lb (36 kg)
                                                                      Work Surface                                                         20 lb (9 kg)
                                                                      NOTE: Not all Accessories are available on every JLG model.
                                                                            Some Accessory combinations are prohibited due to
                                                                            excessive weight and/or load restriction. If any installed
                                                                            JLG Accessories are labeled with weight decals but are
                                                                            not listed in the table above, include their weight when
                                                                            entering the ACC WEIGHT value.
6-64                                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                        SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
   9. The control system will calculate the load cell readings       11.   Use the analyzer keys to select N for no or Y for yes. Press
      and ensure it is greater than 130 lbs. (59 kg), but less
      than 575 lbs.(261 kg).                                               ENTER        . The screen will read:
        If the platform weight is not within the allowed range,
        the calibration attempt will be unsuccessful and the
        Analyzer will show the following:
3121171                                                                                                                          6-65
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
12. Use the analyzer keys to select N for no or Y for yes. Press Table 6-9. Pipe Rack Capacity Reductions
                                                                  PLATFORM OVRLD
         Capacity                  PLATFORM OVRLD
                                                                     RESTRICT
       500 lb (227 kg)               400 lb (181 kg)                      n/a
       550 lb (250 kg)               400 lb (181 kg)                      n/a
       600 lb (272 kg)               400 lb (181 kg)                       n/a
       750 lb (340 kg)                     n/a                      590 lb (268 kg)
      1000 lb (454 kg)                     n/a                      750 lb (340 kg)
Note: If both SkyGlazier and Pipe Racks are configured, capacity will be the lower of the
two values.
6-66                                                                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                   SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                      6-67
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-68                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                                                                     SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
Troubleshooting
  The following tables are furnished to provide possible resolu-
  tions for common difficulties. Difficulties are classified as Gen-
  eral, Calibration, Measurement Performance, and Host System
  Functionality.
                                                    5. The Load Cell has been mechanically damaged. If the Load Cell is physically deformed or has damage to the cover it should be replaced
                                                    immediately. It is also possible to have invisible mechanical damage resulting from an extreme overload (>6000lbs [>2722kg]).
The Visual and Audible Overload Warnings fail       The Control System is failing to regard the overload signal from the LSS System, or the signal is shorted.
to sound when platform is loaded beyond Rated
Load, or when simulated by unplugging the           1. The Load Sensing System must be enabled within the Control System. Plug the JLG Analyzer into the Control System, enter the Access
Load Cell. Controls remain functional at Plat-      Level 1 password (33271), and examine the MACHINE SETUP, LOAD sub-menu. The selection “2=CUTOUT PLT” should be displayed (plat-
form and Ground Control positions.                  form controls prevented during overload, ground controls remain operational). In country- or customer-specific circumstance, the selec-
                                                    tion “3=CUTOUT ALL” is used (platform and ground controls prevented during overload).
The Ground Audible Warning fails to sound, but The Ground Alarm is missing or improperly installed. Verify that the device is mounted. Verify wiring from the Main Terminal Box and
the Platform Audible Warning sounds properly. Ground Module.
Controls remain functional at the Ground Con-       The JLG Control System is configured to prevent platform controls only in the event of overload. Alternately, the Host Control System can be
trol position during an overload, or when simu-     configured to prevent ground and platform controls for country- or customer-specific circumstances.
lated by unplugging the Load Cell. The Controls     Using the JLG Analyzer, enter the Access Level 1 password (33271). Proceed to the MACHINE SETUP, LOAD sub-menu. Set this parameter to
at the Platform Control position are prevented      “2=CUTOUT PLT” to prevent platform controls in the event of overload. Set this parameter to “3=CUTOUT ALL” to prevent platform and
when using the engine, but not when using the       ground controls in the event of overload.
Auxiliary Power Unit.
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                  6-69
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6.11 RESETTING THE MSSO SYSTEM                                      9. Use the arrow keys to reach the LOAD SENSING menu.
                                                                       The screen should read:
    1. Use the following procedure to reset the MSSO system.
    2. Position the Platform/Ground select switch to the
       desired position.
    3. Plug the analyzer into the connector coming from the
       ground control module or from the platform console.
        Enter         .
    7. Enter the Access Code, 33271.
    8. Use the right Arrow key to reach MENU: CALIBRATIONS.
Press Enter .
6-70                                                                                                               3121171
                                                                  SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
  12.   Press Enter   . The screen will read:   13.   Press Enter      . The JLG Control System will reset an
                                                      active 873 DTC and the MSSO System will be reset. Press
3121171                                                                                                6-71
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-72                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
 In both cases above the following will occur:                         When in ground mode, if the Ground Module reads a platform
                                                                       leveling switch command, the switch command is communi-
   1. The Electronic Leveling System Fault Lamp will flash (to         cated over CAN to the Platform Module where it is handled
      indicate that there is a leveling fault).                        normally.
   2. The platform alarm will sound.                                   If Ground Module determines that CAN communication is
   3. A system fault will be logged.                                   inoperable, it turns on the platform control valve and the
                                                                       appropriate platform leveling override outputs while the
   4. All function speeds (lift, swing, telescope, jib and drive)      switch is engaged.
      will be placed in creep mode (except when the platform
      is in the transport position).                                   If the Platform Module is still running when CAN is down noth-
                                                                       ing will operate when in platform mode. When the operator
   5. Automatic leveling remains active.                               switches to ground mode, the platform will not control any of
 Lift, swing, drive and telescope will continue to operate.            its valve outputs and a CAN error message is signaled.
 In each of the cases above it will be necessary to re-cycle the      Additional Platform and Jib Valves
 EMS to clear the fault. Operable functions shall be in the creep
 mode except while below elevation.                                    The high side drivers for the platform left and right and the jib
                                                                       up and down valves are be located in the Platform Module and
 When both sensors appear to be working but have measure-              are proportional. Flow through the valves is individually con-
 ments that disagree by ±5.5° The following will occur:                trollable. The individually controlled duty cycle will be the
   1. All interactions with platform leveling shall cease.             same as would otherwise have been commanded to the flow
                                                                       control valve.
   2. The Electronic Leveling System Fault Lamp shall flash (to
      indicate that the leveling function has been lost).              Only one platform or jib function is allowed at one time to
                                                                       limit the amount of current draw, minimizing the voltage drop
   3. The platform alarm will sound.                                   on the supply to the Platform Module.
   4. A system fault will be logged.                                   The function is enabled first shall remain active until it is
                                                                       released. Any other function commanded while another func-
   5. All function speeds (lift, swing, telescope and drive) will
                                                                       tion is active is ignored.
      be placed in creep mode (except when the platform is in
      the transport position)
 At this point, the operator must use the level up and down
 toggle switch to manually level during descent. It shall be nec-
 essary to re-cycle the EMS to clear the fault.
3121171                                                                                                                           6-73
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-74                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                     SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
STEP 2: BLEEDING THE PLATFORM VALVES                               8. Using the left arrow button, go to the GROUND MODE
                                                                      menu.
   1. Position the Platform/Ground select switch to the
                                                                   9. Hit ENTER.
      Ground position.
                                                                  10.   Using the UP/DOWN arrows, adjust the following per-
   2. Plug the analyzer into the connector inside the Ground
                                                                        sonalities to 100%.
      control box.
                                                                        Basket Rotate
                                                                        Basket Level
                                                                        Jib U/D (if configured)
3121171                                                                                                                     6-75
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
   2. Plug the analyzer into the connector inside the Ground     11.   Using UP ARROW, increase the value until you see the
      control box.                                                     basket up movement.
                                                                 12.   Hit ENTER again. CAL. COMPLETE message should
                                                                       appear
                                                                 13.   Engine should again return to idle.
                                                                 14.   Hit ESC should return to BASKET U CRKPT screen.
                                                                 15.   Hit RIGHT ARROW to get to the “BASKET D CRKPT”
                                                                       screen. Hit ENTER.
                                                                 16.   CALIBRATE? prompt should appear. Hit ENTER again.
                                                                 17.   You will hear engine go to 1800 rpm.
                                                                 Using UP ARROW, increase the value until you see the basket
                                                                 down movement.
                                                                 Hit ENTER again. CAL. COMPLETE message should appear
                                                                 Engine should again return to idle.
   3. Pull out the Emergency Stop switch and start the           Hit ESC to exit.
      engine.
                                                                 Cycle power to the machine.
   4. The analyzer screen should read:
6-76                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6.14 CALIBRATING TILT SENSOR                                              3. Plug the analyzer into the connector inside the Ground
                                                                             control box.
A NEW TILT MODULE WILL ACT AS IF IT IS TILTED ALL OF THE TIME UNTIL THE
FOLLOWING PROCEDURE IS PERFORMED.
3121171                                                                                                                        6-77
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
   9. Use the arrow keys to reach the TILT SENSOR. The screen   6.15 BOOM SENSOR CALIBRATION
      should read:
                                                                 To begin calibration of the boom sensors, the following condi-
                                                                 tions must be met:
                                                                      • Successful completion of the steering sensor and tilt
                                                                        sensor calibrations
                                                                      • The axles are completely extended
                                                                      • The wheels are straight
                                                                      • The platform is unloaded and booms are clean
                                                                      • The jib is fully raised
                                                                      • The jib swing is centered
                                                                      • The platform is level
                                                                      • The platform is not rotated
                                                                      • The turntable is centered between the rear tires
                                                                      • The tower boom is fully retracted
                                                                      • The tower boom is fully lowered
                                                                      • The main boom is fully retracted
                                                                      • The main boom is fully lowered
  10.   Press ENTER.
                                                                      • The machine indicates that it is on a level surface
  11.   When prompted, swing turntable 180° to opposite end             (within ±1.5
        of chassis.                                                   • Ground Mode is selected
  12.   Press ENTER. The screen should read:
                                                                General Notes:
                                                                      • During all Control System lag times the analyzer
                                                                        should display “CALIBRATING…”
6-78                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                  SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                                     6-79
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-80                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
       use of this value). The analyzer will display “CAL FAILED”   Step 3 - Position 3
       and “MAIN ANGL FAULT” if the uncalibrated main boom
       angle sensors read more than 30 (ref tower) before the         1. After completing the previous step, the analyzer will
       main boom transport angle limit switch is tripped.                 read:
3121171                                                                                                                       6-81
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-82                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
       decreasing movement of more than 0.2 deg, Tower Lift         Step 5 - Position 5
       angle for decreasing movement of more than 0.2 deg
       and Tower Telescope length decreasing movement of               1. After completing the previous step, the analyzer will
       more than 0.5" (1.27 cm) for 60 seconds. If one of these           read:
       conditions occur the test will abort and display on the
       top line “CHECK FAILED:” and “MAIN LIFT APU”, “TOWER
       LIFT APU” or “TOWER TELE APU” on the bottom line
       depending on which section moved.
   4. If the “CHECKING BOOM…” test passes then Tower Lift
      Up will be enabled and the analyzer will read:
3121171                                                                                                                       6-83
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
       Telescope tower out to max length                               3. If the “CHECK BOOM…” test passes the analyzer will dis-
                                                                          play “CALIBRATING…”on the bottom line and record
                                                                          tower extended length 1 (upper) and tower extended
                                                                          length 2 (lower). The tower extended length will be set
                                                                          at 669.4”. The length 1 sensor and the length 2 sensor
                                                                          must be in the proper range or “CAL FAILED” and “TWR
                                                                          LEN1 FAULT” or “TWR LEN2 FAULT” will be displayed. The
                                                                          precise tower transport length switch trip point will be
                                                                          verified to be 4.0”+3.5”/-1.5”, otherwise the analyzer will
                                                                          display “CAL FAILED” and “TWR L SW FAULT”.
                                                                    Step 6 - Position 6
                                                                       1. After completing the previous step, the analyzer will
                                                                          read:
6-84                                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                    Step 7 - Position 7
                                                                       1. After completing the previous step, the analyzer will
                                                                          read:
3121171                                                                                                                       6-85
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                 Step 8 - Position 8
                                                                    1. After completing the previous step, the analyzer will
                                                                       read:
6-86                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                         Step 9 - Position 9
                                                                            1. After completing the previous step, the analyzer will
                                                                               read:
3121171                                                                                                                        6-87
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                     Step 10 - Position 10
                                                                        1. After completing the previous step, the analyzer will
                                                                           read:
6-88                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                    SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
Step 11 - Position 11
   1. If the target is reached in the previous step, the analyzer
      will read:
                                                                    2. After pressing the ENTER key         , the Control System
                                                                       will verify the cylinder angle reading is less than 5.9,
                                                                       otherwise, the analyzer will display “CAL FAILED” on the
                                                                       top line and “TWR NOT DWN” on the bottom line each
3121171                                                                                                                     6-89
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6.16 BOOM CONTROL SYSTEM (BCS) VIOLATION                                  • the turntable is centered between the rear tires
                                                                          • Ground Mode is selected
 The Boom Control System (BCS) will generate a fault (“BCS VIO-
 LATION – BOOM LOCKED”) when one of the following faults
 become active;
                                                                  NOTE: During the calibration procedure, if the ESC key         is
       • “TOWER LENGTH MOVEMENT WITHOUT COMMAND”                        pressed after the procedure is started, the calibration will
                                                                        be terminated and exit back to the “UNLOCK BOOM”
       • “MAIN ANGLE MOVEMENT WITHOUT COMMAND”
                                                                        prompt.
       • “TOWER CYLINDER ANGLE MOVEMENT WITHOUT
         COMMAND”                                                 NOTE: In the BCS state, Main envelope and Tower envelope will
                                                                        continuously be monitored after the initial conditions are
       • “TOWER ENVELOPE MASSIVELY ENCROACHED”                          satisfied. If at any time during the test the BCS state is not
       • “TOWER ENVELOPE MULTIPLE ENCROACHMENTS”.                       Normal or the Main envelope or Tower envelope indicated
                                                                        encroachment the Calibration will terminate and the ana-
 This fault will be stored in BCS memory and prevent Main Tele-         lyzer will display “BCS VIOLATION”.
 scope Out and Main Lift Up functions when that section is out
 of Transport position and Lock the Boom into Transport posi-         1. Using the analyzer, put the vehicle into Access Level 1
 tion once a section reaches transport position. The fault will          and enter the “UNLOCK BOOM” calibration. The analyzer
 also cause the Ground and Platform alarms to sound and illu-            will display the following:
 minate the BCS Lamp.
 To clear the “BCS VIOLATION – BOOM LOCKED” fault a
 “UNLOCK BOOM” calibration procedure shall be used.
6-90                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                   SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                                   6-91
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
   5. Once the Main boom lifts such that the Main Boom to          6. Once “CHECKING BOOM…” is started, the control system
      Gravity Angle reads greater then 50 degrees, Main Lift          will wait 2 seconds and then capture the position of the
      Up control will be suspended and once the Main Lift up          Main Boom to Tower, Tower Cylinder Angle and Tower
      control is released, the analyzer will read:                    Length. The control system then will command the Main
                                                                      Lift, Tower Lift and Tower Telescope PVG valves to 40%,
                                                                      engage the Main Control and PVG enable valves and
                                                                      command the Engine to 1800 RPM for 20 seconds. The
                                                                      control system will monitor for the Main Lift and Tower
                                                                      Lift angles increasing by more then 0.2 deg and the
                                                                      Tower Telescope length increasing by more then 0.5”. If
                                                                      one of these conditions occur the test will abort and dis-
                                                                      play on the top line “CHECK FAILED:” and “MN LIFT
                                                                      ENABLE”, “TWR LIFT ENABLE” or “TWR TELE ENABLE” on
                                                                      the bottom line depending on which section moved.
6-92                                                                                                                  3121171
                               SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
or
3121171                                                             6-93
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
or
6-94                                                                                  3121171
                                 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
or
3121171                                                               6-95
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
  11.   Once the Main boom transport angle switch indicates it   12.   Once the Tower Boom is below elevation the Analyzer
        is below elevation the Analyzer will display “TWR DWN          will display “TEST COMPLETE”.
        TO STOP”.
6-96                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                           Fault Message                    Fault Description                             Check
          Code
  001      00        1       EVERYTHING OK                                      The normal help message in Plat-
                                                                                form Mode.
  002      00        2       GROUND MODE OK                                     The normal help message in
                                                                                Ground Mode.
  0010     00        10      RUNNING AT CUTBACK - OUT OF TRANSPORT POSITION     Drive speed is limited to "ELE-
                                                                                VATED MAX" while the vehicle is
                                                                                out of transport position.
  000      00        0       <<< HELP COMMENT >>>
  0011     00        11      FSW OPEN                                            A drive / boom function was
                                                                                 selected with the Footswitch
                                                                                 open.
  0012     00        12      RUNNING AT CREEP - CREEP SWITCH OPEN               All functions at creep while the
                                                                                Creep Switch is open.
  0013     00        13      RUNNING AT CREEP - TILTED AND ABOVE ELEVATION      All functions at creep while the
                                                                                Platform is elevated and the Chas-
                                                                                sis is tilted.
  0014     00        14      CHASSIS TILT SENSOR OUT OF RANGE                   The Chassis is tilted > 19 degrees     - Not reported during power-up.
                                                                                for more then 4 seconds.
  0015      0        15      LOAD SENSOR READING UNDER WEIGHT                   LSS has been calibrated and the        Ensure platform is not resting on
                                                                                UGM has determined that the            the ground or is not leveled at an
                                                                                load sensing system reading is         extreme negative angle.
                                                                                less than -50lbs for 2 seconds. If
                                                                                the load sensing system deter-         Re-calibrate the load sensing sys-
                                                                                mines that the reading is greater      tem if the above items are not a
                                                                                than -50lbs for 5 seconds this fault   factor.
                                                                                will no longer be annunciated.
3121171                                                                                                                                             6-97
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                             Fault Message                      Fault Description                            Check
         Code
  210     21        0       <<< POWER-UP >>>
  211     21        1       POWER CYCLE                                            The normal help message is
                                                                                   issued at each power cycle.
  212     21        2       KEYSWITCH FAULTY                                       Both Platform and Ground modes
                                                                                   are selected simultaneously.
  213     21        3       FSW FAULTY                                             Both Footswitches are closed for
                                                                                   more then one second.
  220     22        0       <<< PLATFORM CONTROLS >>>
  227     22        7       STEER SWITCHES FAULTY                                  Both Steer Left and Steer Right
                                                                                   inputs are closed simultaneously.
  2211    22        11      FSW INTERLOCK TRIPPED                                  The Footswitch was closed for        - Can be reported during power-
                                                                                   more then seven seconds.             up.
  2212    22        12      DRIVE LOCKED - JOYSTICK MOVED BEFORE FOOTSWITCH        A drive function was selected with - Can be reported during power-
                                                                                   Footswitch open.                   up.
  2213    22        13      STEER LOCKED - SELECTED BEFORE FOOTSWITCH              A steer function was selected with
                                                                                   Footswitch open.
  2215    22        15      D/S JOY. OUT OF RANGE LOW                              The D/S Joystick reference voltage - Resistive joysticks, these faults
                                                                                   is low.                            do not occur.
  2216    22        16      D/S JOY. OUT OF RANGE HIGH                             The D/S Joystick reference voltage - Resistive joysticks.
                                                                                   is > 8.1V.                         - If the reference voltage is > 7.7V
                                                                                                                      then the reference voltage is out
                                                                                                                      of tolerance of a short to battery
                                                                                                                      has occurred.
  2217    22        17      D/S JOY. CENTER TAP BAD                                The D/S Joystick center tap volt-    - Resistive joysticks.
                                                                                   age is < 3.08V or > 3.83V.           - There is a +/- .1V range. around
                                                                                                                        these values due to resistor toler-
                                                                                                                        ances
  2218    22        18      L/S JOY. OUT OF RANGE LOW                              The L/S Joystick reference voltage - Resistive joysticks, these faults
                                                                                   is low.                            do not occur.
  2219    22        19      L/S JOY. OUT OF RANGE HIGH                             The L/S Joystick reference voltage - Resistive joysticks.
                                                                                   is > 8.1V.                         - If the reference voltage is > 7.7V
                                                                                                                      then the reference voltage is out
                                                                                                                      of tolerance of a short to battery
                                                                                                                      has occurred.
  2220    22        20      L/S JOY. CENTER TAP BAD                                The L/S Joystick center tap voltage - Resistive joysticks.
                                                                                   is < 3.08V or > 3.83V.              - There is a +/- .1V range. around
                                                                                                                       these values due to resistor toler-
                                                                                                                       ances
  2221    22        21      LIFT/SWING LOCKED - JOYSTICK MOVED BEFORE FOOTSWITCH   A lift / swing function was
                                                                                   selected with Footswitch open.
  2222    22        22      WAITING FOR FSW TO BE OPEN                             The Footswitch was closed during - Can be reported during power-
                                                                                   Platform selection.              up.
  2223    22        23      FUNCTION SWITCHES LOCKED - SELECTED BEFORE ENABLE      A boom function was selected
                                                                                   with Footswitch open.
  2224    22        24      FOOTSWITCH SELECTED BEFORE START                       The Footswitch was closed during
                                                                                   engine start.
6-98                                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                                  SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                         Fault Message                             Fault Description                            Check
          Code
  230      23        0       <<< GROUND CONTROLS >>>
  234      23        4       FUNCTION SWITCHES FAULTY - CHECK DIAGNOSTICS/BOOM         A boom function has both direc-
                                                                                       tions selected together.
  235      23        5       FUNCTION SWITCHES LOCKED - SELECTED BEFORE AUX POWER      A boom function was selected
                                                                                       before aux power.
  236      23        6       FUNCTION SWITCHES LOCKED - SELECTED BEFORE START SWITCH   A boom function was selected
                                                                                       before engine start.
  237      23        7       START SWITCH LOCKED - SELECTED BEFORE KEYSWITCH           The Start Switch was closed dur-
                                                                                       ing power-up.
  23100    23                TOWER LIFT PRESSURE SENSOR - OUT OF RANGE HIGH            Pressure transducer output more       Out of range high
                                                                                       than 4.6 VDC.
  23101    23                TOWER LIFT PRESSURE SENSOR - OUT OF RANGE LOW             Pressure transducer output less       Out of range low
                                                                                       than 0.4 VDC.
  23102    23                TOWER LIFT PRESSURE SENSOR - NOT DETECTING CHANGE         Pressure does not change by at       Not detecting change
                                                                                       least 20 psi when tower lift is com-
                                                                                       manded
  23103    23                TOWER LIFT CYLINDER - OVER PRESSURE                       At the conclusion of a tower lift   Tower lift cylinder over pressure
                                                                                       command that was held for at
                                                                                       least three seconds with the boom
                                                                                       not on the rest and the pressure is
                                                                                       greater than 2200 psi for three
                                                                                       seconds
  250      25        0       <<< FUNCTION PREVENTED >>>
  259      25        9       MODEL CHANGED - HYDRAULICS SUSPENDED - CYCLE EMS          The model selection has been
                                                                                       changed.
  2513     25        13      GENERATOR MOTION CUTOUT ACTIVE                            Driving is not possible while the
                                                                                       vehicle generator is running AND
                                                                                       is configured to prevent drive.
  2514     25        14      BOOM PREVENTED - DRIVE SELECTED                           Boom functions are not possible
                                                                                       while the vehicle is being driven
                                                                                       AND is configured to not allow
                                                                                       simultaneous drive & boom oper-
                                                                                       ation.
  2515     25        15      DRIVE PREVENTED - BOOM SELECTED                           Driving is not possible while the
                                                                                       vehicle above elevation AND is
                                                                                       configured to prevent drive while
                                                                                       above elevation.
  2516     25        16      DRIVE PREVENTED - ABOVE ELEVATION                         Driving is not possible while Boom
                                                                                       functions are selected AND is con-
                                                                                       figured to not allow simultaneous
                                                                                       drive & boom operation.
  2517     25        17      DRIVE PREVENTED - TILTED & ABOVE ELEVATION                Driving is not possible while the
                                                                                       vehicle is tilted and above eleva-
                                                                                       tion AND is configured to prevent
                                                                                       drive while tilted and above ele-
                                                                                       vation.
  2521     25        21      JIB SWING PREVENTED - IN 1000# MODE                       JIB Swing is not possible while the
                                                                                       vehicle is in 1000 LB Mode.
3121171                                                                                                                                                 6-99
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                          Fault Message                      Fault Description                            Check
         Code
  2522    25        22      CAN DONGLE ATTACHED - HYDRAULICS NOT RESTRICTED     CAN Dongle attached. Very lim-
                                                                                ited restrictions for all hydraulics
                                                                                systems.
  2523    25        23      BACKUP BLAM COMMUNICATIONS ACTIVE                   RS232 serial backup communica-
                                                                                tions link to the BLAM is active.
  2524    25        24      DISCONNECT ANALYZER AND CYCLE EMS TO PERFORM BOOM   RS232 serial backup communica-
                            RETRIEVAL                                           tions link to the BLAM is needed
                                                                                but an analyzer is connected.
  2546    25                MACHINE SETUP FAULT - JIB SWING
  2547    25                MACHINE SETUP FAULT - MODEL
  2587     2        5       RUNNING AT CREEP - PLATFORM LEVELED UNDER           The control system has deter-
                                                                                mined that the platform is leveled
                                                                                under and is being considered to
                                                                                be in a loading/unloading posi-
                                                                                tion. Boom, Tower, and Level
                                                                                Override functions will operate at
                                                                                creep speed.
  330     33        0       <<< GROUND OUTPUT DRIVER >>>
  331     33        1       BRAKE - SHORT TO BATTERY                            There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                Brake Valve.
  332     33        2       BRAKE - OPEN CIRCUIT                                There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                Brake Valve.
  3311    33        11      GROUND ALARM - SHORT TO BATTERY                     There is a Short to Battery to the     - Ground Alarm equipped vehicles
                                                                                Ground Alarm.                          only.
  3316    33        16      RIGHT FORWARD DRIVE PUMP - SHORT TO GROUND          There is a Short to Ground to the      - Chassis Module equipped vehi-
                                                                                Right Forward Drive Valve.             cles only.
  3317    33        17      RIGHT FORWARD DRIVE PUMP - OPEN CIRCUIT             There is an Open Circuit to the        - Chassis Module equipped vehi-
                                                                                Right Forward Drive Valve.             cles only.
  3318    33        18      RIGHT FORWARD DRIVE PUMP - SHORT TO BATTERY         There is a Short to Battery to the     - Chassis Module equipped vehi-
                                                                                Right Forward Drive Valve.             cles only.
  3320    33        20      RIGHT REVERSE DRIVE PUMP - SHORT TO GROUND          There is a Short to Ground to the      - Chassis Module equipped vehi-
                                                                                Right Reverse Drive Valve.             cles only.
  3321    33        21      RIGHT REVERSE DRIVE PUMP - OPEN CIRCUIT             There is an Open Circuit to the        - Chassis Module equipped vehi-
                                                                                Right Reverse Drive Valve.             cles only.
  3322    33        22      RIGHT REVERSE DRIVE PUMP - SHORT TO BATTERY         There is a Short to Battery to the     - Chassis Module equipped vehi-
                                                                                Right Reverse Drive Valve.             cles only.
  3324    33        24      LEFT FORWARD DRIVE PUMP - SHORT TO GROUND           There is a Short to Ground to the      - Chassis Module equipped vehi-
                                                                                Left Forward Drive Valve.              cles only.
  3325    33        25      LEFT FORWARD DRIVE PUMP - OPEN CIRCUIT              There is an Open Circuit to the Left - Chassis Module equipped vehi-
                                                                                Forward Drive Valve.                 cles only.
  3326    33        26      LEFT FORWARD DRIVE PUMP - SHORT TO BATTERY          There is a Short to Battery to the     - Chassis Module equipped vehi-
                                                                                Left Forward Drive Valve.              cles only.
  3328    33        28      LEFT REVERSE DRIVE PUMP - SHORT TO GROUND           There is a Short to Ground to the      - Chassis Module equipped vehi-
                                                                                Left Reverse Drive Valve.              cles only.
6-100                                                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                          Fault Message                     Fault Description                             Check
          Code
  3329     33        29      LEFT REVERSE DRIVE PUMP - OPEN CIRCUIT             There is an Open Circuit to the Left - Chassis Module equipped vehi-
                                                                                Reverse Drive Valve.                 cles only.
  3330     33        30      LEFT REVERSE DRIVE PUMP - SHORT TO BATTERY         There is a Short to Battery to the     - Chassis Module equipped vehi-
                                                                                Left Reverse Drive Valve.              cles only.
  3336     33        36      ALTERNATOR/ECM POWER - SHORT TO GROUND             There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                Alternator/ECM.
  3338     33        38      ALTERNATOR POWER - OPEN CIRCUIT                    There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                Alternator.
  3339     33        39      ALTERNATOR POWER - SHORT TO BATTERY                There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                Alternator
  3340     33        40      AUX POWER - SHORT TO GROUND                        There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                Auxiliary Power Pump Relay.
  3341     33        41      AUX POWER - OPEN CIRCUIT                           There is an Open Circuit to the Aux-
                                                                                iliary Power Pump Relay.
  3342     33        42      AUX POWER - SHORT TO BATTERY                       There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                Auxiliary Power Pump Relay.
  3343     33        43      COLD START ADVANCE SOLENOID - SHORT TO GROUND      There is a Short to Ground to the      - CAT engines only.
                                                                                Cold Start Advance Solenoid.
  3344     33        44      COLD START ADVANCE SOLENOID - OPEN CIRCUIT         There is an Open Circuit to the Cold - CAT engines only.
                                                                                Start Advance Solenoid.
  3345     33        45      COLD START ADVANCE SOLENOID - SHORT TO BATTERY     There is a Short to Battery to the     - CAT engines only.
                                                                                Cold Start Advance Solenoid.
  3349     33        49      ELECTRIC PUMP - SHORT TO GROUND                    There is a Short to Ground to the      - CAT engines only.
                                                                                Pump Relay.
  3350     33        50      ELECTRIC PUMP - OPEN CIRCUIT                       There is an Open Circuit to the        - CAT engines only.
                                                                                Pump Relay.
  3351     33        51      ELECTRIC PUMP - SHORT TO BATTERY                   There is a Short to Battery to the     - CAT engines only.
                                                                                Pump Relay.
  3358     33        58      MAIN DUMP VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                  There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                Main Dump Valve.
  3359     33        59      MAIN DUMP VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                     There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                Main Dump Valve.
  3360     33        60      MAIN DUMP VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                 There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                Main Dump Valve.
  3361     33        61      BRAKE - SHORT TO GROUND                            There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                Brake Valve.
  3362     33        62      START SOLENOID - SHORT TO GROUND                   There is a Short to Ground to the      - Diesel engines only.
                                                                                Start Relay.
  3363     33        63      START SOLENOID - OPEN CIRCUIT                      There is an Open Circuit to the        - Diesel engines only.
                                                                                Start Relay.
  3364     33        64      START SOLENOID - SHORT TO BATTERY                  There is a Short to Battery to the     - Diesel engines only.
                                                                                Start Relay.
3121171                                                                                                                                         6-101
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                          Fault Message                          Fault Description                            Check
         Code
  3368    33        68      TWO SPEED VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                       There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                    Two Speed Valve.
  3369    33        69      TWO SPEED VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                          There is an Open Circuit to the Two
                                                                                    Speed Valve.
  3370    33        70      TWO SPEED VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                      There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                    Two Speed Valve.
  3371    33        71      GROUND ALARM - SHORT TO GROUND                          There is a Short to Ground to the     - Ground Alarm equipped vehicles
                                                                                    Ground Alarm.                         only.
  3372    33        72      GROUND ALARM - OPEN CIRCUIT                             There is an Open Circuit to the       - Ground Alarm equipped vehicles
                                                                                    Ground Alarm.                         only.
  3373    33        73      GEN SET/WELDER - SHORT TO GROUND                        There is a Short to Ground to the     - Generator / Welder equipped
                                                                                    Generator Relay.                      vehicles only.
  3374    33        74      GEN SET/WELDER - OPEN CIRCUIT                           There is an Open Circuit to the       - Generator / Welder equipped
                                                                                    Generator Relay.                      vehicles only.
  3375    33        75      GEN SET/WELDER - SHORT TO BATTERY                       There is a Short to Battery to the    - Generator / Welder equipped
                                                                                    Generator Relay.                      vehicles only.
  3376    33        76      HEAD TAIL LIGHT - SHORT TO GROUND                       There is a Short to Ground to the     - Head Light equipped vehicles
                                                                                    Head Light Relay.                     only.
  3377    33        77      HEAD TAIL LIGHT - OPEN CIRCUIT                          There is an Open Circuit to the       - Head Light equipped vehicles
                                                                                    Head Light Relay.                     only.
  3378    33        78      HEAD TAIL LIGHT - SHORT TO BATTERY                      There is a Short to Battery to the    - Head Light equipped vehicles
                                                                                    Head Light Relay.                     only.
  3379    33        79      HOUR METER - SHORT TO GROUND                            There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                    Hour Meter.
  3380    33        80      HOUR METER - OPEN CIRCUIT                               There is an Open Circuit to the       - Can be reported during power-
                                                                                    Hour Meter.                           up.
  3381    33        81      HOUR METER - SHORT TO BATTERY                           There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                    Hour Meter.
  3385    33        85      PLATFORM LEVEL UP OVERRIDE VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND      There is a Short to Ground to the - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                    Platform Level Up Override Valve. equipped vehicles only.
  3386    33        86      PLATFORM LEVEL UP OVERRIDE VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT         There is an Open Circuit to the   - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                    Platform Level Up Override Valve. equipped vehicles only.
  3387    33        87      PLATFORM LEVEL UP OVERRIDE VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY     There is a Short to Battery to the - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                    Platform Level Up Override Valve. equipped vehicles only.
  3391    33        91      PLATFORM LEVEL DOWN OVERRIDE VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND    There is a Short to Ground to the     - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                    Platform Level Down Override          equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                    Valve.
  3392    33        92      PLATFORM LEVEL DOWN OVERRIDE VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT       There is an Open Circuit to the       - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                    Platform Level Down Override          equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                    Valve.
  3393    33        93      PLATFORM LEVEL DOWN OVERRIDE VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY   There is a Short to Battery to the    - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                    Platform Level Down Override          equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                    Valve.
6-102                                                                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                            SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                            Fault Message                    Fault Description                            Check
          Code
  3394     33        94      PLATFORM ROTATE LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND        There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 Platform Rotate Left Valve.
  3395     33        95      PLATFORM ROTATE LEFT VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT           There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                 Platform Rotate Left Valve.
  3396     33        96      PLATFORM ROTATE LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY       There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                 Platform Rotate Left Valve.
  3397     33        97      PLATFORM ROTATE RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND       There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 Platform Rotate Right Valve.
  3398     33        98      PLATFORM ROTATE RIGHT VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT          There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                 Platform Rotate Right Valve.
  3399     33        99      PLATFORM ROTATE RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY      There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                 Platform Rotate Right Valve.
  33100    33       100      JIB LIFT UP VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                 There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 JIB Lift Up Valve.
  33101    33       101      JIB LIFT UP VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                    There is an Open Circuit to the JIB
                                                                                 Lift Up Valve.
  33102    33       102      JIB LIFT UP VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                 JIB Lift Up Valve.
  33103    33       103      JIB LIFT DOWN VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND               There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 JIB Lift Down Valve.
  33104    33       104      JIB LIFT DOWN VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                  There is an Open Circuit to the JIB
                                                                                 Lift Down Valve.
  33105    33       105      JIB LIFT DOWN VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY              There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                 JIB Lift Down Valve.
  33118    33       118      SWING RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                 There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 Swing Right Valve.
  33119    33       119      SWING RIGHT VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                    There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                 Swing Right Valve.
  33120    33       120      MAIN TELESCOPE IN VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY          There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                 Main Telescope In Valve.
  33121    33       121      SWING RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                 Swing Right Valve.
  33122    33       122      SWING LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                  There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 Swing Left Valve.
  33123    33       123      MAIN TELESCOPE OUT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY         There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                 Main Telescope Out Valve.
  33130    33       130      THROTTLE ACTUATOR - SHORT TO GROUND                 There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 Throttle Actuator.
  33131    33       131      THROTTLE ACTUATOR - OPEN CIRCUIT                    There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                 Throttle Actuator.
  33132    33       132      THROTTLE ACTUATOR - SHORT TO BATTERY                There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                 Throttle Actuator.
  33133    33       133      PLATFORM CONTROL VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND            There is a Short to Ground to the     - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                 Platform Control Valve.               equipped vehicles only.
  33134    33       134      PLATFORM CONTROL VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT               There is an Open Circuit to the       - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                 Platform Control Valve.               equipped vehicles only.
3121171                                                                                                                                          6-103
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                           Fault Message                     Fault Description                           Check
          Code
  33135    33       135      PLATFORM CONTROL VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY           There is a Short to Battery to the   - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                 Platform Control Valve.              equipped vehicles only.
  33136    33       136      MAIN LIFT APU VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND               There is a Short to Ground to the    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Main Lift APU Valve.
  33137    33       137      MAIN LIFT APU VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                  There is an Open Circuit to the      - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Main Lift APU Valve.
  33138    33       138      MAIN LIFT APU VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY              There is a Short to Battery to the   - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Main Lift APU Valve.
  33139    33       139      MAIN LIFT PILOT - PRESSURE FAILURE                  The Main Lift Pilot has a Pressure   - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Failure.
  33140    33       140      MAIN LIFT PILOT - NO PRESSURE                       The Main Lift Pilot has No Pres-     - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 sure.
  33141    33       141      MAIN LIFT PILOT - PRESSURE SWITCH FAILURE           The Main Lift Pilot has a Pressure   - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Switch Failure.
  33142    33       142      TOWER LIFT APU VALVE - STUCK OPEN                   The Tower Lift APU Valve is Stuck    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Open
  33143    33       143      TOWER LIFT ENABLE VALVE - STUCK OPEN                The Tower Lift Enable Valve is       - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Stuck Open
  33144    33       144      TOWER LIFT ENABLE VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND           There is a Short to Ground to the    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Tower Lift Enable Valve.
  33145    33       145      TOWER LIFT ENABLE VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT              There is an Open Circuit to the      - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Tower Lift Enable Valve.
  33146    33       146      TOWER LIFT ENABLE VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY          There is a Short to Battery to the   - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Tower Lift Enable Valve.
  33147    33       147      TOWER TELESCOPE APU VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND         There is a Short to Ground to the    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Tower Telescope APU Valve.
  33148    33       148      TOWER TELESCOPE APU VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT            There is an Open Circuit to the      - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Tower Telescope APU Valve.
  33149    33       149      TOWER TELESCOPE APU VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY        There is a Short to Battery to the   - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                 Tower Telescope APU Valve.
  33150    33       150      LIFT PILOT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                  There is a Short to Ground to the    - Gravity Lift Down equipped vehi-
                                                                                 Lift Pilot Valve.                    cles only.
  33151    33       151      LIFT PILOT VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                     There is an Open Circuit to the Lift - Gravity Lift Down equipped vehi-
                                                                                 Pilot Valve.                         cles only.
  33152    33       152      LIFT PILOT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                 There is a Short to Battery to the   - Gravity Lift Down equipped vehi-
                                                                                 Lift Pilot Valve.                    cles only.
  33153    33       153      LIFT DOWN AUX VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND               There is a Short to Ground to the    - Gravity Lift Down equipped vehi-
                                                                                 Lift Down Auxiliary Valve.           cles only.
6-104                                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                                       SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                           Fault Message                                Fault Description                            Check
          Code
  33154    33       154      LIFT DOWN AUX VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                             There is an Open Circuit to the Lift - Gravity Lift Down equipped vehi-
                                                                                            Down Auxiliary Valve.                cles only.
  33155    33       155      LIFT DOWN AUX VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                         There is a Short to Battery to the    - Gravity Lift Down equipped vehi-
                                                                                            Lift Down Auxiliary Valve.            cles only.
  33156    33       156      TOWER LIFT APU VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                         There is a Short to Ground to the     - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            Tower Lift APU Valve.
  33157    33       157      TOWER LIFT APU VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                            There is an Open Circuit to the       - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            Tower Lift APU Valve.
  33158    33       158      TOWER LIFT APU VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                        There is a Short to Battery to the    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            Tower Lift APU Valve.
  33159    33       159      MAIN LIFT ENABLE VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                       There is a Short to Ground to the     - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            Main Lift Enable Valve.
  33160    33       160      MAIN LIFT ENABLE VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                          There is an Open Circuit to the       - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            Main Lift Enable Valve.
  33161    33       161      MAIN LIFT ENABLE VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                      There is a Short to Battery to the    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            Main Lift Enable Valve.
  33162    33       162      TOWER TELESCOPE APU VALVE - STUCK OPEN                         The Tower Telescope APU Valve is      - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            Stuck Open
  33163    33       163      TOWER TELESCOPE ENABLE VALVE - STUCK OPEN                      The Tower Telescope Enable Valve - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            is Stuck Open
  33164    33       164      TOWER TELESCOPE ENABLE VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                 There is a Short to Ground to the     - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            Tower Telescope APU Valve.
  33165    33       165      TOWER TELESCOPE ENABLE VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                    There is an Open Circuit to the       - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            Tower Telescope APU Valve.
  33166    33       166      TOWER TELESCOPE ENABLE VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                There is a Short to Battery to the    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            Tower Telescope APU Valve.
  33167    33       167      PVG ENABLE VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                             There is a Short to Ground to the     - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            PVG Valve.
  33168    33       168      PVG ENABLE VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                                There is an Open Circuit to the PVG - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            Valve.
  33169    33       169      PVG ENABLE VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                            There is a Short to Battery to the    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                            PVG Valve.
  33173    33       173      RESTRICTED TO TRANSPORT - AXLE LOCKOUT VALVE - SHORT TO BAT-   There is a Short to Battery or an
                             TERY OR OPEN CIRCUIT                                           Open Circuit to the Axle Lockout
                                                                                            Valve.
  33174    33       174      RESTRICTED TO TRANSPORT - BRAKE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN     There is a Short to Battery or an
                             CIRCUIT                                                        Open Circuit to the Brake.
  33175    33       175      JIB ROTATE LEFT VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                           There is an Open Circuit to the JIB
                                                                                            Rotate Left Valve.
3121171                                                                                                                                                    6-105
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                           Fault Message                     Fault Description                           Check
          Code
  33176    33       176      JIB ROTATE LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY            There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                 JIB Rotate Left Valve.
  33177    33       177      JIB ROTATE LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND             There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 JIB Rotate Left Valve.
  33178    33       178      JIB ROTATE RIGHT VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT               There is an Open Circuit to the JIB
                                                                                 Rotate Right Valve.
  33179    33       179      JIB ROTATE RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY           There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                 JIB Rotate Right Valve.
  33180    33       180      JIB ROTATE RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND            There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 JIB Rotate Right Valve.
  33181    33       181      MAIN LIFT UP VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                   There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                 Main Lift Up Valve.
  33183    33       183      MAIN LIFT UP VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 Main Lift Up Valve.
  33184    33       184      MAIN LIFT DOWN VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                 There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                 Main Lift Down Valve.
  33185    33       185      MAIN LIFT DOWN VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND              There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 Main Lift Down Valve.
  33186    33       186      MAIN TELESCOPE OUT VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT             There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                 Main Telescope Out Valve.
  33188    33       188      MAIN TELESCOPE OUT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND          There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 Main Telescope Out Valve.
  33189    33       189      MAIN TELESCOPE IN VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT              There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                 Main Telescope In Valve.
  33190    33       190      MAIN TELESCOPE IN VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND           There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 Main Telescope In Valve.
  33207    33       207      HORN - OPEN CIRCUIT                                 There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                 Horn.
  33208    33       208      HORN - SHORT TO BATTERY                             There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                 Horn.
  33209    33       209      HORN - SHORT TO GROUND                              There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                 Horn.
  33279    33       279      GLOWPLUG - OPEN CIRCUIT                             There is an Open Circuit to the       - Glowplugs equipped vehicles
                                                                                 Glow Plugs.                           only.
  33280    33       280      GLOWPLUG - SHORT TO BATTERY                         There is a Short to Battery to the    - Glowplugs equipped vehicles
                                                                                 Glow Plugs.                           only.
  33281    33       281      GLOWPLUG - SHORT TO GROUND                          There is a Short to Ground to the     - Glowplugs equipped vehicles
                                                                                 Glow Plugs.                           only.
  33285    33                ALTERNATOR EXCITATION LINE - SHORT TO BATTERY
  33295    33       295      SWING LEFT VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                     There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                 Swing Left Valve.
6-106                                                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                                         SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                          Fault Message                                   Fault Description                           Check
          Code
  33306    33       306      SWING LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                              There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                              Swing Left Valve.
  33307    33       307      MAIN TELESCOPE FLOW CONTROL VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND              There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                              Main Telescope Flow Control
                                                                                              Valve.
  33308    33       308      MAIN TELESCOPE FLOW CONTROL VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                 There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                              Main Telescope Flow Control
                                                                                              Valve.
  33309    33       309      MAIN TELESCOPE FLOW CONTROL VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY             There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                              Main Telescope Flow Control
                                                                                              Valve.
  33310    33       310      MAIN LIFT DOWN VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                          There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                              Main Lift Down Valve.
  33311    33       311      MAIN LIFT FLOW CONTROL VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                   There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                              Main Lift Flow Control Valve.
  33312    33       312      MAIN LIFT FLOW CONTROL VALVE - OPEN CIRCUIT                      There is an Open Circuit to the
                                                                                              Main Lift Flow Control Valve.
  33313    33       313      MAIN LIFT FLOW CONTROL VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                  There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                              Main Lift Flow Control Valve.
  33329    33       329      MAIN LIFT UP VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY                            There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                              Main Lift Up Valve.
  340      34        0       <<< PLATFORM OUTPUT DRIVER >>>
  343      34        3       PLATFORM LEVEL UP VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                        There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                              Platform Level Up Valve.
  344      34        4       PLATFORM LEVEL UP VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN CIRCUIT       There is a Short to Battery or an  - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                              Open Circuit to the Platform Level equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                              Up Valve.
  347      34        7       PLATFORM LEVEL DOWN VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                      There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                              Platform Level Down Valve.
  348      34        8       PLATFORM LEVEL DOWN VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN CIRCUIT There is a Short to Battery or an  - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                          Open Circuit to the Platform Level equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                          Down Valve.
  430      43        0       <<< ENGINE >>>
  431      43        1       FUEL SENSOR SHORT TO BATTERY                                     The Fuel Sensor reading is > 4.3V.
  432      43        2       FUEL SENSOR SHORT TO GROUND                                      The Fuel Sensor reading is < 0.2V.
  433      43        3       OIL PRESSURE SHORT TO BATTERY                                    The Oil Pressure Sensor reading is - Deutz engine only.
                                                                                              > 6.6V.
  434      43        4       OIL PRESSURE SHORT TO GROUND                                     The Oil Pressure Sensor reading is - Deutz engine only.
                                                                                              < 0.1V for more then 5 seconds. - Not reported during engine
                                                                                                                                 start.
  435      43        5       COOLANT TEMPERATURE SHORT TO GROUND                              The Coolant Temperature Sensor       - Deutz engine only.
                                                                                              reading is < 0.1V.
  437      43        7       ENGINE TROUBLE CODE                                              Displays engine SPN FMI code.
  438      43        8       HIGH ENGINE TEMP                                                 (Ford engine only) The engine        - Ford / Deutz engine only.
                                                                                              temperature is > 117 C.
                                                                                              (Deutz engine only) The engine
                                                                                              temperature is > 130 C.
3121171                                                                                                                                                      6-107
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                          Fault Message                     Fault Description                            Check
         Code
  439     43        9       AIR FILTER BYPASSED                                The Air Filter is clogged.
  4310    43        10      NO ALTERNATOR OUTPUT                               Battery voltage is < 11.5 volts for
                                                                               more then 15 seconds after
                                                                               engine start.
  4311    43        11      LOW OIL PRESSURE                                   (Ford engine only) The ECM has      - Ford / Deutz engine only.
                                                                               reported a low oil pressure fault.
                                                                               (Deutz engine only) Oil pressure is
                                                                               < 8 PSI for more then 10 seconds
                                                                               after engine start.
  4313    43        13      THROTTLE ACTUATOR FAILURE                          The engine RPM is > XXX for more
                                                                               then XX seconds.
  4314    43        14      WRONG ENGINE SELECTED - ECM DETECTED               A ECM was detected with a non-
                                                                               ECM type engine selected.
  4322    43        22      LOSS OF ENGINE SPEED SENSOR                        The engine RPM sensor indicates 0 - Diesel engine only.
                                                                               RPM AND the Oil Pressure Sensor
                                                                               indicates > 8 PSI for three sec-
                                                                               onds.
  4323    43        23      SPEED SENSOR READING INVALID SPEED                 The engine RPM sensor indicates       - Diesel engine only.
                                                                               > 4000 RPM.
  4331    43                SOOT LOAD WARNING - LOW
  4332    43                SOOT LOAD WARNING - HIGH
  4333    43                SOOT LOAD WARNING - SEVERE
  4375     4        3       WATER IN FUEL                                      The engine has shut down           Water in fuel filter for water or in
                                                                               because an unacceptable amount fuel or water in fuel sensor.
                                                                               of water has been detected in the
                                                                               fuel or there is an issue with the
                                                                               water in fuel sensor.
6-108                                                                                                                                        3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                          Fault Message                     Fault Description                            Check
          Code
  440      44        0       <<< BATTERY SUPPLY >>>
  441      44        1       BATTERY VOLTAGE TOO LOW - SYSTEM SHUTDOWN          Battery voltage is < 9V.
  442      44        2       BATTERY VOLTAGE TOO HIGH - SYSTEM SHUTDOWN         Battery voltage is > 16V.
  443       4        4       LSS BATTERY VOLTAGE TOO HIGH                       The load sensor has determined        Check for issue with sensor supply
                                                                                that its supply voltage is too high   voltage.
                                                                                (> 16V).
3121171                                                                                                                                         6-109
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                          Fault Message                     Fault Description                          Check
         Code
  455     45        5       TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - HIGH VOLTAGE                The Tower Lift PVG Valve supply     - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               voltage is high.
  456     45        6       TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - HIGH VOLTAGE           The Tower Telescope PVG Valve       - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               supply voltage is high.
  457     45        7       MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - LOW VOLTAGE                  The Main Lift PVG Valve supply      - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               voltage is low.
  458     45        8       TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - LOW VOLTAGE                 The Tower Lift PVG Valve supply     - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               voltage is low.
  459     45        9       TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - LOW VOLTAGE            The Tower Telescope PVG Valve       - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               supply voltage is low.
  4510    45        10      MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - STUCK NEUTRAL                The Main Lift PVG Valve is stuck in - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               its neutral position.
  4511    45        11      TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - STUCK NEUTRAL               The Tower Lift PVG Valve is stuck in - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               its neutral position.
  4512    45        12      TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - STUCK NEUTRAL          The Tower Telescope PVG Valve is    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               stuck in its neutral position.
  4513    45        13      MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - STUCK EXTENDED               The Main Lift PVG Valve is stuck in - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               its extended position.
  4514    45        14      TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - STUCK EXTENDED              The Tower Lift PVG Valve is stuck in - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               its extended position.
  4515    45        15      TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - STUCK EXTENDED         The Tower Telescope PVG Valve is    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               stuck in its extended position.
  4516    45        16      MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - STUCK RETRACTED              The Main Lift PVG Valve is stuck in - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               its retracted position.
  4517    45        17      TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - STUCK RETRACTED             The Tower Lift PVG Valve is stuck in - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               its retracted position.
  4518    45        18      TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - STUCK RETRACTED        The Tower Telescope PVG Valve is    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               stuck in its retracted position.
  4519    45        19      MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - OBSTRUCTED                   The Main Lift PVG Valve is          - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               obstructed
  4520    45        20      TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - OBSTRUCTED                  The Tower Lift PVG Valve is         - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               obstructed
  4521    45        21      TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - OBSTRUCTED             The Tower Telescope PVG Valve is    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               obstructed
  4522    45        22      MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - COMMAND IMPROPER             The Main Lift PVG Valve command - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               is improper.
  4523    45        23      TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - COMMAND IMPROPER            The Tower Lift PVG Valve com-       - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               mand is improper.
  4524    45        24      TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - COMMAND IMPROPER       The Tower Telescope PVG Valve       - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               command is improper.
  4525    45        25      MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - TIMEOUT                      The Main Lift PVG Valve has timed - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               out.
  4526    45        26      TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - TIMEOUT                     The Tower Lift PVG Valve has        - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               timed out.
  4527    45        27      TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - TIMEOUT                The Tower Telescope PVG Valve       - 1250AJP only.
                                                                               has timed out.
6-110                                                                                                                                   3121171
                                                                                                 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                          Fault Message                           Fault Description                          Check
          Code
  4528     45        28      MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - SETUP FAULT                        The Main Lift PVG Valve has a        - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      setup fault.
  4529     45        29      TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - SETUP FAULT                       The Tower Lift PVG Valve has a       - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      setup fault.
  4530     45        30      TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - SETUP FAULT                  The Tower Telescope PVG Valve        - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      has a setup fault.
  4531     45        31      MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - SENT UNRECOGNIZED FAULT            The Main Lift PVG Valve has an       - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      unrecognized fault.
  4532     45        32      TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - SENT UNRECOGNIZED FAULT           The Tower Lift PVG Valve has an      - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      unrecognized fault.
  4533     45        33      TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - SENT UNRECOGNIZED FAULT      The Tower Telescope PVG Valve        - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      has an unrecognized fault.
  4534     45        34      MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - PARAMETERS INCORRECT               The Main Lift PVG Valve parame-      - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      ters are incorrect.
  4535     45        35      TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - PARAMETERS INCORRECT              The Tower Lift PVG Valve parame- - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      ters are incorrect.
  4536     45        36      TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - PARAMETERS INCORRECT         The Tower Telescope PVG Valve        - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      parameters are incorrect.
  4537     45        37      MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - LOCATION IMPROPER                  The Main Lift PVG Valve is in the    - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      wrong location.
  4538     45        38      TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - LOCATION IMPROPER                 The Tower Lift PVG Valve is in the   - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      wrong location.
  4539     45        39      TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - LOCATION IMPROPER            The Tower Telescope PVG Valve is     - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      in the wrong location.
  4540     45        40      MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - WIRING INCORRECT                   The Main Lift PVG Valve has incor- - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      rect wiring.
  4541     45        41      TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - WIRING INCORRECT                  The Tower Lift PVG Valve has         - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      incorrect wiring.
  4542     45        42      TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - WIRING INCORRECT             The Tower Telescope PVG Valve        - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                      has incorrect wiring.
  4543     45        43      MAIN LIFT PVG VALVE - SPOOL CANNOT REACH NEUTRAL         X                                    - 1250AJP only.
  4544     45        44      TOWER LIFT PVG VALVE - SPOOL CANNOT REACH NEUTRAL        X                                    - 1250AJP only.
  4545     45        45      TOWER TELESCOPE PVG VALVE - SPOOL CANNOT REACH NEUTRAL   X                                    - 1250AJP only.
3121171                                                                                                                                        6-111
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                           Fault Message                          Fault Description                           Check
         Code
  660     66        0       <<< COMMUNICATION >>>
  662     66        2       CANBUS FAILURE - PLATFORM MODULE                         Platform Module CAN communi-
                                                                                     cation lost.
  663     66                CANBUS FAILURE - LOAD SENSING SYSTEM MODULE
  666     66        6       CANBUS FAILURE - ENGINE CONTROLLER                       Engine Control Module CAN com- - ECM equipped engine only.
                                                                                     munication lost.
  667     66        7       CANBUS FAILURE - MAIN LIFT PVG                           Main Lift PVG CAN communica-         - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                     tion lost.
  668     66        8       CANBUS FAILURE - TOWER LIFT PVG                          Tower Lift PVG CAN communica-        - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                     tion lost.
  669     66        9       CANBUS FAILURE - TOWER TELESCOPE PVG                     Tower Telescope PVG CAN com-         - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                     munication lost.
  6610    66        10      CANBUS FAILURE - BLAM                                    BLAM CAN communication lost.         - BLAM equipped vehicles only.
  6611    66        11      CANBUS FAILURE - CHASSIS MODULE                          Engine Control Module CAN com- - ECM equipped engine only.
                                                                                     munication lost.
  6612    66        12      CANBUS FAILURE - CYLINDER LOAD PIN                       Cylinder Load Pin CAN communi-       - Cylinder Load Pin equipped
                                                                                     cation lost.                         engine only.
  6613    66        13      CANBUS FAILURE - EXCESSIVE CANBUS ERRORS                 There has been > 500 Bus Off
                                                                                     errors or >500 Bus Passive Errors.
  6614    66        14      CANBUS FAILURE - MAIN ANGLE SENSOR #1                    Angle Sensor #1 CAN communica- - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                     tion lost.
  6615    66        15      CANBUS FAILURE - MAIN ANGLE SENSOR #2                    Angle Sensor #2 CAN communica- - 1250AJP only.
                                                                                     tion lost.
  6622    66        22      CANBUS FAILURE - TCU MODULE                              Machine Setup/ Telematics=YES,
                                                                                     No device heartbeat for 30 sec
  6623    66        23      CANBUS FAILURE - GATEWAY MODULE                          Machine Setup/ Telematics=YES,
                                                                                     No device heartbeat for 30 sec
  6629    66        29      CANBUS FAILURE - TELEMATICS CANBUS LOADING               X                                    -Telematics only
                            TOO HIGH
  663      6        6       CANBUS FAILURE - LOAD SENSING SYSTEM MODULE              The control system has lost com- Check wiring to load sensor.
                                                                                     munication with the load sensing
                                                                                     system load pin.
6-112                                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                         Fault Message                      Fault Description                             Check
          Code
  820      82        0       <<< PLATFORM LOAD SENSE >>>
  821      82                LSS CELL #1 ERROR
  8211      8        2       LSS READING UNDER WEIGHT                           LSS has been calibrated and the        Ensure platform is not resting on
                                                                                UGM has determined that the            the ground or is not leveled at an
                                                                                load sensing system reading is         extreme negative angle.
                                                                                underweight while a period of
                                                                                time while operating drive or          Re-calibrate the load sensing sys-
                                                                                boom lift up at speeds greater         tem if the above items are not a
                                                                                than creep OR the UGM has deter-       factor.
                                                                                mined that the load sensing sys-
                                                                                tem reading is less than -1.5 x
                                                                                Gross Platform Weight.
3121171                                                                                                                                           6-113
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                         Fault Message                      Fault Description                             Check
         Code
  8223     8        2       LSS STRAIN GAUGE 2 - STAGNANT                      The control system has deter-       Possible sensor hardware issue.
                                                                               mined that the strain gauge 2
                                                                               reading in the load sensor is stag-
                                                                               nant (not changing).
6-114                                                                                                                                       3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                          Fault Message                     Fault Description                          Check
          Code
  8226      8        2       LSS STRAIN GAUGE 1 - OUT OF RANGE HIGH             The shear beam is reporting an      Possible sensor hardware issue.
                                                                                out of range high issue with the
                                                                                strain gauge 1 reading.
3121171                                                                                                                                       6-115
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                          Fault Message                     Fault Description                          Check
         Code
  8229     8        2       LSS STRAIN GAUGE 2 - INITIALIZATION ERROR          The shear beam is reporting an       Possible sensor hardware issue.
                                                                               initialization issue with the strain
                                                                               gauge 2 sensor.
6-116                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                          Fault Message                     Fault Description                         Check
          Code
  8232      8        2       LSS STRAIN GAUGE 1 - SENSOR DEFECT                 The shear beam is reporting a sen- Possible sensor hardware issue.
                                                                                sor defect issue with the strain
                                                                                gauge 1 sensor.
3121171                                                                                                                                     6-117
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                          Fault Message                     Fault Description                          Check
         Code
  8235     8        2       LSS STRAIN GAUGE 2 - NOT INSTALLED                 The shear beam is reporting a not Possible sensor hardware issue.
                                                                               installed issue with the strain
                                                                               gauge 2 sensor.
6-118                                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                                     SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                         Fault Message                                Fault Description                           Check
          Code
  824      82                LSS CELL #4 ERROR
  825       8        2       LSS HAS NOT BEEN CALIBRATED                                  The load sensing system is config- Calibrate the load sensing system.
                                                                                          ured but has not been calibrated.
3121171                                                                                                                                                  6-119
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                         Fault Message                               Fault Description                           Check
         Code
  8313    83        13      PLATFORM LEVEL SENSOR #1 - REFERENCE VOLTAGE OUT OF RANGE   Platform Level Sensor #1 rever-    - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                        ence voltage is outside acceptable equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                        range (4.9 to 5.1 volts).
  8314    83        14      PLATFORM LEVEL SENSOR #2 - REFERENCE VOLTAGE OUT OF RANGE   Platform Level Sensor #2 rever-    - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                        ence voltage is outside acceptable equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                        range (4.9 to 5.1 volts).
  8315    83        15      PLATFORM LEVELING SENSOR - DISAGREEMENT                     The Control System reads the sen- - Electronic leveling system
                                                                                        sor values at power-up. The fault is equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                        triggered when there is a ± 5
                                                                                        degree difference from the initial
                                                                                        reading.
  8316    83        16      PLATFORM LEVEL SENSOR #1 - COMMUNICATIONS LOST              Platform Level Sensor #1 serial       - 1200S and 1350S only.
                                                                                        communication lost.
  8317    83        17      PLATFORM LEVEL SENSOR #2 - COMMUNICATIONS LOST              Platform Level Sensor #2 serial       - 1200S and 1350S only.
                                                                                        communication lost.
  8318    83        18      PLATFORM LEVELING SYSTEM TIMEOUT                            The Platform was unable to main-
                                                                                        tain desired level within range for
                                                                                        the allotted time.
  840     84        0       <<< ENVELOPE >>>
  841     84        1       BOOM ANGLE SENSOR DISAGREEMENT                              There is a disagreement between - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                        the Boom Angle Sensors.         cles only.
  842     84        2       BOOM LENGTH SWITCH FAILED                                   The Boom Length Switches are          - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                        reporting the same state.             cles only.
  843     84        3       BOOM LENGTH SWITCH/SENSOR DISAGREEMENT                      There is a disagreement between - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                        the Boom Length Switch and the cles only.
                                                                                        Boom Length Sensor.
  844     84        4       BOOM LENGTH SENSOR NOT DETECTING LENGTH CHANGE              The Boom Length Sensor is not         - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                        changing during a boom tele-          cles only.
                                                                                        scope command.
  845     84        5       BOOM LENGTH SENSOR - OUT OF RANGE HIGH                      Boom Length Sensor out of range - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                        high.                           cles only.
                                                                                                                        -1200/1350 only
  846     84        6       BOOM LENGTH SENSOR - OUT OF RANGE LOW                       Boom Length Sensor out of range - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                        low.                            cles only.
                                                                                                                        -1200/1350 only
  847     84        7       BOOM LENGTH SENSOR - VALUE OUT OF RANGE HIGH                Boom Length out of range high.        - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                                                              cles only.
                                                                                                                              -1200/1350 only
  848     84        8       BOOM LENGTH SENSOR - VALUE OUT OF RANGE LOW                 Boom Length out of range low.         - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                                                              cles only.
                                                                                                                              -1200/1350 only
6-120                                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                         SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                         Fault Message                     Fault Description                        Check
          Code
  849      84        9       BOOM ANGLE SENSOR #1 - COMMUNICATIONS FAULT       Boom Angle Sensor #1 communi- - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               cations lost.                 cles only.
  8410     84        10      BOOM ANGLE SENSOR #2 - COMMUNICATIONS FAULT       Boom Angle Sensor #2 communi- - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               cations lost.                 cles only.
  8411     84        11      BOOM ANGLE SENSOR #1 - INVALID ANGLE              Boom Angle Sensor #1 out of        - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               range.                             cles only.
  8412     84        12      BOOM ANGLE SENSOR #2 - INVALID ANGLE              Boom Angle Sensor #2 out of        - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               range.                             cles only.
  8413     84        13      WRONG TELESCOPE RESPONSE                          Boom telescope is moving in the    - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               opposite direction of the com-     cles only.
                                                                               mand.
  8414     84        14      WRONG LIFT RESPONSE                               Boom lift is moving in the oppo-   - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               site direction of the command.     cles only.
  8415     84        15      TOWER ANGLE SENSOR DISAGREEMENT                   There is a disagreement between - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               the Tower Angle Sensors.        cles only.
                                                                                                               -1250
3121171                                                                                                                                    6-121
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                        Fault Message                      Fault Description                           Check
          Code
  84151     8        4       TOWER LENGTH SENSOR 1 FAULTY                      There are three ways (a, b, c) that   Check Hardware, Wiring
                                                                               these faults can be set:
                                                                               (a)
                                                                               If the length sensor voltage
                                                                               changes more than 0.0168 volts
                                                                               within 40 milliseconds a counter
                                                                               for the respective length sensor
                                                                               shall be incremented to aid ser-
                                                                               vice in diagnosing bad sensor per-
                                                                               formance. The counter below
                                                                               shall be incremented anytime the
                                                                               description above is met. It is
                                                                               cleared/reset by a power cycle
                                                                               TwrLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_PowerCycle > 30
                                                                               (b)
                                                                               The counter below shall be incre-
                                                                               mented every time TwrLen-
                                                                               Snsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_PowerCycle
                                                                               (described above) reached its
                                                                               threshold. This value is stored in
                                                                               EEPROM in order to track the his-
                                                                               tory of the issue. (A successful
                                                                               Boom Sensor Calibration will reset
                                                                               this counter – this is reflected in
                                                                               the boom sensor calibration docu-
                                                                               ment)
                                                                               TwrLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_EEPROM > 3
                                                                               (c)
                                                                               The fault counter below shall be
                                                                               incremented every time the trig-
                                                                               ger condition described in section
                                                                               (a) is observed during certain
                                                                               steps during Boom Sensor Cali-
                                                                               bration (please see that docu-
                                                                               ment section for further details)
                                                                               TwrLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_BmSnsrCal > 20
6-122                                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                        Fault Message                      Fault Description                           Check
          Code
  84152     8        4       TOWER LENGTH SENSOR 2 FAULTY                      There are three ways (a, b, c) that   Check Hardware, Wiring
                                                                               these faults can be set:
                                                                               (a)
                                                                               If the length sensor voltage
                                                                               changes more than 0.0168 volts
                                                                               within 40 milliseconds a counter
                                                                               for the respective length sensor
                                                                               shall be incremented to aid ser-
                                                                               vice in diagnosing bad sensor per-
                                                                               formance. The counter below
                                                                               shall be incremented anytime the
                                                                               description above is met. It is
                                                                               cleared/reset by a power cycle
                                                                               TwrLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_PowerCycle > 30
                                                                               (b)
                                                                               The counter below shall be incre-
                                                                               mented every time TwrLen-
                                                                               Snsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_PowerCycle
                                                                               (described above) reached its
                                                                               threshold. This value is stored in
                                                                               EEPROM in order to track the his-
                                                                               tory of the issue. (A successful
                                                                               Boom Sensor Calibration will reset
                                                                               this counter – this is reflected in
                                                                               the boom sensor calibration docu-
                                                                               ment)
                                                                               TwrLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_EEPROM > 3
                                                                               (c)
                                                                               The fault counter below shall be
                                                                               incremented every time the trig-
                                                                               ger condition described in section
                                                                               (a) is observed during certain
                                                                               steps during Boom Sensor Cali-
                                                                               bration (please see that docu-
                                                                               ment section for further details)
                                                                               TwrLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_BmSnsrCal > 20
3121171                                                                                                                                       6-123
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                        Fault Message                      Fault Description                           Check
          Code
  84153     8        4       BOOM LENGTH SENSOR 1 FAULTY                       There are three ways (a, b, c) that   Check wiring and hardware
                                                                               these faults can be set:
                                                                               (a)
                                                                               If the length sensor voltage
                                                                               changes more than 0.0168 volts
                                                                               within 40 milliseconds a counter
                                                                               for the respective length sensor
                                                                               shall be incremented to aid ser-
                                                                               vice in diagnosing bad sensor per-
                                                                               formance. The counter below
                                                                               shall be incremented anytime the
                                                                               description above is met. It is
                                                                               cleared/reset by a power cycle
                                                                               BmLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_PowerCycle > 30
                                                                               (b)
                                                                               The counter below shall be incre-
                                                                               mented every time BmLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_PowerCycle
                                                                               (described above) reached its
                                                                               threshold. This value is stored in
                                                                               EEPROM in order to track the his-
                                                                               tory of the issue. (A successful
                                                                               Boom Sensor Calibration will reset
                                                                               this counter – this is reflected in
                                                                               the boom sensor calibration docu-
                                                                               ment)
                                                                               BmLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_EEPROM > 3
                                                                               (c)
                                                                               The fault counter below shall be
                                                                               incremented every time the trig-
                                                                               ger condition described in section
                                                                               (a) is observed during certain
                                                                               steps during Boom Sensor Cali-
                                                                               bration (please see that docu-
                                                                               ment section for further details)
                                                                               BmLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_BmSnsrCal > 20
6-124                                                                                                                                    3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                        Fault Message                      Fault Description                           Check
          Code
  84154     8        4       BOOM LENGTH SENSOR 2 FAULTY                       There are three ways (a, b, c) that   Check wiring and hardware
                                                                               these faults can be set:
                                                                               (a)
                                                                               If the length sensor voltage
                                                                               changes more than 0.0168 volts
                                                                               within 40 milliseconds a counter
                                                                               for the respective length sensor
                                                                               shall be incremented to aid ser-
                                                                               vice in diagnosing bad sensor per-
                                                                               formance. The counter below
                                                                               shall be incremented anytime the
                                                                               description above is met. It is
                                                                               cleared/reset by a power cycle
                                                                               BmLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_PowerCycle > 30
                                                                               (b)
                                                                               The counter below shall be incre-
                                                                               mented every time BmLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_PowerCycle
                                                                               (described above) reached its
                                                                               threshold. This value is stored in
                                                                               EEPROM in order to track the his-
                                                                               tory of the issue. (A successful
                                                                               Boom Sensor Calibration will reset
                                                                               this counter – this is reflected in
                                                                               the boom sensor calibration docu-
                                                                               ment)
                                                                               BmLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_EEPROM > 3
                                                                               (c)
                                                                               The fault counter below shall be
                                                                               incremented every time the trig-
                                                                               ger condition described in section
                                                                               (a) is observed during certain
                                                                               steps during Boom Sensor Cali-
                                                                               bration (please see that docu-
                                                                               ment section for further details)
                                                                               BmLenSnsr(1/
                                                                               2)FaultCounter_BmSnsrCal > 20
3121171                                                                                                                                     6-125
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                         Fault Message                      Fault Description                       Check
         Code
  8416    84        16      TOWER LENGTH SENSOR DISAGREEMENT                    There is a disagreement between - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                the Tower Length Sensors.       cles only.
                                                                                                                -1250
  8417    84        17      MAIN ANGLE SENSOR DISAGREEMENT                      There is a disagreement between - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                the Main Boom Angle Sensors.    cles only.
                                                                                                                -1250
  8418    84        18      TOWER LENGTH SENSOR #1 - OUT OF RANGE HIGH          Tower Boom Angle Sensor #1 out   - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                of range high.                   cles only.
                                                                                                                 -1250
  8419    84        19      TOWER LENGTH SENSOR #1 - OUT OF RANGE LOW           Tower Boom Angle Sensor #1 out   - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                of range low.                    cles only.
                                                                                                                 -1250
  8420    84        20      TOWER LENGTH SENSOR #2 - OUT OF RANGE HIGH          Tower Boom Angle Sensor #2 out   - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                of range high.                   cles only.
                                                                                                                 -1250
  8421    84        21      TOWER LENGTH SENSOR #2 - OUT OF RANGE LOW           Tower Boom Angle Sensor #2 out   - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                of range low.                    cles only.
                                                                                                                 -1250
  8422    84        22      TOWER LENGTH SENSOR - NOT DETECTING LENGTH CHANGE   The Tower Length Sensor is not   - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                changing during a tower tele-    cles only.
                                                                                scope command.                   -1250
  8423    84        23      TOWER LENGTH MOVEMENT WITHOUT COMMAND               The Tower Length Sensor is       - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                changing without a tower tele-   cles only.
                                                                                scope command.                   -1250
  8424    84        24      TOWER LENGTH SENSOR #1 - OUT OF RANGE HIGH          Tower Boom Angle Sensor #1 out   - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                of range high.                   cles only.
                                                                                                                 -1250
  8425    84        25      TOWER LENGTH SENSOR #1 - OUT OF RANGE LOW           Tower Boom Angle Sensor #1 out   - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                of range low.                    cles only.
                                                                                                                 -1250
6-126                                                                                                                                 3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                         Fault Message                     Fault Description                         Check
          Code
  8426     84        26      TOWER LENGTH SENSOR #2 - OUT OF RANGE HIGH        Tower Boom Angle Sensor #2 out      - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               of range high.                      cles only.
                                                                                                                   -1250
  8427     84        27      TOWER LENGTH SENSOR #2 - OUT OF RANGE LOW         Tower Boom Angle Sensor #2 out      - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               of range low.                       cles only.
                                                                                                                   -1250
  8428     84        28      TOWER ANGLE SENSOR #1 - INVALID ANGLE             Tower Boom Angle Sensor #1 out      - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               of range.                           cles only.
                                                                                                                   -1250
  8429     84        29      TOWER ANGLE SENSOR #2 - INVALID ANGLE             Tower Boom Angle Sensor #2 out      - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               of range.                           cles only.
                                                                                                                   -1250
  8430     84        30      TOWER ANGLE SENSOR #1 - INVALID MODEL             Wrong Tower Boom Angle Sensor - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               #1 installed.                 cles only.
                                                                                                             - 1250AJP Only
                                                                                                             - Must be a Rieker Sensor, not a
                                                                                                             Spectron Sensor.
  8431     84        31      TOWER ANGLE SENSOR #2 - INVALID MODEL             Wrong Tower Boom Angle Sensor - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               #2 installed.                 cles only.
                                                                                                             - 1250AJP Only
                                                                                                             - Must be a Rieker Sensor, not a
                                                                                                             Spectron Sensor.
  8432     84        32      MAIN ANGLE SENSOR #1 - INVALID ANGLE              Main Boom Angle Sensor #1 out of - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               range.                           cles only.
                                                                                                                -1250
  8433     84        33      MAIN ANGLE SENSOR #2 - INVALID ANGLE              Main Boom Angle Sensor #2 out of - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               range.                           cles only.
                                                                                                                -1250
  8434     84        34      MAIN ANGLE SENSOR - NOT DETECTING ANGLE CHANGE    The Main Boom Angle Sensor is       - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               not changing during a main lift     cles only.
                                                                               command.                            -1250
  8435     84        35      MAIN ANGLE MOVEMENT WITHOUT CMD                   The Main Boom Angle Sensor is     - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               changing without a main lift com- cles only.
                                                                               mand.                             -1250
  8436     84        36      WRONG TOWER TELESCOPE RESPONSE                    Tower telescope is moving in the    - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               opposite direction of the com-      cles only.
                                                                               mand.                               -1250
  8437     84        37      WRONG TOWER LIFT RESPONSE                         Tower lift is moving in the oppo-   - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               site direction of the command.      cles only.
                                                                                                                   -1250
  8438     84        38      TOWER CYLINDER ANGLE SENSOR - OUT OF RANGE HIGH   The Tower Cylinder Angle Sensor is - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                               < 4721 A/D counts.                 cles only.
                                                                                                                  -1250
3121171                                                                                                                                     6-127
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                        Fault Message                        Fault Description                          Check
         Code
  8439    84        39      TOWER CYLINDER ANGLE SENSOR - OUT OF RANGE LOW       The Tower Cylinder Angle Sensor is - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 > 29535 A/D counts.                cles only.
                                                                                                                    -1250
  8440    84        40      TOWER CYLINDER ANGLE SENSOR - NOT DETECTING CHANGE   The Tower Cylinder Angle Sensor is - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 not changing during a tower lift cles only.
                                                                                 command.                           -1250
  8441    84        41      TOWER CYLINDER ANGLE MOVEMENT WITHOUT COMMAND        The Tower Cylinder Angle Sensor is - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 changing without a tower lift      cles only.
                                                                                 command.                           -1250
  8442    84        42      MAIN TRANSPORT ANGLE SWITCH FAILED                   The Main Boom Angle Switch is      - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 bad.                               cles only.
                                                                                                                    -1250
  8443    84        43      TWR TRANSPORT SWITCH DISAGREEMENT                    There is a disagreement between - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 the Tower Boom Length Switch    cles only.
                                                                                 and the Tower Length Sensor.    -1250
  8444    84        44      TRANSPORT DUAL CAPACITY SWITCHES BAD                 Both the Dual Capacity Switch and - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 the Transport Switch are bad.     cles only.
                                                                                                                   -1250
  8445    84        45      TRANSPORT DUAL CAPACITY BAD TRANSITION               The Dual Capacity Switch and the - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 Transport Switch changed state cles only.
                                                                                 out of order.                    -1250
  8446    84        46      MAIN TRANSPORT LENGTH SWITCH DISAGREEMENT            There is a disagreement between - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 the Main Boom Transport Length cles only.
                                                                                 Switches.                       -1250
  8447    84        47      MAIN DUAL CAPACITY LENGTH SWITCH DISAGREEMENT        There is a disagreement between - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 the Main Boom Dual Capacity     cles only.
                                                                                 Length Switches.                -1250
  8448    84        48      MAIN TRANSPORT ANGLE SWITCH/SENSOR DISAGREEMENT      There is a disagreement between - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 the Main Boom Angle Switch and cles only.
                                                                                 the Main Boom Angle Sensor.     -1250
  8449    84        49      TOWER CYLINDER ANGLE SWITCH/SENSOR DISAGREEMENT      There is a disagreement between - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 the Tower Boom Angle Switch and cles only.
                                                                                 the Tower Cylinder Angle Sensor. -1250
  8450    84        50      NEW MAIN ANGLE SENSOR #1 DETECTED                    A new Main Angle Sensor 1 has      -1250
                                                                                 been detected.
  8451    84        51      NEW MAIN ANGLE SENSOR #2 DETECTED                    A new Main Angle Sensor 2 has      -1250
                                                                                 been detected.
  8452    84        52      TOWER LENGTH SWITCH/SENSOR DISAGREEMENT              There is a disagreement between - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 the Tower Length Switch and the cles only.
                                                                                 Tower Length Sensor.            -1250
  8453    84        53      WRONG MAIN TELE RESPONSE                             Main telescope is moving in the    - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 opposite direction of the com-     cles only.
                                                                                 mand.                              -1250
  8454    84        54      WRONG MAIN LIFT RESPONSE                             Main lift is moving in the opposite - Envelope Control equipped vehi-
                                                                                 direction of the command.           cles only.
                                                                                                                     -1250
6-128                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                             Fault Message                  Fault Description                        Check
          Code
  8482     84        82      TOWER ENVELOPE MASSIVELY ENCROACHED                8482 TOWER ENVELOPE MAS-            8482 TOWER ENVELOPE MAS-
                                                                                SIVELY ENCROACHED - Tower has       SIVELY ENCROACHED - Tower has
                                                                                exceeded the maximum tower          exceeded the maximum tower
                                                                                path stop line.1250 Only            path stop line.1250 Only
  8483     84        83      TOWER ENVELOPE MULTIPLE ENCROACHMENTS              The tower has encroached the        -1250
                                                                                envelope twice in a 15 minute
                                                                                period.
  8484     84        84      BCS VIOLATION - BOOM LOCKED                        Control system has detected one -1250
                                                                                of the following faults 8423, 8435,
                                                                                8441, 8482, 8483. Main lift will be
                                                                                disallowed and boom will be
                                                                                locked in transport until a boom
                                                                                unlock procedure has been per-
                                                                                formed. This fault is maintained
                                                                                through a power cycle.
  8485     84        85      BCS - HYDRAULIC RETRIEVAL ACTIVE                   Alerts operator when control sys- -1250
                                                                                tem is in hydraulic retrieval mode.
  8486     84        86      BCS - ELECTRICAL RETRIEVAL ACTIVE                  Alerts operator when control sys- -1250
                                                                                tem is in electrical retrieval mode.
  8487     84        87      BCS - MULTIPLE FAILURES ACTIVE                     Control system has detected a       -1250
                                                                                main and a tower envelope
                                                                                encroachment at the same time.
  850      85        0       <<< MOMENT / LOAD PINS >>>
  851      85        1       MOMENT PIN - HORIZONTAL FORCE OUT OF RANGE         The Moment Pin horizontal force
                                                                                is out of range.
  852      85        2       MOMENT PIN - VERTICAL FORCE OUT OF RANGE           The Moment Pin vertical force is
                                                                                out of range.
  853      85        3       LOAD PIN - HORIZONTAL FORCE OUT OF RANGE           The Load Pin horizontal force is    -1250
                                                                                out of range.
  854      85        4       LOAD PIN - VERTICAL FORCE OUT OF RANGE             The Load Pin vertical force is out of -1250
                                                                                range.
  855      85        5       MOMENT PIN - SENSOR FAULT                          The Moment Pin has reported a
                                                                                fault.
  856      85        6       LOAD PIN - SENSOR FAULT                            The Load Pin has reported a fault. -1250
  857      85        7       NEW MOMENT PIN DETECTED                            A new Moment Pin has been
                                                                                detected.
  858      85        8       NEW LOAD PIN DETECTED                              A new Load Pin has been             -1250
                                                                                detected.
3121171                                                                                                                                    6-129
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                           Fault Message                                    Fault Description                           Check
         Code
  859     85        9       LOAD PIN/TOWER LIFT CYLINDER ANGLE DISAGREEMENT                    There is a disagreement between -1250
                                                                                               the Load Pin and the Tower Lift
                                                                                               cylinder Angle.
  8510    85        10      LOAD PIN - FORCE VALUES NOT CHANGING                               The Load Pin is not changing.       -1250
  8511    85        11      LOAD PIN - FORCE TOO LOW OVER TOWER ANGLE CHANGE                   Load pin force did not change    -1250
                                                                                               enough for the tower angle move-
                                                                                               ment.
  8512    85        12      LOAD PIN - FORCE TOO LOW OVER MAIN ANGLE CHANGE                    Load pin force did not change   -1250
                                                                                               enough for the main angle move-
                                                                                               ment.
  8513    85        13      LOAD PIN - FORCE TOO LOW OVER MAIN LENGTH TRANSITION               Load Pin force did not change       -1250
                                                                                               enough for main length move-
                                                                                               ment.
  860     86        0       <<< STEERING / AXLE >>>
  861     86        1       RESTRICTED TO TRANSPORT - OSCILLATING AXLE PRESSURE SWITCH         The Oscillating Axle Pressure       - Electrically released Oscillated
                            DISAGREEMENT                                                       Switch indicates pressure while     Axles equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                               not driving or does not indicate
                                                                                               pressure while driving and
                                                                                               restricted to transport.
  862     86        2       AXLE EXTEND VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN CIRCUIT               There is a Short to Battery or an
                                                                                               Open Circuit to the Axle Extend
                                                                                               Valve.
  863     86        3       AXLE EXTEND VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                                There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                               Axle Extend Valve.
  864     86        4       AXLE RETRACT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN CIRCUIT              There is a Short to Battery or an
                                                                                               Open Circuit to the Axle Retract
                                                                                               Valve.
  865     86        5       AXLE RETRACT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                               There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                               Axle Retract Valve.
  866     86        6       RIGHT FRONT STEER RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN CIR-      There is a Short to Battery or an
                            CUIT                                                               Open Circuit to the Right Front
                                                                                               Steer Right Valve.
  867     86        7       RIGHT FRONT STEER RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                    There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                               Right Front Steer Right Valve.
  868     86        8       RIGHT FRONT STEER LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN CIRCUIT There is a Short to Battery or an
                                                                                            Open Circuit to the Right Front
                                                                                            Steer Left Valve.
  869     86        9       RIGHT FRONT STEER LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                     There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                               Right Front Steer Left Valve.
6-130                                                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                                            SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                           Fault Message                                     Fault Description                Check
          Code
  8610     86        10      LEFT FRONT STEER RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN CIRCUIT There is a Short to Battery or an
                                                                                             Open Circuit to the Left Front Steer
                                                                                             Right Valve.
  8611     86        11      LEFT FRONT STEER RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                      There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                                 Left Front Steer Right Valve.
  8612     86        12      LEFT FRONT STEER LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN CIRCUIT      There is a Short to Battery or an
                                                                                                 Open Circuit to the Left Front Steer
                                                                                                 Left Valve.
  8613     86        13      LEFT FRONT STEER LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                       There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                                 Left Front Steer Left Valve.
  8614     86        14      RIGHT REAR STEER RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN CIRCUIT There is a Short to Battery or an
                                                                                             Open Circuit to the Right Rear
                                                                                             Steer Right Valve.
  8615     86        15      RIGHT REAR STEER RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                      There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                                 Right Rear Steer Right Valve.
  8616     86        16      RIGHT REAR STEER LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN CIRCUIT      There is a Short to Battery or an
                                                                                                 Open Circuit to the Right Rear
                                                                                                 Steer Left Valve.
  8617     86        17      RIGHT REAR STEER LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                       There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                                 Right Rear Steer Left Valve.
  8618     86        18      LEFT REAR STEER RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN CIRCUIT      There is a Short to Battery or an
                                                                                                 Open Circuit to the Left Rear Steer
                                                                                                 Right Valve.
  8619     86        19      LEFT REAR STEER RIGHT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                       There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                                 Left Rear Steer Right Valve.
  8620     86        20      LEFT REAR STEER LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO BATTERY OR OPEN CIRCUIT       There is a Short to Battery or an
                                                                                                 Open Circuit to the Left Rear Steer
                                                                                                 Left Valve.
  8621     86        21      LEFT REAR STEER LEFT VALVE - SHORT TO GROUND                        There is a Short to Ground to the
                                                                                                 Left Rear Steer Left Valve.
  8622     86        22      FRONT RIGHT STEER SENSOR - DECOUPLED                                The Front Right Steer Sensor has
                                                                                                 become decoupled.
  8623     86        23      FRONT LEFT STEER SENSOR - DECOUPLED                                 The Front Left Steer Sensor has
                                                                                                 become decoupled.
  8624     86        24      REAR RIGHT STEER SENSOR - DECOUPLED                                 The Rear Right Steer Sensor has
                                                                                                 become decoupled.
  8625     86        25      REAR LEFT STEER SENSOR - DECOUPLED                                  The Rear Left Steer Sensor has
                                                                                                 become decoupled.
  8626     86        26      FRONT LEFT STEER SENSOR - NOT RESPONDING                            The Front Right Steer Sensor is not
                                                                                                 responding to steer commands.
  8627     86        27      FRONT RIGHT STEER SENSOR - NOT RESPONDING                           The Front Left Steer Sensor is not
                                                                                                 responding to steer commands.
  8628     86        28      REAR LEFT STEER SENSOR - NOT RESPONDING                             The Rear Right Steer Sensor is not
                                                                                                 responding to steer commands.
  8629     86        29      REAR RIGHT STEER SENSOR - NOT RESPONDING                            The Rear Left Steer Sensor is not
                                                                                                 responding to steer commands.
3121171                                                                                                                                         6-131
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                          Fault Message                               Fault Description                Check
         Code
  8630    86        30      FRONT RIGHT STEER SENSOR - SHORT TO GROUND OR OPEN CIRCUIT   There is a Short to Ground or an
                                                                                         Open Circuit to the Front Right
                                                                                         Steer Sensor.
  8631    86        31      FRONT RIGHT STEER SENSOR - SHORT TO BATTERY                  There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                         Front Right Steer Sensor.
  8632    86        32      FRONT LEFT STEER SENSOR - SHORT TO GROUND OR OPEN CIRCUIT    There is a Short to Ground or an
                                                                                         Open Circuit to the Front Left Steer
                                                                                         Sensor.
  8633    86        33      FRONT LEFT STEER SENSOR - SHORT TO BATTERY                   There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                         Front Left Steer Sensor.
  8634    86        34      REAR RIGHT STEER SENSOR - SHORT TO GROUND OR OPEN CIRCUIT    There is a Short to Ground or an
                                                                                         Open Circuit to the Rear Right
                                                                                         Steer Sensor.
  8635    86        35      REAR RIGHT STEER SENSOR - SHORT TO BATTERY                   There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                         Rear Right Steer Sensor.
  8636    86        36      REAR LEFT STEER SENSOR - SHORT TO GROUND OR OPEN CIRCUIT     There is a Short to Ground or an
                                                                                         Open Circuit to the Rear Left Steer
                                                                                         Sensor.
  8637    86        37      REAR LEFT STEER SENSOR - SHORT TO BATTERY                    There is a Short to Battery to the
                                                                                         Rear Left Steer Sensor.
  8651    86        51      ENGINE SHUTDOWN - AXLE LOCKOUT VALVE FAULT                   Engine Start is prevented while
                                                                                         there is an Oscillating Axle fault
                                                                                         and vehicle is out of transport
                                                                                         position
  876     87        6       WIRE ROPE SERVICE REQUIRED                                   MACHINE SETUP → CABLE
                                                                                         SWITCH = YES;
                                                                                         Wire Rope Service = Enabled
  990     99        0       <<< HARDWARE >>>
  991     99                LSS WATCHDOG RESET
  992     99                LSS EEPROM ERROR
  993     99                LSS INTERNAL ERROR - PIN EXCITATION
  994     99                LSS INTERNAL ERROR - DRDY MISSING FROM A/D
  998     99        8       EEPROM FAILURE - CHECK ALL SETTINGS                          The Ground Module has reported
                                                                                         an EEPROM failure.
  9910    99        10      FUNCTIONS LOCKED OUT - PLATFORM MODULE SOFTWARE VERSION      The Platform Module software
                            IMPROPER                                                     version is not compatible with the
                                                                                         rest of the system.
  9911     9        9       FUNCTIONS LOCKED OUT
  9914    99        14      PLATFORM MODULE SOFTWARE UPDATE REQUIRED                     The Platform Module software
                                                                                         requires an updated.
  9915    99        15      CHASSIS TILT SENSOR NOT GAIN CALIBRATED                      The Chassis Tilt Sensor gain cali-
                                                                                         bration has been lost.
6-132                                                                                                                                   3121171
                                                                                                 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
          Flash
  DTC             Sequence                          Fault Message                           Fault Description                          Check
          Code
  9916     99        16      CHASSIS TILT SENSOR GAIN OUT OF RANGE                    The Chassis Tilt Sensor gain cali-
                                                                                      bration has become corrupted.
  9917     99        17      HIGH RESOLUTION A2D FAILURE - INTERRUPT LOST             The Platform Module has
                                                                                      reported that its ADS1213 chip
                                                                                      has stopped asserting its inter-
                                                                                      rupt.
  9918     99        18      HIGH RESOLUTION A2D FAILURE - REINIT LIMIT               The Platform Module has
                                                                                      reported that its ADS1213 chip
                                                                                      had to be reset 3 or more times.
  9919     99        19      GROUND SENSOR REF VOLTAGE OUT OF RANGE                   The Ground Module has reported - Not reported during power-up.
                                                                                      that its sensor reference voltage is
                                                                                      outside acceptable range.
  9920     99        20      PLATFORM SENSOR REF VOLTAGE OUT OF RANGE                 The Platform Module has            - Not reported during power-up.
                                                                                      reported that its sensor reference
                                                                                      voltage is outside acceptable
                                                                                      range.
  9921     99        21      GROUND MODULE FAILURE - HIGH SIDE DRIVER CUTOUT FAULTY   The Ground Module has reported
                                                                                      that its high side driver cutout
                                                                                      failed.
  9922     99        22      PLATFORM MODULE FAILURE - HWFS CODE 1                    The Platform Module has
                                                                                      reported that the V(Low) FET has
                                                                                      failed.
  9923     99        23      GROUND MODULE FAILURE - HWFS CODE 1                      The Ground Module has reported
                                                                                      that the V(Low) FET has failed.
  9924     99                FUNCTIONS LOCKED OUT - MACHINE NOT CONFIGURED
  9925     99        25      FUNCTIONS LOCKED OUT - CHASSIS MODULE SOFTWARE VERSION   The Chassis Module software ver-
                             IMPROPER                                                 sion is not compatible with the
                                                                                      rest of the system.
  9926     99        26      FUNCTIONS LOCKED OUT - BLAM MODULE SOFTWARE VERSION      The BLAM software version is not
                             IMPROPER                                                 compatible with the rest of the
                                                                                      system.
  9927     99        27      GROUND MODULE CONSTANT DATA UPDATE REQUIRED              The Ground Module constant data
                                                                                      requires an updated.
  99285     9        9       LSS - FACTORY CALIBRATION ERROR                          The load sensor is reporting a fac- Possible sensor hardware issue.
                                                                                      tor calibration issue (internal
                                                                                      error)
3121171                                                                                                                                             6-133
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
         Flash
  DTC            Sequence                         Fault Message                            Fault Description                            Check
         Code
  9932    99        32      LIFT CRACKPOINTS NOT CALIBRATED                          The Lift Valves have not been cali- - 1200S and 1350S only.
                                                                                     brated.
  9933    99        33      TELESCOPE CRACKPOINTS NOT CALIBRATED                     The Telescope Valves have not          - 1200S and 1350S only.
                                                                                     been calibrated.
  9934    99        34      DRIVE CRACKPOINTS NOT CALIBRATED                         The Drive Valves have not been         - 1200S and 1350S only.
                                                                                     calibrated.
  9935    99        35      BLAM SENSOR SUPPLY OUT OF RANGE HIGH                     The Boom Angle Sensors supply          - BLAM equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                     voltage is high.
  9936    99        36      BLAM SENSOR SUPPLY OUT OF RANGE LOW                      The Boom Angle Sensors supply          - BLAM equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                     voltage is low.
  9937    99        37      LENGTH SENSOR REF VOLTAGE HIGH                           The Boom Length Sensors supply
                                                                                     voltage is high.
  9938    99        38      LENGTH SENSOR REF VOLTAGE LOW                            The Boom Length Sensors supply
                                                                                     voltage is low.
  9939    99        39      BLAM HIGH RES A/D FAILURE                                The BLAM high resolution analog - BLAM equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                     to digital converter has failed.
  9940    99        40      CHASSIS SENSOR SUPPLY OUT OF RANGE HIGH                  The Chassis Sensors supply volt-
                                                                                     age is high.
  9941    99        41      CHASSIS SENSOR SUPPLY OUT OF RANGE LOW                   The Chassis Sensors supply volt-
                                                                                     age is low.
  9942    99        42      BLAM BACKUP COMMUNICATIONS LINK FAULTY                   The BLAM backup communica-             - BLAM equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                     tions link test was activated at       -1250
                                                                                     startup, but no communication
                                                                                     connection established/main-
                                                                                     tained.
  9943    99        43      BLAM BACKUP COMMUNICATIONS LOST - HYDRAULICS SUSPENDED   The BLAM backup communica-             - BLAM equipped vehicles only.
                                                                                     tions link was activated, but no       -1250
                                                                                     communication connection
                                                                                     established/maintained.
  9944    99        44      CURRENT FEEDBACK GAINS OUT OF RANGE                      The factory set current feedback
                                                                                     gains are out of range.
  9945    99        45      CURRENT FEEDBACK CALIBRATION CHECKSUM INCORRECT          The factory set current feedback
                                                                                     checksum is not correct.
  9975    99        75      LOAD PIN NOT CALIBRATED                                  The Load Pin has not been cali-        -1250
                                                                                     brated.
  9977    99                LSS CORRUPT EEPROM
  9979    99        79      FUNCTIONS LOCKED OUT - GROUND MODULE SOFTWARE VERSION    Temporary fault for the telematics
                            IMPROPER                                                 project. The model needs to be a
                                                                                     600S or 1350S if not this fault will
                                                                                     be generated and Platform con-
                                                                                     trols will be prevented. This fault
                                                                                     was to insure that the software
                                                                                     will only work for these two mod-
                                                                                     els.
6-134                                                                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                                               SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM:
PLATFORM SW (CL or OP) Displays the OPEN or CLOSED condition of the ground switch
GROUND SW (CL or OP) Displays the OPEN or CLOSED condition of the platform switch
MODE (GROUND or PLAT) Displays the current operation mode of the machine
ABOVE ELEV. (YES or NO) Displays the current condition of the ABOVE ELEVATION case
BR CABLE CUT (OP or CL) Displays the status of the BROKEN CABLE case
BCS (NORMAL or XXXX VIOL) Displays the status of the Boom Control System
MN ENV (NOMINAL or (STOP or VIOL)(TOP or BOT)) Displays the main boom envelope status
                           (HR or ER)(GRAV or PWR)(DOWN or DN)(SS or                 Displays the current retrieval mode and conditions
                           NP)(ML or TT)
LENGTH ZONE (A or B or C or d or ERR) Displays the status of the main boom length zone
ANGLE ZONE (1 or 2 or 3 or 4 or 5 or 6 or 7 or 8 or HI) Displays the status of the main boom angle zone
CRP MODE (NOT ACT or ACTIVE) Displays the current condition of creep mode
SUPER CREEP (OFF or ON) Displays the current condition of super creep mode
AUX POWER (CL or OP) Displays the status of auxiliary power switch
BASKET STOWED (YES or NO) Displays the status of the BASKET STOWED switch
SOFT LIMIT (CL or OP) Displays the OPEN or CLOSED condition of the soft touch limit switch
3121171                                                                                                                                                     6-135
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
GENSET/WELDER (CL or OP) Displays the OPEN or CLOSED condition of the GENSET/WELDER switch
LIGHTS (CL or OP) Displays the OPEN or CLOSED condition of the LIGHTS switch
AXLE RET SW (CL or OP) Displays the OPEN or CLOSED condition of the axle retract switches
AXLE EXT SW (CL or OP) Displays the OPEN or CLOSED condition of the axle extend switches
AXLE LIM SW (RET or EXT) Displays the condition of the AXLE LIMIT SWITCH case
DOS LIM SW (CL or OP) Displays the OPEN or CLOSED condition of the drive orientation switch
OSC AXLE P SW (CL or OP) Displays the condition of the axle pressure switch
SKY WELDER (YES or NO) Indicates if the accessory has been included in the boom sensor calibration
SKY CUTTER (YES or NO) Indicates if the accessory has been included in the boom sensor calibration
SKY GLAZIER (YES or NO) Indicates if the accessory has been included in the boom sensor calibration
SKY BRIGHT (YES or NO) Indicates if the accessory has been included in the boom sensor calibration
PIPE RACKS (YES or NO) Indicates if the accessory has been included in the boom sensor calibration
CAMERA MOUNT (YES or NO) Indicates if the accessory has been included in the boom sensor calibration
H OIL TEMP SW (CL or OP) Displays the status of the hot oil temperature switch
                              ML PILOT P SW (CL or OP)                                  Displays the status of the main lift pilot pressure switch
            TRANSPORT DATA:
LENGTH ZONE (A or B or C or d or ERR) Displays the status of the main boom length zone
ANGLE ZONE (1 or 2 or 3 or 4 or 5 or 6 or 7 or 8 or HI) Displays the status of the main boom angle zone
ABOVE ELEV. (YES or NO) Displays the current condition of the ABOVE ELEVATION case
TWR BOOM (OUT or IN) TRN Displays the tower status being within or outside of the transport case
TWR BOOM (ABV or BLW) ELE Displays the tower status being above or below of the elevated case
6-136                                                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                                           SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
MAIN TRN LENC (CL or OP) Displays the status of the normally open length switch
MAIN TRN LENO (CL or OP) Displays the status of the normally closed length switch
MAIN TRN LEN (A/D or B/C or DISAGREE) Displays the status of the combined length switches
DUAL CAP LENC (CL or OP) Displays the status of the normally open dual capacity switch
DUAL CAP LENO (CL or OP) Displays the status of the normally closed dual capacity switch
DUAL CAP LEN (A or A/B or B or B/C or C/D or D or FLT) Displays the status of the combined dual capacity switches
TWR TRN SW C (CL or OP) Displays the status of the normally open tower transport switch
TWR TRN SW O (CL or OP) Displays the status of the normally closed tower transport switch
TWR TRN SW (CL or OP or FLT) Displays the status of the combined tower transport switches
TWR TR ANG SW (CL or OP) Displays the status of the tower angle switch
MAIN TRN AGLC (CL or OP) Displays the status of the normally open main angle switch
MAIN TRN AGLO (CL or OP) Displays the status of the normally closed main angle switch
                       MAIN TRN AGL (CL or OP or FLT)                           Displays the status of the combined main angle switches
           LOAD PIN:
RATIO (XX.XXX) Displays the calculated value of the lift cylinder vector force ratio
V.F. (X) Displays the vector force applied to the moment pin
RAW MOMENT (XXXXXXX) Displays the raw data value of the moment pin
RAW RATIO (XX.XXX) Displays the raw value of the lift cylinder vector force ratio
RAW ANGLE (XX.X) Displays the raw angle of the vector force
RAW V.F. (X) Displays the raw data vector force applied to the moment pin
CAL PT ANGLE (XX.X) Displays the angle of the vector force applied to the moment pin during calibration
CAL PT VECTOR (X) Displays the vector force applied to the moment pin during calibration
CAL PT MOMENT (XXXXXXX) Displays the value of the moment pin recorded during calibration
X (XXX) Displays the calculated horizontal force applied to the moment pin
Y (XXX) Displays the calculated vertical force applied to the moment pin
RAW X (XXX) Displays the horizontal force applied to the moment pin
RAW Y (XXX) Displays the calculated vertical force applied to the moment pin
3121171                                                                                                                                                      6-137
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
TWR LEN1 (X.X)" Displays the measured value of tower length sensor #1
TWR LEN2 (X.X)" Displays the measured value of tower length sensor #2
TWR ANGL1 (XX.X) Displays the measured value of tower angle sensor #1
TWR ANGL2 (XX.X) Displays the measured value of tower angle sensor #2
CYL ANGL (XX.X) Displays the measured value of cylinder angle sensor #2
MN ANGL1 (XX.X) Displays the measured value of main angle sensor #1 to the tower
MN ANGL2 (XX.X) Displays the measured value of main angle sensor #2 to the tower
TO GRAV MN ANGL L (XXXX) Displays the measured value of lowest value main angle sensor to gravity
TO GRAV MN ANGL H (XXXX) Displays the measured value of largest value main angle sensor to gravity
A/D T LEN1 (X) Displays the analog to digital counts of tower length sensor #1
A/D T LEN2 (X) Displays the analog to digital counts of tower length sensor #2
A/D ANG1 (XX.X) Displays the analog to digital counts of tower angle sensor #1
A/D ANG2 (XX.X) Displays the analog to digital counts of tower angle sensor #2
A/D CYL (X) Displays the analog to digital counts of cylinder angle sensor
MN ANG A/D SNSR1 (XXXX) Displays the analog to digital counts of main angle sensor #1
MN ANG A/D SNSR2 (XXXX) Displays the analog to digital counts of main angle sensor #2
MN ANG RAW SNSR1 (X.X) Displays the raw value of main angle sensor #1
MN ANG RAW SNSR2 (X.X) Displays the raw value of main angle sensor #2
RET LEN 1 (X) displays the retracted length of the tower found by sensor #1 during calibration
                           RET LEN 2 (X)                              displays the retracted length of the tower found by sensor #2 during calibration
                           EXT LEN 1 (X)                              displays the extended length of the tower found by sensor #1 during calibration
EXT LEN 2 (X) displays the extended length of the tower found by sensor #2 during calibration
                           TRIP LEN (XXXX.X)                          Displays the length of the tower recorded at the transport trip point during calibra-
                                                                      tion
TA1 CAL L (X.X) Displays the lowest tower angle #1 value recorded during calibration
TA2 CAL L (X.X) Displays the lowest tower angle #2 value recorded during calibration
TA1 CAL H (X.X) Displays the highest tower angle #1 value recorded during calibration
TA2 CAL H (X.X) Displays the highest tower angle #2 value recorded during calibration
CYL CAL L (X) Displays the lowest cylinder angle value recorded during calibration
CYL CAL H (X) Displays the highest cylinder angle value recorded during calibration
6-138                                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                               SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
MA2 CAL L (X) Displays the lowest main angle #2 value recorded during calibration
MA1 CAL H (X) Displays the highest main angle #1 value recorded during calibration
MA2 CAL H (X) Displays the highest main angle #2 value recorded during calibration
                          TRIP ANG (X.X)                             Displays the length of the tower recorded at the transport trip point during calibra-
                                                                     tion
LOAD ZERO (X) Displays the value of the moment pin recorded during calibration
LOAD 500LB (X) Displays the value of the moment pin recorded during calibration
BASKET UP (X) Displays the value of the basket up crack point recorded during calibration
BASKET DOWN (X) Displays the value of the basket down crack point recorded during calibration
L FWD DRIVE (XXXX) Displays the value of the left forward drive crack point recorded during calibration
R FWD DRIVE (XXXX) Displays the value of the right forward drive crack point recorded during calibration
L REV DRIVE (XXXX) Displays the value of the left reverse drive crack point recorded during calibration
R REV DRIVE (XXXX) Displays the value of the right reverse drive crack point recorded during calibration
F LT STEER (XXXX) Displays the value of the front left steer crack point recorded during calibration
F RT STEER (XXXX) Displays the value of the front right steer crack point recorded during calibration
R LT STEER (XXXX) Displays the value of the rear left steer crack point recorded during calibration
R RT STEER (XXXX) Displays the value of the rear right steer crack point recorded during calibration
M LIFT UP (XXXX) Displays the value of the main lift up crack point recorded during calibration
M LIFT DOWN (XXXX) Displays the value of the main lift down crack point recorded during calibration
M TELE IN (XXXX) Displays the value of the main telescope in crack point recorded during calibration
M TELE OUT (XXXX) Displays the value of the main telescope out crack point recorded during calibration
BM ANG 1 LO (X) Displays the low value boom angle recorded from sensor 1 during calibration
BM ANG 1 HI (X) Displays the high value boom angle recorded from sensor 1 during calibration
BM ANG 2 LO (X) Displays the low value boom angle recorded from sensor 2 during calibration
BM ANG 2 HI (X) Displays the high value boom angle recorded from sensor 2 during calibration
LEN RETRACT (XXXX) Displays minimum tower length recorded during calibration
                          LEN WIT (XXXX)                             Displays the recorded value of tower length at the witness mark found during calibra-
                                                                     tion
                          LEN SWITCH (XXXX)                          Displays the recorded value of tower length at the transport switch found during cal-
                                                                     ibration
3121171                                                                                                                                               6-139
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-140                                                                                3121171
                                                          SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
A B
                                          PLATFORM MODULE
                                             CANbus Link
  C
              Figure 6-18. CANbus Connections - Sheet 1 of 4
3121171                                                                            6-141
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-142                                                                                                      3121171
                                                        SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                          6-143
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                  Chassis Module J1
                                     (Gray) Plug
        Chassis Module
         CANbus Link
6-144                                                                        3121171
          SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                               6-145
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                                6. Hit ESC to get back to the HELP screen and then use the
                                                                   arrow button to reach VERSIONS. Hit Enter.
6-146                                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
   7. If the CANbus link from the platform module is lost, you       8.   Hit the right arrow button once. The screen will read:
      will see the Ground Module SW version, Ground Module
      HW version, Ground Module SN, BM SW version, Chassis
      SW version, Platform Module SN, but you will not see the
      Platform Module SW version or the Platform Module HW
      version. The Analyzer screen will read:
3121171                                                                                                                     6-147
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-148                                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                          SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
3121171                                                                                                                       6-149
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
 CANBUS LINK FROM THE GROUND MODULE LOST                       4. The analyzer screen should read:
   1. Position the Platform/Ground select switch to the
      Ground position.
                                                               6. Hit ESC to get back to the HELP screen and then use the
                                                                  arrow button to reach VERSIONS. Hit Enter.
6-150                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
   7. If the CANbus link from the ground module is lost, you     8. Hit the right arrow button once. The screen will read:
      will see the Ground Module SW version, Ground Module
      HW version, Ground Module SN, BM SW version, Chassis
      SW version, Platform Module SN, but you will not see the
      Platform Module SW version or the Platform Module HW
      version. The Analyzer screen will read:
3121171                                                                                                               6-151
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
 CANBUS LINK FROM THE BOOM LENGTH & ANGLE                      4. The analyzer screen should read:
 MODULE (BLAM) LOST
   1. Position the Platform/Ground select switch to the
      Ground position.
                                                               6. Hit ESC to get back to the HELP screen and then use the
                                                                  arrow button to reach VERSIONS. Hit Enter.
6-152                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                       SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
   7. If the CANbus link from the Boom Length & Angle Mod-          TROUBLESHOOTING: BLAM CAN COMMUNICATIONS LOST
      ule is lost, you will see the Platform Module SW version,
      Platform Module HW Rev, Platform Module SN, Ground          NOTE: BLAM CAN COMMUNICATIONS LOST (6/6) (Help Fault Code
      Module SW version, Ground Module HW Revision,                     6-6) basically means all communication linked from the
      Ground Module SN, Chassis SW version, but you will not            Ground Module to the Boom Length &: Angle Module is
      see the Boom Length & Angle Module SW revision. The               lost. This also includes the lift cylinder load moment pin as
      Analyzer screen will read:                                        well.
3121171                                                                                                                      6-153
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-154                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                               SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
 CANBUS LINK FROM THE CHASSIS MODULE LOST                      4. The analyzer screen should read:
   1. Position the Platform/Ground select switch to the
      Ground position.
                                                               6. Hit ESC to get back to the HELP screen and then use the
                                                                  arrow button to reach VERSIONS. Hit Enter.
3121171                                                                                                           6-155
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
   7. If the CANbus link from the Chassis Module is lost, you    9. Hit the right arrow button once. The screen will read:
      will NOT see the Platform Module SW version, Platform
      Module HW rev, Platform Module SN, Chassis SW ver-
      sion, Boom Length & Angle Module SW version, but you
      WILL see the Ground Module SW version, Ground Mod-
      ule HW rev, and the Ground Module SN. The analyzer
      screen will read:
10. Hit the right arrow button once. The screen will read:
8. Hit the right arrow button once. The screen will read:
6-156                                                                                                                 3121171
                                                                                    SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
  11.   Hit the right arrow button once. The screen will read:     TROUBLESHOOTING: CHASSIS CAN COMMUNICATIONS
                                                                   LOST
3121171                                                                                                                6-157
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
6-158                                                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                            SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
Load Moment Pin Troubleshooting                                          refer to Section 4 for information concerning replacement of
                                                                         the Load Moment Pin.
 The following Troubleshooting Charts outline diagnostic mea-
 sures to be taken to diagnose problems within the Load
 Moment Pin portion of the JLG Control System. If necessary,
3121171                                                                                                                            6-159
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
Table 6-17. Load Moment Pin Troubleshooting: Moment Pin Horizontal Force Out of Range
6-160                                                                                                                           3121171
                                                                                               SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
Table 6-18. Load Moment Pin Troubleshooting: Moment Pin Vertical Force Out of Range
3121171                                                                                                                              6-161
 SECTION 6 - JLG CONTROL SYSTEM
NOTES:
6-162                             3121171
                                          SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
Grounding
 "Grounding the meter" means to take the black lead (which is
 connected to the COM (common) or negative port) and touch
 it to a good path to the negative side of the Voltage source.
Backprobing
 To "backprobe" means to take the measurement by accessing
 a connector’s contact on the same side as the wires, the back
 of the connector. Readings can be done while maintaining cir-
 cuit continuity this way. If the connector is the sealed type,
 great care must be taken to avoid damaging the seal around
 the wire. It is best to use probes or probe tips specifically
 designed for this technique, especially on sealed connectors.
 Whenever possible insert probes into the side of the connec-
 tor such that the test also checks both terminals of the con-
 nection. It is possible to inspect a connection within a closed
 connector by backprobing both sides of a connector terminal
 and measuring resistance. Do this after giving each wire a gen-
 tle pull to ensure the wires are still attached to the contact and              Figure 7-1. Voltage Measurement (DC)
 contacts are seated in the connector.
                                                                              • If meter is not auto ranging, set it to the correct range
Min/Max                                                                         (See multimeter’s operation manual)
 Use of the "Min/Max" recording feature of some meters can                    • Use firm contact with meter leads
 help when taking measurements of intermittent conditions
 while alone. For example, you can read the Voltage applied to
 a solenoid when it is only operational while a switch, far from
 the solenoid and meter, is held down.
Polarity
 Getting a negative Voltage or current reading when expecting
 a positive reading frequently means the leads are reversed.
 Check what reading is expected, the location of the signal and
 that the leads are connected to the device under test correctly.
 Also check that the lead on the "COM" port goes to the Ground
3121171                                                                                                                              7-1
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
7-2                                                                                                                    3121171
                                        SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                                                                          7-3
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
Installation
 The following is general guidance for the installation of
 dielectric grease in a connector system.
  • Use dielectric grease in a tube for larger connection
    points or apply with a syringe for small connectors.
  • Apply dielectric grease to plug/male connector hous-               Improper                     Proper
    ing which typically contains sockets contact/female
    terminals.
                                                               AMP Micro-Fit
  • Leave a layer of dielectric grease on the mating face of
    the connector, completely covering each connector           This connector system is typically used on control mod-
    terminal hole. Refer the pictures shown below.              ules at JLG. Follow the general guidance for installation.
  • Assemble the connector system immediately to pre-
    vent moisture ingress or dust contamination.
 The following connector systems are specifically
 addressed because of their widespread use at JLG. How-
 ever, this guidance may be applied to similar devices.
AMP Mate-N-Lok
 This connector system is widely used inside enclosures
 for general-purpose interconnect. Follow the general                  Improper                     Proper
 guidance for installation.
Improper Proper
Improper Proper
7-4                                                                                                              3121171
                                     SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
Improper Proper
DIN Connectors
 This connector is typically used on hydraulic valves. Fol-
 low the installation instructions
Improper Proper
Exceptions
 Some waterproof connector applications do benefit
 from dielectric grease, and some non waterproof con-
 nectors do not benefit from dielectric grease.
 In the exceptions below, we have found dielectric
 grease is not needed for some applications, and in some
 cases can interfere with the intended connection.
 Dielectric grease shall be used as an exception in other
 applications.
3121171                                                                                                            7-5
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
7.5       AMP CONNECTOR                                                Check to be sure the wedge lock is in the open, or as-shipped,
                                                                       position (See Figure 7-5.). Proceed as follows:
Applying Silicone Dielectric Compound to AMP
Connectors
 Silicone Dielectric Compound must be used on the AMP con-
 nections for the following reasons:
Assembly
7-6                                                                                                                           3121171
                                      SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
   3. After all required contacts have been inserted, the         4. Slide the wedge lock into the housing until it is flush
      wedge lock must be closed to its locked position.              with the housing (See Figure 7-9.).
      Release the locking latches by squeezing them inward
      (See Figure 7-8.).
3121171                                                                                                                 7-7
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
7-8                                                                                                                               3121171
          SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                                7-9
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
                                                                                    A                             B
               A                                 B
                                                                                                   C
               C                            D
           Figure 7-12. DT/DTP Contact Installation                              Figure 7-13. DT/DTP Contact Removal
NOTE: The receptacle is shown - use the same procedure for plug.
7-10                                                                                                                       3121171
                                           SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
A B A B
                               C                                                                     C
          Figure 7-14. HD/HDP Contact Installation                               Figure 7-16. HD/HDP Contact Removal
3121171                                                                                                                         7-11
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
                                                                  GATEWAY MODULE
 DIAGNOSTICS PLUG
                                                                                                Telematics-Ready (TCU) Plug
                                                                                                    The telematics-ready (TCU) plug is a standard 12-pin Deutsch
                                                                                                    connector. Pin-out locations are shown below:
                                                                                                                                                   12                  1 - BATTERY
                                                                                                                                                   11                  2 - GROUND
                                                                                                                                        CAN-HI 2 - 10                  3
                                                                                                                                        CAN-LO 2 - 9                   4 - IGNITION
                                                                                                                                                    8                  5
                                                                                                                                                    7                  6
TELEMATICS-READY PLUG
7-12                                                                                                                                                                        3121171
          SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                               7-13
7-14
          MS1619-3   MS1619-1
                     MS1619-2
          X1609
MS1620-1
                                S1614
                                                                      MS1618-2
                                    S1615
                                    MS1620-3
                                        MS1620-2
                                          MS1618-3
                                             CO1613-J2
                                                CO1613-J1
                                                                                                 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
X1606
3121171
                                                SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
1 RED 1-0 BAT 16 AWG GXL X1606 (B) A YEL CANH2 18 AWG GXL CO1613-J2 (10)
2 BLK 0-0 GND 16 AWG GXL S1615 (1) B GRN CANL2 18 AWG GXL CO1613-J2 (9)
CONN POS WIRE COLOR WIRE LABEL GAUGE JACKET TO 2 ORN 2-2 IGN 16 AWG GXL CO1613-J1 (12)
CONN POS WIRE COLOR WIRE LABEL GAUGE JACKET TO 2 BLK 0-1 GND 16 AWG GXL X1606 (A)
A YEL CANH2 18 AWG GXL MS1620-2 (A) 2 BLK 0-2 GND 16 AWG GXL CO1613-J1 (11)
                                                                                                            MS1618-2 (CAN-T 1)
                         CO1613-J1 (GATEWAY 1)
                                                                                    CONN POS   WIRE COLOR    WIRE LABEL       GAUGE       JACKET           TO
 CONN POS   WIRE COLOR       WIRE LABEL          GAUGE     JACKET        TO
                                                                                       A          YEL          CANH1          18 AWG        GXL      CO1613-J1 (10)
    9          GRN              CAN1             18 AWG     GXL      MS1618-2 (B)
                                                                                       B          GRN          CANL1          18 AWG        GXL       CO1613-J1 (9)
    10         YEL             CANH1             18 AWG     GXL      MS1618-2 (A)
3121171                                                                                                                                                         7-15
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
FROM TO
WIRE NO. COLOR WIRE GAUGE LENGTH (mm) JACKET REFERENCE PIN REFERENCE PIN
7-16                                                                                                       3121171
          SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
3121171                                                               7-17
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
7-18                                                                                3121171
            SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
0274670 E
3121171                                                                   7-19
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
TO BOOM
HYDRAULIC PUMPS
                                                                                THROTTLE
                                                                                ACTUATOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     4 PLS
                                                                                                                                                                                                                 1
                                                                                                                                                                                       DRIVE LEFT
                                                                                                                             DRIVE RIGHT                                               SIDE FORWARD
                                                                                                                             SIDE FORWARD
                                                                                                                                                                               IN HEAD TYPE
                                                                                                                                                                               GLOW PLUGS
                                                                                                                   STARTER
                                                                                                                                                                                                             GLOW PLUG
                                                                                                                                                                                                             RELAY
                                                 DEUTZ EMR2      110V / 220V GENERATOR                                              START RELAY
                                                 MODULE                                                                                                              INTAKE TYPE
                                                                                                                                                                     HEATERS
                                                                                VALVE HARNESS
                                                                           REF MAIN TERMINAL
                                                                                 BOX ASSEMBLY
HEADLIGHT
                                                                                                                                                                            THERMOSTAT
                                                                                                                                                 MAIN LIFT                      SWITCH
                                                                                                                                                 ENABLE
                                                                B.L.A.M.
                                                                MODULE
J2 J5
                                                                                    J4                                                                       14 PLS
                                                                               J1        J3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                MAIN
                                          DIAGNOSTIC                                                                                                                                                            CONTROL
                                          CONNECTION                                                                                                                                                            VALVE
                          GROUND
                          CONTROL                                                                                                                                                                      TOWER TELE PILOT
                          BOX                                                                                                                                                                          TOWER LIFT PILOT
                                                                                                                                     MAIN LIFT                                                      MAIN DUMP
2 PLS
                                                                                                                                                      SWING RIGHT
                                                                                                                                                                                         MAIN TELE PROP.
                                                                                                                                                      SWING LEFT
STROBE
                                                                                              ALARM                            CHASSIS
                                                                                                                               POWER
                                                                                                                               RELAY
                                                                            HORN                                                                                                          MAIN
                                                                                                                                                   PVG ENABLE                             TELE IN
                                                                                                                                AUX PUMP
                      HEADLIGHT                                                                                                                                                        MAIN TELE OUT
                                                                                               HEAD    AUX POWER
                                                                                               AND     RELAY
                                                                                               TAIL
                                                                                               LIGHT
                                                                                               RELAY
                                         FUEL LEVEL
                                         SENSOR
7-20                                                                                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                                      SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
                                                                                                                                                                         LEFT TOWER
                                                                                                                                                                         ANGLE
                                                                                                                                                                         SENSOR #2
                                                                                                                           TOWER LIFT
                                                                              4 PLS                                        CYLINDER
                                                                                                                           LOAD PIN
                                                 DRIVE LEFT
                                                 SIDE FORWARD
 DRIVE RIGHT
 SIDE FORWARD
                                         IN HEAD TYPE
                                         GLOW PLUGS                                                                                      BOTTOM TOWER LENGTH SENSOR #2
                                                                       GLOW PLUG
                                                                       RELAY
START RELAY
                               INTAKE TYPE                                                                                                                                   RIGHT TOWER
                               HEATERS                                                                                                                                       ANGLE SENSOR #1
                                                                                                    TAIL LIGHT
SWIVEL
                                      THERMOSTAT
                                          SWITCH
SEE SHEET 4
14 PLS
                                                                                                  ENGINE HARNESS
                                                                                                  REF. MAIN TERMINAL BOX ASS'Y.
                SWING RIGHT
                                                   MAIN TELE PROP.
                SWING LEFT
= See Sheet 7
                                                    MAIN
             PVG ENABLE                             TELE IN
0274670 E
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                              7-21
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
7-22                                                                                3121171
            SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
0274670 E
3121171                                                                         7-23
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
0274670 E
7-24                                                                                        3121171
                             SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
SHEET 2: PLATFORM
SHEET 5: B.L.A.M.
SHEET 6: CHASSIS
                                                                                 1001119861-O
           SHEET 1                                                                 MAE37550O
3121171                                                                                         7-25
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
8 7 6 5 4
YEL/RED 2-12-1
                                                                                                                                                                                                       YEL/RED 2-12-2
                                                                                                                                                                                                       ORN/RED 49-80
                                                                                                                                                                                                       ORN/RED 49-63
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             2
           FOOTSWITCH/ENABLE                                                  2                                    YEL/RED 2-21                                                      7
                                               J2
                                                                              3                               BRN/WHT 47-13                                                         21
                                                                              6                                 BLACK                                                               18
                      OVERLOAD                 J4                                                                                                                                                                                             1
                                                                              3                                 ORN/RED 49-100                                                      11
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              4                                                                                                                                              PLATFORM SCH.
             226KG/500# CAPACITY                                              4                                   RED/YEL 54-2                                                      12
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              2
                                    TILT                                      5                                      ORN/RED 49-3                                                    6                                                                                                                                                LIFT
                            GLOW PLUG                                         6                                      WHT/YEL 48-6                                                   17                                                                                                                                               5K                                                           = 19 POSITION DEUTSCH CONNECTOR IN PLATFORM BOX
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              7                                                                                                                                                   = 21 POSITION DEUTSCH CONNECTOR IN PLATFORM BOX
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  = TERMINAL STRIP IN PLATFORM BOX
                                                                                                                                                     YEL/RED 2-16-2        8
       A
                                                                                            SEE SHEET 10
                                                                                            ZONE H8, F8
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                SHEET 2
                                                    8                                                                                         7                                                                                                   6                                                                                              5                                                                                           4
7-26                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   3121171
                                                                                                                                           SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
5 4 3 2 1
8 HOLE PLUG 8
             1               RED                 1                        RED
             2              BLUE                 2              WHITE                                          MOUNTED ON RIGHT
             3              BLACK                3              BLACK                                          SIDE OF BOOM
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              SEE
                      BRAIDED SHIELD                          BLK (18)                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SHEET 3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 BLU/ORN 52-11                  15                YEL/BLK (18)       15                                                                                      G
                                                                                                       BASKET LEVEL SENSOR #2
                                                 1                                                                                                                                                             PLATFORM
                  4        ORANGE                                       RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                               EMS                        YEL/RED
                  5       YELLOW                 2               WHITE                                          MOUNTED ON LEFT                                                                                                                               13                  ORN/BLK (18)       13
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          2-5
                  6                              3        BLACK                                                 SIDE OF BOOM
                           BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       YEL/RED
                      BRAIDED SHIELD                      BLK (18)                                                                                                                                                                                             10                 ORANGE (12)        10
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       2-2(12)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         RED (18)                      1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         RED (18)                      2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      11
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             BLACK                    12
                                                      RED/WHT 50-2-1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          BLACK (18)                   3
       RED/WHT 50-2-3                  5                                  RED/WHT 50-2-3                                                                     PLATFORM DUMP
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          BLACK (18)                   4              MS509
    PINK 25-3-3                        7                                                                                       PINK 25-3-3                  UP
                                                                                                                                                                  LEVEL                                                                                                                                                                                               CANBUS
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       9
    PINK 26-3-3                        6                                                                                       PINK 26-3-3                  DOWN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             GRAY                                                            F
                                                                                                                                                                                       YEL/RED 2-3(16)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      10
                                       8                                                                                        GRAY 23-3                   LEFT                                                                                                                                                         SHIELD (18)                   5
                                                                                                                                                                    ROTATE
                                       9                                                                                        GRAY 24-3                   RIGHT                                                                                                                                                        SHIELD (18)                   6
                                       10                                                                                       BLUE 27-3                   UP                                                                                                                                                                                         7
                                                                                                                                                                    JIB
                                    11                                                                                          BLUE 28-3                   DOWN                                                                                                                                                                                       8
                                    19                                                                                         WHITE 60-3                   RIGHT
                                                                                                                                                                  JIB SWING                                                                     X1001
                                       20                                                                                      WHITE 59-3                   LEFT                                                                                                                                                                    GRAY               5
                                       12                                                                                 BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    BLACK              4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     X1002
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               ZONE E8              BLUE               3       CO99
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    WHITE                      LSS
                                                                                                                                                              RED (18)                                                                    A                     3              RED (18)              3         ZONE H7                                 2
                                                                                                                                                               BLACK (18)                                                                 B                     2             BLACK (18)             2                                                 1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          C                     1                   SHIELD           1
                                                                                                                                                                              output                             YEL/RED 2-3-1                                   4            ORANGE (18)            4
                                                                                                                                                                                                         YEL/RED 2-30-1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             E
                                                                                                                      7                         BLACK                          FOOTSWITCH
                                                                                                         YEL/RED 2-16-2                8       WHITE                                                                GREEN                                        6            YELLOW (18)            6
TO CHASSIS
   SHEET 2                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                1001119861-O
                                            5                                                                                          4                                                                                             3                                                                    2                                                           1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     MAE36290O
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          7-27
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
8 7 6 5 4
                     11            BLU/BLK    11                                                  BLU/BLK
           SEE       12            RED (12)   12                                                RED (12)
           SHEET 2
                     13        ORN/BLK (18)   13                                                           ORN/BLK (18)
                     14         HOLE PLUG     14
                      15        YEL/BLK(18)   15                                                       YEL/BLK(18)
SHIELD
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          SHIELD
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                   RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      RED
                                                                                                                                                              4    BLACK (CAN H)
                                                                                                                                                              5    GRAY (CAN L)
                                                                                                                                   #1 RIGHT SIDE MAIN
                                                                                                                                   BOOM ANGLE SENSOR          1    BROWN (SHIELD)
                                                                                                                                                              2    WHITE (POWER)
                                                                                                                                                              3    BLUE (GROUND)
                                                                                                                                                              4    BLACK (CAN H)
                                                                                                                                                              5    GRAY (CAN L)
                                                                                                                                  #2 LEFT SIDE MAIN           1    BROWN (SHIELD)
                                                                                                                                  BOOM ANGLE SENSOR
       E                                                                                                                                                      2    WHITE (POWER)
                                                                                                                                                              3    BLUE (GROUND)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ORN/RED 49-123                                N
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         YEL/RED 2-70-5                               B
                                                                                                                                                                                             14                    13
                                                                                                                                                                       MAIN BOOM TRANSPORT
       C                                                                                                                                                               ANGLE LIMIT SWITCH
                                                                                                                                                                                                              21
                                                                                                                                                                                             22
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ORN/RED 49-122                                R
                                                                                               WHICHEVER IS PRESENT
                                                                                        (EARLY MACHINES HAD LIMIT SWITCH)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SHEET 3
                           8                        7                       6                                                                  5                                                                              4
7-28                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  3121171
                                                                                                         SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
5 4 3 2 1
                                                                                                                                                                                                        4                 ORANGE (18)                                                         4
                                                                                                                                                                                                        5                      BLUE (18)                                                      5
                                                                                                                                                                                                           6              YELLOW (18)                                                         6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       H
                                                                                                                                                                                                            7              BROWN (18)                                                          7
                                                                                                                                                                                                           8    HOLE PLUG                                                                      8
                                                                                                                                                                                                           9            RED/BLK (18)                                                           9
                                                                                                                                                                                                       10                      ORANGE (12)                                                    10
                                                                                                                                                                                                       11         BLU/BLK                                                                     11
                                                                                                                                                                                                       12         RED (12)                                                                    12
                                                                                                                                                                                                       13                   ORN/BLK(18)                                                       13
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      STROBE LIGHT
                                                                                                                                                                                                       14        HOLE PLUG                                                                    14
                                                                                                                                                                                                       16             BLACK (12)                                                              16                            2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       G
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      HOLE PLUG                                                               17
                                                                                                                                                                                                       18        BLK/WHT (12)                                                                 18
HOLE PLUG 19
                                                                                                                                                                                                           3            RED (18)                                                              3
                                                                                                                                                                                                           2          BLACK (18)                                                               2
                                                                                                                                                                                                           1             SHIELD                                                                1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       F
                                                                                                      BLACK
                                                                                                                  SHIELD
                                                                                                                                      BLACK
                                                                                           RED
RED
SHIELD
                                            4  BLACK (CAN H)
                                            5   GRAY (CAN L)
                 #1 RIGHT SIDE MAIN                                                                                                                         BLACK (14)                                     E           BLACK (12)                                                                 E
                 BOOM ANGLE SENSOR          1 BROWN (SHIELD)
                                            2 WHITE (POWER)                                                                                                 WHT/RED 57-11                                  J             RED/BLK                                                              J
                                            3 BLUE (GROUND)
                                            4 BLACK (CAN H)
                                            5   GRAY (CAN L)
                #2 LEFT SIDE MAIN           1 BROWN (SHIELD)
                BOOM ANGLE SENSOR
                                            2  WHITE (POWER)                                                                                               WHT/RED 57-10                                K                YELLOW                                                                   K                                    E
                                            3 BLUE (GROUND)
                                                                                                                                                                         BLK/WHT (12)                   G         BLK/WHT (12)                                                                 G
HOLE PLUG H
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      HOLE PLUG                                                                W
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      HOLE PLUG                                                                X
                                                                                                                                                                           RED (12)                        D     RED (12)                                                                     D
                                                            BLK                                                                                                                                            C    RED                                                                           C
                                                                                                                                                                               RED
                                  21            22                                                            B            BLU/BLK 49-130                                                                                                                                                      L
                                                     WHT                               BLU/BLK                                                                                                             L     BLU/BLK
                                                                   RED                     RED                A               YEL/RED 2-70-7
                                                      BLK                                  ORN                C                     ORN 49-131                                                          M                ORANGE (18)                                                           M
                                  22            21                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     D
                                                            WHT                                                                                                                                                          BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                      BLACK             F                                                                                         F
                                                            BLK
                                  21            22                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                S
                                                     WHT                                   BLU                    B            BLU 49-120                                                              S          BLUE
                                                                   RED                     RED                    A           YEL/RED 2-70-8
                                                      BLK                                  BRN                    C                 BRN 49-121                                                         U          BROWN                                                                           U
                                  22            21
                                                             WHT                                                                                                                  ORN (12) 2-70-5       B                      ORANGE (12)                                                     B
A SHIELD A
                                                                                                                                                                                                       N                       ORN/BLK(18)                                                     N
                                                                                                     ORN/RED 49-123                           N
                                                                                                      YEL/RED 2-70-5                          B
                                                                          14               13
                                                                                                                                                                                                       R                    YEL/BLK(18)                                                        R
                                                                                      21
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       C
                                                                          22
                                                                                                     ORN/RED 49-122                           R                                                        T          HOLE PLUG                                                                   T
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       B
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     TOWER & MAIN BOOM SCH.
    SHEET 3                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1001119861-O
                              5                                                                      4                                                                                  3                                                                        2                                     1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                MAE36300O
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    7-29
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
                                                    8                                                                                7                                                                                   6                                                                                                  5                                                                                                                                                            4
                                               18
                                                                                             TO BATTERY NEG.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        KEYSWITCH
               13                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                YEL/RED 2-5                                  2 B1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     YEL/RED 2-4 (12)
                B                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      YEL/RED 2-70-5 (14)                                                                                                                                                                                    4
               10                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         YEL/RED 2-2 (12)                                                                    1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               3 B2                    YEL/RED 2-1 (12)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               YEL/RED 2-30
       H
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     BLACK
                                                                     GROUND CONTROL BOX
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      YEL/RED 2-1-1(12)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             YEL/RED 2-30-4
               4                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              YEL/RED 2-3-1
               9
               7                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         POWER DOWN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         RELAY
               5
                                                                                                             RIGHT                       GRAY 23-2                                                                                                                                                         TO BLAM                7
                                                                                                ROTATE
                                                                                                              LEFT                       GRAY 24-2                                                                                                                                                         TO BLAM                8                                                                                                          87        87a
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             ORN/RED 49-102                                                TO BLAM                9                                                                                                      86 85
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  30                            YEL/RED 2-1-3 (12)
                                                                                                                                                          24                                                                                            HORN GND
                                                                                                                                                                                                           17
                                                                                                                  IN                  BROWN 13-2            7
                                                                                               MAIN TELE                                                                                                     2       BLU/ORN 52-2                       HORN OUTPUT
                                                                                                                 OUT                  BROWN 14-2           30
                                                                                                                                                                                                            20
                   M                                                         ORN/RED 49-131                                                                 6                                               22
                   L                                                         ORN/RED 49-130                                                               18                                                         RED/WHT 50-2-1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     4000 W GENERATOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                             3
                                                                                                               UP                        PINK 25-2         17
       G                                                                                           LEVEL
                                                                                                             DOWN
                                                                                                                                                                                                             7       PINK 26-3-1
                                                                                                                                         PINK 26-2          5                                                5       PINK 25-3-1
                                                                                                   START SWITCH                      WHT/YEL 48-1           4
                                                                                                     AUX POWER                                                                                              14
                                                                                                                                     BRN/ORN 53-2         16
                                                                                                       JIB     UP                        BLUE 27-2         19
                                                                                                             DOWN                                                                                          27        BLU/ORN 52-10
                                                                                                                                         BLUE 28-2          8                                                                                                                                                                                                ALARM
                                                                                               MAIN LIFT       UP                          TAN 3-2         23                                                                                                                         HEAD/TAIL LIGHT
                                                                                                             DOWN                          TAN 4-2                    J4                                                                                                  87
                                                                                                                                                          33          (BLUE)                                                                                                           87a
                                                                                                  SWING        RIGHT                    WHITE 22-2        35                                                26        BLU/ORN 52-12                                 86 85
                                                                                                                LEFT                    WHITE 21-2        34                                                18                                                                 30
                                                                                                               RIGHT                    WHITE 60-2        20                                                24                                                                          RED 1-1 (12)                                                                                                                                                                            SEE SHEET 5, ZONE B3
                                                                                               JIB SWING                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SEE SHEET 6, ZONE B6
                                                                                                                LEFT                                                                                        28
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 BLACK
                                                                                                                                        WHITE 59-2         9
                                                                                                               UP                          TAN 5-2        10                                                25   BRN/WHT 47-12                              FUEL SENSOR (SIGNAL)
                                                                                              TOWER LIFT
                                                                                                             DOWN                          TAN 6-2        21                                                 6        BLACK                                 SENSOR (GROUND)
                                                                                                  YEL/RED                           2-40-1                25                                                13       RED/WHT 50-1                            MAIN DUMP
                                                                                                                                                                                                            31      RED/WHT 50-2                             PVG ENABLE
                                                                                                                                                          32                                                                                                 TELE. FLOW CONTROL
       F                                                                                             HOURMETER                                                                                               9       BROWN 55-60
                                                                                                                              BRN/WHT 47-11-1             12                                                 4        BROWN 13-3                            IN
                                  BLACK (10)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  MAIN TELE.
                                                                                 ENGINE LOW OIL PRESSURE                                                                                                   16         BROWN 14-3                            OUT
                                                                                                                              BRN/WHT 47-5-1              29
                                                                                                                                                                                              J2 (GRAY)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          BLACK
                                                                                ENGINE HIGH TEMPERATURE                       BRN/WHT 47-6-1              28                                                33          TAN 55-31                           TOWER LIFT ENABLE
                                                                                                 NO CHARGE                                                                                                                                                  MAIN LIFT PILOT
                                                                                                                              BRN/WHT 47-8-3              26                                                 1          TAN 55-22
                                                                                                GLOW PLUGS                                                                                                 12           TAN 55-32                           TOWER LIFT PILOT
                                                                                                                                WHT/YEL 48-6              15
                                                                                                                                                                                                           32        BROWN 55-10                            TOWER TELE. PILOT
                                                                                   MOMENT CONTROL TEST                        ORN/RED 49-103              13                                               35          WHITE 22-3                           RIGHT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      SWING
                                                                                                   AXLES SET                  WHT/YEL 39-1-1               1                                               34          WHITE 21-3                            LEFT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             SEE
                                                                                     PLATFORM OVERLOAD                        ORN/RED 49-100              14                                               19                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          SHEET 7, ZONE C8
                                                                                               500# CAP                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                SHEET 8, ZONE D4
                                                                                                                              RED/YEL 54-2-1              2                                                21                                  WHT/RED 57-11                                                   K
                                                                                                   1000# CAP
                                                                                                                              RED/YEL 54-3-1              27                                               10                                              WHT/RED 57-10                               J
                                                                                                                                                                                                           11    TAN 55-50                       TO BLAM MAIN LIFT POWER
                                                                                   BOOM SYSTEM CONTROL                        ORN/RED 49-101               3
                                                                                                                                                                                                            8    BROWN 55-50                          TO BLAM TOWER TELE. POWER
       E                                                                                                                              BLACK               31
                                                                                                                                                                                                            15                                                   ORN/RED 49-301
                  N                                                                                  ORN/RED 49-123                                       11                                               30                        BLACK
                  R                                                                                    ORN/RED 49-122                                     22                                               29                         BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                     J8
                                                                                                                           GND FROM BATTERY                          (BLACK)
                                                                                                                                                           1
                                                                                                                             MTB EMS input                 2
                                                                                          BLACK (12)                        GND TO PLATFORM                3                                               11                             WHT/YEL 48-3
              16
                                                                                                                         MTB EMS TO PLATFORM                                                               12                             WHT/YEL 48-9
               12                                                                            YEL/RED 2-1-2(12)                                             4
                                                                                                                                                                                                            8                               BLACK (16)
                                                                                                                                                                                                            5
                                                                                                         YEL/RED 2-3-2                                     1                                                                                     TOWER LIFT POWER
                                                                                                                                                                                                            3       TAN 55-51
                                                                                                     YEL/RED 2-2-1                                         2                                               19
                                                                                                                                                           20
                                                                                                                                                                                                           10                         YEL/RED 2-1-88
                                                                                                                               FOOTSWITCH                  15                                               9
                6                                                                    YEL/RED 2-21
       D                                                                                                                   MTB MODE SELECT
                                                                                     YEL/RED 2-30                                                          3                                               30
                                                                                                                                                                                                           29
                                                                                                                           MTB MODE OUTPUT
               11                                                                        YEL/RED 2-30-1                                                    14
                                                                                                                                                                                                            28
                                                                                                       YEL/RED 2-40-11                                     23                                              20     ORANGE 55-47                    6
                                                                                                                                                           26                                                     ORANGE 55-45                          7
                                                                                                                                                                                                           23
                                                                                                                                          RED               9                                              31
                                               RED                                                                                                        16
           ANALOG             PWR-A                                                                                                                       10
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             YEL/RED 2-70 (14)
                                                                                                                                                                                                           35                BRN/WHT 48-1
                                                                                                                                                          19                                                                                                     HYD OIL TEMP.
                                                                                                                 BLACK                                                                                     25                                                    SENDOR
       C                                                                                                                         YEL/RED 2-61             32                                               14
              ]1]                                                                                                                YEL/RED 2-60             29                                               15
              ]3]                                                                                                                                          33
                                                                                                                                                                                                           22            BLU/ORN 52-5
              ]2]                                                                                                                  ORN/RED 49-64           11
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          YEL/RED 2-20
                                                                                                                                                                                                           16
              ]6]                                                                                                                ORN/RED 49-65            35
                                                                                                                                                                                                            7            WHT/YEL 48-15
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    YEL/RED 2-1-99
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              YEL/RED 2-70-2 (14)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       YEL/RED 2-70-3 (14)
              ]5]                                                                                                                                         25
                                                                 CRIBBING OPTION
                                                                                         {    SEE SHEET 11, ZONE G2
                                                                                              SEE SHEET 11, ZONE G2
                                                                                                                                                RED 118
                                                                                                                                                           7
                                                                                                                                                          30
                                                                                                                                                                                                           21
                                                                                                                                                                                                           26
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          TAN 55-23                            MAIN LIFT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               PILOT PRESSURE
                                                                                                                                                                                                            27               ORN 100-1                                                                                                                                                                   SEE
                       3   RED(18)                      A                A      RED                      A                  A            RED              13                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             SHEET 7, ZONE B3
                                                                                                                                                                                                           17
                       2   BLACK                        B                B                               B                  B        BLACK                24                                               34                                                                                                                                                                                            SHEET 8, ZONE B4
                                                                                BLACK
                       1   SHIELD                       C                C      SHIELD                   C                  C        SHIELD               18
                                                                                                                                                                                                           32     BRN/WHT 47-8-1                                            BLACK (14)
                                                                                                                                                           5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  BROWN                                                     BLACK (16)                             6
                                                             C B A                                                C B A                                    8                                               33
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            BLACK (16)                             5                                                                          SEE
                                                                                                                                                BLK 117   28                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  SHEET 7, ZONE C7
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            BLACK (14)                     J8-3                           2                     1                             SHEET 8, ZONE D3
                                                                                                                                   ORN/RED 49-121         21
       B                   CE MARKET ONLY
                                                                                                                                 ORN/RED 49-120           12
                                MDI
                                                                                                                                                                                                           13          BRN/ORN 53-3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      }
                                                                                                                                                          1                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      ORN 100-1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    SHIELD
                                                                                                                                                          2                                                                                                                             BLACK (CAN LO)                                                                       SEE SHEET 7, ZONE C7
                                                                 3                                     BLACK                        BROWN 103-1           3                                                                                                                                                                                                                  SEE SHEET 8, ZONE D3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        RED (CAN HI)
                                                                 4                                       RED                                              4
                                                                 5                                                                                        5                                                 1                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               CE MARKET ONLY
                                                                                             RED
                                                                 6                                                                                        6
                                                                                         SHEILD
                                                                                         BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                            2                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    MSSO
                                                                 1                                                                                        7                                                 3      RED (CAN HI)                                                                                                                              ORN 101-1
                                                                 2                                                                                        8                                                 4      BLACK (CAN LO)
                                                                                                                                BRN/WHT 47-8-2            9                                                 5      SHIELD                                                                                                                                    ORN 100-2
                                                                                                                                                                                                J12
                                                                                                                                                                      J3 (BLACK)
                                                                                                                                                          10                                                6
                                                                                                                                                          11                                                7                                                                                                                   BLACK                                                          A
                                                            BLUE 102-1                                                                                    12                                                8                        12                                                                                                                                                        B
                                                                                                                                                                                   V REF                                                                                                                                       RED 1-3
                                                                                                                                                          13                                                                          1                                                                                           RED                                                          C
                                                                                                                                                          14                          V BAT                                          11                                                                                         BLACK                                                          D           ADVANCED
              SEE SHEET 7, ZONE C7                                                                                                                                                                                                    4                                                                                        SHIELD                                                          E           DIAGNOSTIC
                                                                 BRN/WHT 47-8                                                                                                                                                         8                                                                                      PLUGGED                                                           F           CONNECTOR
       A      SEE SHEET 8, ZONE C3
               U                                                                                                                                                                                                                      9                                                                                      PLUGGED                                                           G
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      2                                                                                  YEL/RED 2-1-4                                                         H
              S                                                                                                                                                 10                                                                    3                                                                                      PLUGGED                                                           J
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     10
                                                                                                                                                                 11                                                                                                                                    5 AMP
7-30                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                3121171
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
5 4 3 2 1
                                                                                                                                                                                                               KEYSWITCH
                                                                                                                                                     YEL/RED 2-5                                      2 B1                                            MTB                                                                                                                                                                     RED 1-2 (6)                                                                  1 GA
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     YEL/RED 2-4 (12)                 EMS                      30 AMP
   YEL/RED 2-70-5 (14)                                                                                                                                                                                4
                                                                                                         YEL/RED 2-2 (12)                                                                             1
                                                                                                                                                                                                       3 B2            YEL/RED 2-1 (12)
                                                                                              YEL/RED 2-30
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    5 AMP
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            H
                                                                                                                                                                                     YEL/RED 2-30-4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  5 AMP
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         GENERATOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          CONTROL
                   YEL/RED 2-3-1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            RED 1-3                                                                                                                                                                                    7500 W                                                               BOX
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     GENERATOR                                                            B A C
                                                                                                            POWER DOWN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          RED 1-4                                                  1
                                                                                                            RELAY
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          BLACK                                                    2
                             TO BLAM                7
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          BLU/ORN 52-5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  YEL/RED 2-70-6                                                   3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         YEL/RED 2-20
                                                    8                                                                                                                87                                                                                              YEL/RED 2-2A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   4
                             TO BLAM                                                                                                                                           87a
                             TO BLAM                9                                                                                                            86 85
                                                                                                                                                                          30                          YEL/RED 2-1-3 (12)                                                  TELEMATICS
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         SEE SHEET 7, ZONE B3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               BLU/ORN 52-5
                                                                               ALARM                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     SEE SHEET 8, ZONE B6                                                YEL/RED 2-20
14 GA FUSE LINK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               14 GA FUSE LINK
                                                                                                                                                                                                        SEE SHEET 5, ZONE B3                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           POWERMITE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        2500 W                                                         GENERATOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                        SEE SHEET 6, ZONE B6
                                                                                                                                                         BLACK
GENERATOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                5              1                             8                         4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             13               14
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        9                                                  12
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       WHITE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    SEE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   GREEN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    WHITE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 GREEN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          RED
RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              SHEET 7, ZONE C8
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              SHEET 8, ZONE D4
                                 K
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                BATTERY +
   WHT/RED 57-10             J                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               SHEET 7, ZONE B6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             SHEET 8, ZONE E6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             SHEET 9, ZONE H2
    ORN/RED 49-301                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          E
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   GREEN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 GREEN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  BLACK
WHITE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       WHITE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        RED
RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           AUXILIARY  POWER
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1                                                                                                                                                                                                          PUMP MOTOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  4       8              3                          2                  7         5                     6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         M
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  WHITE           2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   GREEN          1             J1-13       BRN/ORN 53-3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   BLACK          3
RED (12)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            C
                                                                                                                  YEL/RED 2-20
                                                         YEL/RED 2-70-3 (14)
                                                                                YEL/RED 2-70-2 (14)
                                                                                                      YEL/RED 2-1-99
                                                                    }
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ORN 100-1                                                                                                                                                                   TO BLAM THRU ENGINE HARNESS
        SHIELD                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   TO SLIP RING CONNECTOR
          BLACK (CAN LO)                                                                       SEE SHEET 7, ZONE C7
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      TO BLAM 12 POS CONNECTOR (THRU VALVE HARNESS)                                                                              (SHEET 5 OF 8,
                                                                                               SEE SHEET 8, ZONE D3
          RED (CAN HI)                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           SECT. 8-D)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   CE MARKET ONLY
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        MSSO                                                                                                                                                          ALL WIRES ARE 18 GA. UNLESS NOTED OTHERWISE.                                                                                                            GROUND CONTROL SCH.
                                                                               ORN 101-1
                                                                               ORN 100-2
                                                  BLACK                                                             A
                                                 RED 1-3                                                            B
                                                    RED                                                             C
                                                  BLACK                                                             D              ADVANCED
                                                 SHIELD                                                             E              DIAGNOSTIC
                                               PLUGGED                                                              F              CONNECTOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            A
                                               PLUGGED                                                              G
                                           YEL/RED 2-1-4                                                            H
                                               PLUGGED                                                              J
                         5 AMP
                                         YEL/RED 2-1-4                                                                   J7-34, ZONE C7
   SHEET 4                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           1001119861-O
                                              5                                                                                                                                                                  4                                                                                                         3                                                                                                                              2                                                                              1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    MAE36310O
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         7-31
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
8 7 6 5 4
       G                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         J3       GREEN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             J5 BROWN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      5V REF.                                                                                                 9                                RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       ORN/RED                                   1                                                                                                            10                             GREEN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  2                                                                                                          11                              WHITE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      BRN/BLK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             12                         BLACK/SHIELD
                                                                                                                   A                                                                                          RED                                                 4                                                                                                                                                                                                      6
                                              TOWER BOOM LIFT CYL. ANGLE SENSOR                                    B                                                                                          BLUE                                                5                                                                                                          4                                                ORN/RED 49-200                             5
                                                                                                                   C                                                                                          BLACK                                               6                                                                                                          1                                                                          ORANGE 8-3       2
                                                                                                                   A                                                                                          RED                                                 7                                                                                                                                                                                     ORANGE 8-2       1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             2
                                               TOWER BOOM LENGTH SENSOR #1 TOP                                     C                                                                                          BLUE                                                8
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          4                                  5
                                                                                                                   B                                                                                          BLACK                                               9                                                                                                                                                                                                      3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 10                                                                                                          6                                                                                           4
                                                                                                                   A                                                                                          ORANGE                                                                                                                                                V BAT.   7
                                           TOWER BOOM LENGTH SENSOR #2 BOTTOM                                      C                                                                                          YELLOW                                             11
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             8
                                                                                                                   B                                                                                          BLACK                                              12
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              10
       F                                                                                                 BRN/BLK                                                                                                                                                              1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        J1
                                                                                           DEUTSCH 12 POS. CONNECTOR 10                      RED                                                                     CAN HI                                                   6
                                                                                                                                                                                  ORANGE 55-45
                                                                                                                                                                                  ORANGE 55-47
                                                                                                                                                                     BLACK (14)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           SHIELD
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                           RED
                                                                                                                                            8 4                       5           6 7                    3   2 1                                                                                                                                      SHIELD                 C                SHIELD
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      BLACK                  B                BLACK
                                                                                                                                              SLIP RING CONNECTOR TO CHASSIS                                                                                                                                                                          RED                    A                RED
       C
                                                                   DEUTSCH 12 POS. CONNECTOR 5                                    BLACK 5 (16)
                                                                   DEUTSCH 12 POS. CONNECTOR 8                                     GRAY 23-2                                                                                               ROTATE LEFT
                                                                   DEUTSCH 12 POS. CONNECTOR 7                                                                               GRAY 24-2                                   ROTATE RIGHT
                                                                                              9                                  ORN/RED 49-102                                                                                                          (LOAD PIN PUSH TO TEST NOT USED AT THIS TIME)
A TO CHASSIS
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SHEET 5
                                       8                                                                                           7                                                                                                             6                                                                                                              5                                                                         4
7-32                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             3121171
                                                                                                                                            SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
5 4 3 2 1
                                                                                                                   BLACK/SHIELD
                                                                                                                  WHITE
                                                                                                                  GREEN
                                                                                                                  RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      G
                                                                          J5 BROWN
                                                                            9                                RED                                                                               ANALYZER POWER                  1
                                                                           10                              GREEN                                                                               ANALYZER RECEIVE                2
                                                                          11                               WHITE                                                                               ANALYZER TRANSMIT               3
                                                   BRN/BLK
                                                                              J2 BLACK
   V-BAT +
                                                                                   12                                             ORANGE 7-2
                                   9           2                                   11                         ORANGE 7-3
                                                                                   1                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  E
                                                                                                     YEL/RED 2-82            1             ORANGE                 1        RED                  #2 LEFT SIDE TOWER BOOM
                                                                                   9                 ORN/RED 49-112          2             YELLOW                 2       WHITE                 ANGLE SENSOR
                                                                                                    BLACK                    3              BLACK                 3       BLACK                 SERIAL OUTPUT
                                                                                                    BRN/BLK                  4             BRN/BLK                4
                                                                                    2
                                                                                                 YEL/RED 2-81               1                RED                  1        RED                  #1 RIGHT SIDE TOWER BOOM
                                                                                   8             ORN/RED 49-111             2                BLUE                 2       WHITE                 ANGLE SENSOR
                                                                                                BLACK                       3               BLACK                                               SERIAL OUTPUT
                                                                                                                                                                  3       BLACK
                                                                                   3
                                                                                                        BRN/BLK             4              BRN/BLK
                                                                                   4                                       ORN/RED 49-102
   4     2                         1   8 3 7                                       5                                       GRAY 24-2
                                                                                   6                                       GRAY 23-2
J4 GRAY
                                                                                   1          WHITE                                1                                                                                                                                                                                  D
                                                                                   2          GREEN                                2
                                                                                   3          RED                                  3                                                  CAN HI                                                                                              RED
                                                                                   4          BLACK                                4                                                 CAN LO                                                                                               BLACK
                                                                                   5          BRN/BLK                              5                                              CAN SHIELD                                                                                              SHIELD
1 2 3 4 5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                   1 2 3 4                 1 2 3 4      1 2 3 4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            LIFT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     TOWER                      TOWER   MAIN LIFT           CYL. PIN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     LIFT                       TELE.
                                                   SHIELD                 C                SHIELD
                                                   BLACK                  B                BLACK
                                                   RED                    A                RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      C
                                                                                                                                                                                    BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                    TAN 55-51
                                                                                                                                                                                    BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                    BROWN 55-50
                                                                                                                                                                                    BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                    TAN 55-50
BLAM SCH.
       SHEET 5                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         1001119861-O
                                                             5                                                                         4                                                                       3                                                    2                              1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            MAE36320O
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   7-33
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
8 7 6 5 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             ORANGE (16)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           YELLOW (16)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              BLACK 14GA
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              RED 14GA
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    SHIELD
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              VIOLET
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            RED
10
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 11
                                                                                                                                                                                                                             1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 9
                           1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                YEL/RED
                           2                                   LEFT FRONT AXLE                                    RIGHT FRONT AXLE
SHIELD
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               BLK 14GA
                                                           EXTEND LIMIT SWITCH                                 EXTEND LIMIT SWITCH
BLACK
YEL/RED 14GA
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             ORANGE 55-47
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 OSC. AXLE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               ORANGE 60-2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               ORANGE 55-45
                                                                   BLACK                           WHITE           BLACK                            WHITE           YEL/RED 2-1-3                                                                                                                                                                LOCK-OUT
                           3                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     VALVE
4 ORN/RED 49-104
                           6          ORN/RED 49-106
           J2 BLACK
F 7 ORN/RED 49-107
                           9                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             BRAKE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   2     VALVE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   SPD
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   VALVE
                           10                                                        YEL/WHT 39-2                               FRONT AXLE EXTEND
       D
                           1      YELLOW 10-2                              RIGHT FRONT STEER RIGHT
       C
                           6      YELLOW 11-2                              RIGHT REAR STEER LEFT
             J5 RUST
                           9    RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              ORN/RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     SHIELD
                                                                                                                                                                                        BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            RED
10 GRN
       B                   11   WHITE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               10
11
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              12
                                                                                                                                                                1
12 BLACK
J1 GRAY
4 3 2 1
ANALYZER HARNESS
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              SHEET 6
                       8                                                       7                                                                            6                                                                           5                                                                                                    4
7-34                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            3121171
                                                                                                                                                             SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               H
                                                                                                                                                                                                                DRIVE ORIENTATION
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      SWITCH
                                                                                                                         ORANGE (16)
                                                                                                       YELLOW (16)
                                                                                          BLACK 14GA
                                                                          RED 14GA
                                                                SHIELD
                                                                                                                                          VIOLET
                                                        BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                               BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                     BLACK
                                        RED
YEL/RED 2-1-7 1
BLACK 2
10
11
                                                                                                                                                                                                  12
                                         1
                                                                                                                                                             9
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               OSC. AXLE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               LOCK-OUT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               PRESSURE                                                                                        G
                                                                 SHIELD
                                                                                                                                                                                     YEL/RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 SWITCH                                               4
                                                                                           BLK 14GA
                                                                                                                                           ORANGE 60-2
                                        RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      J4 GRAY
                                                        BLACK
YEL/RED 14GA
ORANGE 55-45
                                                                                                                                                             OSC. AXLE
                                                                                                         ORANGE 55-47
                                                                                                                                                                                               ORN/RED 49-106
                                                                                                                                                             LOCK-OUT
                                                                                                                                                             VALVE                                                                                                                                    5
ORN/RED 6
ORN/RED 7
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    6 PIN
                                                                                                                                     BRAKE                                                                                                4         BUSS
                                                                                                                               2     VALVE                                                                                                          CONNECTOR
                                                                                                                               SPD                                                                                                        5
                                                                                                                               VALVE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          2
1 RED 1 RED A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   RIGHT FRONT
                                                                                                                                                                                                           2                 WHITE              2          BLUE          B                         STEER SENSOR
3 BLACK 3 BLACK C
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   LEFT FRONT
                                                                                                                                                                                                           5                 WHITE              2          BLUE          B                         STEER SENSOR
                 YEL/RED 2-1-1 (14GA)
                                                                                                                                                                                                           6                 BLACK              3          BLACK         C
    BLACK 14GA
J3 GREEN
7 RED 1 RED A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   RIGHT REAR
                                                                                                                                                                                                           8                 WHITE              2          BLUE          B                         STEER SENSOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               C
                                                                                                                                                                                                           9                 BLACK              3          BLACK         C
10 RED 1 RED A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   LEFT REAR
                                                                                                                                                                                                       11                    WHITE              2          BLUE          B                         STEER SENSOR
                                                                                                         YEL/RED 2-1-6
                 YEL/RED 2-1-5
                                                                                                                                                                                                       12                    BLACK              3          BLACK         C
                                                                          ORN/RED
                                                                 SHIELD
                                                        BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                             BLACK
    BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     BRN/BLK    4          BRN/BLK
                                        RED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               B
                                                                                           10
11
                                                                                                                          12
    4
CHASSIS SCH.
J1 GRAY
   SHEET 6                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      1001119861-O
                                                    5                                                                                                    4                                                            3                                              2                                            1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     MAE36330O
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            7-35
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
8 7 6 5 4
       H
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  BOSCH GPA-S ACTUATOR
                                               CAT ENGINE HARNESS
                                                                                                                                                                                                                PURPLE/LT GREEN 18
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1   SENSOR OUT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                 BLACK/LT GREEN 18
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  2   5V RTN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    TAN/ORANGE 18
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  3   DBW +
                                                                                                                                                                                                                     PINK/WHITE 18
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  4   DBW -
                                                                                                                                                                                                                   LT GREEN/RED 18
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  5   5V EXT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      BOSCH_872-860-521 CONN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      BOSCH_C-TAB 2 99 00 49262 2 TERMINAL
                                                                                                                                              OIL                                                                                     BOSCH_1 99 00 44435 2 SEAL
                                                                                                                                           PRESSURE                                                                                                                                                                 RED/BLACK 18
                                                                                                     BLACK/LT GREEN 18
       G                                                                                             LT BLUE 18
                                                                                                                                             2                                                                                                                                                                      BLACK/RED 18
                                                                                                                                             1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    RED 18
                                                                                                                                          DEUTSCH_DT06-2S CONN
                                                                                                                                          DEUTSCH_0462-201-16141 TERMINAL                                                                                                                                           PINK/TAN 18
           AMP23                                                                                                                          DEUTSCH_W2S LOCK                                                                                                 GROUND
                                                         PINK/WHITE 18                                                                                                                                                              BLACK 14                                13MM RING W/
                             DBW +     1                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    STAR WASHER
                              DBW -    2                 TAN/ORANGE 18
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    BLACK 18
                   STARTER LOCKOUT     3
                                                         RED/BLACK 18                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   PINK/TAN 18
                     GLOW CONTROL      4
                                                         WHITE/BLACK 18
                  SHUT OFF CONTROL     5
                                                         LT GRN/WHT 18                                                                                                                                                                            ECM
                COLD START CONTROL     6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              RED/TAN 16              F2          RED 16
                                       7
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           10A
                                       8
                                       9
                            GROUND 10                    BLACK 16                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    WHITE 16
                                                         RED/TAN 16
       F                        VBAT 11
                                  TPS 12                 PURPLE/LT BLUE 18
                                      13                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               LT BLUE/PINK 18
                                                         LT BLUE 18
                       OIL PRESSURE 14
                                                         PINK/TAN 18
                                 VSW 15                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      BLACK 18
                                                         LT GREEN/RED 18
                              5V EXT 16
                                      17                                                                                                                                                                COLD START SOLENOID
                                                         TAN/WHITE 18                                                                                                                                                             LT GRN/WHT 18                  F5                                                 WHITE 16
                                  ECT 18
                                                         BLACK/LT GREEN 18                                                                                                                                                                                            10A
                              5V RTN 19                                                                                                                                                                 TYCO_172128-1 CONNECTOR
                                                         BLUE/PINK 18                                       TWIST WIRES 10 TURNS(360 DEG)/FOOT FULL LENGTH
                               CAN + 20                                                                                                                                                                 TYCO_63648-1 TERMINAL
                               CAN - 21
                                                         BLUE/WHITE 18                                                                                                                                                                            COLD START
                                                         WHITE/PURPLE 18                                    TWIST WIRES 10 TURNS(360 DEG)/FOOT FULL LENGTH
                             CRANK - 22
                                                         PURPLE/WHITE 18
                            CRANK + 23
                                                                                                                                                                                                             TAN/WHITE 18              A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              LT GRN/WHT 18
           AMP_770680_1 CONNECTOR
           AMP_770520_1 TERMINAL (TIN PLATED)
                                                                                                                                                                                                   BLACK/LT GREEN 18                   B                   ECT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       PINK/TAN 18
       E                                                                                                                                                                                                                    PED_12162193 CONNECTOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            PED_12124075 TERMINAL
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        LT GRN/WHT 18
                                                                                                                                                                                                 DIAGNOSTIC CONNECTOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       UNUSED              1    ANA RTN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       UNUSED              2    5V REF
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       UNUSED              3    PC TX
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       UNUSED              4    PC RX
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       UNUSED                   VBAT                  EPC_1F1T-14A624-AA-004 CONN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      GTS_0330-930009 TERM (18-29)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                       UNUSED              6    GROUND                GTS_0330-940001 TERM (14-16)
                                                                                                                                                                                              BLUE/PINK 18
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           7    CAN1 +                EPC_E6DB-14A468-DA LOCK
                                                                                                                                                                                             BLUE/WHITE 18
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           8    CAN1 -                EPC_F5AB-14A666-AA CAP
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DEUTSCH_0413-204-2005 PLUG
                                                                              JLG WIRING
       D                                                                         FOR                                                                                                                                                                                                SHUT OFF SOLENOID
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             BK/W 18          F4
                                                                              CAT ENGINE                                                                                                                                     CRANK SENSOR                                                                                           10A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  TYCO_172128-1 CONNECTOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  TYCO_63648-1 TERMINAL
                                                                                                                                                                                                 WHITE/PURPLE 18
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    2 CRANK -
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   SHUT OFF
                                                                                                                                                                                                 PURPLE/WHITE 18
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1 CRANK +
                        DEUTSCH_DT04-6P CONN                                              SEE
                        DEUTSCH_0460-202-16141 TERMINAL                                 SHEET 4                                                                                                                                     DEUTSCH_DT06-2S CONN
                        DEUTSCH_W6P LOCK                                                ZONE B5                                                                                                                                     DEUTSCH_0462-201-16141 TERMINAL
                        DEUTSCH_114017 CAVITY PLUG                                                                                                                                                                                  DEUTSCH_W2S LOCK
       C
                            VEHICLE
                          INTERFACE 1
                                           3
                                           4
                                           5
                                           6
                                                        RED CAN HI
                                                        BLK CAN LO
                                                        BRN/WHT 47-8                        SHIELD        }   SEE SHEET 4, ZONE B5
RED 1-10
                                                                                                                                                                                       GLOWPLUG
                                                                                                                      SHEET 7, ZONE G3
                                                                                                                      (VENDOR WIRING)                                      86          RELAY                                                                                                                                 87a
                                                                                                                                                              BLACK                                                                                                                                                    30
                                                                                                                                                                           85                                                                                                                           RED 1-10
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   WHT/YEL 48-15               87
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       86
                                                                                                                                                                                         TO GLOW PLUG RAIL
       B                                                                                                                                                                                 SHEET 7, ZONE H2                                                                                                   BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       85
                                                                                                                                                                                         (VENDOR WIRING)
                                                                                                                   SEE SHEET 4, ZONE E1                      RED
                                                         VEHICLE
                                                       INTERFACE 2                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              FUEL PUMP RELAY
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (LOCATED ON CAT ENGINE)
                                               DEUTSCH_DT04-8PA CONN
                                               DEUTSCH_0460-202-16141 TERMINAL
                                               DEUTSCH_W8P LOCK
                                               DEUTSCH_114017 CAVITY PLUG
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     SHEET 7
                             8                                                          7                                                                      6                                                              5                                                                     4
7-36                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         3121171
                                                                                                           SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
5 4 3 2 1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            H
                                                                                                                                                     8MM RING                                                                                              5MM RING
                                     BOSCH GPA-S ACTUATOR
                                                                                                                                                                                      GLOW PLUG
                   PURPLE/LT GREEN 18
                                                     1   SENSOR OUT
                                                                                                                                                                                       SOLENOID                                                  ALTERNATOR
                    BLACK/LT GREEN 18
                                                     2   5V RTN
                       TAN/ORANGE 18
                                                     3   DBW +                                                                           F3               BLACK/RED 18                                                                UNUSED
                        PINK/WHITE 18                                                                                                                                                                                                                      1
                                                     4   DBW -                                                                                10A                                                                               BROWN/WHITE 18                           CAT 1073134 CONNECTOR
                      LT GREEN/RED 18                                                                                                                                                                                                                      2
                                                     5   5V EXT                                                                                                                                                                 BROWN/WHITE 18                           CAT 1073135 TERMINAL
                                                                                                                                       GLOW                                                 5MM RING                                                       3
                                         BOSCH_872-860-521 CONN
                                                                                                                                       PLUGS
                                         BOSCH_C-TAB 2 99 00 49262 2 TERMINAL
                                         BOSCH_1 99 00 44435 2 SEAL
                                                                                                                        RED/BLACK 18            2                                                                                                              18-22 GAUGE INSULATED BUTT CONNECTOR
                                                                                                                        BLACK/RED 18            3                                                                                                                                                                           G
                                                                                                                        RED 18                  5                                                                                        STARTER B+
                                                                                                                        PINK/TAN 18             1
                                                              GROUND                                                                            4                                                                                    RED 14                         10MM RING
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     RED 8
                                       BLACK 14                                13MM RING W/                                     R3- GLOW CONTROL
                                                                               STAR WASHER
                                       BLACK 18
                                                                                                                                PINK/TAN 18                F1             PINK 18
                                                                                                                                                                5A
                                                     ECM                                                                                                                                                                                 ALTERNATOR +
                                 RED/TAN 16              F2          RED 16                                                                               VSW                         RED 16
                                                              10A                                                                                                                                                                    RED 8                          7MM RING
                                                                                                                                                                     87a
                                                                                                                                                30
                                                                                                                          WHITE 16
                                                                                                                                                                     87               RED 16
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            F
                                                                                                                           LT BLUE/PINK 18                86                  R1
                                                                                                                                                                           STARTER
                                                                                                                                 BLACK 18
                                                                                                                                                          85
                                                                                                                                                                            RELAY
           COLD START SOLENOID
                                     LT GRN/WHT 18                  F5                                                   WHITE 16
                                                                         10A                                                                                          STARTER                                                                              VEHICLE INTERFACE 1
           TYCO_172128-1 CONNECTOR
           TYCO_63648-1 TERMINAL
                                                     COLD START                                                                               7MM RING               SOLENOID                                                            PINK 18       1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           VSW
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 LT BLUE/PINK 18       2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           START
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    BLUE/PINK 18       3
                                                                                                                                                                     87a                                                                                   CAN +
              TAN/WHITE 18                A                                                                                                                                                                                       BLUE/WHITE 18        4
                                                                                                                 LT GRN/WHT 18                  30                                                                                                         CAN -
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                BROWN/WHITE 18         5
      BLACK/LT GREEN 18                   B                   ECT                                                                                                    87               RED 18
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           ALT. EXCITE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           UNUSED
                                                                                                                           PINK/TAN 18                    86                                                                                               DEUTSCH_DT06-6S CONN
                              PED_12162193 CONNECTOR                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        E
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           DEUTSCH_0462-201-16141 TERMINAL
                              PED_12124075 TERMINAL                                                                                                                           COLD                                                                         DEUTSCH_W6S LOCK
                                                                                                                            LT GRN/WHT 18
                                                                                                                                                          85
                                                                                                                                                                              START                                                                        DEUTSCH_114017 CAVITY PLUG
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  SEE VENDOR                     B+
                                                                                                                                                                          WHITE/BLACK 18             2                                                                                                                      D
                                                                                       SHUT OFF SOLENOID                                                                                                                                       SCHEMATIC DETAIL
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 D+
                                                                                                                BK/W 18           F4                                      BLACK/WHITE 18             3                                        CAT ENGINE HARNESS
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    SHEET 5
                               CRANK SENSOR                                          TYCO_172128-1 CONNECTOR                            10A                                                                                                        ZONE G/E2
                                                                                     TYCO_63648-1 TERMINAL                                                                RED 18                     5
     WHITE/PURPLE 18                                                                                                     SHUT OFF
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             REGULATOR
                                       2 CRANK -                                                                                                                          PINK/TAN 18                1
     PURPLE/WHITE 18
                                       1 CRANK +                                                                                                                                                     4
                                       DEUTSCH_DT06-2S CONN
                                       DEUTSCH_0462-201-16141 TERMINAL
                                                                                                                                                                     R2- SHUT OFF RELAY                                                                                           W
                                       DEUTSCH_W2S LOCK
                                                                                                                                          STARTER B+
                                                                                                                                         RED 1-10
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    VEHICLE INTERFACE 2
                                                                                                                                                                      10MM RING
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    UNUSED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    GROUND
                                                                                                                                                                                      SEE SHEET 4, ZONE G2       BLU/ORG 52-5   3
                                                                                                                                                                                      SEE SHEET 4, ZONE F2                          GENERATOR ENABLE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                YEL/RED 2-20    5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    PLUGGED                                                       JLG WIRING
                                                                                                                                                                                      SEE SHEET 4, ZONE B5                          GENERATOR POWER
                                                                                                                                 87a                                                  SEE SHEET 4, ZONE G1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      BLACK     6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    GENERATOR GROUND
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    FOR CAT
                                                                                                                                                                                                                WHT/YEL 48-15   7
                                                                                                                           30                                                                                   WHT/YEL 48-8    8
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    FUEL PUMP ENABLE                                              FUEL PUMP
                                                                                                           RED 1-10                             WHT/YEL 48-8                                                                        FUEL PUMP POWER
                                                                                                      WHT/YEL 48-15                87                                       15 AMP
                                                                                                                           86                                              SLOW BLO
                                                                                                               BLACK                                                         FUSE                                                   DEUTSCH_DT06-8SA CONN                                                                   B
                                                                                                                           85                                                                                                       DEUTSCH_0462-201-16141 TERMINAL
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DEUTSCH_W8S LOCK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DEUTSCH_114017 CAVITY PLUG
                                                                                                                           FUEL PUMP RELAY
                                                                                                                       (LOCATED ON CAT ENGINE)
   SHEET 7                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   1001119861-O
                                 5                                                                     4                                                                                3                                            2                                                                   1
MAE36340O
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         7-37
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
8 7 6 5 4
       H                                                                                                                                                                                        RECTIFER
                                                                                                                                                                                                                   B+        FUSIBLE
                                                                                                                                                                            STATOR                                             LINK
       G
                                                                                                 WHT/YEL 48-13 (8)
                                                  WHT/YEL 48-12(12)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 BRN/WHT 47-8-1
                                                                                                                                                                                        IN HEAD GLOW PLUGS
       F
                               WHT/YEL 48-3
WHT/YEL 48-9
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        BATTERY +
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         SHEET 4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         ZONE E1
       E         COOLANT                      2                       8 GRD(TempAll)                                                                                   BLACK (16)
                 TEMPERATURE                  1                       9 ADC7(TEMP3)                                                                                1
                                                                                                                                                                       BLACK 0-1                                                                                                                                                  BLACK 0-1
                                                                                                                                                                   2
A K L B
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           DIANOSTICS
                  ENGINE                      2                       13 SPEED                                                                                         ORN/RED 49-198                                                                                                                                       ORN/RED 49-199
                  SPEED                                                                                                                                        10
                                                                                                 EMR2 ENGINE CONTROL TO ENGINE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           DEUTZ
                  CAMSHAFT                                                                                                                                     11
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           PLUG
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            YEL/RED 2-1-98
                                              1                       23        GRD (ACD2)
                  CHARGE AIR                  2                       4         ADC5(TEMP1)                                                                                CAN HI
                  PRESSURE                    3                       25        +5Vref(ADC2)                                                                  12
                                              4                       24        ADC2                                                                                       CAN LO
                                                                                                                                                              13
                                              1                       22 +5Vref(ADC4)
                 ENGINE OIL
                 PRESSURE                     2                       21 ADC4                                                                                 14
                                              3                       20 GND (ADC4)                                                                                    YEL/RED 2-1-99
                                              1                       14        ActorOut
                   EMR                        2                       15        ActorOut
                   ACTUATOR                   3                       17        RackMeasCom
       D                                      4                       19        RackMeasSignal
                                              5                       18        RackMeasRef
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            VEHICLE INTERFACE I
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    YEL/RED 2-1-99      1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        WHT/YEL 48-3        VSW
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           RED (18)         START
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         CAN HI                         3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        BLACK (18)          CAN +
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        CAN LO                          4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      BRN/WHT 47-8-1        CAN -
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            ALT. EXCITE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            UNUSED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DEUTSCH_DT06-6S CONN
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DEUTSCH_0462-201-16141 TERMINAL
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DEUTSCH_W6S LOCK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DEUTSCH_114017 CAVITY PLUG
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            VEHICLE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          INTERFACE 2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  VEHICLE INTERFACE 2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          1                                                                  1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                UNUSED                                                                   YEL/RED 2-1-88            J1-10 ON SHEET 4, ZO
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         BLACK (16)                       2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                GROUND                                                       2           BLACK (16)                J1-8 ON SHEET 4, ZON
                                                                                                                                                                                                      SEE SHEET 4, ZONE G2                                BLU/ORG 52-5                    3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                GENERATOR ENABLE                                             3           BLU/ORG 52-5              J1-22 ON SHEET 4, ZO
                                                                                                                                                                                                      SEE SHEET 4, ZONE F2                                WHT/YEL 48-9                    4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                GLOW                                                         4           WHT/YEL 48-9              J1-12 ON SHEET 4, ZO
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             RED 2-20                     5
                                                                                                                                                                                                      SEE SHEET 4, ZONE G2                                                                      GENERATOR POWER                                              5           YEL/RED 2-20              SEE SHEET 4, ZONE B5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               BLACK                      6                                                                              BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                      SEE SHEET 4, ZONE G1                                                                      GENERATOR GROUND                                             6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          7                                                                  7           WHT/YEL 48-15             J1-7 ON SHEET 4, ZON
       B                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        PLUGGED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          8                                                                  8           WHT/YEL 48-8
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                PLUGGED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      SHEET 7
             8                                                                                                                                                         7                                                                              6                                                                         5                                                         4
7-38                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      3121171
                                                                                              SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
5 4 3 2 1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      E
                                 BLACK 0-1
                                                A K L B
DIANOSTICS
                           ORN/RED 49-199
                           ORN/RED 49-198
                                                          DEUTZ
PLUG
YEL/RED 2-1-98
                                                                                                                    VEHICLE
                                                                                                                  INTERFACE 1
                                                                                                                                                       }
       BLACK (18)          CAN +                                                                    3            RED CAN HI
                       4
     BRN/WHT 47-8-1        CAN -                                                                    4            BLK CAN LO                            SEE SHEET 4, ZONE B5
                       5
                           ALT. EXCITE                                                              5            BRN/WHT 47-8                 SHIELD
                       6
                           UNUSED                                                                   6
                           DEUTSCH_DT06-6S CONN
                                                                                                                                                             SEE SHEET 4, ZONE A8
                           DEUTSCH_0462-201-16141 TERMINAL
                           DEUTSCH_W6S LOCK
                           DEUTSCH_114017 CAVITY PLUG
                                                                           VEHICLE
                                                                         INTERFACE 2
    VEHICLE INTERFACE 2
   UNUSED                                                   1            YEL/RED 2-1-88           J1-10 ON SHEET 4, ZONE D6
                                                                                                                                                                                                 BLACK
                                                                                                                                                                                                         2
PLUGGED 8
   SHEET 8                                                                                                                                                                                                                             1001119861-O
                             5                                                            4                                               3                                         2                                              1
MAE36350O
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   7-39
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
8 7 6 5 4
MS932
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       RL930-B+
                                                                                                             BLK 248-19 EXH GAS RECIRC                                                                                                             BLK 248-4 MPROP ACTUATOR 1.5mm²
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    RL930-1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               D
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               H
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               G
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               C
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               B
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               E
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               F
                                                 4                                                                                              11 11                                                                                                                                                        19
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  RL930
                                                                                                             BLK 248-20 EXH GAS RECIRC                                                                                                        BLK 248-37 ENGINE SPEED CAMSHAFT 0.75mm²
                                                37                                                                                              12 12                                                                                                                                                        14
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   BUSBAR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              BLK 248-52 ENGINE SPEED CAMSHAFT 0.75mm²
                                                52                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           13
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              S946
                                                23                                                                                       X1001    X1005                                                                                                                                                      16
                                                          BLK 248-24 BOOST PRESSURE / TEMP 0.75mm²                                                                                                                                          BLK 248-24 BOOST PRESSURE / TEMP 0.75mm²
                                                24                                                                                            1   1                                                                                                                                                          22
                                                          BLK 248-25 RAIL PRESSURE FUEL 0.75mm²                                                                                                                                               BLK 248-25 RAIL PRESSURE FUEL 0.75mm²
                                                25                                                                                            2   2                                                                                                                                                          31
                                                          BLK 248-26 RAIL PRESSURE FUEL 0.75mm²                                                                                                                                               BLK 248-26 RAIL PRESSURE FUEL 0.75mm²
                                                26                                                                                            3   3                                                                                                                                                          25
                                                          BLK 248-27 BOOST PRESSURE / TEMP 0.75mm²                                                                                                                                          BLK 248-27 BOOST PRESSURE / TEMP 0.75mm²
                                                27                                                                                            4   4                                                                                                                                                          29
                                                          BLK 248-28 COOLING TEMPERATURE 0.75mm²                                                                                                                                            BLK 248-28 COOLING TEMPERATURE 0.75mm²
                                                28                                                                                            5   5                                                                                                                                                          24
                                                          BLK 248-29 OIL PRESSURE 0.75mm²                                                                                                                                                        BLK 248-29 OIL PRESSURE 0.75mm²
                                                29                                                                                            6   6                                                                                                                                                          27
                                                30                                                                                            7   7                                                                                                                                                          33
                                                31                                                                                            8   8                                                                                                                                                          60
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           BLK 148-61 FUEL LOW PRESSURE 0.75mm²
                                                34                                                                                            9   9                                                                                                                                                          17
                                                          BLK 248-35 GLOW RELAY CONTROL GND
                                                35                                                                                            10 10                                                                                                                                                          18
                                                36                                                                                            11 11                                                                                                                                                          58
                                                 1                                                                                            12 12                                                                                                                                                          30
                                                          BLK 248-40 AIR INLET TEMP                                                                                                                                                                                BLK 248-40 AIR INLET TEMP 0.75mm²
                                                40                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           28
                                                41                                                                                                                                                                                                                 BLK 148-56 AIR INLET TEMP 0.75mm²         34
                                                42                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           36
                                                          BLK 248-43 OIL PRESSURE                                                                                                                                                                         BLK 248-43 OIL PRESSURE 0.75mm²
                                                43                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           23
                                                          BLK 248-44 OIL PRESSURE                                                                                                                                                                         BLK 248-44 OIL PRESSURE 0.75mm²
                                                44                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           26
       F                                        45                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           39
                                                47                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           43
                                                49                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           44
                                                50                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           45
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       BLK 148-85 EHXAUST GAS RECIRCULATION 0.75mm²
                                                51                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           46
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    BLK 148-72 THROTTLE FLAP 3 0.75mm²
                                                55                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           49
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            BLK 148-44 EHXAUST GAS RECIRCULATION 0.75mm²
                                                56                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           50
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     BLK 148-38 THROTTLE FLAP 4 0.75mm²
                                                57                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           52
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        BLK 148-82 EHXAUST GAS RECIRCULATION 0.75mm²
                                                58                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           51
                                                59                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           53
                                                60                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           54
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             55
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             56
                                              ECM-J1
                         1.5MM (7,29,51,73) 7
                                            8
                                            9
                                           10
                                           11
       E                                   12
                                                       BLK 148-13 COOLANT LEVEL SIG
                                           13
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        S951
                                           14
                                                       BLK 148-15-68 CLUTCH SWITCH
                                           15
                                           16
                                           17
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               S952
                                           18
                                           19
                                           20
                                           21
                                           22
                                           23
                                           24
                                           25
                                                       BLK 148-26 FUEL PUMP RELAY CONTROL GND
                                           26
                                           27
                                           28
                       1.5MM (7,29,51,73)              BLK 148-29 COOLANT LEVEL PWR
                                           29
                                           30
                                           31
       D                                   32
                                           33
                                           34
                                           35
                                           36
                                           37                                                                                                               X1002    X1006
                                                       BLK 148-38 THROTTLE FLAP 4
                                           38                                                                                                                    1   1
                                           39                                                                                                                    2   2
                                           40                                                                                                                    3   3
                                           41                                                                                                                    4   4
                                           42                                                                                                                    5   5
                                           43                                                                                                                    6   6
                                                       BLK 148-44 EXH GAS RECIRC
                                           44                                                                                                                    7   7
                                           45                                                                                                                    8   8
                                           46                                                                                                                    9   9
                                           47                                                                                                                    10 10
                                           48                                                                                                                    11 11
                                           49                                                                                                                    12 12
                                           50
                       1.5MM (7,29,51,73)  51
                                           52
       C                                   53
                                                       GRN CAN 2 LO DIAG CAN LOW                                                           S968
                                                       YEL CAN 1 HI CUSTOMER CAN HIGH
                                           54
                                           55                                                                                                                                                                   S953
                                                       BLK 148-56 AIR INLET TEMP
                                           56
                                                       BLK 148-57 WATER IN FUEL SW RTN
                                           57
                   K [J1]                  58                                                                                                                                         X965
                                                                                                                                                                  YEL CAN 2 HI                                    120 OHM
                                           59                                                                                                                                                A      A
           ECM   CONNECTOR                 60
                                                                                                                                                                   GRN CAN 2 LO
                                                                                                                                                                                             B      B
                                                       BLK 148-61 FUEL LOW PRESSURE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                             YEL CAN 1 HI
                                           61                                                                                                                                                C      C
                                           62                                                                                                                                                        X966
                                           63
                                                       BLK 148-64 WATER IN FUEL SW
                                           64
                                           65
                                           66                                                                                                                                                                                                           X955             X956
                                           67                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      120 OHM
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               A     A
                                                       BLK 148-15-68 CLUTCH SWITCH
                                           68                                                                                                                                                                                                                  B     B
                                           69                                                                                                                                                                                                                  C     C
                                           70
                                           71
                                                       BLK 148-72 THROTTLE FLAP 3
                                           72
                       1.5MM (7,29,51,73)  73
       B                                   74                                                                                                                                                               GRN CAN 1 LO
                                                       YEL CAN 2 HI DIAG CAN HIGH                                                           S969
                                           75
                                                       GRN CAN 1 LO CUSTOMER CAN LOW
                                           76
                                           77                                                                                                                                                S954
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 X1008          X1010
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   YEL CAN 2 HI
                                           78                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         1         1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   GRN CAN 2 LO
                                           79                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         2         2
                                           80                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         3         3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    YEL CAN 1 HI
                                           81                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         4         4
                                                       BLK 148-82 EXH GAS RECIRC                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   GRN CAN 1 LO
                                           82                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         5         5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  SHLD CAN 1 SHLD
                                           83                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         6         6
                                           84                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         7         7
                                                       BLK 148-85 EXH GAS RECIRC
                                           85                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         8         8
                                           86
                                                       BLK 148-87 COOLANT LEVEL GND
                                           87
                                                       BLK 148-88 IGNITION
                                           88
                                           89
                                           90
                                           91
                                           92
                                           93
       A                                   94
                                                       RED 148-5 ECM PWR 2.5mm²
                                            5                                                        S944                                                            X1007
                                                       RED 148-3 ECM PWR 2.5mm²
                                            3                                                                                                                             1   1
                                                       RED 148-1 ECM PWR 2.5mm²                                                                                               X1009
                                            1
                               2.5MM (1-6)             BLK 148-2 ECM GND 2.5mm²
                                            2                                                        S945
                                                       BLK 148-4 ECM GND 2.5mm²
                                            4
                                                       BLK 148-6 ECM GND 2.5mm²
                                            6
                                                       SHLD CAN 1 SHLD
                                           NC
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      SHEET 9
                                        8                                                                    7                                                                                         6                                                                                                     5                                                                                                        4
7-40                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              3121171
                                                                                                                                        SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
5 4 3 2 1
             EIC                                                           BUSSMANN DIODE PACK                                             FUEL PUMP 20A (SW), ECM 30A (CONT)
                   62                                                            (BLUE)                                                            YELLOW CONNECTOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              GLOWPLUG SOLENOID                                                                                        GLOWPLUGS
                   35                                                                                                                                     GENERIC
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   150 AMP
                   42                                                                                                                             RELAY, POWER MODULE
                   37
                   38
                                                                                        5A            10A
                   61
                   40
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 GENERIC
                   41
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           H
87
30
86
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     85
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 GENERIC
                   2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               ALTERNATOR
                   20
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          B+
                                                                 MS932
RL930-B+
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   RL931-85
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             RL931-87
RL931-87
RL931-30
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     RL931-86
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           RL931-87
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        W
                                                                                                                                                                                                              RL930-1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            RL930-2
                                                                         D
                                                                         H
                                                                         G
                                                                         A
                                                                         C
                                                                         B
                                                                                                                                                                 1
                                                                                                                                                                 2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           2
                                                                         E
                                                                         F
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              L
                   19
RL930
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             EC18
                   14
BUSBAR
EC241-B+
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    EC241-W
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     EC241-L
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          1
                                                                                     BLK 248-23 GLOW SENSE 0.75mm²
                   13
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         150A
                   15
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     RED - - 4AWG
                   32
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           BUSBAR
                   57
                   3
                   4                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      BUSBAR
                   5
                   6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    RED - - 2/0AWG
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       X923
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  RED - - 2/0AWG
                   7
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      1
                   8
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      150A
                   10
                   11
                   47
                        EIC (ENGINE INTERFACE CONNECTION)
48 G
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          BUSBAR
                   12                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              EC971-B+
                   59                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1                              M
                                                                                                           S946
16 EC971
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            GENERIC
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            GENERIC
                   22                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1
                   31                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              EC971-B-
                   25                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1
                   29
                   24                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               RL974
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             WHT 48-3 START 18AWG
                   27                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1 DEUTZ PROVIDED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    BLK 000-48-4 ENG GND
                   33                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                START RELAY
                   60
                   17
                   18
                   58
                   30                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               X901
                   28                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   1      VSW
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               WHT 48-3 START 18AWG
                   34                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   2      START
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               YEL CAN 1 HI CUSTOMER CAN HIGH
                   36                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   3      CAN + (HI)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               GRN CAN 1 LO CUSTOMER CAN LO
                   23
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               RED 47-8 ALT EXCITE 16AWG
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        4      CAN - (LOW)                                      VEHICLE INTERFACE 1
                   26                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   5      ALT EXCITE
                   39
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               SHLD CAN 1 SHLD CUSTOMER CAN SHIELD
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        6      CAN SHIELD                                       (SEE SHEET 8, ZONE D3)                     F
                   43
                   44
                   45                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               X902
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                YEL 2-1-99 IGNITION 18AWG
                   46                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      1   EMR4 IGNITION
49 2 GROUND
50 3 GENERATOR ENABLE
52 4 GLOW
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           E
                                                                                                                     S951
                                                                                                                            S952
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    X950
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                YEL 2-48-2 IGNITION
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  BLK 000-48-2 ENG GND
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           B
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           C
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           D
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           E
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     GRN CAN 1 LO CUSTOMER CAN LO
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        GRN CAN 2 LO DIAG CAN LOW
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           F                                                                                               D
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     S963                                            S964                                                                                                                                YEL CAN 2 HI DIAG CAN HIGH
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           G                   DEUTZ DIAGNOSTIC
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           H
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           J
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           K
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           L
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               YEL CAN 1 HI CUSTOMER CAN HIGH
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           M
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    X960
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         YEL CAN 2 HI DIAG CAN HIGH                                                      120 OHM
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           A         A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        GRN CAN 2 LO DIAG CAN LOW
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           B         B
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           C         C
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      X961
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   SN939               PWR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  BLK 148-29 COOLANT LEVEL PWR 0.75mm²
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              NORMALLY CLOSED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               COOLANT LEVEL
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              X941        X942
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        WIF SWITCH
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     BLK 148-64 WATER IN FUEL SW 0.75mm²                                                              BLK 148-64 WATER IN FUEL SW 16AWG
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     1   1                                                                                              1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 BLK 148-57 WATER IN FUEL SW RTN 0.75mm²                                                              BLK 148-57 WATER IN FUEL SW RTN 16AWG
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             WHT 48-96 FUEL PUMP 14AWG
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     2   2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      WHT 48-96 FUEL PUMP 14AWG
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    SN959
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      WATER IN FUEL
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     3   3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             BLK 000-48-1 ENG GND 14AWG                                                               BLK 000-48-1 ENG GND 14AWG
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     4   4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  FUEL PUMP
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              M
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    EC958
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         2                                                        FUEL PUMP
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       X958A                                                                   EC958+
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  WHT 48-96 FUEL PUMP
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               FUEL PUMP
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       1                                                                            1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           B
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       2
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     BLK 000-48-1 ENG GND
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               EC958-      M
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          BLK 000-48-4 ENG GND
                                                                             X1008          X1010
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         BLK 000-48-2 ENG GND                                      T920                                                                           2 x 5mm 14 AWG RING
                                                            YEL CAN 2 HI
                                                                                  1         1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     BLK 000-48-1 ENG GND 14AWG
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     1    GND
                                                            GRN CAN 2 LO
                                                                                  2         2
                                                                                  3         3                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      3/8" 10-12 AWG RING
                                                      YEL CAN 1 HI
                                                                                  4         4                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           X1011
                                                     GRN CAN 1 LO                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           BLK 000-148-246 ECM GND 8AWG
                                                                                  5         5                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                1
                                                    SHLD CAN 1 SHLD
                                                                                  6         6
                                                                                  7         7                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      3/8" 8 AWG RING
                                                                                  8         8
   SHEET 9                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                               1001119861-O
                   5                                                                                                                4                                                                                                                                                                                                                            3                                                                                                                                                                                    2                                                                                                                                          1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          MAE36360O
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        7-41
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
8 7 6 5 4
       H
                                      PLATFORM SENSOR
                                ORN/RED 49-69
              SEE                                          3                YEL/RED P1                                ZONE D6
             SHT 2
           ZONE E6, A7          YEL/RED 2-16-3
                                                                                                                                                                                                         PLATFORM SENSOR
                                                           6                YEL/RED P8
                                                           13
                                                                            YEL/RED P9                                 ZONE D6
                                                                            YEL/RED P2                                 ZONE E2
                                                                                                                    OR SEE SHEET 9
                                                                                                                        ZONE B5
       G
                                                                                                                                                           SEE                YEL/RED P3
                             ORN/RED 49-69                                                                                                                SHT 2
              SEE                                     3                  YEL/RED P1                               ZONE D6                                ZONE F8
             SHT 2
           ZONE E6, A7      YEL/RED 2-16-3
                                                      6               BLK              L   WHT          5
                                                                                                                     SOFT
       F                                                                                                             TOUCH
                                                     13               BLK           R      BLK         4
                                                                        YEL/RED P9                               ZONE D6
                                                                        YEL/RED P2                               ZONE E2
                                                                                                              OR SEE SHEET 9
                                                                                                                  ZONE B5
                                                                                                                                                                               PLATFORM SENSOR
                                                                                                                                                                                                       WHT           ORN/RED P4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                 4
                                                                                                                                                                                                       BLK           ORN/RED P5
                                                                                                                                                                                                                 3
       E                                                                                                                                                                                               BLK           BLK P6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                 2
                                                                                                                                                                                                       WHT           YEL/RED P10
                                                                                                                                                                                                                 1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      YEL/RED P1
       D
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      YEL/RED P9
                                             P-J8
                                             MOLEX
       A
7-42                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     3121171
                                                                        SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
5 4 3 2 1
PLATFORM SENSOR
             YEL/RED P3                                                                    YEL/RED P3              87
                                                                                                             1
                                                                                          YEL/RED P9-1             30
                                                                                                             1
                                                                                                                             RELAY, 12V
                                                                                                                   87a                                                 F
                                                                                                             1
                                                                                            ORN/RED P5             85
                                                                                                             1
                                                                                           ORN/RED P5-1
                                                                                            ORN/RED P4             86
                                                                                                             1
              PLATFORM SENSOR                                                              ORN/RED P4-1
                                       WHT           ORN/RED P4
                                                 4
                                       BLK           ORN/RED P5
                                                 3
                                                     BLK P6                                                                                 SEE
                                       BLK       2                                                                                         SHT 2
                                                                                                                                                                       E
                                       WHT           YEL/RED P10                                           YEL/RED P2                     ZONE F6
                                                 1
                                                                                       18 ohm 25W
                                                      YEL/RED P1                          YEL/RED P1               87
                                                                                                             1
                                                      YEL/RED P9                          YEL/RED P9                                                                   D
                                                                                          YEL/RED P9-1             30
                                                                                                             1
                                                                                                                             RELAY, 12V
                                                                                                                   87a
                                                                                                             1
                                                                                            ORN/RED P5-1           85
                                                                                                             1
                                       P-J8A                                                ORN/RED P4-1           86
                                                                                                             1
   YEL/RED EMS GND 2-1-3
                                        X3
                                          2  CONNECT TO P8                                                                                                             C
                BLK GND
                                          1  (MATING CONNECTOR OF J8)
                                       MOLEX SHT 1 ZONE D-7
                           X4
                                   B
                                   A
                                          CONNECT TO X1002
                                   C      SHT 1 ZONE F-6
                                                                                                                                                                       B
                                       DEUTSCH
                     X5
                           B
                                       CONNECT TO X1001
                           A
                           C           SHT 1 ZONE F-6
               DEUTSCH
   SHEET 10                                                                                                                                             1001119861-O
                               5                                    4                        3                           2                          1
                                                                                                                                                             MAE36370O
3121171                                                                                                                                                                    7-43
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
8 7 6 5 4
S3
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           S2
                                                                                                                             TO ENG DIAG CONN (ORIGINAL)
                           WHT - CAN SHIELD
                             BLK - CAN LOW
                            RED - CAN HIGH
WHT - IGNITION
WHT - IGNITION
                                                                                                                                                                                                      CAN TERMINATOR
                                                                   X2
X5
X9
X7
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                X4
                           12
                           11
                           10
                            9
                            8
                            7
                            6
                            5
                            4
                            3
                            2
                            1
                                                                                 1
                                                                                 3
                                                                                 5
                                                                                 2
                                                                                 4
                                                                                 6
                                                                                11
                                                                                 9
                                                                                 7
                                                                                12
                                                                                10
                                                                                 8
                                                                                                                                                           J
                                                                                                                                                           H
                                                                                                                                                           G
                                                                                                                                                           F
                                                                                                                                                           E
                                                                                                                                                           D
                                                                                                                                                           C
                                                                                                                                                           B
                                                                                                                                                           A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         C
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         B
                                                                                                                                                                                                                         A
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        J
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        H
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        G
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        F
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        E
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        D
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        C
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        B
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        A
                                                                                                                                                                                        PLTFM SNSR
                                  PLTFM SNSR                                               PLTFM SNSR
                                   RELAY #1                                                 RELAY #2
                                  87a
                                                                                            87a
                                  87
                                  30
                                  85
                                  86
                                                                                            86
                                                                                            85
                                                                                            30
                                                                                            87
                                                                                                                                                                                           4
                                                                                                                                                                                           3
                                                                                                                                                                                           2
                                                                                                                                                                                           1
                                                         RL503
RL502
                                                                                                                                                                                       X500
                                                                                                                                                                                         4
                                                                                                                                                                                         3
                                                                                                                                                                                         2
                                                                                                                                                                                         1
       C
                                   WHT P1
                                  WHT P9-1
                                              WHT P5-1
                                              WHT P4-1
                                                                                       WHT P4-2
                                                                                       WHT P5-2
                                                                                                      WHT P9-2
                                                                                                       WHT P3
                                                                                                                                                                                          WHT P5
                                                                                                                                                                                          WHT P4
                                                                                                                                                                                          WHT P6
                                                                                                                                                                                         WHT P10
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             NOTE:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             6 PIN CONNECTOR AND RELAYS LOCATED
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             ON THE LEFT SIDE OF THE CONTROL PLATFORM BOX.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                             IF SKYGUARD RELAYS ARE ON THE RIGHT SIDE, SEE SHEET 10.
S191 INTERFACE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        X5B                                KL
                                                                                                                                                           S192
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        WHT P6                                  BLACK P6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              2                                           SEE SHT 2 ZONE F6
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         SHEET 11
                           8                                                                      7                                                                                                            6                                                                                                                   5                                 4
7-44                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                       3121171
                      SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
5 4 3 2 1
                                        10
                                        11
                                        12
                                         1
                                         2
                                         3
                                         4
                                         5
                                         6
                                         7
                                         8
                                         9
                                                                            10
                                                                            11
                                                                            12
                                                                            1
                                                                            2
                                                                            3
                                                                            4
                                                                            5
                                                                            6
                                                                            7
                                                                            8
                                                                            9
                                                                    X383
                                 X878
                                                                                                                                                                CRIBBING ENABLE LAMP
                                                  GRN CANL_7
                                                  YEL CANH_5
RED/ORN 116
BLK/ORN 114
                                                                                                                                        1
                                                                                                                                        2
                                                                                                                                                     LB373
                                                                             RED 103
                                                                             BLK 102
                                                                                                                                      BLK/ORN 114
                                                                                                                                        BLK 113
                                                                                                 CRIBBING ENABLE SW                                                                                                                     G
                                                                                                           SW374
   SHEET 11                                                                                                                                                                                                              1001119861-O
              5   4                                            3                                                                                      2                                                           1
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                MAE36380O
3121171                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     7-45
 SECTION 7 - BASIC ELECTRICAL INFORMATION & ELECTRICAL SCHEMATICS
NOTES:
7-46                                                                3121171
                  3121171
            Corporate Office
           JLG Industries, Inc.
               1 JLG Drive
    McConnellsburg, PA 17233-9533 USA
          (717) 485-5161 (Corporate)
      (877) 554-5438 (Customer Support)
                (717) 485-6417